WWII Enemy Vehicles & Ordnance

Download as pdf
Download as pdf
You are on page 1of 307

r

TIf

-T

IF Tf-

,e

it I-, IfI,

J, T

f1TTITTift1',
14 41t,

ITIf

ffj

1', 4 IIIT1IT1

,W-r

ITI4
4

Tr fl!+ Tr

T1

4-1

IT7,r

7
44 TITITIITITITIT

IT17

III4

IT1

At

ENEMY ORDNANCE MATERIEL ERRATA


Page Page Page Page 46-Sub-head should read 1. gp. Mun. Trsp. Kw. (Sd. Kfz. 252). 74.43-Sub-head of first vehicle should read Fernschr. Kw. (Kfz. 72/1). 74.84-German nomenclature of first vehicle should read mittlerer Anhanger mit Betriebsstoffkesselanlage (o). 101-Sub-head should read 21 cm Mrs. mit Mrs. Laf. 18. In last paragraph instead of "17 cm Mrs." read 17 cm K. mit Mrs. Laf. 18. 105-Sub-head should read 15 cm s. F. H. 18. 107-Sub-head should read 10 cm K. 18. First line of first paragraph should read The 10 cm Field Gun K. 18.... Under "Specifications" muzzle velocity should be 2,68.Q f/s. 109-Under "Specifications" weight of projectile should read H.E. 33.2 lb. 111-Under "Specifications" weight of projectile should read (H.E.) 20.35 lb.; (A.P.) 20.75 lb. 113-Sub-head should read 8.8 cm Pak 43/41. First paragraph should read The Pak 43/41 instead of Pak 43. In line three of the last paragraph read Pak 43/41 instead of Pak 43. 117-Under "Specifications" delete Weight (firing
position) ... 3,040 lb.

A number of changes, largely in nomenclature and specifications, have been made in the Catalog from time to time, but many sets are in circulation without these changes. The following errata should be marked on the pages indicated if not already made in your Catalog. Volume I-German Section Page 16-Heading should read S.P. Heavy Field Howitzer (On French Lorraine Chassis). Page 17-Heading should read Ammunition Carrier (On French Lorraine Chassis). Page 21-Sub-head should read Pz. Jag. 38 fiir 7.62 cm Pak 36 (r) (Sd. Kfz. 139). Page 28-Under "Specifications" the weight should be 26.5 tons instead of 22 tons. Page 29-In sub-head, instead of figure "142," read 142/2. In the first and second paragraphs, instead of "Pz. Kw.," read Pz. Kpfw. Under "Specifications" the weight should be 27 tons instead of 22 tons. Page 32-Under "Specifications" the weight should be 26 tons instead of 24 tons. Page 33-Sub-head should read Stu. G. IV ("Brummbar) fir 15 cm Stu. H. 43 (Sd. Kfz. 166). the Armament "Specifications" Under should read Stu. H. 43 (15 cm s.I.G. 33). Page 34-Heading should read S.P. Antitank Gun "Rhinoceros" (formerly "Hornet"). Sub-head should read Pz. Jag. III/IV ("Nashorn") fir 8.8 cm Pak 43/1 (Sf) (Sd. Kfz. 164). End of first paragraph should read Comparative figures for weight and maximum road speed of "Hornet" and "Ferdinand" are: 25 tons and 22 m.p.h., 72 tons and 1212 m.p.h., respectively. Under "Specifications" the weight should be 25 tons instead of 28 tons. Page 37-Sub-head should read Pz. Kpfw. "Panther" (7.5 cm Kw. K. 42-L/70) (Sd. Kfz. 171). Second line of first paragraph should read 47 tons instead of 50 tons. Under "Specifications" the weight should 47 tons instead of 50 tons. The armament should read 7.5 cm Kw. K. 42-1 M. G. 34. Page 38-Sub-head should read Pz. Kpfw. "Tiger" (8.8 cm Kw. K. 36-L/56) (Sd. Kfz. 181). Under "Specifications" the weight should be 63 tons instead of 60 tons. Page 39-Heading should read S.P. Antitank Gun"Elephant" (formerly "Ferdinand"). Sub-head should read Pz. Jag. "Tiger" (P) "Elefant" fir 8.8 cm Pak 43/2 (Sd. Kfz. 184). In first line read 72 tons instead of 80 tons. In line eight of first paragraph read 2 2/5
/2 inches instead of 6 1 inches.

Page Page

Page Page Page

Page

Page

Under "Specifications" the weight should be 72 tons instead of 80 tons. Side armor should read 60 mm instead of 160 mm. Armament should read 8.8 cm Pak 43/2M. G. 34. 40-Sub-head should read Pz. Jag. "Tiger" fiir 12.8 cm Pak 44 (Sd. Kfz. 186). tc~B " armament should Under "Speci read 12.8 cm
it } F^ t 4 i

Page 123-First line in first paragraph should read The 7.5 cm Pak 41, Germany's latest... Page 125-Picture shown does not pertain to this item. Page 134-Sub-head should read 2 cm s PzB (Solothurn s/8-1100). Page 136-Under "Specifications" rate of fire should read 220 rounds (practical), 450 (theoretical). Page 207-Sub-head should read 7.92 mm Karabinei 98K (Mauser-Kar. 98K). Page 210-Sub-head should read 7.92 mm PzB 35 (p). Page 214-Sub-head should read 7.92 mm M. G. 34/41. Page 217-Sub-head should read 8.8 cm Raketenpanzerbiichse 43 (8.8 cm R PzB 43)-8.8 cm Raketenpanzerbiichse 54 (8.8 cm R PzB 54). Last word in first line should be spelled Raketenpanzerbiichse. Add to the end of first paragraph: An improved model with a face shield is known as 8.8 cm R PzB 54. Page 218-Sub-head should read Panzerfaust. The first paragraph should read The German rocket grenade, "Panzerfaust" (literally "armor fist") .. . Add the following as a fourth paragraph: Three models of the Panzerfaust exist with the following German nomenclature: Panzerfaust 30 Panzerfaust Klein 30 Panzerfaust 60 Page 306-Sub-head should read 3.7 cm Stielgranate 41. Volume II-Japanese Section Page 114 (Page 113 in later editions). Under "Specifications" Traverse should read 46. (This page refers to the 75 mm Field Gun, Model 95 (1935).)

,1

FtF ENEMY MATERIEL

INDEX TO VOLUME I
GERMAN
Air Compressor ......................... 74.79
Wurfkorper Leuchtpistole ............ 324 27 mm Multi-Star Signal Cartridge ..... 325 Sprengpatrone fur Kampfpistole ........ 325 Nebelpatrone fur Kampfpistole ......... 326 Deutpatrone fur Kampfpistole ......... 326 Fallschirm Leuchtpatrone fir Kampfpistole .................. 326 Mines Behelfs-Schiitzenmine S. 150 ........... 304.7 Glasmine 43 (f) ...................... 304.6 Holzmine 42 ......................... 304.3 Magnetic Hollow Charge Antitank Mine.. 304.5 Panzerwurfmine (L) .................. 304.4 Riegel Mine 43 (R. Mi. 43) Sprengriegel 43 (Spr. R. 43) ......... 304.2 Sprengmine 35 ....................... 305 Sprengmine 44 mit S. Mi. Z. 44 ......... 304.8 Tellermine (T. Mi. 29) ................. 304.1 Tellermine (T. Mi. 35) ................. 301 Tellermine (T. Mi. 35-Stahl) ....... 303 ... Tellermine (T. Mi. 42) ................. 302 Tellermine (T. Mi. Pilz 43) ............. 304 Rocket Ammunition 8.8 cm R. Pz. B. Gr. ................... 357 15 cm Wurfgranate 41 ................. 356 21 cm Wgr. 42 Spr. mit Hbgr. Z 35 K..... 355 28 cm Wurfkorper Spr................. 354 30 cm Wurfkorper Spr ............... 354.1 32 cm Wurfkorper M. Fl. 50 ............ 353 >Rocket-Propelled Bomb ................ 316 Ammunition, A. P., 7.5 cm for 7.5 cm Pak 41 . 306.2 Ammunition, A. P. C. B. C., H. E., 8.8 cm .... 308 Ammunition, Arrowhead, 5 cm ............ 307 Ammunition, Hollow Charge, 10.5 cm ....... 310 Amphibious Truck ....................... 58.2 ........... 62, 74.67 to 74.104 inc. 0 Anhanger fur Erdkabel ................... 74.74 Anhanger fir Fihrseil ................. 74.72 Anhanger fiir 74.73 fiir Fernsprechbau .............. Anhanger 74.73 Anhinger fur Langmaterial ............... . 74.72 Motorboot ................ Anhanger fuir 74.68, 74.69 Anhanger fuir Munition ............. 74.78 Anhanger fiir Sammlerladegerat ......... 74.78 Anhanger fir Schlauchtender ............. 74.94 Anhanger fur Sturmboot ................ ... 74.77 Anhanger fuir Tankspritze .......... 74.91 Anhanger fur Tragflachen ..............

AIRCRAFT ARMAMENT 219 7.92 mm M. G. 15 ................... 220 7.92 mm M. G. 17 ................... 221 7.92 mm M. G. 81 ................... 222 13 mm M. G. 131 .............. 251 20 mm M. G. F. F. M. (Oerlikon) ... 252 20 mm M. G. 151/20 (Mauser) ...... 25330 mm Mk. 101 (Rheinmetall) ....... 255 30 mm Mk. 108 A-3 ................ 74.85 Airplane Fuel Tank Trailer ................ 74.20, 74.21 Ambulance ....................... AMMUNITION Artillery Ammunition 307 5 cm Pzgr. Patr. 40 Pak ............ 306.2 Pzgr. Patr. 41 (W) ........ 7.5/5.5 cm 309 8 cm Wurfgranate 39 ................ 308 8.8 cm Pzgr. Patr. ................... 310 10.5 cm Gr. 39 Rot HL/C ............ 311 10.5 cm "Sabot" Type H. E. Shell .... 10.5 cm Steel Cartridge Case for 313 Recoilless Gun ..................... 17 cm Steel Cartridge Case, 314 Spiral Design ..................... 312 28 cm Rifled Projectile ................ Bombs 315 H . s. 293 ........................... 316 PC 1000 Rs ........................ Grenades 304.4 Panzerwurfmine (L) .................. 306 3.7 cm Stielgranate 41 ............... 306.1 15 cm Stielgranate ................... 317 Gewehr Sprenggranate ................ 317 Gewehr Panzergranate ................ 318 Gross Gewehr Panzergranate ........... 318 Gewehr Propaganda Granate .......... 319 ... ...... Schuss Gr. P-40 ............. 319 Gross Panzergranaten 61 u. 46 ......... 321 Stielhandgranaten 24 u. 39 .............. 321 Eierhandgranate 39 .................. 322 Shaving Stick Grenade ..... .......... 322 Nebelhandgranate 39 ................. 323 Nebelhandgranate 41 .................. 323 Blendkorper 1H u. 2H ................ 26 mm Wurfgranate Patrone 326 324 Leuchtpistole ......................

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 March, 1945

Ind. 1

INDEX TO VOLUME I
74.77 Anhanger fur Tragkraftspritze ............ Anhanger mit Betriebsstoffkesselanlage 74.84, 74.85 74.82, 74.83 Anhinger (offen) ................... 74.6 Antiaircraft Protection Truck .............. 74.40 Antiaircraft Survey Section Truck .......... 74.24 Antiaircraft Unit Car ..................... 67, 68, 69, 70 Armor, Tank (Chart) ............... ARMORED CARS Pz. Sp. Wg. II Luchs (Sd. Kfz. 123) "Lynx" .1 1. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 221, 222, 223) .... 4 s. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 231, 232, 263) 42 (6 R ad) ........................... s. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 231, 232, 263) 43 (8 R ad) ........................... 74.59 M. G. Kw. (Kfz. 13) .................. 74.60 Fu. Kw. (Kfz. 14) .................... 74.60 s. gl. gp. Pkw. (Sd. Kfz. 247) ........ 74.61 Pkw. (Sd. Kfz. 247) ........ s. gl. gp. 74.61' 221) ......... 1. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 74.62 ......... 1. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 222) 1. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Fu.) (Sd. Kfz. 223) ... 74.62 74.63 s. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 231) ........ s. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 231) (8 Rad). 74.63 74.64 s. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Fu.) (Sd. Kfz. 232) s. Pz. Sp. Wg. (Fu.) (Sd. Kfz. 232) 74.64 (8 R ad) ........................... 74.65 kl. Pz. Fu. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 260) ....... 74.65 kl. Pz. Fu. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 261) ....... 74.66 Pz. Fu. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 263) .......... Pz. Fu. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 263) (8 Rad) .. 74.66 307 Arrowhead Ammunition, 5 cm .............. 100.1 Artillery, Large Caliber (Chart) ............ ARTILLERY Antiaircraft Artillery 132 2 cm Flak (Madsen) ................. 135 2 cm Flak (30) ...................... 136 2 cm Flak 38 ........................ 137 ........... 2 cm Flak 38 Geb. ...... 133 2 cm Flakvierling 38 ................. 130.1 3.7 cm Flak 18 u. 36 .................. 129 4 cm Flak 28 (Bofors) ............... 125 . 5 cm Flak 41 ..................... 111 8.8 cm Flak 18, 36, 37 ................ 112 8.8 cm Flak 41 ...................... 109 ............ 10.5 cm Flak 38, 39 .... Antitank Artillery 132 2 cm Flak (Madsen) ................. ....... 136 2 cm Flak 38 ................. 137 2 cm Flak 38 Geb. .................. 133 2 cm Flakvierling 38 ................. 2 cm s Pz. B. (Solothurn s/8-1100) .... 134 131 2.8/2.0 cm Pz. B. 41.................. 3.7 cm Pak .......................... 130

GER k IAN

4.2/2.8 cm Pak 41 ............... 4.7 cm Pak (t) (Skoda) ......... 5 cm Pak 38 ................... 7.5 cm Pak 40 ................. 7.5 cm Pak 97/38 ............... 7.5/5.5 cm Pak 41 ............... 7.62 cm Pak 36 (r)........... 7.62 cm F. K. 39 (r) ........... 8.8 cm Pak 43 .................. 8.8 cm Pak 43/41 ............. 8.8 cm Flak 18, 36, 37 ...........

128 127 126 117 121 123 116 115 112.1 113 111

Field Artillery 119 7.5 cm L. G. 40 ................. 120 7.5 cm 1. F. K. 18 ............... 122 7.5 cm 1. I. G. 18 ............... 116.1 7.62 cm Feldkanone 36 (r) ....... 107 10 cm K. 18 .................... 110 10.5 cm L. G. 40 ............... 108 10.5 cm 1. F. H. 18 .............. 108.1 10.5 cm 1. F. H. 18 (M) ........ 104.1 . .. . ...... 15 cm K. 16 ........ 105 15 cm s. F. H. 18 ................ 104 15 cm s. I. G. 33 ................ 103 17 cm K. mit Mrs. Laf. 18...... 101 21 cm Mrs. mit Mrs. Laf. 18 ...... Mortars 124 5 cm 1. Gr. W. 36 ............... 114 8 cm s. Gr. W. 34 ............... 110.1 10 cm Nebelwerfer 35 ........... 110.2 10 cm Nebelwerfer 40.......... 106 42 .............. 12 cm s. Gr. W. 102 .... 20 cm Leichte Ladungswerfer Mountain Artillery 137 2 cm Flak 38 Geb. .............. 118 7.5 cm Geb. G. 36 ............... 108.2 10.5 cm Geb. H. 40............. Recoilless Guns 119 7.5 cm L. G. 40 ................. 110 L. G. 40 .............. 10.5 cm Self-Propelled Artillery 4 Pz. Jag. I fur 4.7 cm Pak (t) ....... 5 cm s. I. G. 33 .............. Gw. I fir 15 fir 7.5 cm Pak Pz. Jag. II Aus. A-E u. F 11 40 (Sd. Kfz. 131) ................... fur 7.62 cm Pak 36 Pz. Jag. II Aus. D, E 12 (Sd. Kfz. 131) ..................... 13 Gw. II fur 15 cm s. I. G. 33............. Gw. II (Wespe) fur 10.5 cm le. F. H. 18/2 14 (Sd. Kfz. 124) ..................... Pz. Jag. Lr. S. fur 7.5 cm Pak 40/1 (Sd. 15 K fz. 135) .......................... Gw. Lr. S. fr 15 cm s. F. H. 13 ......... 16 Pz. Jag. 38 fur 7.5 cm Pak 40/3 (Sd. Kfz.

138)

..............................

19

Ind. 2

1 March, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF 0 RD

ARfil

RESTRICTED

:.t~E

B~~C

INDEX TO VOLUME
Gw. fir 15 cm s. I. G. 33/1 (Sd. Kfz. 20 138/1) ............................ Pz. Jag. 38 fir 7.62 cm Pak 36 (r) (Sd. 21 Kfz. 139) ......................... 26 Sturmgeschitz 7.5 cm K. (Sd. Kfz. 142).. 26 Sturmgeschiitz 7.5 cm K. (Sd. Kfz. 142).. Sturmgeschiitz 1g. 7.5 cm Stu. K. (Sd. Kfz. 142) ........................ 2 Sturmgeschiitz 7.5 cm Stu. K. 40 (Sd. Kfz. 28 142) ... ......................... Sturmgeschiitz 10.5 cm Stu. H. 42 (Sd. 29 Kfz. 142/2) ........... ........ Stu. G. IV ("Brummbar") fur 15 cm Stu. H. 43 (Sd. Kfz. 166) .............. .... 33 Pz. Jag. III/IV ("Nashorn") fur 8.8 cm Pak 43/1 (Sf) (Sd. Kfz. 164) ......... 34 Gw. III/IV ("Hummel") fur 15 cm s. F. H. 18/1 (Sd. Kfz. 165) ...... ........ 35 Pz. Jag. ("Panther") fur 8.8 cm Pak 43/3 (Sd. Kfz. 173) ..................... 3 Pz. Jag. ("Tiger") (P) "Elefant" fur 8.8 39 cm Pak 43/2 (Sd. Kfz. 184) .......... Pz. Jag. ("Tiger") fir 12.8 cm Pak 44 (Sd. Kfz. 186) .......................... 40 Tank Guns 2 cm Kw. K. 30... 6, 7, 8, 10, 41, 42, 43, 65 2 cm Kw. K. 38................. 8.1, 41, 65 3.7 cm Kw. K. ............ ...... 22, 36, 65 . 18 3.7 cm Kw. K. (t) .................... 23, 65 5 cm Kw. K. (short) ................ 24, 25, 65 5 cm Kw. K. 39 ................. 7.5 cm Kw. K. (short).... 25, 26, 31, 36, 65 27 7.5 cm Ig. Kw. K. ...................... 31, 32, 65 7.5 cm Kw. K. 40 .............. 37, 65 7.5 cm Kw. K. 42 .................. 37, 65 7.5 cm Kw. K. 43 ................... 65 7.5/5.5 cm Taper Bore Kw. K. 41.......... 38, 65 8.8 cm Kw. K. 36 ................... 38.2, 65 8.8 cm Kw. K. 43 .................. Automotive Equipment (see Cars, Trucks, etc.) 74.85, 74.86 Backanhanger ......................
Beacon Trailer ..................... 74.87, 74.89

GERMAN

*
315 316 309 74.96 216 33 35 74.48 74.47 74.47 74.31 74.24 8.1 41 42 43 74.15 74.3 74.10 74.15 74.12 74.59 74.1 '74.16 74.17 74.61 74.8 74.9 74.60 74.65 74.66 74.66 74.23 47 60 74.64

romb, Glider, Radio-Controlled ............. Bomb, Rocket-Propelled ................... "Bouncing Betty" ........................ Box Car Trailer .................... Brno 7.92 mm M. G. 37 (t) ................. "Brummbar" ............................. "Bumblebee" ............................ Bus, Motor, Heavy ......................

74.95,

Bus, Motor, Light ........................ Bus, Motor, Medium ...................... Cable Surveying Truck .................... Car, Antiaircraft Unit, Light .............. Car, Armored, Full-Tracked ("Lynx") ...... Car, Armored, 4-Wheeled ................. Car, Armored, 6-Wheeled ................. Car, Armored, 8-Wheeled ................. Car, Cable Surveying .................... Car, Communications ..................... Car, Cross-Country, Medium ............... Car, Emergency Repair ................... Car, Flash and Sound Ranging, Medium...... Car, Machine Gun ........................ Car, Passenger. Light .................... Car, Personnel, Heavy ................... Car, Personnel, Cross-Country, Heavy ...... Car, Personnel, Armored, Cross-Country, Heavy .......................... 74.60, Car, Personnel, Medium ................... Car, Personnel, Cross-Country, Medium ..... Car, Radio ..... 74.4, 74.5, 74.11, 74.13, 74.14, Car, Radio, Armored, Small ............... Car, Radio, Armored ..................... Car, Radio, Armored, 8-Wheeled ........... Car, Reconnaissance .................... Car, Reconnaissance, Armored, Light ....... Car, Command, Reconnaissance ............ 74.63, Car, Scout, Armored, Heavy ......... Car, Scout, Armored, Heavy, 8-Wheeled 74.63, 74.61, Car, Scout, Armored, Light .........

Befehspanzerkraftwagen .................... Behelfs-Schiitzenmine .....................

3 304.7

74.67 .... ................. .... Beiwagen .... 74.86 Beleuchtungsanhanger .................... 47, 48, 74.27 Beobachtungskraftwagen ........... g 204, 205 Bergman 9 mm Submachine Gun ........ Betriebs-Funkempfangsanhanger ........... 74.89 Betriebsstoffkesselkraftwagen ........ 74.50, 74.51 Bildkraftwagen .......................... 74.41 Blendkorper ............................. 323 Bockwagen ................ .......... 74.95, 74.96 Bofors Antiaircraft Gun ............. .19 ,

74.64 74.62 74.10 74.11 Signal Communications ............... Car, 74.5, 74.6 Section, Light ........... Car, Survey Car, Telephone Exchange ............... 74.13 206.2 7.92 mm Gewehr 33/40.......... Carbine, 103 Field Gun .................... Carriage, (See S. P. Arti llery) Gun Motor ....... Carriage, Carrier, Ammunition (On French - Lorraine Chassis)........................... 17 Carrier, Ammunition, Armored, Light...... 46 Carrier, Personnel ..................... 74.22 Carrier, Personnel, Cross-Country, Light, ,74.1, 74.2 Carrier, Personnel, Armored, Light ........ 44 Carrier, Personnel, Armored, Medium ...... 45

RESTRICTED

OFCE CHIE

1 March, 1945

Ind. 3

INDEX TO VOLU1(

tMLy r

GERMAN

Carrier, Pontoon .................... ..... . 74.97 74.96 Carrier, Pontoon, Light ................... Cartridges, Propelling, Rifle Grenade (Chart) 320 Cartridge H. E., for 27 mm Grenade Pistol... 325 325 Cartridge, Signal, Multi-Star, 27 mm ........ Cartridge Case, Steel, for 10.5 cm Recoilless . 313 Gun .................................. 314 Case, Steel, Spiral Design, 17 cm... Cartridge 74.38 Charging Truck ......................... ..... 74.79 Compressor, Air .... ................ 63 Chemical Warfare Vehicles ............... 74.24 Commercial Truck ........................ 62.1 Crane, Gantry, Portable ................... 74.25, 74.26, 74.39 Cross-Country Truck ........... 326 Deutpatrone fur Kampfpistole .............. 74.81 Dieseleisbereiter als Anhanger ............. Direction & Range Finder Trailer ..... 74.80,.74.90 175, 176 Director, Antiaircraft ................. 320 Dischargers, Rifle, Spigot & Cup Types ...... 74.79 Doughkneading Trailer ................... 74.33 Druckereikraftwagen .................... 74.79 Drucklufterzeuger als Anhinger ............ 321 Egg Hand Grenade ...................... 321 Eierhandgranate ......................... 61 Electrical Repair Truck ................... 39 "Elephant" .............................. 74 Engines, Armored Force Vehicles (Chart) 73, 209 Fallschirmjager Gewehr ................... 326 Fallschirm Leuchtpatrone fir Kampfpistole.. 218 Faustpatrone ........................... 105, 108,108.1 Feldhaubitze .................... 115, 116.1, 120 Feldkanone .................... 74.26; 74.40 Feldfernkabelkraftwagen ............ 39 "Ferdinand" ............................. 74.38 Fernsprechbaukraftwagen ................ Fernsprech-Betriebskraftwagen . .74.13, 74.28, 74.42 74.17, 74.27, 74.39 Fernsprechkraftwagen ......... 74.88 Fernsprech-Vermittlungsanhanger .......... 74.28, 74.42, 74.43 Fernschreibkraftwagen ........ 74.26, 74.40 Field Telephone Cable Truck ......... FIRE CONTROL Antiaircraft Directors Kommando-Gerit 36 .................. Kommando-Gerat 40 .................. Sight Mount for 7.5 cm Howitzer (le. F. K. 18) ................................. Sight Mount for 10.5 cm Howitzer (le. F. H. 18) ................................. Sight Mount for 15 cm Howitzer (s. I. G. 33) Sight Mount for 7.5/5.5 cm A. T. Gun (Pak 41) ................................. Sight Mount for 8.8 icmA. T. Gun (Pak 175 176 177 177 177 178

43/41)

..............

. .

....

Sight Mount for 7.5 cm (Stu. K. 40) on Pz. 179 Kpfw. III Chassis F8, w/o rotary cupola.. Sight Mount for 7.5 cm (Stu. K. 40) S. P. on 179 Pz. Kpfw. III Chassis ................. Sight Mount for 7.5 cm Pak 40 mounted on 180 38 (t) Czech Chassis .................. Sight Mount for 7.62 cm Pak 36 (r) mounted 180 .......... on 38 (t) Czech Chassis .. Sight Mount for 10.5 cm (Stu. H. 42) on Pz. 181 Kpfw. III Chassis ..................... Sight Mount for 15 cm s. F. H. 13 on Lor181 raine Chassis ........................ 66 Sights, Tank and Armored Car (Chart).... 74.52, 74.53 Fire Engine ....................... 74.52 Fire Extinguisher Truck ................... 74.76 Fire Pump, Motor, Transportable ........... 109, 111, Flak (Flugzeugabwehrkanone) .... 112, 125, 129, 130.1, 132, 133, 135, 136, 137 74.23,74.24, 74.41 Flakkraftwagen ............... 74.40 Flakmesstruppkraftwagen ................. . . 133 . .......... Flakvierling ............... 9 Flame-thrower (on Light Tank) ........... 30 Flame-thrower (on Medium Tank) ......... 30 9, Flammenwerfer ........................ 74.35 Flash Ranging Station Truck .............. 74.33, 74.39 Flash Ranging Truck ............... 74.51 Flugbetriebsstoffkesselkraftwagen .......... Flugbetriebsstoff-Kesselwagen als Anhanger.. 74.85 74.50, 74.51 Fuel Servicing Truck ............... 74.84, 74.85 Fuel Tank Trailer .................. 74.88 Funkanhanger ........................... 74.43 Funkbetriebskraftwagen ................ 74.44 Funkhorchkraftwagen ..................... Funkkraftwagen ..... 74.4, 74.5, 74.11, 74.13, 74.14, 74.29, 74.44, 74.60 74.30, 74.46 Funkmastkraftwagen ............... 62.1 Gantry Crane, Portable .................... 118 Gebirgsgeschiitz .......................... 108.2 Gebirgshaubitze .......................... 74.15 Gefechtskraftwagen ..................... 74.86 Generator Trailer ........................ 74.74, 74.75, 74.76 Generator, Transportable ....... 100.1, 104, 110, 119, 122 Geschiitz ............. 208, 208.1 Gewehr ............................ 209 Gewehr, Fallschirmjager .................. 317, 318, 319 Gewehr Panzergranate ........... 318 Gewehr Propaganda Granate .............. 317 ,........ Gewehr-Sprenggranate ............ 304.6 Glasmine .............................. 315 Glider Bomb, Radio-Controlled ............. 212 Granatbiichse ............................ 106, 114, 124 Granatwerfer ................... 317 Grenade, Hand or Rifle, Antipersonnel ...... Grenade, Hand, Antitank, Hollow Charge... 304.4 321 .......... Grenade, Hand, Egg-Type ....... 321 Grenade, Hand, Stick ..................... 322, 323 Grenade, Hand, Smoke ............... 319 Grenade, Hollow Charge ................ 324 Grenade. Pistol ...........................

Ind. 4

1 March, 1945

ICEF

RESTRICTED

INDEX TO VOLUME I
g~N~~i~SMA

GERMAN

Grenade, Pistol, Illuminating Star on Para............ 326 ....... chute 326 Grenade, Pistol, Indicator ..... ............ .. ....... . 326 Grenade, Pistol, Smoke ....... Grenade, Rifle, Antitank ...... ........ 317, 318 Grenade, Rifle, Hollow Charge, H.E.A.T..... 319 Grenade, Rifle, Propaganda .... ............ 318 357 Grenade, Rocket, Antitank .... ............ ............ 322 Grenade, Shaving Stick ....... ............ 323 Grenade, Smoke ............ ........ 306, 306.1 Grenade, Stick ............... Grenade Dischargers, Rifle .... ............ 320 33 ............ "Grizzly Bear" ............... .... ............ 74.82 Grosskiihlbehalteranhanger Gun, Airborne, Recoilless ..... ............ 119 125, 129, 130.1, 135 Gun, Antiaircraft .......... Gun, Antiaircraft/Antitank (Ex-Danish), 132, 133, 136 112.1, 113, 115, 116, Gun, Antitank ........ 117, 121, 123, 126, 127, 128, 130, 131, 134 103, 104.1, 107, 116.1, 120 Gun, Field .......... Gun, Machine, Aircraft, 219, 220, 221, 222, 251, 252, 253, 255 Gun, Machine, Dual-Purpose ...... 213, 214, 215 216 Gun, Machine, Heavy (Ex-Czech) .......... 118 Gun, Mountain ........................... 137 Gun, Mountain, Antiaircraft/Antitank ...... 109, 111, 112 Gun, Multi-Purpose .............. 100.2 Gun, Railway ............................ 110, 119 Gun, Recoilless ....................... 72 71, Guns, Self-Propelled (Chart) ........... 4, 11, 12, 15, 19, Gun, Self-Propelled ....... 40 21, 26, 27, 28, 28.1, 29, 33, 34, 39, 204, 205, 206, 206.1 Gun, Submachine ........... 65 Guns, Tank (Chart) ...................... 123, 128, 131 Guns, Tapered Bore .............. 108 Gun-Howitzer ............................ Haubitze ...... 100.1, 105, 108, 108.1, 108.2, 122 "Hum m el" ................. ........... 35 . 304.3 H olzm ine ............................ 74.45 Horchfunkpeil-Kraftwagen ................ "H ornet" ................................ 34 Hose Truck .............................. 74.54 101 Howitzer, Heavy ......................... Howitzer, Medium ........................ 105 108.2 Howitzer, Mountain ...................... Howitzer, Field, Light .................... 108.1 Howitzer, Infantry ................... 104, 122 35 Howitzer, Self-Propelled .... 5, 13, 14, 16, 20, "Hunting Panther" ................... 38.1 ... Ice Maker, Diesel Engine .................. 74.81 Indicator Grenade ........................ 326 Instandsetzungkraftwagen ................. 74.7 Interceptor Truck ........................ 74.25 Jeep (Volkswagen) ....................... 59 Jeep, Amphibious ........................ 58.1 Kabelmesskraftwagen .............. 74.15, 74.31 Kampfpistole ............................ 201

100.1, 100.2, 103, 104.1, 107, 115, 116.1, 120 Karabiner ........................... 207, 208.2 Kettenschlepper ..................... 74.57, 74.58 "King Tiger" Tank ...................... 38.2 Kommando-Gerat ..................... 175, 176 Krad ................................. 50, 58 Kraftfahrdrehleiter ....................... 74.55 Kraftfahrsirene ......................... 74.4 Kraftfahrspritze ......... ........... 74.52, 74.53 Kraftomnibus ...................... 74.47, 74.48 Krankenkraftwagen ................. 74.20, 74.21 Ladder, Fire-Fighting, Motorized ........... 74.55 Ladungswerfer ........................... 102 Lastkraftwagen (offen), 74.24, 74.25, 74.26, 74.37, 74.46, 74.52 Launcher, Recoilless, Antitank Bomb ........ 218 Launchers, Rocket ..... 48.1, 217, 351, 352, 352.1 Leuchtfeueranhanger ............... 74.87, 74.89 Leuchtpistole .......................... 201 Lichtauswertekraftwagen ................ 74.33 Lichtmessgeratkraftwagen ................. 74.39 Lichtmesstellenkraftwagen ................ 74.35 Luger 9 mm Pistol ........... .............. 202 "Lynx" ................. ............... 8.1 Machine Guns .......... 213, 214, 215, 216, 219, 220, 221, 222, 251, 252, 253, 255 Machine Shop Truck ..................... 61 Madsen Antiaircraft Gun .................. 132 Maintenance Truck ............ 74.18, 74.21, 74.32 Mannschaftskraftwagen ..... 44.45, 60, 74.22, 74.23 Maschinengewehr ....... 213, 214, 215, 216, 219, 220, 221, 222, 251, 252, 253, 255 Maschinengewehrkraftwagen .............. 74.59 Maschinenpistole ............ 204, 205, 206, 206.1 Maschinensatz als Anhanger .... 74.74, 74.75, 74.76 Mauser 20 mm Machine Gun ............... 252 Mauser 7.92 mm Rifle ................. 207, 208.1 Measurement Range and Equipment Truck ... 74.36 Messtellen-und-Geratkraftwagen ........... 74.36 Messtruppkraftwagen ...... 74.5, 74.6, 74.12, 74.40 Meteorological Truck ................ 74.35, 74.45 Mine, Antipersonnel ..... 304.6, 304.7, 304.8, 305 Mine, Antitank, 301, 302, 303, 304, 304.1, 304.2, 304.3, 304.5 Mine, Antitank, Hollow Charge, Magnetic.... 304.5 M ine, Glass ........................... . 304.6 M obile Siren ............................. 74.4 M orser ............................. 100.1, 101 Morserlafette ........... ... ... 100.1, 101, 103 Mortar .......... 102,'106, 110.1, 110.2, 114, 124 Mortar Shell-"Bouncing Betty" ........... 309 Mortar, Spigot ........................... 102 Motorcycle, Heavy (With Sidecar) ......... 58 Motorcycle Tractor ....................... 50

Kanone

...........

RESTRICTED

CSCCI

1D

vu

1 March, 1945

Ind. 5

INDEX TO VOLUME
Motor-Karrete .........................

,
49

GERMAN

74.76 Motorspritze als Anhanger ................. 108.2, 118 Mountain Weapons .................. 17, 46 Munitionstransport ................... Nachrichtenkraftwagen .... 74.2, 74.3,. 74.10, 74.11 74.48 Nachrichtenwerkstattkraftwagen ........... 34 "Nashorn" ............................. 74.80, 74.90 Navigations-Funkpeilanhanger ........ 322, 323 Nebelhandgranate .................... 326 Nebelpatrone fur Kampfpistole ............. 110.1, 110.2, 351, 352 Nebelwerfer .............. 251 Oerlikon 20 mm Machine Gun .............. 74.85, 74.86 Oven, Field ........................ 74.55 Oxygen Tank Truck ..................... Pak (Panzerabwehrkanone), 112.1, 113, 116, 117, 121, 123, 126, 127, 128, 130 "Panther," Tank, Heavy ................. 37 "Panther," S-P Antitank or Assault Gun.... 38.1 38.1 "Panther," Hunting ...................... 131, 134, 210, 211 Panzerbiichse .............. 218 Panzerfaust .... ......................... . 74.65, 74.66 Panzerfunkwagen ...... .......... 306.2, 307, 308 Panzergranate Patrone .......... 40 Panzerjager .. 4, 11, 12, 15, 19, 21, 34, 38.1, 39, Panzerkampfwagen ..... 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 18, 22, 23, 24, 25, 30, 31, 32, 36, 37, 38, 38.2 74.8 Panzerkampfwagen-Nachbildung ........... Panzerspahwagen, 8.1, 41, 42, 43, 74.61, 74.62, 74.63, 74.64 48.1 Panzerwerfer ............................ ...... . 304.4 Panzerwurfmine .................. 74.31 Peilkraftwagen .......................... Personenkraftwagen ..... 59, 74.1, 74.2, 74.8, 74.9, 74.10, 74.16, 74.17, 74.60, 74.61 Personenkraftwagen (Gepanzerte), 44, 45, 46, 74.60, 74.61 74.41 Photographic Truck ...................... 74.37, 74.39 Pionierkraftwagen .................. 201 Pistol, Signal and Grenade ................. 202, 203 Pistol, Automatic .................... . 202, 203 Pistole ........................... 74.101, 74.102, 74.103 Plow, Snow ................ 74.96, 74.97 Pontonwagen ...................... 74.96, 74.97 Pontoon Carrier .................... Prime Movers. .51, 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 74.58, 74.59 74.33 Printing Press, Mobile ................... 312 Projectile, Rifled, 28 cm ................. Projectile, Rocket ..... 353, 354, 354.1, 355, 356 351, 352 Projector, Rocket ..................... 48.1 Projector, Rocket, Self-Propelled ........... 318 Propaganda Grenade ..................... 74.21, 74.22 Protzkraftwagen .................... "Piippchen" .............................. 352.1 74.30, 74.46 Radio Antenna Truck ................ 74.31 Radio Beacon Truck ...................... 315 Radio-Controlled Glider Bomb .............. 74.89 Radio Exchange Office Trailer .............. 74.44 Radio Interception Truck "... ............. Radio Teletype Truck ........ 74.43 F ...... (a

74.88 Radio Trailer ............................ 74.29, 74.44 Radio Truck ....................... 74.56, 74.57 Radschlepper ....................... 100.1,100.2 Railway Guns ..................... 217 Raketenpanzerbichse ..................... 357 Raketenpanzerbuchse Granate ............. 352.1 Raketenwerfer .......................... 74.98 Rampenwagen ....... ... ................ 74.36 Range Finder Truck ..................... 57, 74.58, 74.59 Raupenschlepper ................. 110, 119 Recoilless Guns ..................... 313 Recoilless Gun Ammunition ................ 47, 60, 74.23 Reconnaissance Cars ............... 74.27 Reconnaissance Truck ................... 74.82 Refrigeration Trailer ..................... 253 Rheinmetall 30 mm Aircraft Cannon ........ 34 "Rhinoceros" ............................ .. . 304.2 Riegel Mine .......................... 207 ... Rifle ................................ 210, 211 Rifle, Antitank ....................... 209 Rifle, Automatic, Paratroop ............... 212 Rifle, Grenade-Launching .................. 208, 208.1, 208.2 Rifle, Semi-Automatic ........... 312 Rifled Projectile ......................... (see Ammunition) Rockets ...................... ROCKET LAUNCHERS 8.8 cm Raketenwerfer 42-"Piippchen".. 352.1 8.8 cm Raketenpanzerbiichse 43 (8.8 cm R. PzB 43)-8.8 cm Raketenpanzer217 biichse 54 (8.8 cm R. PzB 54) ........ 352 .... 15 cm Nebelwerfer 41 ............ 15 cm Panzerwerfer 42 (Sd. Kfz. N. W .41) 48.1 351 .... 21 cm Nebelwerfer 42 ............ .... 316 Rocket-Propelled Bomb ............... 38.2 .... "Royal Tiger" Tank . ............... 311 .... Sabot Shell, H. E., 10.5 cm ............. .... 74.38 Sammlerkraftwagen .................. 74.55 .... Sauerstoff-Kesselkraftwagen ........... 74.34 .... Schallausnahme-Kraftwagen ........... 74.34 .... ............ Schallauswerte-Kraftwagen ... 74.100 Scheibenzuganhanger ................. Scheinwerferkraftwagen . .74.18, 74.19, 74.20, 74.39 74.54 .... Schlauchkraftwagen ................. 74.54 .... Schlauchtender ....................... 206 Schmeisser 9 mm Submachine Gun ...... .... 74.101, 74.102, 74.103 Schneepflug ................ 319 Schuss Granate .......................... 58.1, 58.2 Schwimmkraftwagen ................. 74.18, 74.19, 74.20 Searchlight Truck ............. See Artillery Self-Propelled Artillery ............. 322 Shaving Stick Grenade .................... 311 Shell, H. E., 10.5 cm (Sabot Type) .......... 309 Shell, Mortar, 8 cm "Bouncing Betty" ....... 74.67 ............. Sidecar for Motorcycle ....... 66 Sights for Tanks .and Armored Cars (Chart).. SIGHTING EQUIPMENT 177 for 7.5 cm Howitzer, 1. F. K. 18 ........ 177 for 10.5 cm Howitzer, 1. F. H. 18 ....... 177 :owitzer, s. I. G. 33 ........

Ind. 6

1 March, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

INDEX TO VOLUME
for 7.5/5.5 cm Antitank Gun, Pak 41.... 178 for 8.8 cm Antitank Gun, Pak 43/41.... 178 for 7.5 cm (Stu. K. 40) S. P. on Pz. Kw. III Chassis F8, w/o rotary cupola ..... 179 for 7.5 cm (Stu. K. 40) S. P. on Pz. Kw. III Chassis ..................... 179 for 7.5 cm Pak 40 mounted on Czech 38 (t) Tank ........ ..... ........ 180 for 7.62 cm Pak 36 (r) S. P. on Czech 38 (t) Chassis ...... ..... ..... 180 for 10.5 cm (Stu. H. 42) on Pz. Kw. III Chassis ........ ..... ... ..... . 181 for 15 cm s. F. H. 13 on Lorraine Chassis 181 Signal Cartridge ......................... 325 Signal Communication Truck ......... 74.2, 74.3 Signal Repair Truck ....................... 74.48 Siren, M obile ............................. 74.4 SMALL ARMS Machine Guns 7.92 mm M. G. 15 ................... 219 7.92 mm M. G. 17 ................... 220 7.92 mm M. G. 34 ................... 213 7.92 mm M. G. 34/41 ................ 214 7.92 mm M. G. 37 (t) (Brno) ......... 216 7.92 mm M. G. 42 ................... 215 7.92 mm M. G. 81 .................. 221 13 mm M. G. 131 .................... 222 20 mm M. G. F. F. M. (Oerlikon)..... 251 20 mm M. G. 151/20 (Mauser) ....... 252 30 mm Mk. 101 (Rheinmetall) ........ 253 30 mm Mk. 108 A-3 .................. 255 Pistols 9 mm Pistole '08 (Luger) ............ 202 9 mm Pistole 38 (Walther) ........... 203 27 mm Leuchtpistole (Walther) ....... 201 Rifles 7.92 mm Gewehr 33/40 ............... 206.2 7.92 mm Karabiner 98K (Mauser-Kar. 98K) ............................ 207 7.92 mm Gewehr 41 (W) ............. 208 7.92 mm Gewehr 41 (M) ............. 208.1 7.92 mm Karabiner 43 ................ 208.2 7.92 mm Fallschirmjager Gewehr 42 (F. G. 42) ......................... 209 7.92 mm PzB 35 (p) ................. 210 7.92 mm Panzerbuchse 39 (Pz. B. 39)... 211 7.92 mm Granatbuchse 39 (Gr. B. 39)... 212 Submachine Guns 7.92 mm M. P. 43 .................. 206.1 9 mm M. P. 181 (Bergmann) ......... 204 9 mm M. P. 34/1 (Bergmann) ........ 205 9 mm M. P. 38 u. M. P. 40 (Schmeisser) 206 Smoke Grenade ................ 322, 323, 326 Snow Plows ............... 74.101, 74.102, 74.103 Solothurn 2 cm Antitank Gun .............. 134 Sonderanhanger, 74.70, 74.71, 74.80, 74.81, 74.92, 74.93, 74.94 Sound Detector Truck .................... 74.34 Sound Plotting Truck .................... 74.34 Sound Equipment Trailer ................ 74.98

GERMAN

. ... .. .. . . 61 Spare Parts Truck ........... Spigot Mortar ............... . . . . . . . . . . 102 Spiral Design Cartridge Case ... ............ 314 Sprengmine .................. ... .. . . 305, 304.8 325 Sprengpatrone fir Kampfpistole ............ Sprengriegel . .. .............. .......... . 304.2 Stick Grenade ........................ 306, 306.1 Stielgranate ........ ................ . 306, 306.1 Stielhandgranate ......................... 321 Sturmgeschiitz ............... 26, 27, 28, 2 9, 33 Sturmgewehr 44 .......................... 206.1 Submachine Guns .............. (see Small A rms) Supporting Trailer ........................ 74.95 Surveying Trailer ........................ 74.90 TANKS Pz. Kpfw. I Aus. A (Sd. Kfz. 101) .... Pz. Kpfw. I Aus. B. (Sd. Kfz. 101) .... Pz. Kpfw. I kl. Pz. Bef. Wg. (Sd. Kfz. 265) ........................... Pz. Kpfw. II Aus. al, a2, a3, b, c....... Pz. Kpfw. II Aus. A, B, C (Sd. Kfz. 121) Pz. Kpfw. II Aus. D, E (Sd. Kfz. 121)... Pz. Kpfw. II (F) (Sd. Kfz. 122) Flammenwerfer....... .... ..... Pz. Kpfw. II Aus. F (Sd. Kfz. 121)..... Pz. Kpfw. 38 (t) .................. Pz. Kpfw. III Aus. A, B, C, D, E (Sd. Kfz. 141)....... .... ........ Pz. Kpfw. III Aus. F, G, H (Sd. Kfz. 141) Pz. Kpfw. III Aus. J, K, (Sd. Kfz. 141) Pz. Kpfw. III Aus. L, M, N. 0 (Sd. Kfz. 141) ..... ..... ........... Pz. Kpfw. III (Fl. W. 41) ........... Pz. Kpfw. IV Aus. A, B, C, D, E (Sd. Kfz. 161) ...................... ... Pz. Kpfw. IV Aus. fl, F2, G, H, K (Sd. K fz. 161) ......................... Pz. Kpfw. V ....... ................ Pz. Kpfw. "Panther" (7.5 cm Kw. K.42-L/70) (Sd. Kfz. 171) ........... Pz. Kpfw. "Tiger" (8.8 cm Kw. K. 36L/56) (Sd. Kfz. 181) ........... Pz. Kpfw. "Tiger" (8.8 cm Kw. K. 43L/71) (Sd. Kfz. 182) ............... 38.2 Tanks (Chart) ........................... 64 Tank Destroyer ............. (see S. P. Artillery) Tank, Dummy ........................... 74.8 Tank Guns ........... ........ (see Artillery) Tank, Heavy, Experimental ............... 36 Tank, Heavy ("Panther") .................. 37 Tank, Heavy ("Tiger") ................... 38 Tank, Heavy (Redesigned "Tiger") ........ 38.2 Tank, Light ........... 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 18 Tank, Command, Light ................... 3 Tank, Light, Flamethrower ................ 9 Tank, Medium ......... 22, 23, 24, 25, 30, 31, 32 Tank, Medium, Flamethrower ............. 30 Tank Transporter .............. 62, 74.99, 74.100 Tankspritze ................... ... ........ . 74.53 Taper Bore Ammunition ................... 306.2 Taper Bore Guns ................ 123, 128, 131

RESTRICTED

41 ,

CJ

71^

1 March, 1945

Ind. 7

INDEX TO VOLUME
Teigknetanhanger ....................... 74.79 Telephone Construction Truck ............. 74.38 Telephone Exchange Car .................. 74.13 Telephone Exchange Trailer ............... 74.88 Telephone Exchange Truck ................ 74.42 Telephone Generator Truck ................ 74.28 Telephone Truck ......................... 74.17 Teletype Connection Trailer ................ 74.87 Teletype Truck ................ 74.28, 74.42, 74.43 Tellermine ............. 301, 302, 303, 304, 304.1 Tiefladeanhanger ....................... .. 74.99 Tiefladeanhanger fir Panzerkampfwagen, 62, 74.99, 74.100 "Tiger" Heavy Tank ...................... 38 "Tiger" Redesigned Heavy Tank ........... 38.2 "Tiger," King or Royal .................... 38.2 Tractor, Heavy .......................... 74.57 Tractor, Light ...................... 74.56, 74.57 Tractor, Medium .................... 74.56, 74.58 Tractor, Motorcycle ....................... 50 Trailers ..................... 74.67 to 74.100 inc. Trailer for Airplane Wings ................ 74.91 Trailer for Assault Boat .................. 74.94 Trailer, Airplane, Fuel Tank ............... 74.85 Trailer, Beacon .... ................. 74.87, 74.89 Trailer, Box Car ................... .74.95, 74.96 Trailer, Direction and Range Finder... 74.80, 74.90 Trailer, Doughkneading ................... 74.79 Trailer, Fuel Tank ....................... 74.84 Trailer, Generator, Light ................. 74.86 Trailer, Radio ........................... . 74.88 Trailer, Radio Exchange Office ............. 74.89 Trailer, Refrigeration, Large .............. 74.82 Trailer, Sound Equipment ................. 74.98 Trailer, Supporting, Light ................. 74.95 Trailer, Surveying, Heavy ................. 74.90 Trailer, Telephone Exchange .............. 74.88 Trailer, Teletype Connection ............... 74.87 Trailer, Winch ...................... ..... . 74.100 Train, Workshop .......................... 61 Transporter, Tank .............. 62, 74.99, 74.100 Truck, Airplane Fuel Servicing ............ 74.51 Truck, /4 -ton, Amphibious ................ 58.2 Truck, Antiaircraft Protection ............. 74.6 Truck, Antiaircraft Survey Section ........ 74.40 Truck, Antiaircraft Unit ............ 74.23, 74.41 Truck, Cable Surveying .................. 74.31 Truck, Charging ......................... 74.38 Truck, Commercial, Light (Open) .......... 74.24 Truck, Cross-Country (Open) ... 74.25, 74.26, 74.39 Truck, Electrical Repair .................. 61 Truck, Fire Extinguisher ................. 74.52 Truck, Flash Ranging. .............. 74.33, 74.39 Truck, Flash Ranging Station .............. 74.35 Truck, Fuel Servicing ....... ........ 74.50, 74.51 Truck, Hose .................. ...... ...... 74.54 Truck, Interceptor ........................ 74.45 Truck, Light .............. . . .

GERMAN

74.22 Truck, Limber ........................... 61 '...... . Truck, Machine Shop ............. 74.18, 74.21, 74.32 Truck, Maintenance ........... Truck, Measurement Range and Equipment.. 74.36 74.35, 74.45 ....... Truck, Meteorological ....... 74.46 Truck, Motor, Heavy (Open) ............. 74.37 Truck, Motor, Medium (Closed) ........... 74.37 Truck, Motor, Medium (Open) ............ 74.55 Truck, Oxygen Tank ..................... 74.41 Truck, Photographic ..... . ... .......... 74.29, 74.44 Truck, Radio ....................... 74.30, 74.46 Truck, Radio Antenna ............... 74.31 Truck, Radio Beacon ................... 74.44 Truck, Radio Interception ................. 74.43 .......... Truck, Radio Teletype ......... 74.36 Truck, Range Finder ..................... 74.27 Truck, Reconnaissance .................... Truck, Searchlight, Light ...... 74.18, 74.19, 74.20 74.2, 74.3 Truck, Signal Communications ........ 74.48 Truck, Signal Repair ..................... 74.34 Truck, Sound Detector .. ................. 74.34 Truck, Sound Plotting .................... 61 Truck, Spare Parts ....................... 74.17 Truck, Telephone ......................... 74.26, 74.40 Truck, Field Telephone Cable ......... 74.38 Truck, Telephone Construction ............. 74.42 Truck, Telephone Exchange ............... 74.28 Truck, Telephone Generator ............... ..... 74.28, 74.42, 74.43 Truck, Teletype .......... 61, 74.49 Truck, Workshop ...................... 74.6 Truppenluftschutzkraftwagen .............. 63 Vehicles, Chemical Warfare ................ Vehicle, Observation, Armored, 4-wheeled/ Tracked ............................... 48 49 Vehicle, Reconnaissance, Wheeled/Tracked... 74.7 Vehicle, Repair, Small ..................... 74.90 Vermessungsanhanger .................... 74.36 Vermessungsgeratkraftwagen .............. 74.18, 74.32 Verstarkerkraftwagen .............. 59 58.1, Volkswagen ......................... 74.98 Vollgatter ............................... 74.37 Waffenmeister-Geratkraftwagen ............ 74.37 Waffenmeister-Werkstattkraftwagen ........ 74.98 .................... Wagon, Bridging .... 208 ....... Walther 7.92 mm Rifle ......... .... . 203 Walther 9 mm Pistol, 38 ...... ....... 201 Walther 27 mm Signal Pistol ... 14 ....... . "W asp" ................ . ... . 74.53 Water Tank, Fire Fighting ...... .. 61, 74.49 W erkstattzug ................. .74.35, 74.45 Wetterkraftwagen ............ ...... 74.100 Winch Trailer ................ 61 ..... Workshop Train .............

Workshop Truck ...............

....

61, 74.49

. . 309, 356 . .. Wurfgranate . .. 324 Wurfgranate Patrone 326 Leuchtpistole ..... 324 Wurfkorper Leuchtpistole ................. 354.1 Wurfkorper Spr. ....................... 56 aftwagen ........... 51, 52, 53, 54, 55, S

Ind. 8

Marc]h,

1945

OFFICEHI

1FOfbiANCE

RESTRIC TED

CATALO

OF ENEMY ,MATERIEL

INDEX TO WEAPONS BYiALiBER


GERMAN
7.92 mm Submachine Gun, M. P. 43 ............... Carbine, Gewehr 33/40 .................. Rifle, Kar. 98K ......................... Semiautomatic Rifle, Gewehr 41 (W) ...... Semiautomatic Rifle, Gewehr 41 (M) ...... Semiautomatic Rifle, Kar. 43 ............. Automatic Rifle, Paratroop, F. G. 42 ....... Antitank Rifle, Pz. B. 35 (p) .......... Antitank Rifle, Pz. B. 39 ............... Grenade Launching Rifle, Gr. B. 39 ........ Dual-Purpose Machine Gun, M. G. 34 ......
Dual-Purpose Machine Gun, M. G. 34/41 ... 206.1 206.2 207 208 208.1 208.2 209 210 211 212 213 214 215 216 219 220 221 50 mm Light Mortar, 5 cm, 1. Gr. W. 36 ........... Antiaircraft Gun, 5 cm, Flak 41 .......... Antitank Gun, 5 cm, Pak 38 .............. 75/55 mm Tapered Bore Antitank Gun, 7.5/5.5 cm, Pak
41 ..................................

124 125 126 123


117 118 119 120 121 122

Dual-Purpose Machine Gun, M. G. 42 ...... Heavy Machine Gun, M. G. 37 (t) ......... Flexible Aircraft Machine Gun, M. G. 15.... Fixed Aircraft Machine Gun, M. G. 17.... Flexible Aircraft Machine Gun, M. G. 81.... 9 mm Automatic Pistol 08 . Automatic Pistol 38 . 1 .18 . .. . .. . . . . ... . 181 ......... .. Submachine Gun, M. 34/1 ........... Submachine Gun, M. Submachine Gun, M. 38 & 40 .......

75 mm Antitank Gun, 7.5 cm, Pak 40 ............ Mountain Gun, 7.5 cm, Geb. G. 36 ......... Recoilless Airborne Gun, 7.5 cm, L. G. 40... Light Field Gun, 7.5 cm, 1. F. K. 18 ........ Antitank Gun, 7.5 cm, Pak 97/38 ......... Light Infantry Howitzer, 7.5 cm, 1. I. G. 18.. 76.2 mm

Antitank Gun, 7.62 cm, F. K. 39 (r) ..... 115 Antitank Gun, 7.62 cm, Pak 36 (r) ...... 116 Field Gun, 7.62 cm, F. K. 36 (r) ........... 116.1
81 mm Heavy Mortar, 8 cm, s. Gr. W. 34 ......... 114 88 mm Multi-Purpose Gun, 8.8 cm, Flak 18, 36, 37.. 111 Multi-Purpose Gun, 8.8 cm, Flak 41 ....... 112 Antitank Gun, 8.8 cm, Pak 43 .......... 112.1 Antitank Gun, 8.8 cm, Pak 43/41 ....... 113 105 mm Field Gun, 10 cm, K. 18 ..... .......... 107 Gun-Howitzer, 10.5 cm, 1. F. H. 18 ......... 108 Light Field Howitzer, 10.5 cm, 1. F. H. 18 (M) . ......... ..................... 108.1 Mountain Howitzer, 10.5 cm, Geb. H 40..... 108.2 Multi-Purpose Gun, 10.5 cm, Flak 38, 39.... 109 Recoilless Gun, 10,5 cm, L. G. 40 .......... 110 Smoke Mortar, 10 cm, Nebelwerfer 35 ..... 110.1 Smoke Mortar, 10 cm, Nebelwerfer 40..... 110.2 120 mm Mortar, 12 cm, s. Gr. W. 42 ............... 106 150 mm Heavy Infantry Howitzer, 15 cm, s. I. G. 33 104 Heavy Field Gun, 15 cm, K. 16 .......... 104.1 Medium Howitzer, 15 cm, s. F. H. 18 ...... 105 172.5 mm Field Gun on 21 cm Carriage, 17 cm K. mit Mrs. Laf. 18 ..................... . 103 200 mm Spigot Mortar, 20 cm, leichte Ladungswerfer 102 210 mm Heavy Howitzer, 21 cm, Mrs. mit Mrs. Laf.
18 .................................

202 203 204 205 206

13 mm Fixed or Flexible Aircraft Machine Gun, M . G. 131 ............................ 222 20 mm A.A./A.T. Gun, 2 cm, Flak (Madsen) ...... 132 A.A./A.T. Gun, 2 cm, Flakvierling 38 ...... 133 A.T. Gun, 2 cm, s. Pz. B. (Solothurn s/8-100) 134 Antiaircraft Gun, 2 cm, Flak 30 ........... 135 A.A./A.T. Gun, 2 cm, Flak 38 ............ 136 A.A./A.T. Mountain Gun, 2 cm, Flak 38 Geb. 137 Aircraft Machine Gun, 20 mm, M. G. F. F. M. (Oerlikon) ........................... 251 Aircraft Machine Gun, 20 mm, M. G. 151/20 252 28/20 mm Tapered Bore Antitank Gun, Pz. B. 41...... 131 27 mm Signal and Grenade Pistol, Leuchtpistole... 201 37 mm Antitank Gun, 3.7 cm, Pak ............ 130 Antiaircraft Gun, 3.7 cm, Flak 18 & 36..... 130.1 40 mm Antiaircraft Gun, 4 cm, Flak 28 (Bofors)... 129 42/28 mm Tapered Bore Antitank Gun, 4.2/2,8 cm, Pak 41 .................................. 128 47 mm Antitank Gun, 4.7 cm, Pak (t) ............ 127
RESTICTE

101
100.2

280 mm Railway Gun, 28 cm, K 5 (E) ............


1f'March, 1945 1 March, 1945

\s777_
RESTRICTED
-:iP i: z

md.

Ind. 9

FULL-TRAC
Pz. Sp. Wg. II

GERMAN Q

This vehicle, one model of which is shown above, is called an armored car by the Germans. Production began in 1941 and continued through 1943. Models VK 1201, VK 1202, and VK 1303 were manufactured by Maschienfabrik Augsburg-Nurnberg. The box-shaped superstructure is built in with the hull chassis. The thickness of armor of the Lynx is 30 mm on the front of the turret and hull and 20 mm on the turret and hull sides. One gasoline tank located inside on the right holds 83 gallons. Track guards are provided well over the sprockets and idlers only. The turret roof slopes down towards the front and terminates in a cylindrical shape. The engine compartment is at the rear. Old models had smoke projectors, three on each side which were electrically operated. New model 1303 has no such provision. Throat microphones were used for intra tank communication. Periscopes and an optical sighting device are provided in the turret. The suspension consists of torsion bar straddle-mounted Christie type bogie wheels with center guide steel track, front drive sprocket and rear idler. The first two models were equipped with Dreislufenlenkung, three-step clutch type steerinc, while Model VK 1303 has the same system as the Panther-Einradien-Lenkqetriebe, one radius steering. Evolution of this vehicle stems from development of the Pz. Kpfw. II, Models D and E. It is believed that this vehicle served its main purpose in perfecting one radius steering. The transmission is synchromesh selective and adapts itself to the steering mechanism. There are seven speeds forward and one reverse; synchromesh cones are provided for all gear ratios except low and reverse.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ............................... ................ 12.9 tons
15 ft., 2 ins. Length (overall) ..............................

Width (overall) ................................ Height (overall) ................................

8 ft., 11/2 ins. ins. 7 ft., 3


16 ins.

Ground clearance ..........................................

Tread centers ...................................... 6 ft., 10 ins. Ground contact .................................... 7 ft., 3 ins.
Width of track ..................... Track links ....................... ......................... ins. 14 ........... ........................ 67 Pitch of track ..................................

Fording depth .................................... 4 ft., 7 ins. Theoretical radius of action Roads ................................................... 155 miles Cross-country ........................................ 93 miles Speed Roads ............... . ................................ . 50 m .p.h. Cross-Country .................................... 25-30 m.p.h. Armor Front .......................................................... 30 mm Sides .............................................. 20 mm Armament..........................One 2 cm Kw. K. 38 and one 7.92 mm M. G. 34 Ammunition (Rds.).... 400 (2 cm): 1.200 (M. G. 34) Engine ........................................ 178 British B.H.P. Transmission........Synchromesh, 7 speeds forward;
I reverse

Steering.......... One radius double drive epicyclic Crew ............................................... . . ..................

RESTRICTED

fOi

JIJ

/'i.n
8;;U

.
li' F
**\ i ^, ,'~

]
l
baiiC
^ F!
3

C
E
'

8.1

MP 8 Kj

f ^ I

SELF PROPELLED ANTITANK GUN


Pz. Jag. 38 fiir 7.5 cm Pak 39 (L/48)

GERMAN

SLD

The chassis of this self-propelled antitank gun is a modified version of the chassis for the Czech Model 38 tank. (See page 18.) The lower nose of the hull is 60 mm thick set at 400 and interlocked with the sides and upper nose plate. The upper nose plate is 60 mm thick. It is positioned at an angle of 60 and extends to the top of the superstructure. Brinell hardness is approximately 240. All-welded construction is employed except in attaching roof and superstructure rear plates which are bolted on for reasons of accessibility. The two latter plates are 8 mm horizontal and 8 mm at 70 respectively. The side superstructure plates are 20 mm set at 40 with a brinell hardness of approximately 195. The hull floor plate is 10 mm. Side apron plates of 5 mm give added protection against high explosive shell fire. The 7.5 cm Pak 39 (L/48), mounted 15 inches to the right of the hull center line, has an improved type of recoil mechanism. This allows the muzzle brake to be discarded. Elevation is from
-6 to +100. Traverse overall is 16 (-11 right -5 left). A

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight in action ........................................ 17.6 tons
ins. Length (overall excluding gun).... 15 ft., 11 Width (overall) .............................. 8 ft., 7/Va ins. 6 ft., 10V/ ins. Height (overall) ............................ Ground clearance .................... 1 ft., 4/4 ins.

Tread centers ...............................


Ground contact ............................

6 ft., 101/2 ins.


8 ft., 111/2 ins.

Width of track ..........................

1 ft.,

1/4 ins.

new type machine gun mount is built in the roof. The machine gun is fitted with a periscopic sight and extended trigger, and may be traversed in any direction and fired from within. A Sfl ZF la sight and an episcope is provided for the main gunner. The sight projects through the roof. The loader has an episcope fitted in the rear portion of his hatch fixed at 6 o'clock. The steering mechanism is the usual controlled differential type which allows curves of 29 /2 foot radius without "steering losses." Curves of smaller radius are obtained by using the track brakes of the additional clutch brake system also provided. There are two fuel tanks with a total capacity of 85 gallons. Ground pressure is 11.9 pounds per square inch. The power to weight ratio is approximately 9 HP per ton. The Fu 5 radio is fitted. Commanders equipments carry an additional Fu 8.

4.1 ins. Pitch of track ................................................ ......... 96 Track links ....................................... Fording depth ............................... 2 ft., 11 ins. Theoretical radius of action Roads ................................................... . 100 miles Cross-country ........................................ 50 miles Speed Roads ...................................................... 16 m .p.h. Cross-country ........................................ 9 m.p.h. Armor 60 mm at 40 Hull nose plate (lower) ........ Hull side plate ............... 20 mm undercut 15 Hull tail plate .......................... 20 mm at 15 Glacis plate (upper nose) ............ 60 mm at 60 Superstructure side plates............ 20 mm at 40 8 mm at 70 Superstructure rear plate......... Gun mantlet ................................ 30 mm rounded Armament....................7.5 cm Pak 39 (L/48); one M. G. 34; one M. G. 44. Ammunition (Rds.)..........7.5 cm gun, 41 rds.; M. G. 34, 600 rds.;* M. G. 44, 180 rds. Engine............Czech EPA (Type TZJ), 6-cyl., inline, 158 hp. at 2,600 r.p.m. Transmission..................5 speeds forward, 1 reverse Steering ........................ Epicyclic, clutch brake type .............................. 4 Crew .................................... *In addition to the ammunition mentioned above, 12 rounds of signal ammunition, 20 egg hand gqzp IJr&4 grenades, and 6 smoke candles are

RESTRICTED

20.1

SELF-PROPELLED ASSAULT GUI


Stu. G. IV fiir 7.5 cm Stu. K. 40 (L/48)

4'
L

GERMAN

This equipment, consisting of the 7.5 cm Stu. K. 2 mounted on the Pz. Kpfw. IV chassis, represents a furthe ment in German assault guns. The design follows that of Sits predes, cessor, the Stu. G. 40, mounted on the Pz. Kpfw. III chassis with the exception that in the later equipment the usual key,stone gun mantlet has been replaced by a cast steel mantlet wi th curved surfaces to offer the maximum projectile deflection. Th .e mantlet, 130 mm thick, houses the buffer and recuperator. Armor protection has been increased by the additic n of slabs of concrete six inches thick attached to the front plate ar Ld the roof over the driver's compartment by means of wire. The rest of the armor is the same as that provided for the Pz. Kpfw. IV. The division of chassis space follows the usual design for this type of vehicle, with the driver's compartment in the front, the fighting compartment in the center, and the engine co,mpartment in the rear. The gun, the Stu. K. 40 (L/48), with muzzle brake, is a lengthened version of the Stu. K. 40 (L/43) and is similar in clesign and performance to the Kw. K. 40 (L/48). In the inset above is shown the 7.5 cm Stu. K. 40 (L/48) mounted on the Pz. Kpfw. III chassis which also has the improved type of rounded gun mantlet.
i F r -

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ...........................................................
19 ft., 4 ins. Length ..................................................

9 ft., 7 ins. W idth ..................................... H eight ..................... ........................................ Ground clearance ........................................ 15 ins. Tread centers ...................................... 7 ft., 11 ins. Ground contact ................................ 11 ft., 6 ins. W idth of track .......................................... . 15 ins. Pitch of track .......................................... 4/ ins.
Track links ................ Theoretical radius of action ............................ 98

Fording depth ........................................... 3 ft. 130 miles Roads ....................... ............... Cross-country ........................................ 80 miles Speed
..................................... . ....... 28 m.p.h. Roads ..................................... Cross-country ................................... 15 m.p.h.

Armor Front nose plate ........................................ 75 mm ..................... 30 mm Sides .................................


Armament ........................ 7.5 cm Stu. K. 40 (L/48)

Ammunitions (Rds.) ......................................


Engine ...................... Maybach HL 120 TRM, 320 hp. Transmission........Synchromesh-6 speeds forward, 1 reverse. Steering ....................... ..... Epicyclic. clutch brake
.. crew.................................. rew .......................................................................... .5

3 X4_

'

RESTRICTED

MlJN

1 April, 1945

32t1

SELF-PROPELLED Al
Pz. Kpfw. IV (3.7 cm Flak

F GINi

GERMAN
C

This equipment consists of the standard Pz. Kpfw. IV chassis adapted to mount the 3.7 cm Flak 43. It is essentially an antiaircraft weapon, although the gun may be depressed for use against ground targets. The superstructure is especially designed for the second purpose. The side and rear walls of the structure are two spaced 15 mm armor plates nine feet long, eight feet, eight inches wide, and four feet high. The sides can be pushed outwards and downwards to a horizontal position to permit fire against ground targets or to extend the area of the loading platform.
The 3.7 cm Flak 43, wvhich has a

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight Length Width H eight ................................................ 26 tons (est.) .................................................. 19 ft., 4 ins. 9 ft., 7 ins. ............................................... ....................... .......................................
........................................ ........ 11 ft., 15 ins. 6 ins. 7 ft.. 11 Ins.

Ground clearance

Tread centers .......................

Ground contact ............................

tion, is centrallymounted on a pedestal. It is hung from a single trunnion on the right through which passes the feed and ejection aperture. The monobloc barrel is fitted with a combination muzzle brake and flash hider. Both elevating and traversing handwheels are located to the right of the gun. A hydromatic-spring buffer with variable recoil is situated below the barrel, and two return springs lie side by side above the barrel. A tri-sectional gun shield sloped at 30 to the vertical is provided. The center section is 9 mm thick and two side sections each 6 mm thick. The height of the shield, measured up the slope, is four feet, 3/2 inches. The gun is fed horizontally from the left by clips of eight rounds each which are placed on a fixed loading tray. The muzzle velocity of the 3.7 cm Flak 43 is reported as 2,750 f/s, and its theoretical rate of fire 250 rounds per minute. The ammunition issue laid down per equipment is reported as 1,600 rounds, 1,280 high explosive and 320 armor piercing. An official German document states that the standard sight for this gun will be the Schwebedornvisier.

360

6 traverse and 900 eleva-

15 ins. Width of track .............................................. ... 43 ins. Pitch of track ..................................... ............. ............. 98 Track links ........................
Fording depth ............................ ........................ 3 ft.

Theoretical radius of action Roads ................................................... Cross-country ......................................


Speed

130 miles 80 miles


25 m.p.h. 15 m.p.h.

Roads ................................................. Cross-country ........................................ Armor

50 mm Front plate ............................................. ......... 30 mm ... Sides ................................ Armament ...................................... . 3.7 cm Flak 43 1,600 Ammunition (Rds.) ..........................................
Engine......................Maybach HL 120 TRM, 320 hp. Transmission........Synchromesh-6 speeds forward, 1 reverse. Steering .................................. Epicyclic, clutch brake 7 ........................ Crew ...............................................

32.2

1 April,

1945
4

sb

RESTRICTED

__

SELF PROPELLED ATITA

,GUI

GERMAN

Pz. Jag. IV fiir 7.5 cm Stu. K. 42 (L/70) Sd. Kfz. 162

This self-propelled antitank gun consists of the 7.5 cm Stu. K. 42 (L/70) mounted on a modified Pz. Kpfw. IV chassis. The vehicle is of all-welded construction except that the fighting compartment roof is bolted. The upper and lower nose plates are interlocked with each other and with the hull sides. The upper nose plate, set at an angle of 45 to the vertical, has a thickness of 80 mm. The lower nose plate, set at an angle of 55 to the vertical, has a thickness of 45 mm. The superstructure front plate is interlocked with the superstructure side plates and additional strength is provided by two brackets which are welded into recesses in the hull sides and bolted to plates welded to the superstructure front. The crew compartment occupies the front three-quarters of the vehicle and accommodates a crew of five. The remaining quarter houses the engine which is the standard Maybach HL 120 as fitted in the Pz. Kpfw. IV. The gun, which has no muzzle brake, is bailastically similar to the 7.5 cm Kw. K. 42 as mounted on the Pz. Kpfw. Panther. It is located eight inches to the right of the hull center line. The hydraulic buffer and hydropneumatic recuperator are mounted above the piece, the buffer being on the left. The recoil gear is protected by a cast mantlet with curved outer surfaces. Stowage is provided for 55 rounds of ammunition, all except four being stowed horizontally. A port is provided in the superstructure front plate to the right of the 7.5 cm gun, behind which is a small machine gun ball mounting, five inches in diameter.

SPECIFICATIONS
28 tons Weight (approx.) ........................................ Length ............................................. 19 ft., 91/2 ins. W idth .................... ..................... 10 ft., 4 /4 ins. 6 ft., 5 ins. H eight ................................................ Ground clearance ........................................ 15 ins. Tread centers .................................. 8 ft., 1/4 ins. ins. 11 ft., 6 Ground contact .............................. W idth of track ........................................... 15 ins. 4/4 ins. Pitch of track ........................... ........... ..... ......... 98 Track links ...................................... Fording depth .................................................... 3 ft. Theoretical radius of action ........ 130 miles Roads .................................. . 80 miles Cross-country .................................. Speed Roads ...................................................... 28 m.p.h. Cross-country ........................................ 15 m.p.h. Armor Superstructure, front.... 80 mm at 50 to vertical Superstructure, sides (fighting compartment) ........................... 40 mm at 30 Gun Mantlet ........................... 150 mm (rounded) 80 mm at 45 Upper nose plate ...................... Lower Nose plate ........................ 45 mm at 55 Hull sides .................................... 30 mm (vertical) Armament..........7.5 cm Stu. K. 42 (L/70); one M. G. . 55 Ammunition (Rds.) ............................................... Engine ...................... Maybach HL 120 TRM, 320 hp. Transmission........Synchromesh-6 speeds forward. 1 reverse Steering ................................ Epicyclic, clutch brake ............................... 5 Crew ........................

RESTRICTED

SOFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE1

1 May, 1945

32.3

ANTIAIRCRAFT GUN ON MEDI


Pz. Kpfw. IV fir 2 cm Flakvierling 38

GERMAN

This equipment consists of the four-barrelled 2 cm (.79 in.) antiaircraft gun mounted on the Pz. Kpfw. IV chassis. The gun has been mounted in an open topped, nine-sided turret. Elevation is from 10 to 90 and traverse is 360.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ..................................... 26 tons (estimated) 19 ft., 4 ins. Length ......................................... 9 ft., 8 ins. Width ............................................ 9 ft. H eight ............................................. 15 ins. Ground clearance .......................... 7 ft., 107/s ins. Tread centers ................................ 11 ft., 6 ins. Ground contact ............................... 15 ins. Width of track ............................... 4/4 ins. Pitch of track ................................. 98 Track links .................................. 3 ft. Fording depth ........................... Theoretical radius of action: 130 miles Roads ....................................... 80 miles Cross country ......................... Speed: 25 m.p.h. Roads .................................. 15 m.p.h. Cross country ......................... Armor: Front plate of superstructure85 mm at 10 to vertical Sides of superstructure30 mm Armanent .. ....................... 2 cm Flakvierling 38 Ammunition H.E. Shell, tracer; H.E.-Incendiary: A.P. shell, tracer. Rounds ............ 16 clips in turret (20 rds in each) 15 boxes in tank. Engine .................... Maybach HI 120 TRM, 320 hp. TransmissionSynchromesh-6 speeds forward, 1 reverse Steering ................................ Epicylic, clutch brake Crew ............................... .............................. 5

The gun is the normal 2 cm Flakvierling 38 with the triangular base removed. Two guns are mounted on either side of the cradle. The guns are fired by a set of foot pedals; each pedal operates the trigger mechanism of the two diametrically opposite guns. The weapon is traversed and elevated manually by the gunner who also aims and fires it. The 2 cm Flakvierling 38 is supported by two four-inch I-beams which are located 15 inches below the normal tank turret ring. The I-beams are in the center below the turret opening and extend across the width of the tank chassis. There is no traversing rack on the turret ring. A rod from the gun upper carriage supports the gunner's seat and is fastened by a U-bolt to the turret to form a connection between the gun mount and the turret armor. At the front of each side of the upper carriage is a collapsible rod which also can be fastened to the turret armor. In this manner, the gun mount and turret traverse together. The turret is 43 inches high, 6 feet, 6 inches wide, and 8 feet long. The armor plate is 15 mm thick. Each side of the turret is composed of two plates of equal dimensions welded together. The top plates are sloped at an angle of approximately 30 degrees and the bottom plates are undercut at the same angle.

RESTRICTED

FioCE CHIEF

O CORDNF

1 1 *' 'h 'x 1

iENe

1t 'I

1 August, 1945

34.1

SELF-PROPELLED ANTITANK GUN


Pz. Jag. IV fir 7.5 cm Pak 39 (L/48)

GERMAN

This equipment consists of a Pz. Jag. IV chassis upon which is mounted a 7.5 cm Pak 39 (L/48). The chassis is a modified Pz. Kpfw. IV, designed to mount either the 7.5 cm Pak 39 (L/48) or the 7.5 cm Stu. K. 42 (L/70). The chassis has upper and lower nose plates sloped at 45 and 57 respectively. The all-welded construction of the hull is retained, and this structure is strengthened by limited interlocking of the front plates. The main armament is mounted in the sloping front plate of a squat all-welded superstructure, and is offset 8 inches to the off-side of the center line. The mounting is of gimbal type, and is protected externally by a heavy casting. The superstructure is bolted through angle sections to the lower hull. The sloping sides of the superstructure are extended beyond the vertical hull sides over the width of the tracks, and the rear edges of the floor of the sponsons so formed are locked upon the hull angle section. The rear superstructure and engine cover plates are similar to those of the Pz. Kpfw. IV. Spaced plates of 5 mm armor are bolted to brackets welded to the basic side plates of the rear superstructure sides. The armor is treated with Zimmerit. Mechanically, the vehicle is similar to the Pz. Kpfw. IV, but with small modifications. The final spur gear carries 41 teeth instead of the 40 on the tank. The final drive sprockets are of cast steel with webs of flat section instead of the rounded spokes of the tank sprockets.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight .......................................... Length ............................................... W idth ................................................ 19 ft., 9 ft., 4 ins. 7 ins.

Height . ............................... ... Ground clearance .............................. 15 ins. Tread centers .................................... 7 ft., 11 ins. Ground contact .................................. 11 ft., 6 ins. Width of track .................................. 15 ins. Pitch of track .................................... 4/4 ins. Track links .............................. ... 98 Fording depth .................................. 3 ft. Theoretical radius of action: Roads ........................................ 130 miles Cross country ............................ 80 miles Speed: Roads ......................................... 28 m .p.h. Cross country ............................ 15 m.p.h. Armor: Front plate of superstructure60 mm at 50 angle Sides of superstructure30 mm at 30 angle Armanent .............................. 7.5 cm Pak 39 (L/48) Ammunition (Rds.) Engine ................ Maybach HL 120 TRM. 320 hp. Transmission Synchromesh-6 speeds forward, 1 reverse Steering .............................. Epicylic. clutch brake

Crew ...................................

..........................

34.2

1 August,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

S. P. ANTITANK OR ASSAULT GUN (Gun Motor Carriage)


Pz. Jag. "Panther" fur 8.8 cm Pak 43 3 (Sd. Kfz. 173)

GERMAN O

The standard Model A Panther chassis is used for building this vehicle. The vehicle embodies all of the engineering principles and methods of design accumulated by the Germans up to the time of its production, and is quite effective as an antitank or assault weapon. The hull and fighting compartment are of all welded construction. The fighting compartment is 45 inches in height at the front and 57 inches at the rear. The length of the roof is 93 inches and the width 72 inches. The steering mechanism, "one radius steering," is new. It is unnecessary to engage the transmission in order to turn or traverse the tank through 360 degrees. The use of either steering lever will traverse the tank in a small radius or on the spot. The annulus gear of each of the two epicyclics is driven by the transmission output shaft and is subject to seven speeds forward and one reverse. The sun gears are held stationary on the straightaway by steering brakes. In making a turn, the inside sun gear is released to rotate backward for a sharper turn, the inside sun gear is driven by engagement through a steering clutch with the engine. The vehicle is armed with the 8.8 cm Pak 43/3 gun in a massive cast steel mantlet which is flexibly mounted in a cast steel ring welded to the front plate. Traverse is 11 degrees. Stowage is provided for 29 rounds of each of two types of ammunition. One M. G. 34 is ball mounted in the front plate to the right. Driver's vision is by periscope. _Fuel capacity is 193 gallons, of which 34 gallons are held in auxiliary.

SPECIFICATIONS
45 tons ............ Weight ..................................... Length (overall) Including gun ...... 28 ft., 4 ins. Excluding gun ...... 22 ft., 8 ins.

W idth (overall) ................................ 10 ft., 10 ins.


9 ft., 10 ins. Height (overall) ................................ 21 ins. .............. Ground clearance ........................ 8 ft., 7'/2 ins. Tread centers ................................. Ground contact .......................... 12 ft., 9V2 ins. W idth of track ............................................. 26 ins. Pitch of track ....................... .................... 6 ins. 67 ......... Track links ...................................... 67 ins. Fording depth ................... ......... Theoretical radius of action Roads ...................... .................... 124 miles Cross-country ...................................... 62 miles Speed 34 m .p.h. Roads ...................... ... ................... 15-18 m.p.h. Cross-country .................................. Armor Front plate .......... 80 mm at 55 to the vertical Sides .............. 45 mm at 30 to the vertical

Rear

................. 40 mm at 30 to the vertical

Top .................... 17 mm at 85 to the vertical Armament............ 8.8 cm Pak 43/3 (MV 3.280 f/s, A.P.C.B.C.), M. G. 34 58 (8.8 cm) Ammunition (Rds.) .............................. Engine............Maybach HL 230 P 30 V12 gasoline Transmission..........Synchromesh 7 speeds forward,
1 reverse Steering............One radius double drive epicyclic 5 ...................... C rew ........................................

RESTRICTED

Replacement Page

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

38.1

HEAVY TANK ("KING TIGER" or "ROYAL TIGER")


Pz. Kpfw. VI (B) "Tiger" fir 88 cm Kw. K. 43 L/71 (Sd. Kfz. 182)

GERMAN

This heavy tank designed for defensive warfare or for penetrating strong lines of defense made its combat appearance in 1944. It is distinguished by heavy frontal armor and by the employment of the heaviest German gun to be used in a turret with 360 traverse-the 8.8 cm Kw. K. 43 (L/71). This gun has a muzzle velocity of 3,280 f/s, and firing an A.P.C.B.C. projectile weighing 22.4 pounds against 30 homogenous plate has a reported penetration of 6.3 inches at 1,000 yards. The hull and superstructure are of single-skin welded construction with interlocked joints. The hull front is formed of a single sloping plate 150 mm thick, and a lower nose plate 100 mm thick. Each of these plates is set at an angle of 50 from the vertical, resembling in design the Panther rather than the earlier Tiger. The pannier side plates, 80 mm thick, are set at a 250 angle and also resemble those of the Panther. The turret is located sufficiently back of the angle of deflection to be clear of direct hits on the front plate. The rounded front is 180 mm thick. At the rear of the vehicle'is a Maybach 600, V-12, gasoline engine of 600 horsepower. The transmission, steering, and final drive are similar to those of the Tiger E. The suspension is made up of nine torsion bars on each side to carry the tank on steel tired road wheels. Five of these overlap the four internal ones. Every alternate track link has two ground contact bars. This tank mounts the 8.8 cm Kw. K. 43 (L/71), two M. G. 34's, an antiaircraft machine gun, and a smoke projector. A commander's version of this tank was also manufactured. The transport trailer for this tank is described on page 62.2.

SPECIFICATIONS
W eight .......................................................... 75 tons Length .................................................. 23 ft., 10 ins. Width (overall) ................................ 12 ft., 7 ins.

Height ............................................... 10 ft., 2 ins. Ground clearance .............................. 1 ft., 5 ins.


Tread centers ........................................ 9 ft., 4 ins. Ground contact ............................................ 32.5 ins. Width of track ......................................

Pitch of track .............................................

5.9 ins.

................... 90 Track links ....................... Fording depth ............................................. 69 ins. Theoretical radius of action . .............. 106 R oads ................................. Cross-country ............... ...............................
Speed

23.6 m .p.h. Roads .............................................. m.p.h. Cross-country ...................................... 10 Armor Front glacis plate .................................. 150 mm 80 mm Sides .................................................... Armament............(1) 8.8 cm Kw. K. 43; (2) 7.92 mm M.G.'s; (1) A.A. M.G.; (1) smoke projector 80 Ammunition (Rds.)-88 mm .............................. Engine ........................................... Maybach HL 230 Transmission ............ 8 forward speeds; 4 reverse Steering..........Controlled differential, hydraulically operated ...................... 5 Crew ...................................

38*2

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

(Replacement Page)

RESTRICTED

38 cm ROCKET PROJECTOR ON TIGER E CHASSIS


Sturmmorser

GERMAN

Top: General view of Sturmmorser. Above: The Raketenwerfer 61 as mounted on vehicle. Right: The projector, showing method of rifling.

A DESCRIPTION OF THIS EQUIPMENT APPEARS ON THE FOLLOWING PAGE.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 June, 1945

38.3

38 cm ROCKET PROJECTOR ON TIGER E CHASSIS


Sturmmorser
This equipment consists of a 38 cm rocket projector (Raketen Werfer 61) mounted on a modified Model E Tiger I chassis (see p. 38). A heavy rectangular superstructure of the type used on the German self-propelled guns replaces the normal superstructure and turret of the Model E. The rocket projector is mounted in the front plate of the superstructure, offset to the right of center. The superstructure is made of rolled armor plates and is of welded construction with the side plates interlocked with the front and rear plates. A heavy strip of armor is used to reinforce the joint between the front plate and glacis plate on the outside. Armor thickness varies from 40 mm to 150 mm. The main armament, which fires a splined projectile 58.6 inches long (see page 354.2), differs radically in design and construction from any weapon previously examined. The barrel consists of a cast outer jacket, and a spaced liner of 1/2-inch steel. The latter, which is 741/4 inches long, is rifled, having nine grooves with right hand twist, one turn in 17.6 calibers. At the extreme rear, the grooves widen to aid in positioning splines near the base of the projectile. The liner is held in place by four steel blocks at the rear, and a perforated ring at the muzzle end. This ring has 31 equally spaced holes around its face. The breech mechanism is a horizontal sliding plate 2-5/16 inches thick opening from left to right. The propellant gases are deflected between the tube and liner by an unusual obturator, and escape through a perforated ring at the muzzle. The metal obturator comprising a thin "L" shaped outer ring, a heavier "L" shaped perforated inner ring, and a spacer ring, fits into a circular recess in the front face of the breech plate. When the projectile is fired, the propellant gases pass through the ports to the chamber between the inner and outer rings. The face of the outer ring is forced against the rear face of the tube, and the sides against the recess in the breech plate, thereby obtaining the gas seal.

GERMAN O

SPECIFICATIONS
(VEHICLE)
Weight (in action) (estimated)...................... 68 tons ......... 20 ft., 8/2 ins. Length (overall) .............. ins. Width (overall) .............................. 12 ft., 3 Height (overall including stowage ins. 11 t., 4 crane) ..................................... ins. Height (overall less stowage crane) 9 ft., 3 ins. Ground clearance ...................................... 17 Tread centers ................................. 9 ft., 3/2 ins. ins. Ground contact .......................... 12 ft., 6 Width of track ...................... 281/2 ins.-2012 ins. 51/ ins. Pitch of track ............................................... ............................. 96 Track links ......................... Fording depth ...................... ..................... 70 ins. Theoretical radius of action Roads ..................................................... 87 miles Cross-country ........................................ 53 miles

Speed Roads ....................... ............................ Cross-country ........................................

25 m iles 15 miles

Superstructure Armor Front plate ................ 150 mm at 45 to vertical Projector mantlet (average)...... 69 mm rounded Projector shield (average)........ 150 mm rounded 84 mm at 20 to vertical Side plates ................ 84 mm at 10 to vertical Rear plate ................ 40 mm Top plate ................................................... Spherical cradle .................... 100 mm rounded Ammunition (Rds.) ........................................... 12 Engine .................. Maybach HL 210, V-12, 630 hp. Transmission....................Preselector, hydraulic-8 speeds forward, 4 reverse Steering..................Controlled differential, hydraulic 7 Crew (unconfirmed) .................... .......................

(PROJECTOR) Caliber .................................... 380 mm (14.96 ins.) Length of tube .......................................... 811/s ins. Length of liner .......................................... 741/ ins. Thickness of liner ......................................... . W"
No. of grooves ................................... .......... ... Width of grooves .......................................... 0.4 in. Width of grooves at rear ............................ 1.06 in. 0.2 in. Depth of grooves .......................................... Twist of grooves......................Right hand, one turn in 17.6 caliber 6,179 yds. Max. range (horizontal) ........................ Firing mechanism ............................ Continuous-pull Traverse ......................... ...................... 20 Elevation (approx.) ........................................... 85 . 0 Depression (approx.) ....................................... Ammunition........H.E. (R. Sprenggranate 4581) HEAT (R. Hollandungsgranat 4592) .............. . . . . .. W t. of projectile* ................. ..... 761 lbs. *Weight zones are marked to the nearest 5 kg.

(12 lbs.)

PHOTOGRAPHS OF THIS EQUIPMENT APPEAR ON THE PRECEDING PAGE. THE ROCKET IS DESCRIBED ON PAGE 354e2.

38.4

1 June, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTI ED

S.P. ANTITANK GUN-"Elephant"


Pz. Jag. "Tiger" (P) "Elefant" fiir 8.8 cm Pak 43/2 (Sd. Kfz. 184)

GERMAN Q

The "Elephant," weighing 72 tons, was the first of German heavy self-propelled antitank guns to be manufactured. It was designed and built under the supervision of Dr. Ferdinand Porsche and was first introduced under the name of "Ferdinand" in the Summer of 1943. The vehicle is actually improvised to utilize an unsuccessful tank produced by Dr. Porsche. Ninety of these vehicles were so converted. The armor is approximately 8 inches thick in the front of the hull and the sloping fighting compartment. The sides of the hull are 21/2 inches, the fighting compartment 33/ inches thick; while the rear plates of the hull are 4 1/3 inches, and the fighting compartment 3 1/3 inches. The roof of the fighting compartment and belly plates are approximately 1 /2 inches thick. The "Elephant" is powered by two 12-cylinder Maybach H.L. 120 T.R.M. engines mounted centrally in the hull. From the engine the drive is taken forward directly to generators and thence to electric driving motors having a capacity of 230 Kw. at 1,300 r.p.m. which are mounted across the rear of the vehicle, under the floor of the fighting cab. The suspension consists of six dual bogie wheels 263 inches in diameter on each side, mounted in pairs on stub axles which are bolted and welded to the hull; rear drive sprocket, and front idler. There are no return rollers. The armament consists of a long-barreled 8.8 cm gun, with muzzle brake. It has an overall length of 22 feet, 11.63 inches, of which 13 feet, 11/2 inches projects beyond the mantlet. The gun is mounted on trunnions 8.8 cm in diameter which are located inside the ball joint in the front armor plate of the fighting compartment. The maximum elevation of the piece is 250; traverse is 120 left and right.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight .......................... ................. 72 tons

Length ...................................... 22 ft., 11 Width ............................................ 11 ft., 53 9 ft., 10 Height ......................................... Ground clearance ...................................... 191/2

ins. ins. ins. ins.

Tread centers ................ .................................. Ground contact ........................................ Width of track ........................................ 25V2 ins. Pitch of track ............................................ 5 ins. Track links ................... ................................... Fording depth ............................................. Theoretical radius of action Roads ........................ ... ..................... 65 m iles Cross-country ........................................ 35 miles Speed Road ..................... ......................... 12.5 m .p.h. Cross-country ...................................... 6-9 m.p.h. Armor Front plate .............................................. 200 mm Sides (hull) ............................................. 60 mm Armament...................................... 8.8 cm Pak 43/2 MG 34 Ammunition ..................... 8.8 cm gun-70-90 rds. MG-2,000 rds. Engine........2 Maybach HL 120 TRM, 320 hp. each Transmission..............Gas-electric, D.C. current, 650 amps. @ 385 volts. Steering ............................................. Field control

Crew .........................

..

....................... 6

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

39

SELF-PROPELLED GUN
Pz. Jag. Tiger fir 12.8 cm PJK 44 (Sd. Kfz. 186)

GERMAN

The Jagdtiger was the most formidable self-propelled antitank gun used by the Germans. It consists of a 12.8 cm PJK 44 (L/55) (less muzzle brake), mounted on a Tiger B chassis. The hull consists of the normal Tiger B with a builtup superstructure to form a fixed turret. The front plate of the superstructure is 250 mm thick and slopes back at 15 to the vertical. It is made of one solid piece of cast steel armor. The sides of the superstructure are made in one piece with the sloped sides of the fixed turret and, like the Tiger B, are 80 mm thick sloped at 25 degrees. The rear plate of the superstructure is also 80 mm thick with a 10 slope. The main armament consists of a 12.8 cm PJK 44 set in the center of the front plate of the built-up superstructure. It has a cast, bell-shaped gun shield similar in design to that of the 8.8 cm Kw. K. 43 on the Tiger B. The spherical housing of the gun cradle mounting pivots on a steel ball. The gun is electrically fired and has a vertical sliding breechblock. Separate loading ammunition is used, and the same cartridge case is utilized for armor piercing and high explosive rounds. With A.P.C. ammunition, penetration of approximately 6 inches of armor at 1,000 yards at 300 is effected; with A.P.C.B.C. ammunition, the penetration is approximately 8 inches.

SPECIFICATIONS
................. 77 tons W eight ........................................ Length (overall) .................................... 23 ft., 11 ins. Width (overall) .................................... 12 ft., 7 ins. Height (overall) ................................ 9 ft., 3 ins.

Ground clearance ..............................

19 ins.

Tread centers .................................... 103/110 ins. Ground contact .................................. 13 ft., 4 ins. Width of track .................................. 26/311/2 ins. 5.9 ins. Pitch of track ................................... Track links ............................ 92 (46 double shoes) 69 ins. Fording depth .................................... Theoretical radius of action: 106 miles Roads ...................... ............... 75 miles Cross country ............................ Speed: 23.6 m.p.h. Roads ......................................... 10 m.p.h. Cross country .............................. Armor: Front plate of superstructure250 mm at 15 to vertical Sides of superstructure-

80 mm at 25 to vertical
Armament ........................................ 12.8 cm PJK 44

Ammunition .................................. A.P.C.; A.P.C.B.C.


Engine .......................................... Maybach HL 230 Transmission ............ 8 speeds forward; 4 reverse Steering .................................. Two radius system Crew .................................. ......................... 6

40

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

(Replacement Page)

RESTRICTED

CABLE-CONTROLLED DEMOLITION VEHICLE


"Goliath-B I"

GERMAN

This miniature tank, weighing less than 700 pounds, is controlled by a 2000-foot electric cable from a hand control box carried in the rear. It is used to send a demolition charge to a point at which detonation destroys the tank as well as the target. The hull is fabricated frcm a mild 16 gauge steel with front upper and lower sloping plates 9 mm thick. These are set at 48 degrees and 50 degrees to the vertical. The hull contains three compartments. The rear compartment houses the cable and drum; the central compartment houses the power unit and control mechanism; and the front compartment contains the high explosive charge. The power plant consists of a 2-cylinder, 2-cycle air-cooled engine. Ignition is by coil and 6 volt battery. The power is transferred through chain drives to each track by means of electromagnetic clutches. The total reduction from the clutches to the sprocket is 9.33:1. Steering is accomplished by breaking the circuit to the side to which the turn is to be made. This releases the magnetic clutch, cutting the power from the engine for that side of the vehicle. The suspension consists of five small bogie wheels on the bottom with two return rollers on top, and an idler wheel at the rear. Each bogie is independently sprung by coil springs. The chain driven sprocket is at the front of the vehicle. The track is 6 5/16 inches wide, with a simple grouser placed on every other track pin. This vehicle carries an estimated 100-125 pounds of explosive, and has sufficient power to operate on practically all types of terrain. The control cable consists of three strands, in pairs, two for steering, and the third for setting off the detonator. In operation, the engines are started by a hand crank, the clutches engaged, and the tank then handled from the control box through the cable. Another version of this tank is powered by two electric motors.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ....................................................... 650 lbs.
3 Ins. Length ........................................... 5 ft.,

Width ................................................. Height .............

2 ft., 10 ins.

............................ 2 ft. .....................


5/4 ins.

Ground clearance ......................................

Tread centers .................................... 2 ft., 3

ins.

Ground contact ................................ 2 ft., 6V2 ins. Width of track ...................................... Pitch of track ...................................... Track links .......................... 6 5/16 ins. 2 13/16 ins.

.......................... 47

Theoretical radius of action .................... 770 yds. Speed ............................................... Armor Front plate (upper and lower nose)............ 9 mm 4 to 6 m.p.h.

Hull .............................................. 16 gauge steel


Armament......(100-125 est.) pound explosive charge Engine ...........................Inline, 2 cylinder, 2 cycle Transmission..............Chain drive, through electric magnetic clutch. Steering............Controlled by two electric clutches

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 April, 1945

40.1

RADIO-CONTROLLED DEMOLITION VEHICLE-B IV

*ERMAN

This vehicle is designed to convey a heavy demolition charge to a selected tactical objective, at which point the load may be dropped, the vehicle retracted, and the charge detonated. While it may be driven near the target, its special feature is the remote radio-control with which it may be operated after the driver leaves. Its chief use is to demolish pillboxes and strongpoints. The hull, which is of one piece welded construction, is divided into three compartments. The engine, radio equipment, and hydraulic mechanism are contained in the rear compartment, the transmission units in one of the forward compartments, and the driver's controls and instruments in the other. Three overlapping flaps of 8 mm armor protect the top of the driver's compartment. The vehicle is powered by a 6-cylinder, inline, water-cooled, gasoline engine, similar to commercial types. It develops approximately 80 horsepower and is supplied by two fuel tanks with a combined capacity of 28.6 gallons. From the engine, the drive is taken forward through a fluid coupling to the gear box. Two speeds forward and two speeds reverse are provided by high and low range gears. Power is transmitted to the forward sprockets through a train of four spur gears. Suspension is on torsion bars. There are five double rubber-tired bogie wheels on each side. The cast steel center quide tracks have detachable rubber pads and are 7% inches wide. An 800-pound explosive charge is carried in a container on the sloping front. Drop arms hinged to the sides of the front permit the warhead to be lowered to the ground, jettisoned, and the vehicle withdrawn from the destructive arc before the charge is detonated by means of a time fuze or electric detonator. Radio control of the vehicle is effected by transmitting a carrier of frequency between 24 Mc/s and 25 Mc/s which is amplitude modulated by audio frequency tones. The transmitter power is apprdximately 4 watts.
4O.2
-

SPECIFICATIONS
W eight .................................................. ...... 4 ton

Length ..................................... Ground clearance ..................................


Tread centers ................................ 5 ft.,

12 ft. 12 ns.
2 ins.

W idth .............................................. ............ 6 ft. Height (including driver's shield)........ 4 ft., 7 ins.

Ground contact ................................ 5 ft. 10.5 ins. Width of track ......................................... 7.75 ins.
Track links ........................................................... 50 Pitch of track ............................................. 5.5 ns. Armor Front plate ............................................. 10 mm m Sides ............................ 13 mm (5 mm + 8 m)

Armament ........................ 800-lb. explosive charge Engine...................... -cylinder . H. V. gasoline,


80 horsepower. Transmission............1 fwd, 1 reverse with high and

low range-hydraulic clutch.


Steering........Epicyclic Crew steering brakes either man-

ually or hydraulically controlled.


........................................ ............................... 1 RADIO EQUIPMENT Type receiver ................................. Superheterodyne Frequency .................................. 24,600 kilocycles Crystal controlled Local oscillator ........................

Intermediate frequency .................... 464 kilocycles Tubes Receiver........1 ECH 11 Mixer-Oscillator


1 EF 13 Fixed i-f amplifier

1 EBF 11 second i-f AVC, Second detector


2 EF 12 Audio amplifiers

Filter unit...........................5

EF 12 Relay control

1 EF 13 Relay control Power supply..............12 v. storage battery with dynamotor

Voltage

.......................................... Plate-200 v. Filament-6 v. RESTRICTED

1 April,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

8-WHEELED ARMORED CAR


s. Pz. Sp. Wg. (5 cm) Sd. Kfz. 234/2

GERMAN

This armored car is basically the 8-wheeled Model Sd. Kfz. 234 equipped with a 12-cylinder, 750, air-cooled diesel engine. The armor plate on the front of the turret, superstructure, and hull is heavier than that of earlier models. The vehicle, itself, is also about three tons heavier. The main armament consists of the 5 cm tank gun, Kw. K. 39/1, fitted with a muzzle brake. This gun has a muzzle velocity of 2,700 f/s, with A. P. ammunition. Its penetration performance with A. P. C. ammunition is estimated at 2.2 inches at 300 from 1,000 yards. The mantlet is cast in one piece somewhat similar in appearance to that on the latest assault guns, but the casting also includes the coaxial machine gun. This design gives greater protection than the older types. The gun has a vertical sliding block and is of the semi-automatic type. A spring type equilibrator is mounted on the right hand side between the cradle and the turret top plate. The hydropneumatic recoil mechanism is mounted in the mantlet
on top of the piece. Elevation is from 70 to

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ..................................................... 11.5 tons 4 ins.
8 ins.

Length (overall with gun at 12 o'c.).. 22 ft.,


Length (overall with gun at 6 o'c.).. 19 ft.,

Width ....................................
Height

....

7 ft., 10 ins.
7 ft., 1 ft., 6 ins. 2 ins.

..............................................

Ground clearance ............................

Tread centers ..................................


Wheelbase

6 ft., 4% ins.

........................................ 13 ft., 5V2 ins.

Tire size .................................................... 8.27 x 16 Fuel tank ...................................... 89 gal. capacity Fording depth ...................................... 4 ft., 7 ins. Speed (maximum) ...................................... 50 m.p.h. Engine................12-cylinder, 75, air-cooled diesel. 217 BHP at 2250 engine r.p.m. Bore and stroke .......................... 110 mm/130 mm Diesel

+ 250. Six smoke

projectors are mounted, three on each side of the turret. The front of the turret is protected by 30 mm armor set at an angle of 20 from the vertical. The sides and rear have 10 mm armor set at 250, and the top plate is of the same thickness. The gun mantlet is rounded, and is 40 to 100 mm thick. The front of the superstructure has 30 mm armor set at a 35 angle, and the sides 10 mm at 30. The nose plates of the hull are 30 mm thick,
the upper plate being set at a 550 angle and the lower at 300. The

Ignition ............................................................. Battery ......................

........................................

Transmission................6 speeds forward: 6 reverse Steering ......................(Dual control) worm and nut Crew ................................... ......................... 4

glacis plate is 17 mm at 700 and the sides of the hull 9 mm at 300.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 April, 1945

42e1

HALFTRACKED ARMORED CAR


leichtes Schitzenpanzerwagen (2 cm) (Sd. Kfz. 250/9)

GERMAN

This vehicle, adapted from the light armored personnel carrier, mounts the 2 cm tank gun, Kw. K. 38, and is effective for reconnaissance, action against lightly armored ground targets, protection of troop and supply trains, and as a personnel and supply carrier. It differs from the basic vehicle principally in the addition of an armored turret which has been found in three forms: 10, 8, and 6-sided. The turret is of truncated cone shape and is similar to that used in the German 4-wheeled armored cars. The turret has no roof, but instead is provided with a wire mesh grill as anti-grenade protection. The gun is mounted in the center with a 7.92 mm M. G. 34 on the left, and a telescopic sight on the right. The armament is controlled by one man who sits in a seat suspended from the right rear of the turret. A single handwheel controls traverse and elevation, or, by use of a small lever, the gun may be locked in a horizontal position. Counterbalance is maintained by two spring equilibrators, one mounted on each side. The turret is mounted on a ring permitting traverse through 360 degrees. Access to the turret is through a large entrance door in the left rear of the superstructure. The vehicle is provided with a transmitter-receiver, Fu. Spr. f, with intercommunicating facilities.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight (approx.) ............................................ 6 tons Trailer load capacity ..............................
Length ........................... .......................... 15 ft.

Width ................................................. 6 ft., 5 ins. Height .............................................. 6 ft., 10% ins. Ground clearance ........................................ 11 ins.
Tread centers ...................................... 5 ft., 5 ins. Ground contact ................................ 3 ft., 11 ins.

... 10 V ins. Track width ..................................... .................... 38 Track links .........................


Fuel tank ................................................. 20-25 gals.

Fuel consumption ..........................................


Fording depth ............................................. 27 ins.

Speed

....................................................... 35 m.p.h.

Engine...........................6 cylinder Maybach: Watercooled, 100 hp. Bore and stroke .................................... 90 x 110 mm Ignition .............................................. Bosch magneto ............. 12 volt Battery ................................. Transmission......Semi-automatic, preselective type. 7 speeds forward. 3 reverse. Steering ...................... Front wheel-track epicyclic

3 Crew ...................................................................... Armament..........1 20 mm tank gun (Kw. K. 38)


1 7.92 mm machine gun (M. G. 34) Armor Front plate (approx.) ................................ 15 mm Side plate (approx.) ............................... . 6 mm 8 mm Rear plate (approx.) ................................

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 April, 1945

44e1

ARMORED FLAMETHROWER VEHICLE


m. Flammpanzerwagen (Sd. Kfz. 251/16)

GERMAN

This flame-throwing vehicle is employed in association with more heavily armored panzer units. It is an adaptation of the medium armored personnel carrier on which have been mounted the various items of equipment required. There are two large projectors mounted well back on either side of the vehicle in V-shaped shields. Each of these has a nozzle .55 inch in diameter, and a traverse of 160 degrees. The third flamethrower takes the form of the cartridge ignition projector used in the small portable flamethrower Model 42, on the end of 33 feet of hose, connecting it to the propulsion unit and fuel tank through the back of the vehicle. The nozzle of this projector is .28 inch in diameter. Fuel propulsion is by a pump driven by a small gasoline engine supplied by a 5V2-gallon tank which will run the engine for two hours. One hundred and fifty-four gallons of fuel for the flamethrowers is carried. This allows about eighty bursts of one or two seconds' duration each. The effective range of the large flamethrowers is about 40 yards; that of the portable unit about 30 yards. 1,850 gallons of fuel are carried in the three 3-ton lorries of platoon transport. This is sufficient for two refuels for all six flamethrower vehicles of the flamethrower platoon. The crew of the vehicle consists of one vehicle loader who also acts as wireless operator and machine gunner, two flamethrower operators, and a driver.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight (approx.) ............................................ 8 tons
Trailer load capacity .................................. 3.3 tons Length ............................................................. 19 ft.

Width ..............................................
Height :...

............

7 ft.
7 ft. 3 ins.

.................................... ...........................

Ground clearance ........................................ 12 ins.


Tread centers ........................................ 5 ft.,

Ground contact .................................. 5 ft., 11 ins. Track width .................................................. 11 ins.


Track links .......................................... ........... .. 55

Fuel tank ................................................ 42.5 gals. Fuel consumption ...................... 5 miles per gal.
Fording depth .............................................. Speed ........................................................ 20 ins. 30 m.p.h.

Engine..................Maybach, NL 42 TUKRR, 100 hp. Bore and stroke ................................ 90 x 110 mm


Ignition ........................................................ Magneto Battery ............................................................ 12 volt Transmission................4 speeds forward, 1 reverse. High and low range.

Steering................Front wheel and track epicyclic


Crew ............................................................... 4 Armor

Radiator cover ................ 7.5 mm at 81 degrees Sides .......................... 8.5 mm at 55-60 degrees
Front plate ...................... 15 mm at 55 degrees

Armament........................2 large flamethrowers 1 portable flamethrower 2 7.92 mm M. G. 34's

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 April, 1945

46.1

TRIPLE MACHINE GUN ON SEMITRACKED VEHICLE


M. G. 151/15 und M. G. 151/20 Drilling auf m. S. P. W. (Sd Kf. 251/21)

6EftMAN

This is the 3-ton, armored semitrack mounting triple 15 mm or 20 mm heavy machine guns of the Model 151 aircraft type. The equipment is an assault weapon intended for ground combat, and engagement of low flying aircraft is a secondary role. The three guns, which are cocked manually and percussion fired, are set coaxially and in the same plane. Each gun is held in a standard MG 151 aircraft cradle, less the body extension. The cradles are bolted to a common block on the top bracket of the pedestal, pivoting on trunnions for elevation and depression. The top bracket is bolted to a bottom conical skirt and the whole rotates freely on a cone pedestal fixed to the floor of the vehicle. Elevation (- 50 to 490) and traverse (360) are shoulder controlled by the firer. A brake locking device is provided for traverse. The guns, capable of firing 700 r.p.m. each, are belt fed, the belts being contained in steel boxes, one for each gun. A total of 3,000 rounds of ammunition in belts is carried in the vehicle. Penetration of A. P. projectiles fired from the 15 mm MG 151 is reported as 18 mm from 100 meters at 30 degrees. Sighting apparatus consists of a telescopic sight with a magnification of 3 and a field of view of 8 degrees; a cartwheel type antiaircraft sight, and a hand periscope with a magnification of 8 and a field of view of 7.5 degrees. A further description of. the components of this equipment is available on pages 4 and 252.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ........................................ .......... 8 tons
3.3 tons Trailer load capacity ....................................

Length ..............................................................

19 ft.

7 ft. W idth ........................................................... .................. Height ............................... 12 ins. Ground clearance ........................................
Tread centers ................................ 5 ft. 3 ins.

Ground contact .................................. 5 ft.. 11 ins. 11 ins. Track width .................................................... ........... .. 55 Track links .........................................
Radius of action ...................................... Fuel tank .................................................. 186 miles 42.5 gals.

Fuel consumption (roads) ............ 5 miles per gal. Fording depth ........................................ Speed .................................................. 20 ins. 30 m.p.h.

Engine ................................

Maybach, NL 42 TUKRR

Bore and stroke ................................


Horsepower .....................................

90 x 110 mm
..... . 100

Ignition ........................................ Bosch magneto

Battery ........................

.................... High and low range.

12 volt

Transmission..............4. speeds forward. 1 reverse. Steering................Front wheel Crew ............................ and track epicycllc 4

........................

4602

April,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

SELF-PROPELLED ROCKET PROJECTOR


15 cm Panzerwerfer 42 (Sd. Kfz. N. W. 41)

GERMAN O

The chassis of this self-propelled rocket projector follows the half-track design but differs materially from the standard German half-track series of prime movers. A standard commercial chassis manufactured by Opel (Chevrolet) has been modified to carry a spacious armored body of welded plates. The hull thus formed provides a firm and stable firing platform, and permits of easy mass production. The armor is intended only for protection against small arms fire of .30 caliber. The rear wheels and springs of the original truck chassis have been displaced by a track assembly, prefabricated and then bolted to the original frame. The original rear end differential has been retained but the drive shaft has been shortened and the asembly moved forward to mount the drive sprockets. The hydraulic brake system is retained only for the front wheels. A separate cable for each sprocket brake is connected to two hand levers mounted to the right of the driver's seat. Normal steering is assisted by the sprocket brake when necessary. The rocket projector consists of ten tubes mounted in two layers of five each. Provision is made for a simple optical sight, and for hand wheels for a maximum of 80 elevation and a maximum traverse of 290. The projectiles are the same as those fired from the 15 cm Nebelwerfer 41 and can be electrically fired, singly or ripple, by means of a squib placed in each round. They are loaded with high explosive, smoke, and chemical warfare ammunition. Auxiliary weapons include one 7.92 mm machine gun, M. G. 34, and three 9 mm submachine guns. Ammunition stowage is provided for ten extra rockets, 2,000 rounds for the M. G. 34, and 2,000 rounds for the submachine guns.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight (net) ......................................... Trailer load capacity ................................ 13,558 lb. 2.425 lb.

Length (overall) ................................ 19 ft.

5 ins.

Width (overall) .................................... 7 ft.. 2 ins.

Wheel base (approx.) ................................ 130 ins.


Height (overall) .................................... 8 ft., 6 ins. Armor .................................. 5/32 ins. to 5/16 ins.

Ground clearance (minimum) .................... 10 ins. Tread centers .............. 5 ft. 2 ins./5 ft. 11/2 ins. Ground contact (tracks) .............................. 78 ins. Track width ............................................... 10'/4 ins. .. 82

Track links ...................... .................... Fuel tank .................................................

22.4 gals.

Fuel consumption .................................... Unknown Fording depth ............................................... Speed ........................................................ 32 ins. 25 m.p.h.

Engine .................... Open (Chevrolet) 6 cyl. O.H.V. Displacement ............................................ 220 cu. ins. Horsepower .............................................. 67 U.S.A. Ignition .................................... Bosch 12 Volt (Coil) Battery ........................ 12 Volt with special heater Transmission ............ 5 speeds forward, 1 reverse Steering ........ Normal assisted by differential brake

Crew .................................

.........................

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

48.1

A.A./A.T. GUN ON SEMITRACK CHASSIS


m. Zgkw. 8 t Sd. Kfz. 7 (2 cm Flakvierling 38)

GERMAN

The 2 cm Flakvierling 38 has been mounted, as illustrated above, on the chassis of the 8-ton medium semitrack prime mover described on page 54. Details of the weapon and its performance may be found on page 133.

ANTIAIRCRAFT GUN ON SEMITRACK CHASSIS


m. Zgkw. 8 t Sd. Kfz. 7 (3.7 cm Flak 36)

The 3.7 cm Flak 36 has also been mounted on the chassis of the 8-ton medium prime mover described on page 54. Data on the weapon may be found on page 130.1.

RESTRIC RSTRED TED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

94 1 April, 1945

54Ar.1 54*1

AMPHIBIOUS VOLKSWAGEN
Kfz. 2 S

GERMAN

The basic construction of this vehicle is identical with that of the standard type 82 Volkswagen. Front wheel drive has been added to the ingenious positive lock differential rear drive already employed and removes all objections to its poor cross-country performance. The steering assembly and the front wheel suspension are placed outside a watertight bulkhead. A rubber sealed stuffing box is used for the front wheel drive shaft. In the rear the suspension is mounted outside the watertight hull. The only openings are for each drive shaft. These are entirely hooded by two bellows type rubber boots that sheath the axle allowing movement in all directions. Shock absorbers are provided for each wheel. In the front they are mounted outside the hull. In the rear, a watertight shaft extends through the hull from shock absorber to wheel. Normal grease seals on the rear axle keep water from seeping into the differential and transmission assemblies. The transmission, transfer case and the positive locking differential comprise a unit assembly secured to the floor at its extreme rear end. A power takeoff has been added to the normal transmission to provide front wheel drive. A cross-country gear position is also provided. It is an extra low gear necessitating the normal transmission be kept in neutral position when used. The clutch is a dry single disc foot operated type. The propeller assembly is mounted on a spring-loaded hinge that is positioned in the rear directly in line with the hand crank pulley. It incorporates a slip clutch to eliminate damage to the propeller blades by underwater obstructions. Engagement direct with the engine is made through a dog clutch sealed by a rubber bushing on the engine side.

SPECIFICATIONS
W eight ........................................................ Loading capacity .................................... 2.040 lbs. 960 lbs.

Length (overall-propeller down) ............ 150 ins. (overall-propeller up) ................. 140 ins.

Width (overall) .........................................


Height (overall to top of windshield)........

55 ins.
57 ins.

(overall less windshield) ........... 38 ins. Ground clearance ...................................... 11.5 ins.
Tread centers ............................................. Wheelbase ............................................. 47 ins. 78 ins.

Tire size .................................. 5.25 xl6-one spare

Fuel tank .............................. 13 gallons, 70 octane Fuel consumption (land) ........................ 20 m.p.g. (water) ........................ Unknown
Fording depth ............................................ Unlimited

46.5 m.p.h. Speed (land) ............................................ (w ater) ........................................ 7.5 m.p.h. Engine...................... 4 cyl. horizontally opposed, air-cooled Horsepower .............................. 24.5 at 3,300 r.p.m. Bosch, 6 volt coil Ignition ..........................................
Battery .......................................................... 6 volt Transmission ............ 4 speeds forward, 1 reverse Steering .................................. Normal-front wheels

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

58.1

AMPHIBIOUS 1/4-TON TRUCK. MODEL 1942


Trippel S. G. 6 Schwimkraftwagen

GERMAN

Development of this vehicle began prior to 1939 at the Trippelwerke Hamburg Saar. According to German press reports, in 1941 Mr. Hans Trippel, the inventor, made improvements over his earlier models as a result of experiments and his plant prepared to go into mass production. The above vehicle was manufactured in 1942. Field examination shows that the application of its design to combined land and water transportation is successful. Simplicity of design throughout makes it possible to produce the vehicle in large quantities very easily. The body is arranged with a front engine compartment, a center crew compartment, and a rear stowage compartment. Water sealing is accomplished by means of rubber seals throughout. The only openings in the rear of the body are for the wheel and propeller drive and for the shafts of the shock absorbers. In the front of the body there are three openings on each side as follows: one for the shock absorber rod, the radius rod, and for the wheel drive. Four-wheel drive with independent double coil spring suspension contributes to the cross-country mobility which is said to be remarkable. The shock absorbers are mounted inside the hull and connect with the suspension through an auxiliary shaft that is stuffing box sealed. A special transmission is provided with three speeds forward and one reverse for highways plus three speeds forward and one reverse for cross-country and a forward and reverse gear for operation in the water. The three-bladed propeller is lowered to position when in the water and is protected inside the body work when on land. Steering is accomplished by front wheels. A one-shot lubrication system is operated from the dash.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight (net) .............................................
Cargo capacity (land) ................................ Cargo capacity (water) ............................ Length (overall) ........................................ W idth (overall) ............................................ Height (overall-top of windshield)............ Ground clearance ....................................... Tire (Continental, cross-country type) .......................... ....................

3,860 lb.
2,400 lb. 2,100 lb. 190 ins. 71 ins. 74 ins. 15 ins.

Tread center to center .............................. 58V/2 ins. 6.00 x 18 ins. 98 ins. 12 ins.

W heel base ............................... ... ................ Freeboard .....................................

Speed (highway) .................................... 44 m.p.h. Speed (water) ...................................... Radius of action (land) ............................ Radius of action (water) .......................... Fuel tank .............................................. Fuel consumption (land) ........................ 6-10 m.p.h. 130 miles 46 miles 15V/2 gal. 9.7 m.p.g.

Fuel consumption (water) .................. 4.35 m.p.g. Engine........................Double radiator, water-cooled, details unknown. Brakes ......................................... 4-wheel hydraulic Crew .............................................. ....................... 5

Ignition and Electrical System............ 12-volt Bosch

58*2

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

PORTABLE GANTRY CRANE

GERMAN

The portable Gantry Crane was manufactured in 1942 by J. S. Fries & Son, Frankfurt, Germany. It has a capacity of 33,000 pounds, and is used by field tank maintenance units in removing turrets and engines from heavy German tanks. With a crew of eight men, the crane can be erected from traveling position to the operating position in an estimated time of twenty minutes. When the crane is in the operating position, it can be moved on its bogies on hard surface ground, or it can be run on rails that engage the flanges on the inside of the bogie wheels. The equipment has a tendency to be top heavy in the traveling position. It is easily erected to the operating position because of its jack-knife tubular legs which are equipped with wire cable tackle blocks and manual winch. The bridge is fabricated from welded "I" beams and angle iron shapes. The hoisting winch and motor assembly are permanently mounted at one end of the bridge. The motor, a ten-horsepower, three-phase, fifty-cycle 220/380-volt squirrel cage induction type, is equipped with magnetic friction brake and a two-station start-and-stop starter. The hoisting block, a twin sheave type using a six-37-strand three-quarter-inch galvanized cable, can be raised or lowered manually when power is off. The trolley is supported by four ball bearing flanged wheels and has ball bearing equipped sheaves. The trolley is traversed manually by a chain.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ................................................ 17250 lb. Weight on front wheels ........................ Weight on rear wheels .......................... Length (overall) ............................................. Length of bridge ................................ 9,170 lb. 8,180 lb. 48 ft.

30 ft., 5 ins.

Length of bridge track ...................... 23 ft., 9 ins. Length of drawbar .......................................... Width (overall) ................................ Width of bridge ............................ 11 ft.

7 ft., 41/ ins. 3 ft., 3 ins. ins.


ins.

Height (overall) .............................. 22 ft., 8


Height in traveling position .......... Height of bridge .............................. Center to center of bridge track...... 8 ft., 2

2 ft., 7/2 ins. 2 ft., 3 ins.

Tread centers (front) .......................................... 5 ft. Tread centers (rear) .............................. 6 ft., 8 ins. Ground clearance at axles .............................. 1 ft. Ground clearance at bogie wheels............ 5/2 ins. Tire size .................................... 34 x 7 (8.00 x 20) Bogie wheel size....150 x 410 mm - 5.9 in. x 16.1 in. Capacity ...................................................... 15 tons.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

62*1

LARGE CALIBER ARTILLERY*


Length of Weight of Barrel in Equipment Cali(lb.) bers 45 PROJECTILE Max. Range (yds.) 26,000 Muzzle Vel. (ft./ sec.) 2,730 H.E. (15

GERMAN

Gun 15 cm K. in Mrs. Laf.

Type of Car. and Traverse

Weight

Type** cm K. gr. 18)

(lbs.)

Remarks Probably used on platform for coast defense Probably mfd. by Krupp Krupp, Essen Krupp, Essen 360 on platform. Krupp, Essen Skoda design Both reported to be very similar to 21 cm K. 39 Muzzle brake fitted

94.6 94.6 94.6 138 249 265 278

K. 18 (149 mm) K. 39 (149 mm) K. in Mrs. Laf. cm Mrs. 18 cm K. 38 cm K. 39 cm K. 39/40 cm K. 39/41 cm K. 42 cm H. 39 cm H. 39/40 cm K. 3 (238 mm) 24 cm K. 18 (238 mm) 28 cm H.L./12 28 cm Kst. H. 35.5 cm M. 1 42 cm Gamma Mrs. 61.5 cm Mrs. 15 cm K. (E) 17 cm K. (E) 20 cm K. (E) (203 mm) 21 cm K. 12 (E) 21 cm K. 12V (E). 21 cm K. 12N (E) 24 cm Th. Br. K (E) (238 mm) 24 cm Th. K. (E) (238 mm) 28 cm Ks. Br. K. (E) 28 cm Ig. Br. K. (E)

Mod. Box Trail 12' Split Trail 60 Mod. Box Trail 16 Mod. Box Trail 16 Field 360 Field 360

28,459 27,280 38,500 36,700 78,000 74,800

55 55.4 50 31 50 45

27,040 27,040 32,370 18,300 37,200 32,800

2,840 2,840 3,035 1,854 2,870 2,620.

H.E. (15 cm K. gr. 18) H.E. (15 cm K. gr. 18) H.E.B.C. (17 cm K. gr. 38 Hb.) H.E. (21 cm gr. 18) H.E. (21 cm K. gr. 38) H.E. (21 cm gr. 40)

Field 360' 6 Field 6 Static 360 Static 360 Field Static 45

59,400 119,000
]118,800

28 46 (55?) 55 12 12

37,000 19,700 41,000 40,500 11,400 12,500 21,900

2,820 1,970 3,248 3,180 1,150 1.243 1,870 1,485 1,380 2,800 2,870 3,030 5,330 H.E. (28 cm Spr. gr. L./3.5 m. Bdz.), H.E. (28 cm Sprgr. L./3.5 m. Bdz.) Anticoncrete (35.5 cm gr. Be.) Anticoncrete (s. Gr. Be.) Anticoncrete (gaschosse L./4.1 fiir Karl gerat) H.E. (15 cm K. gr. 18) H.E.B.C. (17 cm Sprgr. L./4.7 Kz. m. Hb.) H.E.B.C. (20.3 cm Sprgr. L./4.7 m. Hb.) H.E.B.C. (21 m. Hb.) cm gr. 35 236 H.E. (24 cm gr. 39) H.E. (24 cm gr. 35) 365 331 332 770 770 825 2,249 2,253 4,400 94.6

Skoda design similar to 21 cm K. 39 Later version of 24 cm H. 39

111,000 81,500 165,000 308,000 264,000

Fires splined projectile, Rheinmetal Borsig Uses DeBange Type obturator. Obsolete except for coastal defense Similar to 28 cm. H.L./12. Fires same projectile

16 8 40 40 55 196

15,500 15,300 25,200 29,200 40,000 131,000

Similar to last war equipment Reported to have an auxiliary 54 cm barrel Naval design. Krupp. Same projectile as 15 cm K. 18 Naval design. Krupp Naval design. Also known as 20 cm S. K. C./34 Splined projectile. Differences are not known Believed to involve an alteration of the rifling

Rly. 360 Rly. 360 Rly. Turntable 360 Rly. Rly. Rly. Rly. 1

167,000 176,000 189.500 744,000

138 247

207,000

35

22,200

2,210

H.E.B.C. (24 cm Sprgr. L./4.5 Bdz. u Kz. m. Hb. ung) H.E.B.C. (24 cm Sprgr. L./4.2 m. Bdz. u Kz. m. Hb.) H.E.B.C. (28 L./4.1 Kz. H.E.B.C. (28 L./4.4 m. m. Hb.) cm Sprgr. m. Hb.) cm Sprgr. Bdz. u Kz.

328

Sister piece to "Theodor Kanone"

Rly.

209,000

40 (48?) 40 45

29,000

2.660

330 529

"Theodor Kanone" Naval design Naval design Carriages are believed to be very similar

Rly. Rly.

262,000 271,000

32,300 40,500

2,690 2,820

626

Naval design

28 cm s. Br. K. (E)

Rly.

286,000

50

40,500

2,880

H.E.B.C. (28 cm Sprgr. L./4.4 m. Bdz. u Kz. m. Hb.) H.E.B.C. (28 cm Gr. 39 m. Hb.) H.E.B.C. (28 cm Gr. 35)

626 496 550

Naval design Probably splined projectile Weight does not include turntable. Fires splined projectile. Also reported to fire a rocket assisted shell (28 cm R. Gr. L/4.7) with range of 53 miles. Differences from 28 cm K5 are unknown

28 cm Br. N. K. (E) 28 cm K. 5 (E)

Rly. Rly. 1 Turntable 360

330,000 480,000 76

50,200 63,000

3,260 3,670

28 cm K. 5/1 (E) 28 cm K. 5/2 (E) 38 cm Siegfried K. (E) 40 cm K. (E) (406 mm) 80 cm Gustav Geschiitz Rly. Turntable 360 Rly. 710,000 2,750,000 55 (52?) 50 35 61,000 49,000 51,500 3,450

H.E.B.C. (28 cm Gr. 42) H.E.B.C. (28 cm Gr. 42) H.E.B.C. (38 cm Sprgr. L./4.5) (Si) 1,096 1,320 2,100 16,700

3,450 H.E. (40 cm gr. 40) 2,790

Naval design. Also fires a 1,764 lb. shell with maximum range of 46,000 yds. Naval design-Adolf. K.

*Almost all the data given have not been verified by tests performed by any Allied government and information from sources available varies considerably in reliability and degree of confirmation. **Of the several types of projectiles fired by each weapon, only one believed to give maximum range is listed.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1001

RAILWAY GUN
28 cm K5 (E)

GERMAN

The German 28 cm K5 (E) has an unconfirmed range of 31 miles and fires a pre-engraved projectile weighing approximately 550 pounds. It is fired from a turntable affording a 360 traverse. The gun has a 70-foot 8-inch barrel held in a sleeve-type cradle. The barrel recoil mechanism, fitted between two arms projecting downward from the cradle, consists of two hydropneumatic cylinders and a single hydraulic buffer cylinder. The cradle is supported by trunnions which rest in bearings on top of a box-like frame, of girder construction, which in turn is supported on two pintles resting in bearings in the center of two 12-wheel trucks. The front pintle bearing rides in a rail on the front truck and can be positioned six inches either side of center, thereby allowing a car traverse of approximately 1 . The equipment in effect has a double recoil action. Besides the barrel recoil which is approximately 32 inches, the gun car recoils. It is coupled to the front of the turntable platform by a hydraulic buffer and a hydropneumatic counterrecoil mechanism which returns the car to battery position. A turntable platform is transported as part of the equipment and in transport forms a flat car with a 103-foot bed resting on two 8-wheel trucks. A central jack helps support the tremendous weight of the gun and carriage which amounts to around 230 tons and also serves as a central pivot for the turntable. The powder chamber is approximately 10 feet 5 inches long. Obturation is obtained by means of a short brass cartridge case and the breech is closed with a horizontal sliding type of breechblock. Firing is of the percussion type.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 280 mm (11 ins.)
Length of barrel ................................ 70 ft., 8 ins. Length of tube .................................. 67 ft., 5 ins. Length of rifling ............................................. 57 ft.

Rifling .............................. Right Hand uniform twist Weight of barrel (Leopold)*.................. 187,880 lb. Length of car ...................................... 95 ft., 7 ins. Length of carriage ............................ 69 ft., 8 ins. Width of carriage (overall) .............. 8 ft., 8V2 ins.

Number of grooves ............................................. 12


W idth of grooves ........................................... Depth of grooves .
5/

in.

.................................... 17/64 in.

54,680 yds.** Max. range ........................................ Traverse on turntable ...................................... 360


Carriage traverse (approx.) ............ V/2 R; /2 L Elevation (estimated) ......................................... . 50

Ammunition............Separate loading-steel splined projectile Weight of projectile (approx.).................... 550 lb.

*Two of these guns were found in Italy; one was


called "Leopold," and the other "Robert." The weight of the barrel on the latter model is 187,165 pounds. **Not verified.

10092

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

HEAVY FIELD GUN


21 cm K. 39
_ ____II _I_~____

GERMAN

__

__

__

__

The 21 cm heavy field gun (K. 39), an original Skoda design, was taken over by the German Army shortly after the invasion of Czechoslovakia. For transport, the equipment may be broken down into three loads, each of which is mounted on two 2-wheeled, pneumatic-tired bogies. The piece consists of an autofrettaged monobloc barrel and loose liner, and a breech ring. The breechblock is of the interrupted screw threaded type, incorporating an obturator pad, obturator spindle and percussion firing lock. On recoil, the piece slides in a cylindrical sleeve in the cradle. The upper carriage is fitted to a turntable which revolves on a ball race mounted in the platform. The platform consists of a rectangular sheet steel box which is dug into the ground. Four removable arms located at the corners of the platform support it by bearing on the ground by means of special feet. During transport, the arms are lowered and serve to support the platform on its bogies. The traversing and elevating mechanisms, each with twospeed gearing, are operated from handwheels on the left of the carriage. Four types of ammunition are used in the gun: the original Czech high explosive shell; a German version of the same shell with the base fuze omitted; an anti-concrete shell with ballistic cap and base fuze; and an armor-piercing shell with base fuze. It is loaded at 80 elevation with the help of a special 2-wheeled shell trolley. There are two other versions of the weapon, the K. 39/40 and the 39/41. Although the two later models are modifications of the original Skoda design, they do not differ in main performance details.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliker ...................................... 210 mm (8.27 ins.)

Weight (traveling position) Three loads approx. 161/2 tons each Weight (firing position) .......................... 37.2 tons Length of barrel including breech ring.... 31.3 ft. Muzzle velocity (max.) ............................ 2,625 f/s

Max. range (horizontal) ........................ 32,800 yds. Traverse ............................. ...... ........ 3600

W t. of max. charge .................................... 82.8 Ibs. Elevation Depression ....................... .................... ........ ... .......... 45

.............. - 4

Ammunition .......................

E.; Anti-concrete;: A.P.

Wt. of projectile .................................... All 298 lbs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

100e3

RAILWAY GUN
20 cm K. (E)

GERMAN

Batteries of these railway guns in concrete emplacements were found on both the Cherbourg and Brest Peninsulas in France. Equipment consisted of the gun, carriage, turntable, power plant and electrical operating unit, and ammunition car. The piece is of the built-up type, consisting of a tube and two jackets. It is screwed into the breech ring. The breechblock is of the horizontal sliding wedge type. The hydropneumatic recoil system has two cylinders located under the carriage; the pistons are fastened to the lower end of the breech ring. The carriage, when mounted on a turntable, has a traverse of 360 degrees; it is estimated that elevation is from 0 to 840 mils. The turntable, consisting of two sections bolted together, rotates on a central pivot and a portable circular track. Four wheels at each end of the turntable support it on the track. Electric motors are geared through these wheels to rotate the piece in azimuth. It is very similar to the 28 cm K. 5 (E) reported on page 100.2. A small ammunition car, equipped with a removable roof, is mounted on trucks and runs on a two-rail track which is built in as a part of the turntable track.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight Weight Caliber Weight of gun ...................................... 45500 lbs. of carriage w/ gun .............. 189,000 lbs. .................................... 203 mm (7.982 ins.) (firing position) ............................ 92.5 tons

Length (traveling position) .......... 63 ft. (approx.) Height (traveling position) .............................. 13 ft. Height (firing position) ..................................

Width (overall)

.............................. 13 ft. (approx.)

Track .......................... Std. railway gage 561/2 ins. Length of tube .................................... 30 ft., 7 ins. Length of tube and breech ............. 32 ft., 81/2 ins. Length of rifling ............................................. No. of grooves ................................. Depth of grooves ................... 22 ft. Rifling ............................................ Uniform R.H. twist .......... . 64 Width of grooves .................... 0.188 in. (approx.) .125 in. (approx.) ............ 2,800 f/s W idth of lands ................................ Muzzle velocity (shell) ............................

Range (est.) ............................................. 36,000 yds. Traverse (on turntable) .................................... 360 Elevation (estimated) ........................................... . 47 Depression ........................................... ....... ...... 0 Length of recoil (from recoil index slide) 251/2 ins. Ammunition................APCBC, APBC, HE, Practice, Illuminating with parachute W t. of projectile .......................................... 259 lbs. Wt. of propellant (max. charge) ............ 96.5 lbs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

102.1

HEAVY FIELD GUN


15 cm K. 16

GERMAN

The 15 cm K. 16 differs from other German 15 cm guns by reason of its appreciably heavier projectile. The ammunition

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 150 mm (5.9 ins.) Weight in action .................................. 24,000 lbs.

employed in the K. 16 is not interchangeable with other guns of the caliber. This weapon is generally regarded as obsolete, although it may be employed as a coast defense weapon or in some other static role. The piece may be used on the 21 cm Howitzer carriage and then may be known as 15 cm K in Mrs. Laf. Features of the 15 cm K. 16 are: the location of the buffer and recuperator below the piece; a large three-ribbed collar which surrounds the piece just forward of the breech ring; a cylindrical breech ring; and a box-type trail terminating in a spade of massive dimensions.

Length of piece .......................................... 248 ins. Elevation ............................ Depression ........................ 420

.................................

............ . -3 8

Traverse ...................... ....................

Maximum range ................................ 21,370 yds.*


Maximum muzzle velocity ...................... 2.480 f/s' Ammunition ........................................ H. E. Capped

Weight of projectile .................................... 113 lb.

Propellant
16 lb. Ngl R.P. plus 3 oz. igniter powder 26 lb. Ngl R.P. plus 3 oz. igniter powder 29 lb. Ngl R.P. plus 3 oz. igniter powder

*Not verified.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

104.1

MEDIUM FIELD GUN


15 cm K. 18

GERMAN

This weapon was being replaced by the 15 cm K. 39 during the closing months of the European war. For transport, the K. 18 may be broken down into two loads and drawn by either horse or truck. The built-up tube consists of a main tube, breech jacket, and breech ring. Rifling is a 60 constant twist. Hydraulic recoil and hydropneumatic counterrecoil cylinders are of standard German design. The buffer is located below, and the recuperator above the piece. A rectangular breech ring has a crank-operated horizontal sliding type breechblock opening to the right. Two pneumatic, push-type equilibrators are incorporated in the design. Elevation and depression are accomplished by means of an off-center elevating arc which is operated by a handwheel on the left side of the piece. The traversing handwheel is also located on the left. The carriage is mounted on two rubber-tired wheels and has a hollow, box-type trail allowing a total traverse of 12 degrees. The ammunition is semi-fixed; there are three charges.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ...................................................... 149 mm
Weight (firing position) ........................ 28,400 lbs.

Maximum chamber pressure.... 41,200 lbs./sq. in.


Length of barrel .......................................... 323 ins. Twist of rifling, constant ............................... ..... 6 Length of rifling .......................................... 253 ins.

Volume of chamber ..........................

1,770 cu. ins.


2,840 f/s

Muzzle velocity ..........................................

Max. range (horiontal) ............................ 27,000 yds. Traverse ........................ .................... 12

Elevation ..........................
Depression .........................

.....................
.................... .

43
2

Length of recoil .........................................


Ammunition types-HE: anticoncrete

1,450 mm

Weight of max. charge ........................ 42.5 lbs. Weight of projectile (HE) .................... 94.6 lbs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 June, 1945

104e3

MEDIUM FIELD GUN


15 cm K. 39

GERMAN

The K. 39 was gradually replacing the K. 18 as Germany's standard medium mobile artillery weapon. It is basically the same design as the earlier model, and has an identical range, muzzle velocity, and chamber pressure. Modifications to the piece, while extensive, were confined largely to the carriage, which resembles the 15 cm s. F. H. 18, page 105. The tube is approximately two inches longer than that of the K. 18, and the rifling was changed from a 6 constant twist to a
variable one, increasing from 4 17' to 50 59'. The breech mechan-

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ....................... ...................... 149 mm Weight (traveling position) ........................... Weight (firing position) ...................... 27,300 lbs. Length (traveling position) ........................... Length (firing position) .................................. Height (traveling position) ........................... Height (firing position) .................................. Width (overall) ............................................ Width of trail spread ...................................... Twist of rifling-increasing ............ Length of barrel ........................................ Length of rifling ...................................... Volume of chamber ........................ 4 17' to 5 325 ins. 256.6 ins.

ism is of the horizontal sliding block type. The hydraulic recoil cylinder is apparently the same as that on the K. 18, but the hydropneumatic counterrecoil cylinder is shorter and larger in diameter than that of the earlier model. Length of recoil varies from 1250 mm to 1500 mm (49.2 inches to 59.2 inches). The equilibrators of both the K. 18 and the K. 39 are of the push type, but those on the K. 39 are spring activated. Elevation and traverse are accomplished in much the same manner, changes being principally in the location of the handwheels. A rigid gunners' platform constructed of a non-skid open steel lattice work is bolted to the upper carriage. Although awkward in appearance, it performs the function for which it was intended without hampering the movements of the crew about the gun. Traverse has been increased from 12 to 60 by the use of a split trail with detachable spades instead of the box-type trail used on the K. 18.

1,829 cu. ins. 2,840 f/s

Muzzle velocity .........................................

Max. range (horizontal) .............................. 24.7 km Rate of fire ................................. Traverse ....................................... Elevation .................... D epression .... ............... ......... . 60 45 4

.................... .........

..................................... ....

Length of recoil (max.) ............................

1,500 mm

Ammunition types-H.E.; anticoncrete, APHE Weight of max. charge ............................ 41.2 Ibs. Weight of projectile (HE) ........................ 94.6 lbs.

104.4

1 une,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

HEAVY ANTIAIRCRAFT GUN


12.8 cm Flak 40

GERMAN

i,

This weapon, together with the 8.8 cm Flak 41, is Germany's standard heavy antiaircraft gun. There are four different type mounts used with the gun: mobile, static, railway, and a twin mounting. When used with the latter, the equipment is known as the 12.8 cm Flakzwilling. In construction and appearance this weapon resembles the 10.5 cm antiaircraft gun described on page 109. The barrel consists of a three-piece tube with jacket and sleeve. The breech mechanism is of the horizontal sliding block type, and an electric firing device is used. A hydropneumatic recuperator is located above the barrel, and a hydraulic buffer below. Elevating and traversing may be operated either by power or by handwheels; are located on the right side of the equiprent with the layers seated facing the gun. A machine fuze setting gear and loading and ramming gear identical with those of the 10.5 cm Flak are used. The static mounting is a pedestal type secured to a concrete base. The cradle pivots in trunnions mounted at the extreme rear of the upper carriage, and almost in line with the breechblock. A large box-like construction, located underneath the buffer and forward of the elevating arc, contains the oil motors. The equilibrators extend from an anchoring just forward of the trunnions to the forward edge of the casing containing the oil motors. The gun being extremely high off the ground, platforms for the gun crew are provided. The gun is fitted to receive firing data by remote control transmission.- A normal panoramic sight is provided as well as an antitank sight.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ...................................... 12.8 cm (5.04 ins.) Weight (static mount) .......................... 28,600 Las. Weight (traveling position) .................... 59.400 lbs. Mobile mount Weight (firing position) ........................ 37,400 lbs. Mobile mount Length (traveling position) .............................. 49 ft. overall Length (firing position) .................................. 29 ft. overall Height (traveling position) ................................ Height (firing position) .................................. Height of trunnions (firing position).......... 75/s ft. Width (overall) ............................................. Length of piece ............... 308.5 ins. (61 calibers) Length of rifling .................................... 255.13 ins. Twist of rifling (increasing)........ 3 20' to 5 30' 40 No. of grooves ............................................... Width of grooves (forward section) .......... 0.26 in. (center section) ............ 0.25 in. Depth of grooves ........................................ 0.06 in. Width of lands (forward section) ............. 0.13 in. (center section) ............. 0.14 in. Muzzle velocity (H.E. shell) .................... 2886 f/s Max. range (horizontal)..20.950 meters (22.910 yds.) Max. ceiling at 85............14,800 meters (48,555 ft.) Rate of fire .......................................... 12 r.p.m. 360 Traverse ...................................................... ........... 88 Elevation ...................................... Depression ............................................... -3 Length of recoil .......................... from 36 to 51 ins. Ammunition ............................................ A.P.C., H.E. Wt. of complete round (approx.)................ 106 Ibs. W1. of H.E. projectile (12.8 cm Sprgr. Patr. 57 lbs. 1. 4.5) ....................................................... Wt. of A.P.H.E. projectile (12.8 cm Pzgr.
Patr.) ................................ ...... ...... . . 58.13 lbs.

RESTRICTED

Replacement Page

OFCE

CHIEF

OF

RDNANCE

1 August,

1945

106.1

MEDIUM FIELD GUN


12.8 cm K. 44

GERMAN

Left: Rheinmetall Model: Right: Krupp Model.

There are two versions of the 12.8 cm dual purpose, antitank/field gun, one manufactured by Rheinmetall and the other by Krupp. The Rheinmetall model has a slightly longer breech ring; the carriage has one rear axle and two front axles, whereas the Krupp model has one rear and one front axle. Reports indicate that there may be a third version designated 12.8 cm K. 81. The tube, of monobloc construction, is equipped with a cylindrical muzzle brake having perforations on both sides. The muzzle brake of the Krupp model is shorter and has the greater number of perforations. The manually operated breechblock is of the horizontal sliding type. A variable hydropneumatic recoil mechanism is provided, the recoil and recuperator cylinder being carried within the cradle. Two hydropneumatic equilibrators, one on either side of the tube, compensate for muzzle preponderance. The piece is mounted on a cruciform platform. The carriage, which incorporates torsion bar suspension, is jacked off the wheels in firing and, with the outriggers extended, a 3600 traverse may be obtained. Elevating and traversing handwheels are fitted to both sides of the carriage, and a seat for the gunner is provided on the left. A single shield is used with the Krupp gun, while the Rheinmetall version is equipped with a spaced shield. Both types, however, are angular in appearance and the sides are swept back towards the rear.

SPECIFICATIONS
Rheinmetall Length of gun (including muzzle brake and breech ring) .............. Length of gun (including brech ring)............ Length of chamber (from rifling) ........................ 413/4 ins. 41/4 ins. 2771/2 ins. 277s/ ins. 3121/2 ins. 299 ins. Krupp

Length of rifling............

2191/2 ins.

2191/2 ins.

Overall

length

(travel433

ing position) .............. not determined

Overall

width

(travel10814 ins.

ing position) ..............

98

ins.

Overall

height (travel81 ins.

ing position) ..............

90

ins.

10692

August,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

LIGHT FIELD HOWITZER


10.5 cm 1. F. H. 18 (M)

GERMAN O

In order to obtain longer range, the 105 mm German Howitzer 1. F. H. 18 was modified so that the muzzle velocity of the weapon could be increased. The Germans accomplished this by preparing a new propellant charge (Fern ladung-long range charge) which increases the muzzle velocity from approximately 1,542 feet per second to 1,772 feet per second, and the range from approximately*1,670 yards to 13,500 yards. To compensate for the increased velocity and the resulting recoil, the Germans found it necessary to add a muzzle brake. It was also necessary to slightly modify the recoil mechanism and to increase the nitrogen pressure in the counterrecoil cylinders from 730 pounds per square inch to 854 pounds per square inch. To differentiate between the two models, the letter "M" (Miindungsbremse-Muzzle Brake) was added to the old nomenclature, hence the later model is known as the 1. F. H. 18 (M). The tube is of monobloc construction. The weapon has a continuous pull firing mechanism and a breech mechanism of the horizontal sliding type. The carriage, of riveted and welded steel, is equipped with split trails, folding spades, wooden wheels with rubber tires, and a protective armor shield 4 mm thick. It also has hand operated friction brakes.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ...................................... 105 mm (4.13 ins.)
Weight (traveling position) ................... 4,255 lbs.

Weight (firing position) ..............................


Length (traveling position) ................ 19 ft.. 6 ins. Length (firing position).... 20 ft.. 5 ins. (at 0 elev.) Height (traveling position) .............. 5 ft., 9 ins. Height (firing position) ........................ 5 ft., 9 ins. Width (overall) ................................ 6 ft., 6V2 ins. Width of trail spread ........................ 15 ft.. 10 ins. Length of bore ........................................ 25.7 cals. No. of grooves ............ 32-R.H. Progressive Twist Width of grooves ......................................... Depth of grooves .......................................... Width of lands ............................................. Muzzle velocity (maximum) ............... Traverse .......................... ........................ 1,772 f/s' Max. range (horizontal) (Reported)...... 13.500 yds. ........................ 56 .......... ........... ... 40 7 ....................... . Elevation ......................... Depression

Length of recoil .......................... 39.3 ins.-46.8 ins. Ammunition....................H.E. w/P.D. Fuze: Hollow Charge; Smoke; A.P.: Incendiary Wt. of projectile.. 32/4 lb. (Long Range H.E. Shell) *Reports indicate that a special long range H.E. shell weighing approximately 32/4 lb. is used with the super charge to obtain this muzzle velocity.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

108.1

MOUNTAIN HOWITZER
10.5 cm Geb. H. 40

GERMAN

The 10.5 cm Geb. H. 40, introduced into the German Army in 1942, is the companion piece to the 7.5 cm Geb. G. 36 described on page 118. Its design is basically the same as that of the 10.5 cm le. F. H. 18 (M). The weapon can be split into nine loads for transport. The barrel, of monobloc construction, is fitted with a double baffle muzzle brake with wide side flanges; the breech mechanism is of the horizontal sliding block type. A hydraulic buffer is built into the cradle on which the barrel slides in recoil, and a hydropneumatic recuperator is mounted above the barrel. The split trail carriage has trails of riveted box construction which are fitted with large detachable spades. It is mounted on wheels of cast light alloy with detachable rims and solid rubber tires. The wheels are mounted on stub axles fitted to the trail legs and remain parallel to the legs when they are opened. Internal expanding brakes, adjusted by a handwheel from the front, are fitted to both wheels. The traversing and elevating handwheels are located on the left and right sides of the carriage respectively. There are two range drum scales: one in mils ranging from 0 to 1,250; the other in meters ranging from 0 to 1,500 for hollow charge ammunition and from 1,500 to 9,675 for high explosive shells, both with charge 6 in the lower register.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ...................................... 105 mm (4.14 ins.)
Weight (traveling position) ......................... Weight (firing position) ............................ 3.660 lb. Length of piece .................................... 10 ft., 4 ins. Length (firing position) .................... 18 ft., 6 ins. Height (traveling position) ........................... Height (firing position) .................... 4 ft., 11 ins. Width (overall) .................................... 4 ft., 6 ins. Width of trail spread.................................. Length of bore ...................................... 9 ft., 5 ins. No. of grooves ................................. .......... . 32 Width of grooves ........................................... Depth of grooves ........................................... Width of lands ............................................ Muzzle velocity ...................................... 1870 f/s Max. range (horizontal) .......... 13,807 yds. (Chg. 7)

Max. range (vertical) ......................................


Rate of fire ................................ .............. , Traverse ................................ 25 20' left and right

Elevation ......................
Depression

.....................
-4

70
4 7'

...........................................

Length of recoil (variable).... 19.7 ins. to 49.2 ins.


Ammunition....10.5 cm F.H. Gr. Al. (32 lb.)* 10.5 cm F.H. Gr. 38 Al.

10.5 cm F.H. Gr. Buntrauch (32 lb.) 10.5 cm 39 rot HL/A and HL/B (25.8 lb.)-Chg. 6 only.
10.5 cm 39 rot AL/C *A star shell is also reported to be fired with Charge 6.

108*2

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

LIGHT FIELD HOWITZER


10.5 cm le. F. H. 18/40

GERMAN

Feeling the need of a weapon having the performance characteristics of the le. F. H. 18 (M) but lighter in weight, the Germans brought out, early in 1944, a modified version mounted on the carriage of the 7.5 cm Pak 40. This carriage was used because at that time it was in large scale production and required a minimum amount of modification to adapt it for use with the howitzer. The piece, of monobloc construction with a removable breech ring, is fitted with a double baffle muzzle brake having projecting wings welded on to give it the increased efficiency necessary for the lightened carriage. The breech mechanism is a manually operated horizontal sliding block type. The firing mechanism is of the percussion type with the lever on the left side of the cradle. The cradle is a rectangular box design. A single hydropneumatic equilibrator is attached to the right side of the cradle. The recoil is a hydropneumatic type, independent system. The elevating handwheel and firing mechanism are now so located on the left hand side of the carriage that the layer can carry out the three operations of traversing, elevating, and firing, making the weapon suitable for direct fire. The suspension consists of two torsion bars each extending the full width of the carriage body. As the two pieces are ballistically identical, the le. F. H. 18 (M) and the le. F. H. 18/40 use the same range tables. A normal type of German artillery field sight is used for laying.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ Length Height Height Width 105 mm (4.13 ins.)
4,322 lbs. Weight (firing position) ..........................

(overall) .................................. 20 ft., 2 ins. (overall) ....................... ........................ 6 ft. (firing position) .................................. 6 ft., 11 ins. (overall) ..................................

Length of barrel excluding muzzle 115.75 ins. brake ................................................. 106.66 ins. Length of tube ......................................... Length of rifling .................................... 93.06 ins. Rifling..............................Increasing twist; 1 in. 23 to 1 in. 17/4 ........... . 32 No. of grooves ........................................ Width of grooves ...................................... 0.220 in. Depth of grooves ...................................... 0.04 in. Muzzle velocity (H.E. long range shell).. 1.772 f/s W t. of projectile............................... 32 lbs., 11 ozs. Max. range (horizontal) ........................ 13,479 yds. Max. range (vertical) ...................................... Max. pressure ............................ 34.000 lbs./sq. in. .............. Rate of fire ................................. ...................... .. 56 Traverse ...................... ..................... 40 Elevation ........................ ....................... 6 Depression ....................... Length of recoil ............................................ Ammunition........H.E.: H.E./I; Incendiary; Smoke; Star Shell; Prop. Leaflet Shell; Hollow Charge; Indicator Shell.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

108.3

SMOKE MORTAR
10 cm Nebelwerfer 35

GERMAN

TRAVERSIN( G GEAR SIGHT BI RACKET

BARREL

CROSS LEVELING GEAR BASE PLATE ELEVATING TUBE BIPOD

The 10 cm Nebelwerfer, standard smoke and chemical mortar in use by the German Army, has also been used, to some extent, by airborne troops. It is serviced by five men and transported on a two-wheeled handcart.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 105 mm (4.1 ins.) W eight in action ............................................ 228 lb. Weight of barrel .......................................... Weight of bipod ...................................... Weight of baseplate .................................... 72 lb. 73 lb. 83 lb.

Although the standard ammunition for the weapon is a 16pound smoke shell designated Wurfgranate 35, a 19-lb. high explosive shell, Wurfgranate 40 is also used.

Method of operation......Muzzle loaded: percussion fired Maximum range .................................. 3,300 yds.*

Rate of fire .................................... 12-15 rds./min. Ammunition........................................H.E. and Smoke

The mortar, which is merely a heavier and larger model of the German 8 cm mortar, consists of a barrel, bipod, and baseplate constructed on the usual mortar lines. The traversing gear, however, is unusual in that the traversing screw is housed in a sleeve which is supported by the two ends of a box-shaped yoke secured to the top of the elevating screw.

Weight of shell ...... 16 lb. (Wurfgranate 35) Smoke 19 lb. (Wurfgranate 40) H.E. Transport .............................. 2-wheeled handcart

*Not verified.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1.10.1

SMOKE MORTAR
10 cm Nebelwerfer 40

GERMAN

This weapon is designed for either smoke, chemical, or high explosive ammunition. The smooth-bored tube of monobloc construction is independent of the breech and breech block. When the piece is loaded, both breech and breech block remain stationary, and the back end of the tube moves outward in a vertical direction in grooves cut into the inside of the legs of the breech block. During this operation, the tube pivots about its trunnions located midway between the muzzle and breech ends. There is no spring tension in the breech mechanism so that its movement is entirely manual. The piece is fired by percussion, a spring-driven firing pin being located in the breech block. The firing lever is located just below the breech operating lever. There are two recoil cylinders, one located on either side of the tube. The cylinders are anchored to the ends of the frame, and the pistons attached to the sides of the breech. The counterrecoil system is located above the tube. Its cylinder is attached to the frame, and the piston to the yoke. Apparently both the recoil and the counterrecoil system is hydropneumatic. The weapon is fired from the base plate (missing in photo) and wheels. In order to traverse the piece, it is pivoted about a ball and socket joint in the base plate by means of an axle traversing mechanism of ordinary design. Elevation is controlled by two parallel arcs which travel on pinions geared to and rotated by the elevating handwheel. Both traversing and elevating handwheels are located on the left side, as is also the sight bracket.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber Weight Weight Length Length Length ................................. 105 mm (4.1 in.) (traveling position) ................... ........... (firing position) ........................... 1,730 lb. (traveling position) ......................... (firing position) ................................. of barrel ....... .............. (16 cals.) 66 ins.

Height (traveling position) ..................................

Height (firing position) ................................... Width (overall) ............................................


Width of trail spread ................................... Longth of bore No. of grooves Width of grooves ............................. Smooth bore Depth of grooves

Width of lands
426-1.380 f/s* Muzzle velocity .............................. 6,810 yds.** Max. range (horizontal) ...................... Min. range (horizontal) ............................ 1.668 yds. Max. range (vertical) ...................................... Rate of fire ...................................... 8-10 rds./mln. ........................ ... 14 Traverse ........................... ........... . 45-85 Elevation ......................................... Depression .................. ........................... ...... Length of recoil ........................................... ..... H.E.; Smoke; Chemical* Ammunition ............ Wt. of projectile ....................... H.E.-(20.6 lbs.) Smoke-21.9 lbs.) *No chemical ammunition has ever been captured, although it is believed that the gun is designed for that type of shell. "Not verified.

110*2

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

RECOILLESS GUN
10.5 cm L. G. 42 and 42/1

GERMAN

This weapon represents modifications of the 10.5 cm L. G. 40 described on page 110. It is a product of Rheinmetall, and was introduced into the German Army in 1943. The principal changes are as follows: the venturi tube has three steel strips spirally welded to the inner lip presumably to offset torque; elevation of the equipment examined was limited to approximately 30 by a fixed stop; the carriage has been completely changed-it now consists of a single tubular axle to which wheel spindles and three folding trail legs are fitted; a horizontal sliding type breechblock (resembling that of the 7.5 cm L. G. 40) has been installed; the weight has been increased by approximately one-third; the design of the shield differs from the earlier model; the percussion firing mechanism has been retained on top of the breechring necessitating the use of a cartridge case with a side primer. Maximum range is approximately the same as the 10.5 cm L. G. 40 and both models use the same range table. The equipment has been designed to break down into five loads for use as pack or airborne artillery. The two models, 10.5 cm L. G. 42 and L. G. 42/1, differ principally in weight. As in the case of the 7.5 cm L. G. 40 and 10.5 cm L. G. 40, the characteristic feature of this weapon is the lack of recoil attained by allowing part of the propellant gases to escape to the rear through a venturi tube. The resulting blast creates a danger zone approximately 20 yards wide and 50 yards long to the sides and rear of the gun. The sharp sound of the discharge through the venturi tube makes it necessary for the gun crew to use ear plugs.

SPECIFICATIONS
Length of piece (including breech ring and venturi) ............................................ Length of rifling ...................................... Tw ist of rifling ......................... 72.28 ins. 31.41 ins. 10 32

......................

No. of grooves ............................................... Length of venturi tube ............................

18.18 ins.

Length of chamber .................................. 18.93 ins. Capacity of chamber .................................. Weight in action (L. G. 42) .................. 9.5 pints 1,217 lbs.

(L. G. 42/1) .............. 1,191 lbs. Elevation Traverse at elevations up to 12


at elevations over 12

......................

.......................

15

to 42

................................ 360
.......................... 71

Ammunition................H.E., H. E. I., Hollow Charge, Smoke. Muzzle velocity (H.E. Shell) .................... 1,099 f/s 8,694

Maximum range ..........................................

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

I May, 1945

110.3

ANTITANK GUN
8.8 cm Pak 43

GERMAN

The 8.8 cm Pak 43 is an electrically fired, semiautomatic gun, mounted on a cruciform platform (Kreuzlafette) and transported on two single axle limbers similar to those used on the 8.8 cm Flak 18. It has a very low silhouette, on wheels the height to the top of the shield is 5 feet, 6 inches, and to the trunnions, 4 feet. When emplaced it is 12 inches lower. The gun can be fired from its wheels without extending the side legs, if the direction of fire does not exceed 30 either side of the longitudinal girders. If the direction of fire is greater than 30, the side legs must be extended and the pads brought firmly in contact with the ground. There is an automatic electric cut-out to the firing gear which restricts elevation to 12 on early equipments and 16 on later equipments when firing over the mounting legs. There are several other versions of the Pak 43. The Pak 43/41 (page 113) has a two-wheeled carriage with split trails. The Pak 43/1 (page 34) is a self-propelled gun called the "Rhinoceros." Its chassis is a combination of a Pz. Kw. III and Pz. Kw. IV. The Pak 43 2 (page 39) is a self-propelled gun called the "Elephant"; it is also mounted on the chassis of the Panther (Pz. Kw. V). :All of these guns use the same ammunition and have the same ballistic characteristics.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 88 mm (3.46 ins.)
Weight (traveling position) ...................... 13.000 lb. ...... 7,900 lb. Weight (firing position) ................ Length (traveling position) ................................ Length (firing position) .................................. Height (traveling position) ................ 5 ft., 6 ins. Height (firing position) ........................ 4 ft., 6 ins. Width (overall) ............................................ Length of barrel (w/o muzzle brake)...... 247.5 ins. Length of bore ........................................ 236.9 ins. 32 No. of grooves ........................................... .202 in. Width of grooves .................................. .048 in. Depth of grooves .................................... .134 in. Width of lands ........................................ Muzzle Velocity (A.P.C.B.C. shell) ........ 3,280 f/s (H.E. shell) .................... 2,460 f/s Max. range (horizontal)...... 17,500 yds. (H.E. shell)* Max. range (vertical) ...................................... .............. Rate of fire ................................ .............. 360 Traverse ................................. ..................... 40 Elevation ................... -8 ..................... Depression ....................... Length of recoil (normal) ...................... 47.5 ins. Ammunition .................................... A.P.C.B.C.-H. E. Wt. of projectile .......................... (H.E.) 20.68 lbs.* (A.P.C.B.C.) 22 lbs.

'Unconfirmed

**AP 40 round (tungsten carbide core) 16 lb. Pzgr. Patr. 40/43 ................................ Gr. Patr. 39 HL/A and B .................. 16.8 lb.

RESTRICT FD

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1121

SHORT MORTAR
Kz. 8 cm. Gr. W. 42

GERMAN

This weapon is of the same general design as the standard 8 cm mortar (s. Gr. W. 34) described on page 114. It is, however, shorter and lighter. It differs from the original weapon in the following respects: The Model 42 has a shorter barrel with no striker control bolt at the base. It has a smaller baseplate, square in shape, with no carrying handle. The barrel is fastened to the baseplate by a

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 81 mm (3.2 ins.) 62 Ibs. 29.5 ins. Weight in firing position .............................. Length of barrel, overall ..........................

Length of bore ............................................ 25.5 ins.


Size of baseplate .................... 12 ins. x 12V2 ins. Principle of operation..........Muzzle loaded; percus-

spring catch. It also has a smaller bipod.


Elevation .......................

sion fired (only)


..................... 47 to 88 1,200 yds.

The elevating handle is situated at the base of the elevating column between the bipod legs. The cross levelling screw is halfway down the elevating column, and is connected to the left bipod leg by a sliding screw clamp. The sight is situated on the left side of the traversing screw. Ammunition fired is the same as for the 8 cm s. Gr. W. 34. A firing table printed on a steel plate is clamped to the tube.

Maximum range ...................................... Ammunition..............Same

as for 8 cm s. Gr. W. 34

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 June, 1945

114.1

FIELD GUN (Ex-Russian)


7.62 cm Feldkanone 36 (r)

GERMAN

The 7.62 cm F. K. 36 (r) is a gun of Russian design and manufacture. The Germans captured so many pieces during the early months of the invasion of Russia that they were adopted by the German Army both in the original form for standard divisional field guns and as antitank guns known as the 7.62 cm Pak 36 (r) described on page 116. Both weapons have the same general characteristics: built-up tubes fitted in reinforcing jackets, vertical sliding breech blocks, hydropneumatic recoil mechanisms, and split trail carriages. In addition to a number of minor changes, the principal difference is in the much greater chamber length of the Pak 36 (r)-28.25 inches compared with 15.20 inches, and the addition of a muzzle brake to the Pak 36 (r). The breech mechanism may be operated either by hand or semi-automatically. Extractors housed in the breech ring are operated by cams when the block opens. A hand control on the left side of the breech ring is provided in case the cartridge fails to eject. The firing mechanism is a continuous pull type.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 76.2 mm (3 ins.) 3,619 lb. Weight (complete) ....................................

Weight (firing position) .............................. 3.564 lb. Length (overall) .............................. 22 ft. 61/4 ins. Length of gun ......................................... 153 ins. Height (traveling position) ....................... Height (firing position) ............................ W idth (overall) ........................................... Width of trail spread ............................... Length of rifling ...................................... 120 ins. Length of tube ................................... 12 ft. 2 ins. No. of grooves ............ 32 R.H. Polygroove form: Twist-1 in 25 Uniform (5 mm) Width of grooves .................. 0.196 in. Depth of grooves .................. 0.033 in. (0.84 mm) (2 mm) Width of lands ...................... 0.078 in. Muzzle velocity (A.P.H.E. shell) 2,249 f/s (H.E. -2,335 f/s) Max. range (horizontal) (A.P.-H.E.)...... 14,000 yds. Rate of fire .................................. ........... ........ ... 60 .... Traverse ..................................... .................... 72 Elevation ...................... 4 ............ Depression ........................................ Length of recoil (average)..H.E.-A.P.H.E.-31.1 ins. Ammunition ............................ H.E.-A.P.H.E.-A.P. 40 Wt. of Projectile .......................... H.E.-13.45 lbs. A.P.H.E.-14.2 lbs. A.P. 40-9.2 lbs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

116e1

MOUNTAIN HOWITZER
7.5 cm Gebirgs Kanone 15 (Geb. K. 15)

GERMAN

This 7.5 cm light mountain howitzer used extensively by the German Army is an original Skoda design. The same weapon, designated 75/13, was also used by the Italians. Both armies provided their own ammunition in addition to some Czech and Austrian rounds also utilized. Types of ammunition include high explosive, hollow charge, shrapnel, and armor piercing. The piece is wholly enclosed within a slipper which moves on a cradle extending the whole length of the piece. Breech mechanism is of the horizontal sliding block type. The recoil mechanism, contained within the cradle, consists of a hydraulic buffer and spring recuperator. A 50/50 mixture of water and glycerine is used in the buffer; quantity is approximately one-half gallon. The carriage has wooden wheels and modified box-type trails which curve downward towards the rear. A fixed spade is attached at the rear of the trail. The shield is in two parts: a fixed upper section and a hinged lower one. It is frequently removed altogether when the howitzer is in firing position. For mountain transport, the equipment may be broken down into seven animal loads as follows: upper carriage, slides, cradle, piece, trail and wheels, upper shield, and lower shield. The various sections are carried by mules.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 75 m m (2.95 ins.) Weight (traveling position) ...................... 2,449 lbs. 1,351 lbs. Weight (firing position) .......................... Length (traveling position) .......................... Length (firing position) .................................. Height (firing position) .................................. Height of trunnions .................................... 27.7 ins. Width of carriage ...................................... 37.4 ins. Length of bore............................................. 13 cals. Length of barrel and breech ring.............. 43.8 ins.
Rifling ........................ R.H. polygroove plain section Length of rifling ........................................ No. of grooves ....................... .......... Width of grooves ........................................ Depth of grooves ................................... Width of lands .............................................. 31.2 ins. .......... . 28 5 mm .68 mm 3.5 mm

Muzzle velocity (H.E. shell) ...................... 1,270 f/s W t. of projectile .......................................... 12 lbs. Max. range (horizontal) .......................... Rate of fire .................................. 7,270 yds. M ax. range (vertical) ........................................ ..............

Traverse
Elevation

..................................... ....
................. .................. ...........................

...........
........... -10

7
50

Depression

Length of recoil (max.) .............................. 35.4 ins. Ammunition .......................... H. E. & Hollow Charge

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

122e1

LIGHT INFANTRY HOWITZER


7.5 cm I. G. 37

GERMAN

The 7.5 cm I. G. 37, formerly known as the 7.5 cm Pak 37, consists of a short barreled piece fitted with a muzzle brake, and mounted on the carriage of the obsolete 3.7 cm antitank gun. The equipment has been utilized as a close support infantry weapon. The barrel of monobloc construction is 20V/2 calibers long. The muzzle brake is in the shape of a rectangular box with four baffles, each at approximately a 45 angle deflecting to the rear. There is a hydrospring recoil mechanism and a breech mechanism of the vertical sliding wedge type. The latter has no provision for semi-automatic operation. A percussion type firing mechanism is cocked automatically when the breech is closed, and the gun is fired by pressing a plunger on the elevating handwheel. There is an auxiliary firing lever on the left side of the breech ring. The carriage, which is mounted on two rubber-tired wheels, has split tubular trails. The shield is in two main parts, the upper shield and the lower shield. The lower part hinges upward when travelling, and is swung downward when the weapon is in the firing position. The upper shield is in two sections, the upper half being hinged. This section can be folded forward in order to give a lower silhouette. Traversing, elevating, and sighting are accomplished by one man. Direct sighting is obtained by means of a telescope. A quadrant plane is located on top of the breech ring, and there is also a range drum graduated for firing semi-fixed high explosive and fixed hollow charge ammunition. With the present fire control equipment, the maximum effective range is 2,900 yards.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 75 mm (2.95 ins.) Weight (traveling position) ......................... Weight (firing position) ............................ Length (traveling position) .............. 1.124 lbs.

11 ft., 7 ins.

Length (firing position) .................... 11 ft., 1 in. Height (shield lowered) .......................... 38 Height (shield raised) .............................. ins.

464 ins.

Width (overall)

................................ 5 ft., 3V2 ins.


in. ins. 42

Width of trail spread ........................ 9 ft., 1 Length of rifling ........................................ Rifling ..................................................... No. of grooves ...............................

.R. H. tw ist ........... . 24

Muzzle velocity (H.E. shell) .................... 920 f/s* Max. range ............................................. 5,630 yds. Max. range (present fire control).......... 2,900 yds. Traverse Elevation Depression .................................... .............................. ................................ .................. ...................... .................... 60 221/2
0

Tires ....................................

Pneumatic-6.00 x 20 17 ins.

Length of recoil (max.) ................................

Ammunition ............................ H. E., Hollow Charge Wt. of projectile....H. E.. I. Gr. 18-13.2 lbs. HE-AT, I. Gr. 38HI/A-6.6 Ibs. *Muzzle velocity with hollow charge ammunition is 1,165 f/s. Range, 5,410 yds.

122*2

1 May,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ANTIAIRCRAFT GUN
5 cm Flak 41

GERMAN

This gas-operated, automatic, antiaircraft gun is transported on two-wheeled transporters. To put the gun into action, the platform is lowered from the transporters by means of winding gear. The two transverse legs are lowered and the platform is roughly leveled with jacks. The final leveling is done with leveling screws in the base ring of the mounting. The barrel is removable for easy replacement in the field. The right hand twist of the rifling increases from one in 361/2 to one in 30 calibers. The breech mechanism is similar to that of the 3.7 cm Flak 43. It differs in that the breech block drops into the closed position from the open position. The dropping of the block allows buttress guides on the block to engage with similar guides on the jacket. This locks the block in the firing position and prevents any rearward movement. The feed mechanism is operated by the recoil of the breech casing. The recuperator consists of two spiral springs which are mounted side by side in the cradle. The buffer is mounted centrally in the cradle. The traversing gear and the sight are on the right hand side of the mounting. The sight bracket is connected by means of a parallel motion link to a cross shaft. Here it is keyed to a pointer on the elevation scale. The gun elevating gear is on the left side of the mounting. This is also connected to a pointer on the elevation scale. The layer keeps the two pointers in line and the gun is laid at the same angle of elevation as the sight.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ............................................ 5 cm (1.97 ins.) Weight (traveling position) ...................... 7.18 tons Weight (firing position) .............................. 4.30 tons Length (traveling position) .............. 27 ft., 5.5 ins. Length (firing position) .................... 19 ft., 10 ins. Height (traveling position) .............. 7 ft., 1 in. Height (firing position) .................... 7 ft., 4 Ins. Width (overall-traveling) ................ 7 ft., 10 ins. Width of trail spread ...................................... Length of gun (incl. muzzle brake)........ 184.5 ins. Length of gun (excl. muzzle brake)........ 170.8 ins. Length of rifling ................................... 117.28 ins. No. of grooves ............................... .......... . 20 W idth of grooves ...................................... 0.160 in. Depth of grooves ...................................... 0.020 in. W idth of lands ............................................ Muzzle velocity (H.E. shell) ...................... 2,756 f/s Firing mechanism protrusion ...................... 0.1 in. Max. range (horizontal), APCBC .......... 11,300 yds. Max. range (vertical), APCBC .............. 8600 yds. Effective ceiling ......................................... 10,000 ft. Rate of fire .............................................. 130 r.p.m . Traverse .......................................................... 3600 Elevation ................................................... 90 Depression ........................................ .... -10 Length of recoil .............................. 7 ins. (approx.) Ammunition............H.E. 41/tracer; Incendiary/H.E. 41/tracer; A.P.C.B.C. 42 Wt. of projectile................................H.E.-4.8 lbs. A.P.-4.87 Ibs. Tracer burn out point Short (8 sec.) 2.740-3,750 yds. Long (18 sec.) 5,400-6,120 yds.

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 June, 1945

125

ANTITANK GUN
5 cm Pak 38

GERMAN

The 5 cm Pak 38, introduced during the 1941 campaigns in Greece and Egypt, was developed to combat the more heavily armored vehicles of the Allies. The gun has a barrel of monobloc construction, threaded at the muzzle for attaching a two-baffled muzzle brake. Because of the position of the breech-operating cam, a minimum length of recoil of approximately 181/2 inches is needed to operate the semi-automatic breech mechanism which is of the sliding horizontal block type. The recoil recuperator system is hydropneumatic. The carriage, constructed of welded steel, is mounted on metal disk wheels with solid rubber tires. Torsion bar suspension is automatically locked when the tubular trails are spread. A 5 mm spaced armor shield and single apron protect the gun crew. The left side of the shield has a sighting port. There are five types of ammunition fired from the Pak 38: an armor-piercing capped, high-explosive projectile; a high-explosive shell; an A.P.-H.E. (uncapped) shell; a tungsten carbide core arrowhead type projectile (A.P. 40), and a stick grenade similar to the 3.7 cm grenade described on page 306.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................
Weight

50 mm (1.97 ins.)
15 ft., 3 ins. 9 ft., 3 ins. 5 ft., 1 in.

(complete) .............. 2,015 lbs. (approx.)

Length of gun (overall) ...................... Length of barrel (overall) ................ W idth C-C ............................................

Carriage......................Welded steel w/solid rubber tires and tubular trails Breech mechanism................Horizontal Recoil mechanism ............................ sliding block

Hydropneumatic

Rifling ............ 20 lands & grooves; right-hand twist Muzzle velocity A.P.C.-H.E. .............................. H.E. ........................................ Depression Traverse ......................... 4.5 lb.-2600 f/s 4.0 lb.-1800 f/s 22 -4 80 ..................... ...................

Elevation ................................................

.......................

Sights .................................... Straight tube telescope Ammunition....................A.P.; Penetration A.P.C.; H.E.; A.P. 40

Range
Yards 500

Thickness of armor in mm
30 .............................. 2.6 2.4 2.2 2.0 Normal 3.1 2.9 2.6 2.5

700 .................................. 1000 .................................... 1200 ..................................

126

1 June, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

(Replacement Page)

RESTRICTED

ANTIAIRCRAFT GUN
3.7 cm Flak 18 and 36

GERMAN

/
1:~~~~iif ~ cl".: r

46,
-

~-

;-",:. p. iilrhl-::ili~:r? P~ " ~.~~"~~~ ~I ,afbls_ PsC*-.:IP

THE 3.7 cm FLAK 18

THE 3.7 cm FLAK 36

The performance of both the Flak 18 and the Flak 36 are approximately the same, the latter being the lighter and the more mobile version. The weapon is transported on a trailer; the chassis consisting of a "U" shaped steel frame mounted on two pneumatic tires. The weapon and its firing mount may be detached from the chassis by the aid of two winches. In firing position the mount rests on three adjustable firing pads. There are three seats provided; two for the gun pointers and one for the ammunition loader. The gun has a monobloc tube. The firing mechanism is operated by recoil and residual pressure of gas in a manner similar to the 2 cm Flak 38. The recoil mechanism is located inside the trough-shaped cradle with the buffer above and the recuperator below. Traversing and elevating mechanisms are operated by handwheels; the former providing a 3600 traverse with 35 / 2 turns, and the latter giving a rate of about 4 for each turn. The gun is fired by means fo a foot pedal connected to the trigger by a system of levers. Armor-piercing ammunition is provided in addition to the regular high explosive ammunition, permitting the guns to be employed as antitank weapons.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 37 mm (1.45 ins.)
Weight (traveling position) .... Flak 36-5,290 lbs. Weight (firing position) .......... Flak 36-3,430 lbs. Length of piece (including flash hider).... 129 ins.

Length of rifling .......................................


Height of trunnions ..................................

71 ins.
44 ins.

W idth (overall) .............................................


Length of bore ............................................ No. of grooves........................20-R.H. plain section,

Twist, increasing (1 in 50 to 1 in Width of grooves ...................................... 0.197 Depth of grooves ...................................... 0.02 0.08 W idth of lands ..........................................
Muzzle velocity (H.E. Shell) ................

40) in. in. in.

2,610 f/s*

Max. range (vertical) ............................ 13,775 ft.* Max. range (horizontal) ........................ 7,080 yds.* Effective ceiling ........................................ 5000 ft.*
Rate of fire (practical) ............................... 80 r.p.m.

360 Traverse ............................................... ............................. 85 Elevation ......................


Depression .......................................................... - 5

Length of recoil ......................................... Ammunition ................................................ A.P., H.E.


Wt. of projectile.. *Not verified. .................................. A.P.-1.5 lb.

H.E.-1.4 lb.

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFCE

CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August,

1945

130.1

ANTIAIRCRAFT GUN
3.7 cm Flak 43

GERMAN

The 3.7 cm Flak 43, a light, fully-automatic, gas-operated antiaircraft weapon, may be statically emplaced, transported on a mobile mounting, or mounted on a self-propelled chassis. The gun consists of a removable, monobloc barrel fitted with a muzzle brake with six elongated ports and multi-perforated flash eliminator, and a breech casing which houses the breech mechanism. The gun is fed horizontally from the left in clips of eight rounds from a fixed loading tray, and is operated by the recoil of the gun itself. A hydro-spring buffer with variable recoil is located below the barrel, and two return springs lie side by side above the barrel. Mounting is of the pedestal type, the gun being hung from a single-ring type trunnion on the right. The feed to the gun is mounted through the ring and on the axis of the trunnion, making unnecessary any alteration in the position of the center of gravity of the gun and other elevating parts with variation in the quantity of ammunition in the clips and feed mechanism. Elevating and traversing handwheels are both on the right of the gun, the former being vertical and the latter horizontal. The equipment, which is of low build, is fitted with a shield varying in thickness from 9 mm at the center to 6 mm at the outer edges. The shield slopes backward at a 300 angle and is 4.2 feet high. In the middle is a space through which the mantlet elevates and depresses. A twin version of the 3.7 cm Flak 43 also exists. It is known as the 3.7 cm Flakzwilling 43. The weapon fires only the single rotating band projectiles.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber .................................. .. 37 mm (1.45 ins.) 4,180 Ibs. 2,750 lbs. Weight (traveling position) .................... Weight (firing position) ..........................

Length (traveling position) ........................... Length (firing position) .................................. Height (traveling position) ........................... Height of trunnion .................................... 29.9 ins. Length of piece (excluding muzzle brake).. 9.68 ft. Length of muzzle brake .......................... 14.96 ins. Length of bore .............................................. 7 ft. No. of grooves ....................... ......... ........... 20 Width of grooves ........................................... Depth of grooves .......................................... W idth of lands ............................................ Muzzle velocity (HE shell) ...................... 2,750 f/s Max. range (horizontal) .......... 7,200 yds. (approx.) Effective range (vertical)............ 9,000 ft. (approx.) Rate of fire (theoretical) .................. 250 rds./min. (practical) .................... 150 rds./min. Traverse ............................... ..................... 360 Elevation .................... ..................... 90 Depression .............................. ............. -6 Type of recoil ................................................. Variable Ammunition................AP/rIE; H.E.; HE/T-HE/I/T;
HE/I and HE/I/short T

130.2

August,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ANTIAIRCRAFT DIRECTOR
Kommando-Gerat 36

GERMAN

The Kommando-Gerit 36 is a goniographic director, thus differing from directors which operate on plan prediction or angular travel methods. The present instrument measures target course and speed and solves the problem by setting up to scale in ground plan the various distances involved. Ballistic data are obtained from graphical drums; varying heights are accepted, and corrections can be applied for wind, drift, displacement, dead time, and variations in muzzle velocity. The instrument which has a built-in range finder is large and heavy and has a 4-wheeled traveling carriage for mobile use. A crew of thirteen men is required to operate it. Readings must be called out to the appropriate operator on the director. Information is passed from one operator to another by voice and via a telephone system. The instrument is manufactured by Zeiss and displays excellent workmanship. This director, however, has been criticized by fire control experts for poor coordination of basic design and for the excessive number of men needed to operate it.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

175

ANTIAIRCRAFT DIRECTOR
Kommando-Gerat 40

GERMAN O

The Kommando-Gerit 40 is a director used principally for major caliber weapons such as the 8.8 cm and 10.5 cm antiaircraft guns. However, by installing the proper ballistic cams, it may be used with any type of gun. The director is operated by five men. Two are required to track in azimuth and elevation; a third sets in slant range by means of a 4-meter base stereo range finder mounted on the director; the fourth man sets in horizontal angle of approach; and the fifth man operates various switches. Data are transmitted to the guns for reception by a signal-light manual follow-up system. A trailer equipped with devices for lifting the director is used for transport. The Kommando-Gerdt 40 computes continuously Case III data (for invisible targets) by a target speed and angle of approach method, and can handle diving and curving target courses. The time from initial pickup to first round is estimated to be 20 or 30 seconds. When shifting to a new target in the vicinity of the target previously tracked and flying an approximately parallel course, as little as 10 seconds may be required. A change in course which requires a change in operating procedure upsets firing data for only a few seconds. In principle, the director will predict correctly for a target flying at constant speed with a constant rate of change of altitude and constant curvature. The stability is not affected by gradual changes in course. After an abrupt change in speed, altitude rate, or course azimuth, about 10 to 15 seconds are required to evaluate the new course.

SPECIFICATIONS
Azimuth .......................................................... No limit Elevation .............................. -1.5 to 90.5 Slant range ................................ 1,200 to 18,000 m
Present horizontal range ............ 570 to 14,500 m

Future horizontal range ........... 570 to 14.500 m


Future altitude .................... -500 to 12,000 m Present altitude .............................. 0 to 12,000 m Ground speed of target ................. 0 to 300 m/s Vertical speed of target .................. 0 to 200 m/s Horizontal travel during time of flight ............................................ 0 to 6.000 m Lateral deflection ................................ +1.065 mils Course azimuth correction ................ 1.600 mils Altitude prediction ................................ 3,000 m Maximum tracking rates Azimuth .................................... 130 mils/sec., Slewing 700 mils/sec. 105 mils/sec. Elevation .................................... Time of flight ................................ 0 to 30 sec.

Horizontal parallax .................................. 500 m


210 m Vertical parallax .................................... Fuze dead time ............................ 0 to 10 sec.

Wind velocity ........................... 0 to 28 m/s


Muzzle velocity.... 24 numbers (Gebrauchssttfe) ............................................................ 60/16 d

dA, ...............................

.............

70 mils

5 secs. dF due to dead time ............................ dF due to MV and wind .................... 5 secs.

176

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ON-CARRIAGE FIRE CONTROL


Sight Mounts for Howitzers
MOUNTS: The telescope mounts of all three howitzers are of the same basic design. All are of the azimuth compensating type and automatically compensate for trunnion cant when cross-levelled. The angle of site mechanism has a scale graduated from 100 to 500 mils with 300 mils representing normal.
OPERATION: Range or super-elevation is introduced

GERMAN O

10.5 cm le. F. H. 18

by turning the large handwheel below the bracket for the panoramic telescope. Operation of this knob causes the range drum to be rotated past the index and the index arm to be moved through an angle equal to superelevation. Angle of site is introduced by two operations. The first operation is to offset the angle of site level vial an amount equal and opposite to the angle of site. This is done by turning the small knob between the superelevation handwheel and panoramic telescope bracket. The second operation is to rotate the telescope mount by means of the knurled knob beneath the super-elevation handwheel until the angle of site level is again on a horizontal plane. This second step moves the index arm an additional amount and positions it in an angle equal to quadrant elevation. The second index arm which is actuated by the gun is brought into agreement with the first index arm by elevating the gun. The gun is then laid for quadrant elevation. It is necessary to operate the angle of site mechanism on the panoramic telescope to bring the line of sight back on its original plane. 15 cm s. I. G. 33 7.5 cm le. F. K. 18

Sight Mount for 10.5 cm Howitzer


RANGE DRUM GRADUATION: The mil scale on the

range drum for the above instrument is graduated in the same manner as for the 7.5 cm howitzer. The range scale is graduated for zone 5; the scale is divided into 50 meter units from 100 to 9150 meters.

Sight Mount for 15 cm Howitzer Sight Mount for 7.5 cm Howitzer has two scales: an elevation mil scale numbered from 0 to 800, divided into two mil units, and a range scale graduated in hectometers and numbered from 1 to 15.
RANGE DRUM GRADUATION: The range drum above

800 mil scale on the above instrument there is a second mil scale, filled with red, placed to the right of the 0-800 scale. This second scale is graduated in 2 mil steps from 800 to 1330 mils. The range scale is preceded by the Roman Numeral I and is divided in increments of 25 meters from 25 to 1475 meters.

RANGE DRUM GRADUATION:

In addition to the 0 to

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

177

ON-CARRIAGE FIRE CONTROL


Sight Mounts for Antitank Guns
7.5 cm Pak 41
8.8 cm Pak 43/41

GERMAN

Sight Mount for 7.5/5.5 cm A. T. Gun


RANGE SCALES: There are five scales engraved

Sight Mount for 8.8 cm A. T. Gun


RANGE DRUM GRADUATION: The range drum has

about the periphery of the range drum. The first is an elevation scale graduated from 0 to 80 mils. The other four are range scales, numbered from 0 to III and graduated from 0 to 4200, 3800, 3400, and 3200 meters respectively. The range scale on the sector is graduated for ranges from 0 to 1500 meters.
TELESCOPE MOUNT:' The telescope mount for the

three scales engraved about its periphery.

These

scales, from left to right are: an elevation scale in steps of 2 mils from 0 to 800; a range scale marked for 8.8 cm Sp. Gr. L/4.7 with limits of 0 to 5500 meters; and a range scale marked 8.8 cm Sp. Gr. 39H1 with limits of 0 to 3000 meters.
TELESCOPE MOUNTS: There are two telescope

7.5/5.5 is of simple construction. There is a range drum with its axis parallel to the axis of the telescope and a range scale inscribed on an arc that is located on the right side of the telescope mount. A deflection mechanism is located below the range setting handle.

mounts mounted side by side on the left side of the weapon. The first telescope mount is of the rocking bar type and is designed primarily for anti-tank use. There is no deflection mechanism apparent on the available model. The range drum is graduated from 0 to 4000 meters. The second telescope mount is of the same general design as that used with the 7.5 cm, 10.5 cm and 15 cm howitzers. Both its use and operation are also the same.

178

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ON-CARRIAGE FIRE CONTROL


Sight Mounts for Self-Propelled Artillery

GERMAN

Sight Mount for 7.5 cm (Stu. K. 40) S. P. on Pz. Kpfw. III chassis F8, w/o rotary cupola

Sight Mount for 7.5 cm (Stu. K. 40) S. P. on Pz. Kpfw. III chassis

RANGE SCALES: In the above sight mounts there are

cant. The telescope used with mounts of this type is of periscopic design and has a removable head. Quadrant elevation is obtained by placing the range drum index in agreement with the proper scale and depressing the telescope mount through the super-elevation angle necessary for the range and then elevating the gun until the apex of the triangle on the telescope reticle is superimposed on the target. There is no angle of site mechanism on the telescope mount, nor is there a longitudinal level vial or index arm to indicate when the gun has been moved through an angle equal to the original movement of the telescope mount. Deflection is introduced by operating the knurled knob at the top-right of the instrument. The deflection scale is graduated in increments of one mil from 0 to 20 on each side of zero.

four scales engraved about the periphery of a vertical range drum. The first scale, used for the Pzgr. 40, is graduated from-300 to 1400 meters; the second for the Spr. is graduated from 100 to 3300 meters, and the third for the Pzgr. 39, is graduated from 200 to 2400 meters. The fourth scale on the drum is a micrometer for the elevation scale located immediately to the right and above the telescope bracket. The elevation scale is graduated in units of 100 mils from 0 to 500. MOUNTS: The telescope mount for the 7.5 cm Stu. K. 40 is attached to a bracket to the left of the weapon and is connected by a linkage bar so that elevation of the weapon is relayed to the telescope mount. The mount does not automatically compensate for trunnion

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

179

ON-CARRIAGE FIRE CONTROL


Sight Mounts for Self-Propelled Artillery

GERMAN

Sight Mount for 7.5 cm Pak 40 mounted on 38 (t) Czech chassis

Sight Mount for 7.62 cm Pak 36 (r) mounted on 38 (t) Czech chassis

MOUNTS: The telescope mounts for these two guns are of the same general design, the only differences being in the ballistic cam and markings on the range drum. They are of the rocking bar type and have a range drum graduated for the various types of ammuni-

tion used in the weapons. A three power, straight tube telescope is used as the sighting component. For indirect fire, a panoramic telescope, the Aushilfsrichmittel 38 can be fitted.

180

OFFICE CHIEF 6

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ON-CARRIAGE FIRE CONTROL


Sight Mounts for Self-Propelled Artillery

GERMAN

Sight Mount for 10.5 cm (Stu. H. 42) on Pz. Kpfw. III chassis

Sight Mount for 15 cm s. F. H. 13 on Lorraine chassis

Sight Mount for 10.5 cm (Stu. H 42) on Pz. Kpfw.


III chassis. RANGE SCALES: There are three scales en-

This scale in conjunction with a pointer actuated by the gun trunnion indicates the angle of elevation imparted to the gun. MOUNT: The telescope mount for the 15 cm s. F. H. is not an azimuth compensating type. A panoramic telescope bracket is attached to a rack gear and is moved through vertical angles by operation of the knurled knob in the center of the range drum. Angle of site is introduced by turning a wing nut immediately below the telescope bracket. The angle of site scale is engraved about a spiral groove cut into a plate; the index is fitted with a lug that fits in the groove and raises up or down as the scale is turned. Operation of the angle of site mechanism when the range mechanism is locked causes the panoramic telescope to be tilted through an angle equal and opposite to the angle of site. The mount is cross-leveled by turning the wing nut below and forward of the range drum. There is no level vial to indicate a horizontal plane.

graved above the range drum: the top scale is the elevation micrometer for the elevation scale which is graduated from 0 to 300 mils; the next, a range scale, used with the Spr. F. H. Gr., is graduated from 100 to 3300 meters; and the third scale, for the 10.5 cm Gr. 39 HL/A. HL 18, is graduated from 400 to 1500 meters. MOUNT: The telescope mount for the 10.5 cm Stu. H. 42 is basically the same as the telescope mount for the 7.5 cm Stu. K. 40. The principles of operation are identical. Sight Mount for 15 cm s. F. H. 13 on Lorraine
chassis. RANGE DRUM: The range drum is quite broad,

but there are only two scales on it. The first is a range scale graduated from 100 to 8150 meters. The inner scale is engraved from 0 to 800 mils in 2 mil steps. An elevation scale graduated in units of 100 mils is engraved on a plate fastened to the left trunnion bearing.

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

June,

1945

181

PANORAMIC TELESCOPES 16 AND 16/18


Rundblickfernrohr 16 (Rbl. F. 16) Rundblickfernrohr 16/18 (Rbl. F. 16/18)

GERMAN

The Panoramic Telescope Rbl. F. 16, which has been replaced by the Rbl. F. 32 and 36, is still used on the 7.5 cm 1. I. G. 18. It is a 4-power, fixed-focus type with a cross level and longitudinal level for checking the alignment when the telescope and bracket are secure to the mount. Since the levels are not readily visible in this position, a mirror is provided on the telescope. The elevation scale and micrometer of the head resembles those of the standard telescope, Rbl. F. 32. The azimuth scale is graduated in 100-mil intervals and numbered from 0 to 64. The azimuth micrometer scale is graduated in units of one mil. The throwout and locking mechanism is the same as that of the usual type of panoramic telescope. The Model 16/18, shown herewith, is very similar to the 16.

MORTAR SIGHT
This instrument is designed to be used for laying the German 81 mm Mortar in azimuth and elevation. It embodies means for obtaining right or left lateral deflection, elevation or depression, and a collimator sight for sighting on an aiming point. The elevation scale is graduated from 0 to 16, representing 0 to 1600 mils. The lateral deflection scale is 'graduated from 0 to 64. The collimator sight consists of a reticle having horizontal and vertical translucent slits located at the focal length of a single eye lens. The

grooves on the top and side of the collimator are used

as an open sight.

182

1 June, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

- OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

PANORAMIC TELESCOPE 32
Rundblickfernrohr 32 (Rbl. F. 32)
ACLE. OF SITE

GERMAN

WCROMETER

AZI~UTH

SCALEf

I06400::

,ZAIMUTHCORRiECT
ALCAE 10-320, 0.~CI

HOC
M2CROMTIER

*mI

''THROWO'UTi

rEVERwoi i LEVERi

This panoramic telescope is used on all standard field equipment. It is a 4-power, fixed-focus type with a field of view of 10 degrees. The line of sight may be raised or lowered by rotation of the angle of site knob. The angle of site scale is graduated from 100 mils to 500 mils (300 mils in normal). The angle of site micrometer is graduated in mils from 0 to 100 mils. The azimuth scales on the vertical barrel of the telescope are graduated in 100-mil intervals; the upper scale, 0 to 64, is fixed in relation to the rotating head. The lower has two semicircular scales numbered 0 to 32 and can be rotated independently of the rotating head. A knurled portion permits adjustment. The azimuth micrometer includes two scales graduated in mils from 0 to 100 mils. The outer scale can be rotated independently of the azimuth worm. Evidently the fixed azimuth scale and micrometer are used for initial laying of the piece and the second scale and micrometer are then zeroed and used to measure base deflection. A throw-out lever is provided for rapid setting in azimuth. A locking lever locks the azimuth micrometer in any setting. The reticle pattern is shown above. The existence of Panoramic Telescopes 36 and 37 has been confirmed. They are believed to be very similar to the Rbl. F. 32.

SPECIFICATIONS
Pow er .................................................................................. .......................... 4X
Field of view .................................................. ....... ........... ......................... 10 W eight ............................................................................. ........................ 5 bs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 une,

1945

183

AUXILIARY QUADRANT SIGHT 38


Aushilfsrichtmittel 38

GERMAN

This quadrant sight is called a "substitute aiming device" by the Germans. It will fit into the sight mount found on the 7.62 cm Pak 36 (r), the 5 cm Pak 38, and the 7.5 cm Pak 40. The device has apparently been designed as a cheap instrument for indirect laying and may be used with any weapon having a suitable adapter. The elevating worm wheel housing fits into the adapter bracket and is retained by the elevation worm wheel. The telescope bracket, which is made of cast aluminum, is fastened to the elevation worm wheel by holding screws. The cross-level vial and longitudinal level vial are part of the telescope bracket assembly. The cross leveling mechanism consists of a worm meshed with a worm wheel segment cut on the adapter. bracket. Turning the cross leveling knob causes the telescope bracket and elevation worm wheel assembly to be tilted in relation to the adapter bracket. The azimuth mechanism consists of a worm and worm wheel provided with a rather unique anti-back-lash arrangement. Both the elevation and azimuth scales are divided into increments of 100 mils, and each is supplemented with a micrometer for 1 mil settings. The elevation scale is graduated from 0 to 1300 mils. There is a simple elbow telescope with a reticle design consisting of a large inverted "V" and two vertical lines such as is found in the German panoramic telescopes.

SPECIFICATIONS
Power of telescope ........................ ............................. 3 diameters 8 Field of view of telescope ................................... Overall height of instrument ................................... .................... ............

8/8 ins. 3 ins.

Overall width of instrument ..........................................................

Complete weight of instrument ........................................ 3 lbs.. 12 ois.

184

1 June, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARTILLERY SIGHTS
Rbl. F. 40

GERMAN

,head.

and numbered on each ten mils is located near the center of the upright section and traverses the objective The lower section of the objective head is graduated in hundred mils, the even hundreds being numbered. By pressing a small lever near the adjusting knob, free traverse of the head for quick spotting is possible. An adjustment for elevation is controlled by a knob on top of the objective head which is graduated in hundredths and numbered on each tenth mil graduation. An unusual feature in this sight is that the adjusting knobs are click mounted to enable adjustments to be made at night without light.

The Rundblickfernrohr 40 is believed to have been designed for use with the 7.5 cm L. G. 40 or the 10.5 cm night lighting devices are provided with the STwo L. G. 42. A carrying case and two night lighting devices sight. One mounts on the left side of the eye piece and employed with the instrument were also recovered, illuminates the reticle with a red light which is reguThis is a panoramic artillery sight, consisting of an lated by an aperture in the attachment. The other is upright section approximately five inches long, supworn by the operator for reading graduations on the porting an objective head which has a full 3600 trasight and has an aperture selection for either clear or verse, and an eye piece approximately four inches long red light. It is held in place on the forehead of the set at an angle to the base. The eye piece traverses operator by an elastic strap. approximately 200, permitting the operator to use the sight from different positions. A knob graduated in mils Weight of the sight is approximately 2 V2 pounds.

Rbl. F. Flak
The Rbl. Flak is used with heavy antiaircraft guns for indirect fire against ground targets and for reciprocal laying. A modified type is designed for use with the predictor. When mounted in their respective sockets with the azimuth scales set to zero, the line of sight of the panoramic telescope on the predictor is 1800 from that of the predictor telescope. The reason for the eyepiece of the gun sight being 90 from the axis of the gun is for convenience as the operator can stand at the right side of the gun and look into the sight at right angles to the axis of the gun. This sight is 9.3 inches in height.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

August,

1945

1 85

27 mm DOUBLE BARREL SIGNAL PISTOL


27 mm Doppel Schuss

GERMAN

The 27 mm double barrel signal pistol is unique in that the basic parts such as the trigger, trigger-guard, lever release, hammer assembly and switch lever, as well as all pins, are made of steel; the remaining parts, with the exception of the wooden forestock and hand grips, are made of an aluminum alloy. The firing mechanism is of the continuous pull type incorporating concealed hammers. A switch lever is located on the top rear of the pistol frame to control the firing mechanism. By use of this lever, either one of the two barrels, or both, can be fired by action of the trigger. Turning the lever to the left allows only the left barrel to be fired; turning it to the right allows only the right barrel to be fired. With the lever in the center position, both barrels fire simultaneously. Breaking of the piece is accomplished by pushing forward the release lever which is located just forward of the trigger guard. Indicator pins located in the breech plate show whether the respective barrels are loaded. A safety lever is located on the left side of the receiver. The words "Feuer" and "Sicher" indicate the two positions of Fire and Safe. Another model, a double barrel air force signal pistol of somewhat similar design, is pictured in the inset above.

SPECIFICATIONS
W eight ............................ 3.... 31/s lbs. 137/8 ins. Length ..................................
Ammunition types ....... ................... .............

W eight of barrel ............................

Length of barrel ........................................... Rifling .................................................


Muzzle energy ..................

91/s ins.

(sm ooth bore)


..............

Maximum range ............................

.......

*Signal cartridge with single star-max. vertical range 260 ft.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

202.1

SUBMACHINE GUN
7.92 mm M. P. 43, M. P. 43/1, M. P. 44 (Sturmgewehr 44)

GERMAN

7.92 Submachine Gun: Top. M. P. 43; Center. M. P. 43/1: Bottom, M. P. 44

The German M. P. 43 is an automatic, air-cooled, gas-operated, magazine-fed shoulder weapon, firing from a closed bolt and a locked breech. Provision is made for both full-automatic and semi-automatic fire. For full-automatic fire, the trigger must be held back until all rounds in the magazine have been fired; for semi-automatic fire, the trigger must be released after each round. However, German official sources say that full automatic fire will be used only in emergency. Despite the fact that it is of cheap construction, made chiefly of steel stampings, the M. P. 43 is a very serviceable weapon. It is believed that the gun was developed from the 7.92 mm M. Kb. 42 (machine carbine 42) inasmuch as the general design is quite similar, and the same type of ammunition is used. However, the M. P. 43 has a shorter barrel and gas cylinder, and has no bayonet as does the M. Kb. 42. The receiver, frame, gas cylinder, jacket, and front sight hood are made from steel stampings. As all pins in the trigger mechanism are riveted in, it cannot be disassembled, although a complete trigger assembly may be very quickly inserted. The gas piston assembly, bolt, hammer, barrel and gas cylinder are machined parts. The gas piston assembly consists of a piston, piston rod, and slide which appear to be machined from one piece with a stamped handle inserted. The stock and pistol grips are of low grade wood. The curved magazine is inserted from the bottom, and the fired cartridge cases are ejected on the right. The various models of this weapon, including the M. P. 43, M. P. 43/1, and M. P. 44, have been officially designated M. P. 44. A recent official German order changed the nomenclature to Sturmgewehr 44.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ................................. 7.92 mm (.312 in.) 10 lb., 1 oz. Weight (with empty magazine).......... Length (overall) ...................................... 3 ft., 1 in.

Length of barrel ........................................ 16.2 ins. Sight radius ................. ................................... Principle of operation ...................................... gas Feeding device .......................... Curved magazine
Capacity of feeding device ................ Cooling system ........................ Ammunition types 30 rounds air .....................

........................................ 7.92 mm Postolen Patronen Semi AP.. M.P. 43

Effective rate of fire (automatic) ........................ 100 to 120 rds./min. (semi-automatic) ................ 40 to 50 rds./min. Type of sight............Leaf sight graduated from 100

to 800 meters
Rifling Twist ....................... ....................... R. H. No. of grooves ........................................... Chamber pressure .......................................... Muzzle velocity (approx.) ........................ 2250 f/s Muzzle energy ............................................. Maximum range ............................................ Effective range ........................................ 400 yds.

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF

ORDNANCE

March,

1945

20691

CARBINE
7.92 mm Gewehr 33/40

GERMAN

This carbine, a typical Mauser, is very similar to the latest model of the Kar 98K. It is a manually operated, air-cooled, clip-fed shoulder weapon, having a laminated wood stock, a large metal butt plate to protect the stock when grenades are launched, and a sling mounted on the left-hand side. The Gewehr 33/40 and the Kar 98K have interchangeable bolts. The most obvious differences are found in the length, weight, hand guards, and bolt handles.
The present weapon has an overall length of 391/8 inches as

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ..................................... 7.92 mm (.312 in.) 7 lbs., 11 ozs. 391/8 ins. Weight ..................... ...................

Length (overall) .......................................

Principle of operation................Manually operated. bolt action Feeding device......Clip-fed, hand-loaded magazine

Capacity of feeding device........................ 5 rounds C ooling system ...................................................... A ir

compared to the 431/2 inches of the Kar 98K. The barrel length is 193/ inches instead of 231/2 inches. The carbine weighs 7 pounds 11 ounces; the rifle 9 pounds. The hand guard on the Gewehr 33/40 extends behind the rear sight and covers a greater percentage of the barrel than the one on the Kar 98K. The bolt handle on the carbine is turned down uniformly forming a semi-circle, and the knob on the end of the handle has been hollowed out and milled flat on the underside to reduce weight. On the Kar 98K, the bolt handle slopes down abruptly at right angles and the knob is solid.

Ammunition .................. All 7.92 mm Mauser Types Type of sight......Inverted "V" or barleycorn front sight with hood protector and tangent leaf rear sight graduated from 100 to 1,000 meters. Length of barrel .......................................... 19 / ins.

Length of rifling ........................................... R iflin g ................... ...........................................

Twist ................................................. Uniform R. H. No. of grooves ...................................................... 4

Muzzle velocity .......................................... 2,509 f/s

206.21

March,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF.

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

SEMIAUTOMATIC RIFLE
7.92 mm Gewehr 41 (M)

GERMAN

The Gewehr 41 (M)

is a self-loading, gas-operated, clip-fed, It is basically the same as the

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ W eight 7.92 mm (.312 in.) 10 lb., 13 oz. 468 ins. Gas ...................... ...................

air-cooled shoulder weapon.

Gewehr 41 (W) except for several changes that have been made in the manufacture and appearance. Most of the parts of the Gewehr 41 (M) are machined pieces with the exception of the magazine well, follower, piston rod and butt plate. The majority of the machined pieces have had no further finishing, but are of a very high quality. The upper band, lower band, magazine well, magazine follower, trigger guard, piston rod, dust cover and butt plate of the Gewehr 41 (M) stamped pieces. The differences between the Gewehr 41 (M) and the Gewehr 41 (W) are as follows: the piston rod of the G. 41 (M) terminates fn a yoke, the two arms of which extend rearward and contact the bolt head. The piston rod of the G. 41 (W) is one piece and is in direct contact with the bolt retractor slide. The handguard of the 41 (M) is made of wood unlike that of the G. 41 (W) which is plastic. are

Length without bayonet ..........................

Principle of operation .......................................

Feeding device ............ Vertical box-type magazine Capacity of feeding device .................... Cooling system 10 rounds A ir

...................................................

Ammunition used ........ All 7.92 mm Mauser types Type of sight......Inverted V blade type front sight; tangent leaf rear sight; graduated 200 to 1,200 meters. Length of barrel ...................................... Rifling Tw ist .......................................... . w ist 21V2 ins.

ormof groves .................................................... ..............


No. of grooves ........... ...................... Depth of grooves ......................................... idth of grooves .....................................

Cuam
'uzzle

er pressure ......................................

M uzzle velocity .................................................... energy .....................................................

Maximum range ........................................... Effective range .................................. ............

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

2081

SEMIAUTOMATIC RIFLE
7.92 mm Karabiner 43 (Kar. 43)

GERMAN

The Karabiner 43, a gas-operated, semi-automatic, magazinefed, air-cooled shoulder weapon, is basically the same in design as the Gewehr 41 (W) described on page 208. Two notable changes found in the later weapon are a modified gas operation and a change in manufacturing policy. This weapon utilizes a gas vent and gas piston, a method used for the first time in German small arms weapons in the Fallschirmjager Gewehr 42. The improved gas operation insures more positive operation, and malfunctions due to carbonization are less likely to occur. A great deal of effort was put into an attempt to reduce the time and expense in the manufacture of this weapon. In order to accomplish this, forgings and stampings were used in as many parts as was practical. Machined or ground surfaces are found only where necessary to insure proper operation. The bolt, bolt channel, and contacting surfaces of the trigger group are included in these. Such surfaces as the outside of the receiver, the top of the retractor slide, and the non-contacting surfaces of the trigger group are left untouched. Several other slight changes were made, the most notable being the use of a ten-round, detachable box-type magazine; the addition of a threaded section on the muzzle making it possible to attach a flash hider or an adapter which is used with blank ammunition; the omission of the bayonet stud; and the addition of a telescopic sight base indicating that the Kar. 43 is intended for use as a special weapon. The weapon is lighter and better balanced than the Gewehr 41 (W) due to the elimination of the gas trap assembly at the muzzle and the long piston rod.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ W eight .......................... ... 7.92 mm (.312 in.) .................. 8 lb., 9 oz. 441/4 ins. Gas Length ................... ........ ....................

Principle of operation ......................................... Feeding device........Detachable

box-type magazine

Capacity of feeding device.................... 10 rounds Cooling system .................... .................. .... Air

Ammunition used ........ All 7.92 mm Mauser types Type of sight......Parallel sided, flat top blade type Tangent leaf rear front sight. sight graduated from 100 to 1,200 meters. Telescopic sight base at rear of right side of receiver. Length of barrel ........................................ Rifling Tw ist ............................................ Uniform R. H. Form ..................... ....................................... ........ ............ 4 No. of grooves ................... 22 ins.

Depth of grooves .......................................... W idth of grooves ......................................... Chamber pressure .......................................... Muzzle velocity ............................................. Muzzle energy ................................. ............

Maximum range ............................................ Effective range .............. ................................

208.2

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ANTITANK RIFLE
7.92 mm M SS 41

GERMAN

This antitank weapon, a manually operated, magazine-fed, aircooled, high-velocity rifle which was standardized for production in 1941, fires the same necked-down cartridge as the Panzerbiichse 39. Although classified as an antitank rifle, the use of heavier armor on modern tanks has rendered the weapon effective against lightly-armored vehicles only. A hinged bipod similar to that of the MG 34 is attached to the front of the receiver jacket. It folds forward for convenience in carrying. The gun is also equipped With carrying handle and sling; the former is fitted to the top of the barrel group, and the latter is attached on the right side at the bipod and back plate assembly. A "U" type rear sight and an adjustable front sight of the square block type fold to the rear when not in use. The gun is put in a "Safe" position by pulling the barrel housing lock extension /4-inch to the rear so that its rear alignment mark is aligned with the mark "S" on the barrel housing lock. When in this position, the trigger cannot be pulled, nor can the action be opened. If the trigger is pulled while the action is not entirely closed, the gun will not fire. It is necessary to release the trigger and pull it again in order to release the sear. When the magazine is empty, the action is kept open by the protrusion of the magazine follower which stops the rearward movement of the barrel housing.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ...................................... 7.92 mm (.312 in.) Weight (with empty magazine) .............. 29/4 lbs. Length (overall) .................... . ............... 59/4 ins. Sight radius .................. ........ 30 15/16 ins. Principle of operation ................ Manually operated .......... Magazine Feeding device ............................. Capacity of feeding device .................... 6 rounds ................. ...... Air Cooling system ...................
Ammunition types....13 mm case necked down to 7.92 mm. Same as used in the PZ B39. See Page 211.) Rate of fire... .......... ....................

Type of sight..............U" type rear sight; square block type front sight. lbs. Weight of barrel (w/fittings).................. 131/4 Length of barrel ........................... Length of rifling .......................... .... . 433/ ins. ..

Rifling R. H. Tw ist ............ ....................................... F orm .................... ......... ............................... 4 ...... .....No. of grooves .................. ............. Depth of grooves ............... ............ Width of grooves ............. Muzzle velocity (estimated) ...................... 3,540 f/s Type of mount ...................... . B ....... ipod

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

210.1

UNDERCOVER AIMING AND FIRING APPARATUS


Deckungszielger t fir le. 34 u. 42 Dezetqerat

GERMAN

The apparatus shown attached to the 7.92 mm M G 42.

This device is an undercover aiming apparatus for firing the standard machine guns from foxholes, trenches, or depressions in the ground. It permits the user to aim the weapon without exposing himself to enemy fire. Construction is of welded steel boxwork, and consists of a shaft with a shoulder stock at the lower end and a securing arm which extends from the upper part of the shaft to the receiver of the weapon. Three milled edge clamping screws secure the device to the weapon. Two mirrors through which the weapon is aimed are lined up so as to utilize the standard sights. One mirror is mounted on the shaft and the other on an extension of the securing arm above and to the rear of the buffer group. The firing mechanism is a simple linkage that enables the machine gun to be fired from a trigger on the instrument. It is necessary to have a different linkage for the MG 34 than with the MG 42. These are obtained by positioning the connecting bar in the trigger linkage. A window on the connecting bar shows when the desired linkage is obtained. The trigger linkage may also be positioned to make use of the semiautomatic arrangement on the MG 34, if desired. The field of vision at 1,000 meters (1,093 yards) is about 200 meters (218 yards) broad. This can be increased by 100 meters (109 yards) by moving the head to the left or right. In the same manner, vertical vision which is 100 meters at 1,000 meters can be increased.

SPECIFICATIONS
H eight ................................................ ........... 24 ins. 9 ins. Maximum width ......................................... Weight ......................................... .

.......... 7 /2 lbs.

The undercover aiming and firing apparatus not attached to gun.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

May,

1945

214.1

AIRCRAFT MACHINE GUN


30 mm Mk. 108 A-3

GERMAN

The Mk. 108 A-3 is an automatic, air cooled, belt-fed weapon operated by blowback and firing electrically from an open bolt. Initial cocking and initial depression of the sear to release the bolt are accomplished by compressed air. The gun is mounted on its side, and fires through the propeller hub in ME 109 G fighters. It is attached at the forward end of the receiver to a blast tube which extends through the engine. This gun is unusual in being a blowback operated, low muzzle velocity weapon. Sixty rounds of ammunition are fed by means of a disintegrating belt from an ammunition can mounted above the gun. On release of the sear, the bolt travels forward under the action of two driving springs. A projection on top of the bolt passes through the ring extracting a round and forcing it into the chamber. After firing the empty cartridge case reseats itself in its link. The ejection is accomplished by pawls actuated by camming grooves cut in the top of the bolt. Position of a new round takes place by the same action. A feature of the gun is the fact that the barrel and receiver do not move in recoil, the entire force of which is taken up by the rearward motion of the bolt against driving springs which act as buffers on recoil. There is no locking action between the barrel and bolt at any time. All ammunition found to date has been high explosive, high explosive-tracer, incendiary and incendiary tracer. It is doubtful if the muzzle velocity is high enough for the effective use of armor piercing ammunition.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ...................................... 29.6 mm (1.17 in.)

Weight (total) ................................................ Weight of gun ..............................................


Weight of mount ............................................

265 lb. 136 lb.


28 lb.

Weight of ammunition can ..........................


Weight of ammunition (60 rounds) .............. Weight of recoiling parts ..........................

36 lb.
65 lb.

242 lb.

Length of gun with blast tube .......... 7 ft. 6/4 ins. Length of gun .................................... 3 ft. 51/4 ins. 21V/2 ins. 16

Length of barrel .........................................

Number of lands and grooves ..............................

Maximum length of recoil of bolt .......... 11/2 ins. Rate of fire ........................................ Muzzle 500 rds./min. f/s.*

velocity (approx.)..............H.E.-1.650

*Not verified

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

255

IGNITERS

GERMAN

Practically all German mines, including antitank and antipersonnel mines and booby traps, are fired by one or more of several standard igniters. Mines and prepared charges have one or more holes drilled and threaded to receive these igniters. Hand Grenades also employ igniters of the friction, pull, and pressure types. These specialized firing devices are divided by structure and function into friction, pull, and pressure igniters, and a miscellaneous group including such special devices as the tilt, rupture, chemical, and time delay types. A number of the styles most commonly employed by the German army are pictured on the following pages; a few examples are described as representative of each group.

Friction Igniters

-,
B..2

............. .. ..., s:.

."

.....: J

......
.. ' ... ......J

'!

'

.Z )

B .Z

B..3.Z

p...4.Fec

Mocl,38 BRoh

Sc.

Sklag

B.Z. 24

B.Z. 39
Mod.

NB.B.Z.
38

B.Z. 39

B.Z. Exp.

B.Z. 4.5
Sec.

Feld
SchlagRohr

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

August,

1945

275

IGNITERS
Friction Igniters

GERMAN

Zdschn. Anz.
29

Zdschn. Anz.
39

Reisszunder

Reibziinder
West

N.B.Z. 29

French
Friction Igniter

Friction Igniter B.Z.E. (Brenziinder Ei)


egg grenades, and the yellow-capped with prepared or hollow charges. Red and white-capped igniters are seldom used. The Germans have at times boobytrapped these igniters by removing the delay pellet, which is usually screwed into the base of the igniter, and by replacing the igniter in the grenade. The igniters normally fitted with delays have right-hand threads on the caps which differentiate them at night from the left-hand threaded, grey-capped fuze igniter, Zdschn. Anz. 39. In order to operate the device, the cap is unscrewed and the string given a sharp jerk, pulling the wire through the friction composition.

This igniter, which is used in the German egg grenades, resembles the Zdschn. Anz. 39. The B.Z.E. type has different colored caps indicating various lengths of delay in the delay pellets. Red indicates 1 second delay, blue, 4.5 seconds; yellow, 7 seconds; and white, 10 seconds. The blue-capped igniters are used in the

276

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

IGNITERS
Pull Igniters

GERMAN

Spring-loaded

Zu.Z.Z. 35

Zu.Z.Z. 35

Z.Z. 42

French

B.Z.E.

(Pull and
tension release)

Mod.
(Pull only)

Pull
Igniter 1939

Pull Igniter Z.Z. 35 (Zugziinder 35)

This brass igniter is used with the stock mine and occasionally with the
HOLE FOR

"S" mine. It is also commonly used with booby traps.

SAFETY PIN1

SLIDING /CYLINDER

STRIKER

The igniter is provided

with -a

SPRING

SION COMPRES SPRING

safety pin which is inserted through the inner of the two holes in the end of the spring-loaded striker. A trip wire is attached to the outer hole at the end of the striker. In normal use, it is screwed into one of the antilifting wells of a mine, a trip wire is attached, and the safety pin is withdrawn.

PINS

L'1'[;

-STRIKER

'

-- GUIDE

[ DISTANCE PIECEF

--CAP

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

August,

1945

277

IGNITERS
Pressure Igniters

GERMAN

(Used

Hebelziinder 44 with Glasmine 43)

D.Z. 35 (B)

French A.T.

Pressure Igniter D. Z. 35 "A"

This igniter is designed for use with improvised mines and booby traps. The igniter consists of a white metal body housing the ball-release, springloaded striker assembly. The igniter is provided with a safety pin through the head of the plunger. To operate, after withdrawal of the safety pin, the igniter is fired by pressure on the pressure piece which depresses the plunger until the steel balls are free to escape into the recess in the guide. The spring-loaded striker is released against the percussion cap. A pressure of 130-160 pounds is necessary to fire the igniter.

278

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

IGNITERS
Pressure Igniters

GERMAN

PTRIKR

with T. Mi.

29.)

RCHR

SAFETY FIN

530 (e)

P.X. 38

S.Mi.Z. 44

Z. D. Z. 29

This is the standard igniter used in mine. It consists of a white2 the ""
metal body,
ball-release

ANTENNAE

housing
type

the
striker

springas-

MOVING
C Y N DE R

Sloaded,

Z.

sembly. The igniter is provided with PIN SAFETY HOLE a safety pin through the plunger just above the top of the igniter body.M. There are three pressure prongs atSPRINGN tached to the top of the plunger and STEEL held in place by a screw. The mine
B S ALL is usually buried with just the prongs of the igniter above the ground. wSRIKER

STEEL

BALL

When the safety pin is removed, a Spressure or 20 pounds is necesof 15 sary to depress the plunger until the striker retaining balls are freed in the lower recess, releasing the striker.

CAP

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

August,

1.945

279

IGNITERS
Pressure Igniter T. Mi. Z. 35

GERMAN

This metal igniter is used with the Tellermine 35 and 35 (steel). On the top of the igniter is a setting screw with a red dot which may be turned to coincide with a white groove marked "sicher" (safe), or to a red groove marked "scharf" (armed). This screw is connected to an arming spindle inside the igniter. When set at "scharf," a flange is turned out of the striker recess putting all the strain of the spring-loaded striker on the small shear wire holding the striker to the striker guide. There is a safety bolt which, in the safe position, passes through a hole in the top of the striker.

PressureIgniter T. Mi. Z. 42
SHEAR WIRE

Pressure Igniter T. Mi. Z. 43


WIRE SHEAR

STRIKER

5 PRIN

SHEAR SHEAR PINS \ PINIS

ISTRIKER

STRIKER BODY

ROD

RETAINING BALLS

STRIKER

HEAD PERCUSSION
THREAD

This

igniter,

used

in

the

Tellermine

35

(steel), 42, and 43, consists of a cylindrical, steel-shelled body housing a simple steel striker retained against the pressure of a steel spring by a thick shear wire which passes through a hole in the top of the striker, the ends resting on the top of the igniter body. There is no safety pin. This igniter is sometimes manufactured with the detonator attached. In operation, pressure on the mine cover presses against the striker head, shearing the wire and releasing the striker.

Externally this igniter resembles the T. Mi. Z. 42, but the head (actually a sleeve) is a little longer, and the shear wire is located a quarter inch above the igniter body. Once installed, this igniter cannot be disarmed. When the cover of the Tellermine is screwed down, the sleeve shears the two brass pins holding it to the body. Further. pressure forces the sleeve down until the two steel balls escape into the upper recess and release the striker. If an attempt is made to unscrew the mine cover, the sleeve rises, letting the balls escape into the lower recess, releasing the striker.

280

August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

IGNITERS
Pressure Release Device E.Z. 44
This device consists of a thin-shelled, round steel body, 5 inches in diameter and 1.75 inches high, housing a simple clockwork mechanism and a one-half pound charge. It is designed to be laid under mines, but may also be used as a booby trap. On the top is a small pressure plate connected to a hinged arm holding the springloaded striker back. A safety bar runs through the pressure piece into one of the clockwork wheels, preventing the wheel from turning. The mechanism is wound up with a special key and a weight of at least 10 pounds placed on ....ap l c d

GERMAN

,"

. :. 'j..... .

-.

o n

the p re ss u re p ie ce ; the n th e s a fe ty b a r is p u lle d out starting the clockwork. As the mainspring unwinds, it pushes the safety pin from the hole in the striker. The mine is then armed and the only thing holding the striker back is the hinged arm held down by the pressure piece
against a compressed spring. When the

weight is lifted from the pressure piece, the hinged arm moves up, freeing the striker. Once this device is armed under an object, it cannot be disarmed or neutralized.

Rupture Igniters 43/I and 43/II


PROTECTIVE CAPSTRIKER SCREW--

Each of these igniters is approximately 35 inches in length including the elongated staff.

Either type is screwed vertically into any standard igniter socket and is designed to initiate the
SHEET METAL SHEATH OUTER TUBE----TUBE SECTIONS

mine when tilted. I Kn. Z. 43/I has a staff made up of 5 sections containing a chain of hooks, the bottom one engaging the shear strip in the igniter. Sideways

STRIKER EXTENSION
H-OOK SHEARING GROOVE

SAFETY SHEATH---.
Spressure
Q SIDE

on the staff causes the hooks to pull PIN the shear strip upwards, raising the sleeve bar, sleeve, and spring, rupturing the shear strip
and releasing the spring-loaded striker. Kn. Z. 43/II is featured by a striker extension made of brittle plastic enclosed in an outer tube with a shear groove towards its lower end. Sideways pressure breaks the outer tube at the
sharn

VIEW F
/ 1 -SAFETY
STRIKER'
BUSTRIKER

SPRING STRIKER
SLEEVE BAR

EEAR STRIP

SLEEVE
STRIKERSPRING

STRIKER CAP
----

HOLDER

CHOLDER

TRANSIT CAP--spring-l

shearing groove and breaks the striker extend i i sion, releasing the spring-loaded striker.

exten-

Kn. Z. 43/1

Kn. Z. 43/11

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

281

IGNITERS
Tilt Igniters 43A and 43B

GERMAN

PRESSURE PIECE

RETAINING BALLS ,m NUT RETAINER STRIKER GUIDE --

E SUR 1 1 PRESSURE STRIKER

Igniter 43B is similar to the preceding except for the method of arming and the safety device. A safety bolt runs horizontally through the igniter body. At each end of the bolt is a detachable chain with a metal tag on the end. One tag is round, marked "sicher" (safe); the other is triangular, marked "scharf" (armed). When the igniter is armed, the "scharf" chain is pulled out. This positions the bolt in such a manner that the pressure piece will be depressed when the rod is tilted. The igniter may have a trip wire attached to the tilt rod or it may be provided with the two-foot extension rod.

Kippzunder 43 (A)

This igniter, designed to fire when the tilt rod is pushed or tilted in any direction, has standard German threads, permitting its use in any igniter well. It has been found screwed into the bottom well of Tellermines laid upside-down and buried in the ground, the tilt rod extension extending into the air about two feet. The igniter is armed by removing the safety pin. When the tilt rod is moved, the base rod tilts inside the igniter body, depressing the pressure piece and pressure spring, allowing the retaining balls to escape into the recess which releases the springloaded striker. A pressure of 15 or 20 pounds will set off the igniter.

TRIP WIRE

TILT ROD-

SAFETY NU COLLAR-

'SAFI

'RMED" TAB

Kippziinder 43

(B)

Topf Mine Chemical Igniter


GLASS PRESSURE HEAD

SHEAR RIDGE -

GLASS BODY

CELLULOID DISC
PLASTIC DETONATOR HOLDER

This chemical igniter, used in the Topfmine, is an entirely non-metallic pressure type without a safety device. It consists of a hemispherical pressure head fitted into a hollow glass body. The body screws into a plastic detonator holder. Two glass vials, one containing sodium and potassium as a liquid alloy and the other ethyl nitrate, are fastened within the body to a celluloid disc by adhesive tape. When the pressure plate of the mine is sheared under a load of about 330 pounds, the head of the igniter shears along its ridge and crushes the glass vials. The resulting chemical reaction causes a flash which sets off the detonator.

282

August,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

IGNITERS
Buck Chemical Igniter

GERMAN

igniter is threaded to fit in the activating well of any German mine with a standard thread. In operation, when the soft metal shell is crushed, the glass vial breaks, and the acid coming in contact with the powder produces a chemical reaction which ignites the mixture, sending a flame down to the detonator. There is no safety. The Buck Chemical Igniter consists of a soft metal shell containing a glass vial of sulphuric acid surrounded by a white, sugar-like powder containing potassium chlorate. The base of the A newer version of this igniter differs from the old type in that it is shorter and contains a glass vial of purple chemical instead of sulphuric acid.

21-Day Clockwork Igniter J. Feder 504


This igniter, which can be set to go off at any time up to 21 days, is accurate to within 5 minutes in the maximum time limit. It is housed in a white metal case, threaded to take a lid. The mechanism is set by means of a wheel under the lid. Two metal rings are visible through a glass window in the side of the igniter. One wheel, numbered in red, indicates the number of days desired to elapse before the striker is released; the other, numbered in black, is for the hours. The setting ring, marked "Steht" (stop) and 'Geht" (go) is located just above the window. A combined safety and arming hole is in the striker "neck" just below the clockwork housing. The arming screw, marked "scharf" is attached to a chain; the safety screw marked "blind" is carried in the hole.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

August,

1945

283

ANTITANK MINE
T. Mi. 29

GERMAN

ZDZ 29 IGNITER

CARRYING HANDLE

SOCKET FOR ANTI-LIFTING IGNITER

The German Mine, T. Mi. 29, is a light antitank mine having a total weight of 131/4 pounds. It is 10 inches in diameter, 2% inches high, and contains a 10 pound charge of cast T.N.T. Outside, the mine is painted olive green; all internal surfaces are shellacked. The zinc casing comprises two sections: the top, 3/64-inch thick, slides into the base which is 1/32-inch thick, and is secured by eight tabs which pass through slots in the base and are then bent over and soft soldered. Two steel carrying handles shaped to fit close to the case when folded are held by brass strips. The top is slightly domed and has three adapters sweated into shallow recesses. The adapters have sockets to take the standard German igniters, ZDZ 29. There are three additional sockets provided for fitting anti-lifting igniters: two are in the side of the casing, diametrically opposite one another and four inches to the right of the center of each handle; the other is in the center of the base. In addition to being sweated into the casing, each socket is secured by two brass pins which fit into slots on either side of the hole in the mine casing. The ZDZ 29 can function as either a push or pull igniter. When it is used as a pressure igniter, there is a choice of two settings allowing the mine to fire under medium or heavy loads. The operation depends respectively on the shear of one or two pins acting as detents to a spring-loaded striker pellet. When in use as a pull igniter, the operation depends upon the withdrawal of one detent pin from the spring-loaded striker pellet. The igniter is held in a "safe" position by the insertion of a safety key into a slot in the main body. The key slides under the striker pellet, preventing the striker from moving until the key is withdrawn.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

304*1

ANTITANK MINE
Riegel Mine 43 (R.-Mi. 43)
Sprengriegel 43 (Spr. R. 43)

GERMAN

SAFETY PIN

SWIVEL CLIP

PIN
SLOTTED PRESSURE PLATE

HANDLE

The Sprengriegel 43 or "high-explosive bar mine" is used in open country, on roads, and in minefields. It consists of three main parts: a metal encased charge of TNT, a sheet steel tray, and a lid which acts as a pressure plate on the charge. The charge is provided with five igniter sockets: two for the main igniters (Type Z. Z. 42) are located in the ends of the charge and are recessed so that only the ends of the igniters show when they are fitted and laid; the other three are for the new tilt igniter 43 (Ki. Z. 43) or other antilifting or trip-wire igniters. One of the latter three sockets is located in the top center of the charge; the other two are in one side five inches from the ends. By reversing one of the main igniters with its wings below the end pressure plate, it will function as an antilifting device. The mine may also be fired electrically by remote control. The tray is equipped with shear wires which are threaded through reinforcing strips welded to the inner sides of the tray. The ends of the tray are folded over on top to form slotted pressure plates to actuate the Z. Z. 42 igniters fitted to each end of the charge. Near each end are holes through which safety bars are threaded to keep the charge clear of the shear wires in the unarmed position. A thin red line painted along the sides of the tray one-half inch from the bottom indicates the correct position of the lid when the mine is armed. The lid of spot welded sheet steel construction is equipped with a handle at one end. It, too, is fitted with holes to correspond with the sockets, shear wires, and safety bars. A pressure of about 440 pounds at either end, or 880 pounds in the center of the mine forces the lid and charge down, shearing the wires and actuating the igniters which set off the main charge.

SPECIFICATIONS
Overall length .......................................... Overall width .......................................... Height (laid) .............................................. 31% ins. 2 3/ 3 ins. ins.

Total weight (approx.) .............................. 20.5 lb. Color ......................................................... Light khaki Thickness of casing (approx.) .................... 04 in. Weight of charge .......................................... 8.8 lb. Main igniters ........................................ Type Z. Z. 42

Firing pressure (ends) ................................ 440 lb. Firing pressure (center) .............................. 880 Ib.

304.2

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

WOODEN BOX MINE


Holzmine 42

GERMAN

STRIKER ACTUATING PIN PRIMER CHARGES

SPRING

IGNITER BODY-

IGNITER BODY

PRESSURE BLOCK

IGNITER BODY

HANDLE

PRESSURE BLOCK

Z. Z. 42 FUZE

ACTUATING PIN

The body of the German Holzmine 42 consists of a wooden box of %-inch lumber divided into four compartments by removable partitions. The two side compartments contain the main explosive filling; the central compartment the 7-ounce primer charges; and the end compartment the operating mechanism. The main filling consists of two charges of 50/50 Amatol covered with a bitumastic substance as a protection against water. While it is believed that several different types of primer charges are used, three Sprenngkorper 28 charges are presumed to be standard for the mine. The end compartment contains a shearing flange secured to the outside wall by two 3 /-inch wooden dowels. It is provided with a central slot to receive the end of the striker. The igniter rest consists of a small block of wood with a U-shaped piece cut out at the top, and screwed to the base from the underside. When the mine is armed, the feet of the pressure block rest on the shear flange, in which position the head of the pressure block projects about two inches above the lid. During transit, the pressure block is reversed so that the feet rest on blocks in the bottom of the box. A pressure of approximately 200 pounds on the pressure block shears the dowels securing the shear flange to the outer wall of the mine and forces the flange down onto the igniter pin which is withdrawn freeing the spring-loaded striker. The fuze used is the standard German Z. Z. 42. The Holzmine 42 has also been used as a booby trap by employing an anti-lifting device. This device which is fitted into a hole underneath the central compartment is believed to consist of a Z. Z. 35 fuze screwed into a 7-ounce charge.

SPECIFICATIONS
Internal dimensions ............ 11.4 x 10.7 x 3.2 ins.
Size of lid .................................. 13 x 12 x /4 ins. 6.4 x 2.5 ins.

Size of aperture in lid ......................

Pressure block (without feet).... 6 x 2.4 x 2.4 ins. Size of compartments: Main charges .................................. 4.5 x 7.7 ins. Priming charges .......................... 1.7 x 6.8 ins.

Thickness of partitions .................................. 19 in. Size of shearing flange ............ 7.6 x 1.25 x .5 ins. Size of slot in shearing flange .......... .27 x .67 in. Size of wooden blocks.. 3.1 x .78 x .86 ins. deep Main explosive ...................................... Amatol 50/50 11.9 lb. lb.

Total weight of explosive ..........................

Total weight of mine .................................. 18

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

304.3

HOLLOW CHARGE ANTITANK HAND GRENADE


Panzerwurfmine (L)

GERMAN

FLASH CAP

-g

STRIKER HOUSING SG SCAP TAPE HANDLE CLO1*H FINS CONE CARRYING HANDLE

SPRING ---

STRIKER

SAFETY PIN--I.'

DETONATOR

PRIMER

SPRING STEEL RIBS

MAIN CHARGE

The Panzerwurfmine (L) consists of a metal body and a wooden handle to which four canvas fins are attached. The grenade is intended to be thrown by hand, and is armed by the removal of a metal cap at the base of the handle. This cap not only acts as a fuze cover, but also serves to hold the fins close against the handle of the grenade before throwing. The body is made in two pieces crimped together and attached to the handle by a metal band. It contains an 181/2 oz. filling of 50/50 R.D.X./T.N.T. cast around a hollow charge liner made of pressed steel. A sensitive impact fuze consisting of a striker, a creep spring, and two steel balls is located in the base of the handle. The two balls fit into a recess in the striker and are held outward by a safety pin fitting between them, causing them to bear against the top of the striker housing and preventing the striker from moving down onto the primer. Beneath the primer in the base of the handle is a detonator and a picric acid booster. A small length of tape is attached to the safety pin at one end, and is held in at the other end by the metal cap and a semicircular clip attached to one fin and fitting around the handle. When the grenade is thrown, the fins which are attached to the handle by steel ribs open out umbrella fashion, and the clip attached to one fin is pulled away from the housing. This action releases the tape which unwinds and pulls the safety pin out of the striker. During flight, the two steel balls move in, freeing the striker which compresses the creep spring on impact, setting off the primer, detonator, booster, and main filling.

SPECIFICATIONS
Overall length .......................................... 21 Length of body ........................................ 9 ins. ins. ins.

Length of fins ...................................... 11 Diameter of body ......................................

4V2 ins. 3 lb.

Weight (approx.) ..............................................

Filling ........................................ Cast R.D.X./T.N.T.


Color of body ................................................. Grey

304.4

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

MAGNETIC HOLLOW CHARGE ANTITANK MINE


Haft-Hohlladung 3 Kg.

GERMAN @

PLYWOOD - FRAMEWORK

The German magnetic, hollow-charge, antitank mine, designed for use by tank-hunting squads, consists of a main filling of TNT in a pressed metal container of conical shape. The conical container has an elongated apex threaded externally at its upper end to receive a closing cap. The closing cap is fitted with a detonator well, and threaded internally to receive (B. Z. E.) friction igniter which has a 4.5 second delay. a standard

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight of live charge .................
Weight of explosive Weight of booster

7 lbs., 121/2 oz.


151/2 oz. 3 oz.

(TNT) .......... 1 lb..

(Pentrite) ........................

Height of charge ....................................... 10/4 ins. Height of bursting charge container...... Height of magnets .................................. 7/4 ins. 2/4 ins.

Height of apex of hollow cone ............ 6 7/16 ins.

The base of the cone is attached to a plywood framework. Three horseshoe type magnets, sufficiently powerful to cause the mine to adhere to a vertical surface, are fixed to the bottom of the frame. During transit, the magnets are fitted with a keeper. A brass chain terminating in a hook is also attached to the frame.

Diameter of base of hollow cone ........ 4 3/16 ins.

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

March, , pr

1945

304*5

GLASS MINE (ANTIPERSONNEL)


Glasmine 43 (f)

GERMAN

ALTERNATIVE IGNITER PLATE USED WITH BUCK IGNITER

The mine consists of an outer glass casing, the upper portion of which is /4-inch thick and the lower portion 2/5-inch thick. The external diameter at the base is 4 1 inches and at the top, 6 inches /2 at the widest part. A grooved shoulder on the inside of the case, about 2 inches from the bottom, supports the igniter plate. The mine may employ either a Buck chemical igniter or a new mechanized igniter, the Schuko. When the latter is used, the igniter plate consists of a thin sheet metal plate, which has a central hole for the igniter. When the Buck igniter is used, however, an igniter plate having the same diameter and igniter hole but of stronger design is employed. Around the top of the case is a grooved ledge which supports a thin glass shear plate approximately 1/32-inch thick. A moulded glass pressure plate of %-inch extreme thickness and 41/2 inches in diameter rests on the shear plate. There are two parallel grooves on the underside of the pressure plate which are designed to accept a metal safety fork that will bridge the outer edge of the mine and support the pressure plate until such time as the mine is laid. The two prongs are then withdrawn through the two grooves arming the mine. This fork is not supplied with the mine but is improvised by units. Four raised strips moulded in the bottom of the mine are spaced so as to take a standard 200 gm. charge (Sprengkorper 28). When sufficient pressure (40 lbs.) is applied to the glass pressure plate, the shear plate is broken and crushes the top of the Buck igniter or trips the actuating lever of the Schuko igniter, depending on which is employed.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight of standard charge ...................... 200 gm External diameter at top .............................. 6 ins.

External diameter at base ...................... 4.5 ins. Height to lip of container ........................ 4.2 ins. Thickness of casing (upper) ..................... Thickness of casing (lower) ..................... .25 in. .4 in.

304e6

1 March, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ANTIPERSONNEL MINE
Behelfs-Schiitzenmine S. 150

GERMAN O

CRUSH IGNITER WHITE POWDER

GLASS CAPSULE ACID BAKELITE ADAPTER

TOP PLATE
SSTEEL RING

DETONATOR

BODY

--- POWDERED PICRIC ACID

The German Behelfs-Schiitzenmine S. 150, known to allied troops in the field as the "Pot Mine," "Picric Pot," "Mustard Pot," or "Jerry Mine," consists of a cylindrical body, a top plate, and a crush igniter. The body, which is made of pressed steel, contains a 51/4 oz. explosive charge of powdered picric acid. A chemical crushactuated igniter is screwed into the mine by means of a brass or plastic adapter which fits into the top of the body. A synthetic rubber washer is provided between igniter and adapter for waterproofing the mine. The igniter, known as the German Buck Igniter (Chemischer Ziinder Buck) consists of a thin metal drum with circumferential grooves to reduce its resistance against It contains a glass ampule half filled with acid and surrounded by a white powdered flash composition. A small brass detonator (German Nr. 8) is inserted into the detonator pocket. vertical pressure. A moderate pressure on the top of the igniter crushes the metal drum and the glass inside it. The acid pours into the white powder, and a flash resulting from their chemical interaction sets off the detonator which in turn sets off the mine.

SPECIFICATIONS
Height of body ..................................... Diameter of body ................................ Diameter of top plate .............................. Height of igniter ...................................... Diameter of igniter .................................. Depth of detonator pocket ...................... 2 ins. 21/2 ins. 3 ins.

1/2 ins. / in.

112 ins.

Total w eight ....................... ..................... 121/2 ozs. Weight of igniter with adapter ............ 1 oz.

Explosive charge ................ Powered picric acid (51/4 oz. approx.) Color ..................................... Mustard brown

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

304*7

ANTIPERSONNEL MINE
S. Mi. 44 mit S. Mi. Z. 44

GERMAN O

SAFETY

IGNITER

This anti-personnel mine is basically the same, both in construction and operation, as the S. Mi. 35 described on page 305. It consists of an outer casing and an inner cylinder which contains a T.N.T. charge surrounded by small shot. There are three threaded openings in the cover plate: one is used for pouring the charge into the mine; the second, which takes a S. Mi. Z. 44 igniter, opens into a tube containing a 4.5 second delay pellet and a propellant consisting of three grams of fast burning gun powder; the third which is closed by a wooden plug leads into a tube containing a detonator, a flash cap, and a pull igniter. The pull igniter, located at the base of the tube, contains a spring-loaded striker held in place by two steel balls which are prevented from moving by a pin in the base of the igniter. The pin is attached to the base of the outer case by approximately three feet of coiled wire. The S. Mi. Z. 44 is a percussion igniter differing from the usual percussion type in that it has two small wings which, when forced outward by pressure from above or tension through trip wires from the side, release the spring-loaded striker to fire the cap. A pressure of 21 pounds or a tension of 14 pounds will actuate the igniter. Operation of the igniter initiates the 4.5-second delay pellet which fires the propellant throwing the mine upwards. When the coiled wire is fully extended (about 21/2 feet above ground level) it pulls the pin from the igniter, enabling the retaining balls to move inward and release the striker to fire the flash cap, detonator, and bursting charge.

SPECIFICATIONS
Height ......................................................... 51/ ins. Height with igniter .................................... 87/ ins. Diam eter ........................................ .............. 4 ins.

Weight ........................................................... 8.8 lb. Color ............................................ Camouflage ellow

304*8

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ANTITANK MINE
Topf Mine

GERMAN

PRIMER CHARGE

CARRYNG HANDLE

Above:

A cross-section of the antitank topf mine showing principal parts.

Upper right: Top view. Lower right: Bottom view showing carrying handle.

The Topf Mine, a completely non-metallic, waterproof, antitank mine, consists of a circular body filled with a 12 /2-pound charge of TNT, a primer plug assembly, and an igniter. The top of the mine is flat, with a fixed pressure plate in the center slightly higher than the surface; a 4 1 /2-inch circular recess located in the bottom takes the primer plug ang igniter assembly. The outer casing is made of a hard pulp-like material covered with pitch. The mine rests on three glass studs; two of the studs secure a pasteboard carrying handle, while the third, which is sometimes larger than the two others, is used as a filler plug. The primer plug assembly consists of a glass screw cap and a cylindrical wooden booster holder, the top of which has a deep threaded recess to take the Topf Mine Igniter. A subsidiary igniter socket in the glass cap leads to the booster charge, and is threaded to take a standard igniter. The Topf Mine Igniter, which is made of glass, has no safety device. It comprises a cylindrical glass body 3 mm thick; a solid glass pressure head, hemispherical in shape and two small glass ampules, one of which contains sodium and potassium as a liquid alloy and the other ethyl nitrate. The ampules are held in position by a black celluloid disc. A thin bakelite detonator well is provided. The mine is activated by a pressure of at least 330 pounds, which forces the pressure plate down onto the igniter head and thereby breaking the two glass ampules. A flash results, setting off the detonator, booster, and main charge. If a standard igniter is used, the mine must be laid upside down.

SPECIFICATIONS
Diameter of mine ...................................... Height of mine .................................. 12 V2 ins. 51/2 ins.

Weight (complete) ......................................... 20 Ibs. W eight in crate .............................................. Filling ....................................... 29 lbs.

.................... TNT 12 2 lbs. 330 lbs. 31/2 ins.

Weight of filling ........................................ Firing pressure .......................................... Height of igniter (including capy ..............

Diameter of igniter body .............................. 1/2 ins. Shear pressure of igniter .......................... 132 lbs. Overall height of primer plug assembly.... 3.1 ins. Diameter of primer holder ...................... 2/V2 ins. 4.6 Diameter of glass cap .................................................. ins.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May,

1945

304

15 cm STICK GRENADE
15 cm Stielgranate

GERMAN O

OVEAALL

LEcNTH

4- 2'/2

SLNH

7 /i
11 V2

I
WI
4'- 2/2"

-I

The German 15 cm high explosive Stick Grenade is reported to be used with the 15 cm heavy infantry gun, s. I. G. 33. Its prime purpose is for demolition, and for clearing minefields and wire obstacles. Of welded steel construction, the bomb has a 1/8-inch case consisting of three main parts: the nose, a cylindrical center piece, and a tapered rear piece. Both the nose and the base are reinforced with steel rings welded to the casing. The ring in the nose is tapped to receive the fuze adaptor; that in the base to accommodate a steel cup. This cup, which has machined surfaces, is %-inch thick at the base and 3/16-inch at the sides. A stick unit which leaves the bomb approximately 150 yards from the muzzle of the gun fits over the cup. According to reports, the unit weighs 22.2 kg. (49 lb.) and the propelling charge 5.5 (121/8 lb.). The main filling consists of approximately 60 pounds of poured 50/50 Amatol. A 2-inch cylindrical booster charge made up of compressed T.N.T. pellets is located in the center of the main filling about 15 inches from the booster; two normal annular picric pellets surround the booster. The bomb is fitted with a percussion type nose fuze, Wgr. Z.36, which is also reported as being used in the German 20 cm Spigot Mortar Bomb. The tail, of unusual construction, has three tubular steel sockets equally spaced around the bomb and projecting from the rear portion of the casing at an angle of 20 to the main axis. These sockets receive tubular bars to which the sheet steel tubular fins are attached. The bars are bent in order to bring the fins parallel to the main axis and also to provide clearance of the muzzle of the gun. In addition there are six 5/32-inch steel plate fins welded to the casing and spaced in pairs between the tubular sockets.

SPECIFICATIONS
Overall length ......................................... 50 ins. Overall length (excluding tail fins & fuze) 30/4 ins. Diameter (maximum) ................................ 11 Thickness of casing ........................................ Total weight (approx.) ................................ Weight of filling (approx.) ............................ Color .......................................................... ins. in. 105 lb. 60 lb.

Field grey

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

30601

7.5 cm PAK 41 ARMOR-PIERCING AMMUNITION


7.5/5.5 cm Pzgr. Patr. 41 (W) COMPLETE ROUND

GERMAN

PRIMER

CHARGE

CARTRIDGE CASE

TRACER

I ^

OUTER CASE

{I

TUNGSTEN CARBIDE CORE

SCREW HEAD

BALLISTIC CAP

This round is designed for use in the 7.5/5.5 cm Pak 41 tapered bore antitank gun described on page 123 of this volume. It is an armor piercing tracer projectile of Gerlich design with the nomenclature 7.5 cm Pzgr. Patr. 41 (w). The projectile consists of an outer case, a tungsten carbide core 1.16 inch in diameter, a screw head, a ballistic cap, and a tracer. It is fired from a regular cartridge consisting of cartridge case 6344, primer C/12n. A. St., an igniter of pyroxylin porous powder, and the propelling charge of diglycol tubular powder.

SPECIFICATIONS
Total weight of round .............................. 16.65 lb. Total length of round ................................ 29.8 ins. W eight of projectile .................................... 5.68 lb. Weight of tungsten carbide core ................ 2.01 lb. Diameter of core ........................................ Weight of propellant charge ........................ 1.16 ins. 5.4 lb.

306.2

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED'

8 cm MORTAR SHELL-"Bouncing Betty"


8 cm Wurfgranate 39

GERMAN

The 8 cm Wgr. 39 consists of a nose fuze, front cap, rear body, and tail assembly. The body, which is separated from the cap at the ogive, has a standard shape and TNT filling. The cast nose cap fits over a cylindrical boss, concentric with the longitudinal axis of the projectile. This cap is secured to the boss by four shear pins that extend through the cap and the boss. The seam where the two parts are joined is then shellacked to form a watertight seal. An impact type, nondelay fuze is screwed into the cap; inside the cap is a plastic container of about 1V2 ounces of smokeless powder. Under the charge, screwed into the projectile body, is an iron plug with a small axial hole through it. This plug separates the smokeless powder charge from the combination delay pellet and booster which is in an aluminum container. The tail assembly is a standard type, having the usual base charge, ring increments, and fin assembly. Upon impact, the nondelay fuze ignites the smokeless powder charge, sending a flash through the hole in the separating plug, setting off the delay pellet. The explosion from the first charge shears the pins holding the nose cap to the projectile body, and throws the shell from 5 to 10 feet into the air. In the meantime, the booster detonates the main TNT bursting charge at approximately the moment when the projectile is at the height of its bounce. This gives the effect of an air burst without the use of a precision time fuze. Height of the burst is governed by the angle of the shell axis with the ground at the time of impact.

KEY TO PARTS (A) (B) (C) (D) (E) (F) (G) (H) (I) (I) (K) (L) (M) (N) Propellant increments Propellant cartridge Projectile body False ogive Point ignition fuze-Wgr. Z 38 st Booster well Booster capsule Delay type detonator Paper washer Paper diaphragm Plastic washer Booster well adapter Ejector capsule Ejector capsule igniter

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF

ORDNAINCE

August,

1945

3099

HOLLOW CHARGE AMMUNITION


10.5 cm HL, HL/A, HL/B, HL/C

GERMAN

Type HL

Type HL/A

Type HL/B

Type HL/C

There are four known variations of the 10.5 cm (105 mm) Hollow charge ammunition fired from the German 10.5 cm le. F. H. 18 series:
Type H1 has a deep conical cavity, a short ogive, and flash tube extending through the shaped cavity to the fuze booster. All types have an additional detonator booster combination at the base of the flash tube. Type HI/A has the same shaped cavity but has a larger diameter flash tube that is attached to the apex of cavity liner by a pressed collar, and does not extend into the cavity. This type has a long ogive. The principal difference between types Hl/A and H1/B is in a shallower, hemispherical-shaped cavity. The principal difference between types H1/B and Hl/C is the addition of a funnel-like steel washer inverted over the cavity. This funnel is supposed to counteract the effects of centrifugal force on the hollow charge jet. The explosive filler is pressed into two pellets in types HI/A, H1/B, and type HI/C. Explosive fillers in all rounds are inclosed in waxed paper cartons. The metal ogive screws into the projectile, holding all components of the filler in place. The aluminum fuze (AZ 38) carries the primer detonator. It is armed by centrifugal force and contains no other safety features. It functions by a "spit" from the booster, which travels down the central tube and initiates the base booster, and hence the main bursting charge.

SPECIFICATIONS
H1 Weight of projectile as fired: H.E. filling, carton, wax: Empty shell: Collar ("funnel") Muzzle velocity f/s* HI/A HI/B Hl/C

25.8 lb.

27.1 lb.

26.6 lb.

27.2 lb.

4.6875 lb.

3.5 lb.

3.255 lb.

22.55 lb. 22.937 lb. 22.315 lb.

.5195 lb.

1375

1360

1360

1360

ESSENTIAL MODIFICATIONS Type H1/A: (a) Lengthened nose-piece (ogive), giving greater standoff. (b) Elimination of flash tube between fuze and apex of cavity and larger diameter of flash tube. Type H1/B: (a) Further increase of standoff obtained by shortening the HE filler. Nose piece is identical with that of Type H1/A. (b) Hemispherical cavity instead of rounded cone. (c) HE filling RDX/WAX, instead of RDX/WAX/TNT. Type H1/C: Introduction of a washer, shaped like an inverted funnel in front of the cavity. Otherwise, types B and C are essentially identical.

Estimated performance at normal against Homogeneous armor. Type HI/A-170 mm (static) 105 mm (dynamic) Type HI/B-155 mm (static) 100 mm (dynamic) Type Hl/C-155 mm (static) 100 mm (dynamic) (From German claims)

'Firing with charge five which is normally used.

310

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

(Replacement Page)

RESTRICTED

10.5 cm "SABOT"

TYPE H. E. SHELL

GERMAN

CENTERING RING LOCKING BALL

SINTERED IRON DRIVING BAND BASE RING LOCKING PIN LOADING SHIELD OF BASE RING -

SHELL WALL

REJECTABLE BASE RING

This new type projectile consists of an 8.8 cm streamlined shell body fitted with centering and rotating band rings which permit it to be fired from a 10.5 cm weapon. Both the centering ring and rotating band ring are so designed that they become detached from the shell body under the influence of centrifugal force on leaving the muzzle of the gun. The advantage of such a design, provided it functions properly, is that a lighter weight projectile of smaller diameter is fired from a 10.5 cm weapon instead of the normal 10.5 cm projectile. The effect is to give a higher muzzle velocity and longer range for the 8.8 cm streamlined shell body than would be obtained with the standard 10.5 cm high explosive projectile. However, the effectiveness is reduced due to lower weight of projectile. One disadvantage of this type of shell lies in the possibility of injury to friendly troops when the centering rings and rotating band are cast from the projectile. The centrifugal force would make these pieces into dangerous missiles. The complete weight of the projectile is 23 pounds. Projectiles examined have been filled with a high explosive charge, and fitted with a percussion type nose fuze (AZ 23v.). The 15 cm shell of similar design employs the same fuze. The explosive trains of these projectiles are similar to those for the usual type of German high explosive shell.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

311

28 cm RIFLED PROJECTILE

GERMAN

BALLISTIC CAP

LONGITUDINAL INCLINED STEEL SPLINES

11 Ya"

49" (Est.)

This pre-engraved, projectile recovered in Italy is used for long range bombardment. It has longitudinal inclined steel splines and a single one-inch-wide copper band that acts as a gas seal. The splines are set at a slight angle to the axis of the projectile and are 19.2 inches in length. In loading the projectile, the splines are

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber .................................. 280 mm (11.023 ins.)
Weight (approx.) ........................................ 550 lbs.

Length (excluding windshield) .................

33 ins.

lined up with the rfling of the gun tube. The shell is 33 inches in length, exclusive of the windshield. Fragments indicate that the windshield would add an extra two feet to the length. A nose percussion fuze (AZ 35 K) and a base fuze (BD Z 35K) are fitted. The Germans are reputed to have four types of 28 cm railway guns able to employ this type of projectile. They are: 28 cm Br. N. Kan E.; 28 cm K. 5 (E); 28 cm K. 5/1 (E); and 28 cm K. 5/2 (E).

312

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ROCKET ASSISTED PRERIFLED PROJECTILE


28 cm R. Gr. 4331

GERMAN

Top, left, forward body (ogive) and venturi tube: center, venturi assembly without spun glass sleeve: right, forward body assembled to main body, showing prerlfling: at right, assembly with cast explosive charge.

This high explosive projectile is fired from the 28 cm K. 5 (E) railway gun, and is prerifled in the same manner as the 28 cm Gr. 35 described on page 312. The outstanding feature of this new projectile is an increase in range from 67,800 yards to 93,100 yards -nearly 53 miles. This increase of 37% over the maximum range for the standard high explosive round is the result of energy supplied to the projectile by the addition of rocket propellant powder which is ignited 19 seconds after leaving the gun. After building up sufficient pressure to shear the lip on the base plug, the rocket propellant located in the ogive of the projectile discharges through a central venturi tube. On the main body there are 12 steel splines set at the angle of rifling. The forward body (ogive) is threaded externally to screw into the main body and internally at its nose to receive the fuze and a rocket propellant ignition system. The venturi tube which extends from the base of the projectile to its middle section is secured by being screwed into the fuze and venturi adapter. A spun glass sleeve insulates the venturi tube from the explosive charge which is cast on the resulting assembly. A Zt. Z. S/30 time fuze set to operate 19 seconds after the projectile is fired is screwed into the nose of the projectile. Two percussion fuzes, AZ 4331, are located in the venturi adapter. These are armed by the burning of the rocket propelling charge through a powder pellet incorporated in the fuze. The rocket propellant is moulded as one piece, and extending through it are eight longitudinal holes %-inch in diameter, located around a circular hole 15 /-inch in diameter.

SPECIFICATIONS
Length of projectile (less fuze) ............. 48.79 ins.

Diameter of ribs ...................................... Diameter of rotating band ......................

11.70 ins. 11.85 ins

Diameter of body .................................... 11.10 ins Total weight ............................................ 545/4 lbs. Rocket propellant weight ............................ 43 lbs. Explosive weight ...................................... 30 Ibs.

Maximum range .................................. 93,100 yds.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

June,

1945

312.1

METHOD OF RAMMING AND INDEXING SPLINED PROJECTILE

GERMAN

i~rS~

~zc "Ts~-~ : :

"'

~~*~

-~~

6.-Y

Indexing and ramming the 28 cm prerifled projectile in the German railway gun, 28 cm K5 (E), is accomplished with the aid of the rammer which, by gripping the base of the shell, allows the projectile to be indexed during its final travel through the powder chamber. Fitted centrally in the flat head of the rammer are two claws, reversed to each other and held outwardly by spring tension. A circular undercut recess in the base of the projectile receives these two claws holding the base of the shell against the face of the rammer. Two keyways milled in the periphery of the base of the shell receive corresponding, lugs on the face of the rammer and hold the members in rotation. Four evenly spaced lugs projecting longitudinally from the face of the rammer fit over the sides of the base of the projectile and hold the two in a transverse direction. The head is fitted by a universal joint to the rammer, the front portion of which is a plain two-inch shaft approximately ten feet long and the rear portion machined with four longitudinal splines set at the same angle as the rifling of the tube. Over the splined portion of the rammer, which is 6 feet, 10/4 inches long, slides a collar fitted with two radially projecting horns set at approximately 75 degrees. The last 161/4 inches of the rammer are not splined and the extremity threaded, in all proba-

bility to receive a transverse handle. A lever which depresses the claws to release the head from the base of the projectile is fitted to the rear portion of the shaft. A bracket bolted in the rear face of the breech ring has the function of receiving in two longitudinal keyways, the extremities of the two radial horns of the sliding collar. In operation, the rammer is held securely to the base of the projectile and the shell is rammed through the powder chamber until the two horns of the sliding collar, in its forward position along the splines, engage in the two matching keyways of the bracket fitted to the rear of the breech ring. At this point, the shell, which still has approximately 2 feet, 6% inches to travel before the leading edge of the splines engage in the grooves of the rifling, is indexed and during the remaining forward travel of ramming remains indexed by virtue of the sliding collar which being held against rotation causes the rammer sliding through it to rotate at the same twist as the rifling. The position of the two horns can be adjusted in relation to the body of the collar and once set for a particular gun, no further adjustments are necessary. A scale etched on the spline portion of the rammer indicates the depth of ramming from 2,850 to 4,050 centimeters for the 28 cm K5 (E).

312.2

1 June, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

CARTRIDGE CASE FOR 10.5 cm RECOILLESS GUN

GERMAN

SIDE
PRIMER

The German Recoilless Gun, versions of which are described on pages 110 and 119, operates without a recoil or counterrecoil mechanism. This is made possible by a design which allows the propelling gases to escape to the rear when the weapon is fired. This unusual design of brass coated steel cartridge case, which makes possible an unexpectedly long range for such a weapon, is provided with a primer in its side and a plastic base insert. This plastic base insert, 1.12 inch thick, momentarily withstands the pressure of the ignited propellant and then disintegrates, being blown out the rear of the weapon along with the released propellant gases. The propelling charge and igniter are made up to suit side ignition. The propellant is contained in a cylindrical bag; the igniter bag is in the form of a cap, and fits over the end of the propellant bag. The igniter composition is contained in pockets formed between the outer fabric and the lining by quilting the bag. There are twelve pockets around the side and six in the end. The propellant is a flashless composition of the normal "Gudol" type and the igniter composition is the normal porous chopped cord.

SPECIFICATIONS
Propellant weight ........................................ 6.9 lbs.
Propellant analysis Nitrocellulose (N-12.34%) ....................... 34.47%

Nitroguanidine .......................................... 33.81%


Diethylene Glycol dinitrate ................ Graphite .................................... ...... 30.22% 0.14%

Potassium Sulphate ................................


Propellant bag .................................... Cartridge case..........Brass

1.36%

Viscose rayon

coated, 1010 type steel

Thickness of brass coating .................. 0.0001 in. Base insert .................... Phenol-formaldehyde resin

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

313

17 cm STEEL CARTRIDGE CASE, SPIRAL DESIGN

GERMAN (

CARDBOARD DISC

COLLAR

BASE

RETAINING PLATE

This is a large caliber steel cartridge case of different design from those customarily used by the Germans. The body is a wound cylinder made of 0.084 inch thick sheet steel three and four turns thick and turned under at the base to fit into a base assembly. The base assembly is provided with a retaining plate, screwed collar, and a disc which seals the cartridge case and prevents the escape of gases through the base. The disc is of cardboard; all the other parts are of steel. A shallow spiral groove, about 0.003 inch deep and .23 inch wide, is rolled into the inner surface of the body under such pressure as to show the marks of the groove on the outer surface of the case. A layer of black wax is used between the overlapping coils of the body to assist waterproofing. The upper surface of the cardboard disc is also covered with black wax. It appears that this case is manufactured by coiling the sheet approximately to shape, placing the body in a die and rolling to shape with an internal roller. The base, retaining plate, and screwed collar have completely machined surfaces. All the parts have a thin surface film of oxide for protection from corrosion. This is not completely effective. The Vickers Diamond Hardness of the body increases from about 105 near the base to 133 near the mouth. It is approximately 222 across the base except in the primer boss where it is about 280. On the retaining plate the V. D. H. varies from 160 at the center to 172 on the rim. The screwed collar is 175 V. D. H.

314

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

RADIO-CONTROLLED GLIDER BOMB


H. s. 293

GERMAN

NOSE PLUG

STEEL TUBE FOR MAIN SPAR

FUZE POCKET

The German high explosive bomb, H. s. 293, is a radio-controlled, jet-propelled glider, designed primarily for use against merchant ships and naval craft. It is usually released when the plane is in level flight at an altitude of from 3,000 to 5,000 feet, and at a distance of from 3 to 5 miles from the target. However, the bomb is not launched directly at the target, but is released during flight on a course parallel to that of the target. Upon release, the jet propulsion automatically goes into action, and thereafter the flight of the bomb is controlled from the airplane by radio. It is apparently aimed by eye alone and, as an aid to visibility, the tail is provided with flares and an electric lamp for night use. H. s. 293 is made up of six main parts: the bomb which forms the forward part of the fuselage; the rear portion of the fuselage containing the radio control unit, a gyro, and a destructor; the jet propulsion unit (slung from the base of the bomb); the wings, or planes; the tail plane; and the tail tracer unit. The bomb case is of forged steel and is filled with approximately 600 pounds of 60/40 poured Amatol. A cylinder of compressed T.N.T. pellets lies in this filling, running forward from the fuze pocket. The control unit consists of a radio receiver, a motor generator, and a relay unit. A radio destruction device is located directly under the radio receiver and consists of a small charge with a clockwork fuze. Propulsion is accomplished by means of a bi-liquid rocket unit. Wings and tail planes are of aerofoil section and the skin is of thin sheet alloy. Ailerons are provided for lateral control, and an elevator is concealed in -the tail plane. Five flare candles burning consecutively make up the tail tracer unit.

SPECIFICATIONS
Overall length ............................................ 148 ins. ins. Length of bomb ........................................ 60
Diameter of bomb .................................. Total weight (approx.) .......................... Span of mainplanes ..............................

18 V2 ins. 1,980 lbs. 122 /s ins.


5

Span of tailplanes .................................. Diameter of jet-propulsion unit (approx.)..


Weight of bomb (approx.) .................... Color ..........................................

43/4 ins. 12 ins.

1320 lbs.

................... Sky-blue

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

315

ROCKET-PROPELLED BOMB
PC 1000 Rs

GERMAN

VENTURI TUBES

ROCKET SPACE

The German 1,000 kg. (actual wt. 2,176 lb.) armor-piercing bomb (PC 1000 Rs) is a rocket-propelled type designed primarily for use against ships or similar targets The rocket, which is used to increase terminal velocity and armor penetration qualities of the bomb, consist of 19 sticks of propellant contained in a separate compartment at the base of the bomb. Gases generated by the propellant escape from the rocket container through six propulsion venturi tubes which are sealed with pitch until combustion is effected. The compartment is provided with a spring-loaded pressure release valve at the base. It is reported that the minimum height for release is 4,000 ft., and that the rocket burns for approximately three seconds after ignition, leaving a trail of flame 150 ft. long. The bomb which is filled with alternate layers of good and poor quality TNT, and a very pure cast TNT in an aluminum container in the nose, is fuzed through the baseplate. A charging head, located in a distance piece between the bomb and the rocket container, has a junction box with connections leading to a pyrotechnic and an impact fuze through two pin plugs. These plugs are colored black and red respectively. The pyrotechnic fuze has a 21 V2-second delay, and consists of an igniter bridge (which functions when an electrical impulse from the charging plate is received at the time of the bomb's release), and a pyrotechnic train calculated to give a safe interval between the time of release and ignition of the rocket element. The bomb fuze, of the electrical impact type, is also armed by the electrical impulse from the charging head. There are three other bombs of the same general type: PC 500 .Rs; a lighter version of the PC 1000 Rs; PC 1000 Rs Ex, for practice or experimental use (it has no main filling, no baseplate or bomb fuze and the weight is made up by the extra thickness of the bomb casing); and the PC 1800 Rs.

SPECIFICATIONS
Total weight ............................................ Weight of case ........................................ Weight of explosive ............................. 2,176 lbs. 1,470 lbs. 119 lbs. ins. ins.

Overall length .................................. 7 ft., 2/ Length of bomb ................................ 3 ft.; 9

Diameter of bomb ............................ 1 ft., 3V2 ins.


Diameter of tail fins Large ................................................ 2 ft. 4 ins.

Small .......................................

...

1 ft., 10 ins.

Dimensions of Propellant 6............221/V ins. long x 2 15/16 ins. diameter 12............20/s ins. long x 2 15/16 ins. diameter 1............11/4 ins. long x 2 15/16 ins. diameter Filling ............................................................ T.N .T.

Color .............................................................. Sky-blue

316

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ANTIPERSONNEL RIFLE OR HAND GRENADE


Gewehr-Sprenggranate

GERMAN

This grenade consists of a tubular steel body containing


STRIKER

an explosive filler of

penthrite wax, a

detonator,

a direct

FUZE BODY

action nose fuze, a delay friction igniter, and a base assembly containing a self-destroying system. A diaphragm near the

CLOCK INERTIA PRIMER


DETONATOR

bottom of the grenade is

threaded centrally to receive the The fuze and base assemblies are not integral friction igniter.
parts of the grenade, but are screwed into the nose and base respectively.

HOLDER
DETONATOR

If the nose fuze does not function properly, the


On firing, the flash from the prothe base closing plug and

grenade is self-destructive.
CARDBOARD
CONTAINER

pelling cartridge enters a hole in


ignites a

DELALETEE

L BODY

6.5 second delay pellet contained in

a brass holder.

IGNITER

This fires the friction igniter which, gives an additional delay

B8dD'
WIRE

of 4.5 seconds before setting off the detonator. may

The grenade

FRICT ON

also be used as a hand grenade by removing the base

LANYARD

assembly and pulling a cord attached to the friction igniter.

Overall length..........
DELAY & 6.5 SEC. PLAS-PELLET
-Maximum

5.5 ins. 1.2 ins. alumnium

Explosive

filler

.............

PETN/Wax

Maximum diameter ..........


HHOLE

Weight of fille..........1.1 range ......


Delay

o.
550 yds.

BASCOSIGLUG PLUG CLOSING BADE


LA HOEbase

Color............Black

body:

sec. ........ Self-destroying-l1 Friction igniter-4.5 sec.

Total weight .........................

9 OS..

Impact-no

delay

ANTITANK RIFLE GRENADE


Gewehr Panzergranate
The Gewehr Panzergranate is constructed in two parts, the head and the stem. The head, a seamless steel tube fitted
CAP EALLISTIC

STEEL

CONE.

with a light ballistic cap, contains a hollow charge cone and provided in the rear an explosive filling of T.N.T. A cavity

is

TUBE STEEL

portion of the main filling to take an exploder of penthrite wax. The stem of light alloy or aluminum is screwed onto

the head of the grenade. It is divided into two compartments. The upper portion contains the booster which consists of a
T.N.T. FILING

WAX EXPLODER' PENTHRITE

detonator surrounded by a penthrite wax filling contained in a light alloy case. The percussion type fuze is located in the
lower part of the stem. In the, septum is a small flash pellet A pre-engraved

WAX PEWTHRAXE

held

in place by a perforated screw plug.


inch fromn the base.

driving band is
DETONATOR

formed on the outside of the grenade ap-

64

proximately /

The entire assembly is

closed by a ease plug which positions the fuze by a stem which fits into a recess in the rear of the striker body.
FLASHPELLET

SPRING ARMING

Overall length ............ Maximum diameter ......

...

6.4 Ins.

Filler ........

........... T.N.T./Cyclonite

RETAINING SPRING
STRIKER

1 3/16 ins.

Weight of filler.................. 1.75 ess. Range................50 yds.

PLUG STEEL BASE

Color....Black body: aluminum stem


Total weight

........................

8.8

ozs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

317

H.E.A.T. (Hollow Charge) RIFLE GRENADE


Gross Gewehr Panzergranate

GERMAN

This grenade, while larger and of slightly different conSTEEL WASHER

tour than that described on the preceding page, is basically

the same in construction and operation. The body of pressed


STEEL CASING!

steel contains a steel cone around which the T.N.T. filler is .FILLING ST.N cast, and at the bottom of the filler is an exploder pellet of penthrite wax. Two types of stem may be used, one entirely of light alloy and the other of plastic with a steel shank by which it is screwed onto the body. The booster assembly and the percussion type fuze are both located in the stem divided by a perforated septum which contains a small flash pellet.
S
PENTHRITE

At the base of the stem is a rifled band which corresponds to

the rifling on the discharger. The assembly is closed by a


DETONA"OR

base plug.
FLASH PELLET

Overall length ........................ ARMING SPRING EP

7 ins.

Weight of filler..................

ozs.

Maximum diameter ............ 13 ins. Color .............................. Black overall


Total weight .................. 132 ozs.

Filler ........................ T.N.T./Cyclonite Range (maximum) ............ 100 yds.

PROPAGANDA RIFLE GRENADE


Gewehr Propaganda Granate
This grenade which is used for propaganda purposes
52

econsists I.iA.

of a cylindrical steel body with a pre-rifled base and

STEEL BALLISTIC CAP

Sa

removable ballistic cap. The base of the grenade contains a


9-second delay fuze and an ejecting charge covered by a

LEAFETS--

cardboard disc-to prevent moisture from causing deterioration. Leaflets are inserted in two steel packing covers held loosely inside the case, and then the case and cap are var7

S PACKNG ERS TEEL,

nished to protect them from rust. On firing, the flash from the propelling cartridge ignites the fuze and approximately 9

BODY-STEEL

PLATFORM

seconds later the ejecting charge explodes, blowing off the

CHARGE EJECTING

cap and forcing the leaflets out of the nose of the projectile.
Overall length ...................... 5.7 ins. Delay Range ...................................... ................................ 9 sec. 500 yds.

RIFLED DRIVING BAND

Total weight .......................... 8 ozs.


D

ELAY TRAIN

Weight without leaflets........ 7 ozs.

318

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

H.E.A.T. (Hollow Charge) GRENADE


Schuss Gr. P-40
_ ___

GERMAN O

This grenade consists of a bell-shaped body of thin steel with a slightly convex aluminum closing disc, a graze fuze which screws into a cylindrical projection welded to the base of the body, and a finned tail unit. The bursting charge of cy-

CLOSING DISC CUP IALUMINUM

BURSTING

clonite wax is cast around an aluminum hollow charge liner which is hemispherical in shape. A detonator and intermediary exploder are contained in an aluminum magazine which fits into the base of the main explosive cavity. The tail unit screws onto the base of the fuze housing and consists of a drawn-steel tube with six vanes formed in pairs. The cartridge is of the 7.92 mm small arm type with an undyed hollow wooden bullet.

Overall length .................. 9.3 ins. Maximum diameter ............ 2.4 ins. Color .............................. Olive green

Markings......Blue band round projection at base of body Length of body .................... 3.1 Ins. Filler ........................ Cyclonite/Wax

H.E.A.T. (Hollow Charge) RIFLE GRENADE


Gross Panzergranate 61 and 46
Two additional H.E.A.T. (hollow charge) armor piercing rifle grenades have recently been recovered and are illustrated herewith. They bear the designations G. Pz. Gr. 61 and G. Pz. Gr. 46. The numerals "61" and "46" refer to the diameter of the explosive head in millimeters. The maximum range of the "61" is 218 yards. Static fired at normal, the "61" is reported to penetrate to 4.96 inches of homogeneous armor plate; the "46" is reported to penetrate 3.54 inches of the same plate.

"61" Total weight ............ 1 lb., 4.25 ozs. Weight of H. E. filling...... 8.69 ozs. .24 oz.

"46" Total weight .................. 14.65 ozs. Weight of H. E. filling.... 5.16 ozs.

Weight of booster explosive

Weight of booster explosive .24 oz. Weight of propelling cartridge powder ........................ 27 grains

Weight of propelling cartridge powder ........................ 27 grains

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

319

GERMAN RIFLE GRENADE PROPELLING CARTRIDGES


Powder Filling Nz. T. P. (1.4:2:0,5/0:25)
Cartridge for German Name grams Markings

GERMAN

Remarks

Large A. P. Grenade

G. Treib. Patr. fur Gr. G. Pzgr.

1.9

Black wooden bullet

Propaganda Grenade

G. Kart. fur G. Propgr.

1.7

Red ring

In the future to be used only for Rifle Propaganda Grenade

Propaganda Grenade

G. Kart. (Alter Art) fiir G.

1.7

Red ring

Obsolete

(Old Type) Small A. P. Grenade Small A. P. Grenade

Propgr. G. Kart. fir G. Pzgr. G. Kart. (Alter Art) fur G. Pzgr. G. Kart. fur G. Sprgr. 1.1 1.1 Black ring Black ring (partly) Packed attached to grenade Obsolete

H. E. Grenade

1.0

Yellow ring

In the future to be used only for H. E. grenade Obsolete

H. E. Grenade

G. Kart. (Alter Art) fir G. Sprgr. G. Kart. (Alter Art) fiir G. Sprgr.

1.0

Yellow ring (partly)

H. E. Grenade (Old Type)

0.85

Packed attached to grenade

RIFLE DISCHARGERS
The two standard German rifle dischargers are the cup type (Schiessbecher) and the spigot type. The former is

made of steel and consists of a rifled barrel which screws into a holder fitted with a clamp for attaching it to the rifle barrel. There are no gas ports, and varying ranges are obtained by altering the elevation of the rifle by the aid of the sighting attachment. The latter type consists of a hollow tubular
CUP TYPE

TYPE

spigot about one inch in diameter, terminating in a part resembling the hilt of a bayonet. It is fitted to the rifle in the same manner as a bayonet, and is locked in position by a spring-loaded bolt. The hollow tailpiece of the grenade is fitted over the spigot, and on firing the propelling cartridge, the gasses pass out of the barrel of the rifle through the spigot and into the hollow tailpiece to propel the grenade. Both a swing-over blade front sight and a rear sight are provided.

320

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

NEW TYPE STICK HAND GRENADE


Stielhandgranate 43

GERMAN Q

The new type German Stick Grenade, consisting of a head filled with TNT, a smooth fragmentation sleeve, fitted over the head, and a detachable wooden handle, is a modification of the standard Stielhandgranate scribed on page 321. 24 de-

igniter operated by a cord running through the handle.


1

Instead,

the

detonator

and

4 /2-second

delay

igniter

similar to that used with the egg grenade, are screwed

into the top of the explosive head.

The grenade may be

thrown with or without the handle. The later model, however, does not have a friction

Arming and priming

are the same as for the egg grenade.

OFFENSIVE DISC TYPE GRENADE


This grenade, a new type of offensive weapon, has no outer casing or cover, but consists merely of a disc cut from a pre-cast or pressed pellet of explosive,

and an igniter.
R.D.X./wax,
L__JS F--i

The disc, which is


3 5/16 inches in is drilled to

believed

to be
17/32 and

is It

diameter and

inches thick. detonator.

receive

the igniter

I f1

'

A standard friction igniter with a delay of approxiI

mately six seconds, and a detonator (Sprengkapsel 08)


I
I

are used.

L. J

SPECIFICATIONS
c-

Diameter Thickness Explosive

of disc

........................................

3 5/16 Ins. 17/32 in. .D.X./wax

of disc ........................................ ..................................................

Color............................................Chocolate

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

320.1

STICK HAND GRENADE MODELS 24 AND 39


Stielhandgranaten 24 u. 39

GERMAN O

The head of this grenade is a thin steel casing containing the explosive filler. This is screwed onto a hollow wooden handle through the center of which runs a double length of cord. This cord connects at the forward end to a friction pull igniter (B. Z. 24) and at the rear to a porcelain ball in a metal cap. In operation, the cap is removed, the porcelain ball pulled, and the missile thrown to detonate after a 4-5 second delay.

MODEL 24 Overall length ............ 1 ft., 2 ins. Diameter of body .............. 2 /4 ins. Color of body ................ Weight Olive drab
3

MODEL 39 Overall length ............ 1 ft., 4 ins.

Color ................................. Olive drab W eight ....................... 1 lb., 6 ozs.

........................ 1 lb., 5 oz. filler.... 6 ozs.

Weight of explosive filler.... 7 ozs. Igniter .................................... B. Z. 24 Delay .................................. 4-5 sec.

Weight of explosive

Explosive filler ........................ T.N.T. Igniter ................................ B. Z. 24 Delay ................................ 4-5 sec.

EGG-TYPE HAND GRENADE MODEL 39


Eierhandgranate 39
This grenade consists of a thin egg-shaped case filled with an explosive charge, and a friction type igniter with a delay pellet. The upper end of the friction wire in the igniter is attached to a disc in the head which screws on to the top of the body. In operation, the head is unscrewed and pulled, drawing the wire through the friction composition and igniting the delay pellet. After a delay of from 4 to 5 seconds the pellet initiates the detonator which in turn sets off the explosive filler. This type hand grenade has been used as a booby trap by fitting a non-delay friction igniter which can be identified by its left-hand threads.

Overall length ....................... 3 ins. Maximum diameter .............. 2 ins. Color......................Black bcl-y with blue igniter head

Weight of explosive

filler 3.85 oz.

Weight .................................. 12 ozs. Igniter .................................. B. Z. 39 Delay .................................. 4-5 sec.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

321

SHAVING STICK GRENADE

GERMAN
This is a thin-cased offensive type grenade with a B. Z. E. friction igniter screwed into the top. The cylindrical body is

FRICTION WIRE

made

of aluminum

and painted yellow.

There

are two

GRENADE BODY

models of this grenade, one 35/

inches long and the other 4

inches long. This grenade may also be used as a booby trap


COMPRESSED PELLETS

by the insertion of a D. Z. 35 Pressure Igniter.

To operate the

grenade, the head of the igniter is unscrewed and pulled,


drawing the wire through the friction composition and igniting the delay pellet. The grenade is then thrown and after a

4-5 second delay, the delay element initiates the detonator.

Overall length.............. Color........ Yellow

35/s or 4 ins. body with

Maximum diameter .......... Igniter .................................... B.

2 ins. Z. E.

blue igniter head

Delay ..................................

4-5 sec.

SMOKE HAND GRENADE 39


Nebelhandgranate 39
This grenade closely resembles the high explosive stick grenade 24 in external form and size. However, instead of

CAP DISC SPRING


METAL CAP

the high explosive filling this grenade is filled with a smoke


mixture.

PORCELAIN BALL PULL WOODENHANDLE

CORD

There are eight holes in

the base

of

the head

through which the smoke escapes.

The handle has three

horizontal corrugations at the screw cap end to assist in differentiation by touch. Upon activation, smoke is period of two min-ites, forming, an emitted for a screen for

effective

Bz 39IGNITER
DELAYPELLET
SMOKEHOLE

mmachine
Total

gun nests and pillboxes.

COMPOSITIL N FLASH
N 4 IGNITES

weight

.........

1 lb., 14 ozs.

Color ............................... Olive drab

BODY

ILE

II~lft~o~~L~Overall

length ...................... 14 ins.


Z. 39

Markings......White

band

8 inches

Igniter ............................... B. Delay N4 ignition tube ................

7 sec.

wide around center of handle and lettering Nb. Hgr. 39 stencilled in white around the body
white

Filling............(HC) 1mixture zinc and


hexachlorethane

above a
band.

broken

322

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

SMOKE HAND GRENADE 41 AND PROTOTYPE


Nebelhandgranate 41

GERMAN

The prototype of this grenade is comprised of the body of the smoke hand grenade 39 with a synthetic resin adapter to hold the B. Z. E. igniter.
-IGNITERHEAD FRICTION WIRE

The Model 41 is

of similar con-

struction but the body has been modified so that the igniter fits into a small central neck without the use of an adapter.

DELAY ELEMENT

There are only two smoke holes instead of eight.

The friction

igniter operates with a 4-5 second delay, setting off a 2-minute smoke discharge.

Overall length

............

4.7 ins. 2.3 Ins.

Filling........(HC) type mixture. Zinc and Hexachiorethane Igniter .................................... B. Z. E.

Maximum diameter .......... Color .................................


NECK IGNITERTE SMOKE HOLES

Olive drab 21 ozs. Delay N4 Ignition tube .......... 4-5 sec.

Total weight ........................

TYPE 41

SMOKE GRENADES
Blendkorper 1H u. 2H
These grenades are made in the form of glass flasks.
Model 1H is a single container; Model 2H includes an inner glass tube filled with a solution of calcium chloride. filled with titanium with the air. The

body of each grenade is which vaporizes, upon

tetrachloride The calcium

contact

chloride permits the second model to operate at low relative


-=-~FSE FUE SULPHUR PLASTER OF PARIS
FUSED SULPHUR

humidity, whereas the first model produces a thin fog unless the air is quite moist. Both models discharge upon impact

RUBBER PLASTIC WASHER


CALCIUM CHLORIDE

with any hard object.


1H Overall length ........................ 6 ins. Maximum diameter ......... Total weight ..................... 21/2 ins. 13.2 ozs.

TITANIUM

ETRACHLORID'E

2H
Overall length ............. Maximum diameter ......... Total weight ........................ Filling & filling weight Outer flask.......... 10 oz. titanium tetrachloride 4.8 ins. 21/2 ins. 17 ozs.

Filling............................(FM) Titanium Tetrachloride


INNERGLASSTUBE

Weight of filling................ 10.6 ozs.

GLASS TUBE OUTER

Inner flask.... 1.3 oz. aqueous solution of calcium chloride

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF 8

OF ORDNANCE

323

AMMUNITION for 27 mm SIGNAL PISTOL PISTOL GRENADE


PROJECTILE

GERMAN

26 mm Wurfgranate Patrone 326 Leuchtpistole


This grenade, consisting of a rounded nose cap screwed to a cylindrical body, is equipped with four fins which are
fixed to the base of the body. A brass or aluminum cartridge

SFIXEDPIN--FIRING
CREEPSPRING

crimped to the grenade completes the assembly. A case


DETONATOR ASSEMBLY
BURSTINGCHARGE

containing the detonator and main filling is separated from a

fixed firing pin in the nose of the grenade by a creep spring.


The case is prevented from moving forward before firing by
5
CHARGE BURSTING CONTAINER

two metal balls in the base of the carrier. An arming rod inserted between the two balls prevents them from moving.

METALBALL

This is forced out of the base by setback about ten or twelve yards after the grenade leaves the muzzle of the gun. The
balls then slide out of their grooves and the case is free to

CARTRIDGECASE

move against the firing pin, exploding the grenade on impact.


Overall length .................... 4.5 ins.
. 1 in.

FINS

Weight of projectile............ 3.2 ozs.


Filler ....................... .............. T.N.T. 0.25 oz.

ROD SAFETY r IPAA Wf l -. NTAInFT

Maximum diameter ......... Color ..........................

......... Yellow

Weight of filler ..................

Weight of complete round 4.2 ozs.

PISTOL GRENADE
EGGGRENADE

Wurfkorper Leuchtpistole
This pistol grenade is formed by adding to the egg-type

hand grenade (Eierhandgranate 39) a plastic stem to which


DELAY IGNITER

TUBE RETAINIG
I
PLASTIC BODY-

it is attached by a retaining tube. The tube contains the delay


igniter at the forward end inside the grenade. An alloy flash

FLASHTUBE

tube connects this to the fuze which is located in the base of the stem. The fuze is separated from the primer by a safety
S
STRIKER

C^
0.89

pin which is pulled out before the grenade is placed in the


pistol barrel. Upon firing, the firing pin strikes the primer

SAFETYPIN

CREEP SPRING

RETNING
SPRING \ I !!'

I
PROPELLANT

which sets off the delay igniter, detonating the explosive charge after a delay of 4.5 seconds.

FLASH CAP

Overall length ..................

6.89 ins. 3 ins.

Delay .................................... Range ..................................

4.5 sec. 80 yds.

Maximum diameter ................

Color .............................. Olive green

324

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

AMMUNITION for 27 mm SIGNAL PISTOL

GERMAN

27 mm MULTI-STAR SIGNAL CARTRIDGE


SETTING CAP

CLOSING

(GREEN)
3STARS GREEN

TThe
5

cartridge consists of a light alloy outer container complete with the propelling charge and an inner-container in which there are six star units. Running through the center of the star units is an assembly of two brass tubes with seholes for the six choices of settings. The inner tube contains gunpowder and is closed by a plug which contains
a delay pellet. In firing, the inner container is propelled and after the delay pellet has burned through, the flash passes

TUBE INNER

Slector
OUTER

TUBE
3 RD STARS

OINNER

INER

TER"
CONTAINER

immediately along the whole length of the inner tube, ignitI i

CLOSING DIC
(RED I DELAY PELLET

ing and ejecting the stars in accordance with the setting.


Overall length .................... 5/4 ins. Filling........Propellant & pyrotechnic

PROPELLANT
5
PERCUSSION CAP

Maximum diameter .......... 1.06 ins. Star combinations and dial settings: 3 red 1 red 3 red 3 green (0-2) 2 green (7-8) 1 green (14-15)

1 red 3 green (21-22)

2 red 2 green (27-29)

2 red 1 green (34-35)

SSTRIKERHEAD
6 STEEL BALLS

H. E. CARTRIDGE FOR 27 mm GRENADE PISTOL


Sprengpatrone fiir

Kampfpistole

,.PM,
BOOSTER ALUMINUM CONTAINER
TUBE STEEL
HIGH EXPLOSIVE

This grenade consists of a die cast aluminum container


which encases a steel tube containing the explosive charge.
Into the steel tube is screwed a direct action nose fuze with

, ISH

a protruding striker head. The striker is held away from the detonator by six steel balls kept in position by a steel collar supported on three aluminum pins. The creep spring separates the striker and primer beneath which is a booster separated from the main filling by an empty air space. The black powder propelling charge is contained in a cup with a
lead Styphnate primer. The grenade has grooves on the

BLACKPOWDER

P R OE L LT
FLASHHOLES. \ ,

aluminum body fitting the rifling of the Kampfpistole from


which it is discharged.

CAP BRASS HOLDER P


RI

MER

Overall length .......................

3 ins.

Filler .............................. PETN/W ax Weight iof filler ..................... 77 oz. Propellant..Graphited black powder

Color ............... Unpainted aluminum Weight of complete round.... 5 ozs. Weight of projectile .......... 3/2 ozs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

325

MISCELLANEOUS PISTOL GRENADES SMOKE


Nebelpatrone fiir Kampfpistole
This grenade is similar in appearance and construction to the high explosive grenade except that it contains a smoke generator instead of an explosive filler. It is fitted with a percussion type nose fuze which has a charge of gunpowder located just below the flash cap instead of a detonator. The projectile functions on impact and the gunpowder, ignited by the flash cap, ejects the smoke generator from the body of
the grenade and at the same time ignites it. The projectile

GERMAN

BASE

GUNPOWDER

INCREMENTS COMPO

CANG ALLOY

PLUG

QUICKMATCH

ALLOY TUBE

PERCUSSION CAP

DELAY PELLET

QUICKMATCH

CO

may be recognized by the following stencilled marking on the base of the cartridge case: NEBEL. Z.

INDICATOR
Deutpatrone fiir Kampfpistole
The indicator grenade is similar externally to the smoke and high explosive grenades except for the head which is parabolic. There is no fuze. The smoke train, a puff of reddish-brown smoke, is fired by the flash from the propellant. The indicator system begins to function v4'hn the projectile has been in flight for about two seconds. The weight of the complete round is 4.5 ounces; that of the grenade itself, 3 ounces. The marking on the base of the cartridge case is: DEUT. Z.

ILLUMINATING STAR ON PARACHUTE


Fallschirm Leuchtpatrone fiir Kampfpistole
This type grenade has the same general contours as the two others previously described. It has a black bakelite head and a screwed-on base plug which is perforated to hold a
gunpowder pellet. Inside the grenade, directly above the

QUICKMATCH GUNPOWDER PRIMING

PROPELLING CHARGE

STAR COMPOSITION

PARACHUTE

plug is an illuminating star to which a parachute is attached. On firing, the flash from the propellant ignites the gunpowder pellet, which, after a brief delay, ignites the star. The bakelite head is blown off, and the star ejected. The grenade may be identified by the stencilling "F. Leucht. Z." on the base of the cartridge case.

DELAY COMOSTE

CHA

SUSPENSIN STAR OR

326

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ROCKET PROJECTOR
28/32 cm Nebelwerfer 41
This rocket projector fires the 28 cm high explosive rocket (page 354) and the 32 cm incendiary rocket (page 353). Ranges are given below. This device, which functionally does not differ from the 15 cm and 21 cm Nebelwerfers, consists of six projectors grouped in two tiers of three each, mounted on a two-wheel trailer. The cages are constructed of round steel bars shaped to the outside contours of the 32 cm rocket. Detachable liners for the forward end of the projectors permit the use of 28 cm rockets. The portion of the projector holding the propelling chamber remains the same for both rounds. The firing mechanism is electric. Traverse (approximately 300) and
elevation (from 0 to 45) are by

GERMAN

means of cranks.

The piece is fired from its mounting and is held in position by two jacks in front and a small spadelike

arrangement in the rear. The equipment weighs approximately 2,460 lbs.

TRANSPORTABLE ROCKET PROJECTORS


28/32 cm schweres Wurfgerat 40 and 41

These two rocket projectors, or ramps, differ from each other only in construction details and in the material used. The Schweres Wurfgerdt 40 is made of wood and weighs 115 pounds; the 41 model is of metal, weighing 243 pounds. Each is designed to carry four crates of the 32 cm incendiary rocket (page 353) or the 28 cm high explosive rocket (page 354). Either model is adjustable for elevation. Firing is accomplished- by the hand electric firing system proRESTRICTED

vided for the crates themselves. Maximum ranges for these projectors are identical: 2,106 yards for
OFFICE CHIEF

the 28cm Wurfkorper Spr. and 2,406 yards for the 32 cm Wurfkorper M. Fl. 50.

OF ORDNANCE

1 May,

1945

349

ROCKET PROJECTORS ON SEMITRACK VEHICLES


Schweres Wurfrahmen 40
This rocket projector is de......

GERMAN

signed for use on half-tracked armored personnel carriers. The principal feature of the device is the carrier plate, three of which are mounted on each side of the halftrack. Each is adjustable for elevation of 5" to 45 , and is believed to

be

equipped

with

an elevating

scale. The actual projector consists of the crate in which the 28 cm or 32 cm rocket is packed, and which may be secured to the plates. Reports indicate that each vehicle carries six rounds, five of which are 28 cm high explosive and one 32 cm incendiary. Range figures are identical to those applying to the Schweres Wurfgerat 40 and 41 and the 28/32 cm Nebelwerfer 41. The photos above show the 3-ton
armored semi-track (m. gp. Zgkw.)

fitted with rocket described above.

projectors

as

ROCKET PROJECTOR
30 cm Nebelwerfer 42
This rocket projector very closely resembles the 28/32 cm Nebelwerfer 41. The individual projectors are of similar construction, each one being shaped to the contours of the standard 30 cm rocket ammunition. The rear portion, however, is considerably larger than that of the 28/32 cm projector to accommodate the larger propelling chamber of the 30 cm rocket. As a result of the heavier charge, this rocket achieves a range of 4,976 yards. Both traversing and elevating mechanisms are identical with those of the 28/32 cm piece. Total traverse is 30 degrees, and elevation is 45 degrees. The firing mechanism is electric with a contact box located at the right side of the piece. A sight bracket is located at the

rear of the framework. There is a small spade under the frame in the rear, but no other evi-

dence of supports. The ammunition for this projector is described on page 354.1.

350

May,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ROCKET LAUNCHER
8.8 cm Raketenwerfer 43 ("Piippchen")

GERMAN

This weapon is a closed breech rocket launcher which fires a rocket projectile. It is transported on a two-wheeled carriage, and may be fired from the carriage or from firing segments to lower the silhouette. If necessary, it may be readily disassembled into seven loads for transport. A cone-shaped gas deflector is fitted over but does not protrude beyond the muzzle. The piece is aimed by grasping two handles fitted to the left rear of the cradle and aligning the open sights on the target. The rear sight is adjustable from 180 to 700 meters. The launcher fires from a closed breech which is operated by a handle on top of the breech ring. Opening of the breech cocks the hammer which is held in firing position by a sear. When the projectile has been inserted and the breech closed, a squeeze of the right handle depresses the sear, releasing the hammer. A safety device fitted to the left of the firing pin in the center of the breechblock must be turned to "F" position before the launcher can be fired. An additional safety feature prevents the hammer from striking the firing pin unless the breech is fully closed. The small shock of recoil developed by the rocket gases against the closed breech is transmitted directly to the spade. Ammunition used with the rocket launcher is a modified version of the 8.8 cm rocket projectile, having a percussion primer instead of the electric type. The rocket is fitted with a base plate with a prortuding rim to seat the round in the tube. The base plate and primer are the only parts of the round which are extracted after firing.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 88 mm (3.46 ins.) Weight (firing position) ............................ 315 lbs. Length of weapon (overall) ................ 9 ft., 9 ins. Length of barrel ........................................ Height (traveling position).............. 2 ft., 11 63 ins. ins.

Height (on segments) .................... 1 ft., 71/ ins. W idth (overall) .................................... 3 ft.. 4 ins. Length of bore No. of grooves Width of grooves Depth of grooves ............................. Smooth bore

Width of lands
velocity ........................................ 460 f/s* Max. range (horizontal) (limited by sight) ...................................................... . 765 yds. .............. Rate of fire ................................ Muzzle Traverse on wheels: Right (max.).................. 28 Left (max.) .................... 28 Traverse on firing segments .............................. 360 ...................... 23" Elevation ............................... Depression ............................ ......... 14 .................... none Length of recoil .................... Ammunition .................. 8.8 cm R. Pz. B. Gr. 4312 W t. of projectile .................................. 5 lbs., 13 ozs. *Not verified.

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

352.1

MULTIPLE ROCKET LAUNCHER


7.3 cm "Fohn"

GERMAN

MOBILE TYPE MOUNT

FIXED TYPE MOUNT

This multiple rocket launcher, used for antiaircraft barrage purposes and known as the "Fohn" is of different design from any other weapon of its type used by the Germans. Launching sites were located along river fronts, indicating the use of this weapon
against river crossings. There are 35 individual launchers, each

SPECIFICATIONS
Traverse ..................................................... Elevation ........................
Depression

360 90

31 inches long and approximately 7.3 cm square, assembled in 5


horizontal and 7 vertical rows. The rockets are fired by hammer

........

............

type firing pins mounted on horizontal shafts. All 35 of the pins are actuated by a single trigger. The whole assembly measures 32
inches from top to bottom, and 23 inches from side to side. A

.....................

........... ...... -10

Ammunition 7.3 cm R. Sprgr. (H.E.)


Weight of complete round .................. W eight of propellant ............................ Weight of explosive charge .................. Type of explosive (RDX/TNT/WAX .................................. = 55/40/5) 6 lbs. 1.19 lb. 0.62 lb. "95"

simple clamp at the rear of the racks holds the rockets in position until firing takes place. The frame of the assembly is made of
3/16-inch metal. A trunnion, set in each side of this framework, rests upon arms extending up from the pedestal base. The weapon, with its pedestal base, is used with either a mobile or fixed mount. When used as a mobile mount, the launcher is fitted with a circular metal folding platform mounted on a 2-wheeled trailer. The fixed launchers are not provided with the folding platform, and it is believed that they are normally set up more or less permanently on sheet iron platforms. The sight, trigger mechanism, and elevating and traversing mechanisms are mounted on the inside of a metal protective shield located on the left side of the launcher. Elevation is from -10 to 90. The upper part of the front wall of the shield is made of transparent plastic for sighting purposes. The 7.3 cm Raketen Sprenggranate, used with the launcher, is a spin stabilized rocket fitted with a nose percussion fuze and a self-destroying delay element ignited by the burning propellant.

352 ,

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

7.5 cm MULTIPLE FORTRESS ROCKET PROJECTOR

GERMAN

This projector consists of 28 projector rails mounted in four rows of seven each, at the forward end of a long, low carriage. The projectors are constructed of welded T-section steel bar. Each row is a separate assembly, and is bolted to an inclined welded steel superstructure built above the carriage. The projectors are displaced from the center both for line and elevation to give dispersement of fire. Each row is fired as a unit by means of a bar provided with a firing hammer and striker for each projector. Each of the four bars may be separately cocked, and all may be fired by one pull of the firing cable from the central point. The carriage consists of a framework of U-section steel extended well to the rear, where it terminates in a protected control point containing the elevating handwheel, the firing cable, and two handgrips for traverse. A 1 cm thick (0.39 inches) protection shield is provided. There are two metal-rimmed, rubber sprung detachable wheels 27 inches in diameter. The equipment can be traversed about a fixed center pivot or about its wheels. The center pivot is locked into a bracket welded to the center of the axle-tree and rear support is provided by two steel rollers welded on the under side of the carriage. Each row of projectors is independently trunnioned and all four are elevated together by means of a linkage through a chain drive from the handwheel.

SPECIFICATIONS
Overall length (approx.) ................................ Overall width ................................ 5 t., 11 Track (wheel center to center)........ 5 ft., 14 ft. ins.

77/8 ins.

Width of each projector frame .................... 49 ins. Depth of each projector frame ................. Maximum height (above center pivot
platform) ....................................... 3 ft., 4 ins. 4 ft., 5 ins.

5/4 ins.

Maximum height (on road wheels)......

Elevation (approx.) ............................................ 550 Depression (approx.) ........................................ 4

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

352.3

30 cm ROCKET
30 cm Wurfkorper 42 Spreng

GERMAN

This rocket is packed in a wooden crate from which it may be fired in the same manner as the 28 cm rocket described on page 354. It is also fired from a rocket projector consisting of six welded metal frames mounted on a two-wheeled, split trailed carriage described on page 350. This model has been selected to illustrate the construction of the motor assembly of a typical rotating rocket. The motor tube is 0.43 inch thick, closed at one end, and threaded inside to take the venturi block. Eighteen venturis are drilled in this solid block. The throat diameter of each venturi is 0.365 inch with an exit section of approximately 0.82 inch in diameter. The axes of the venturis are inclined at an angle of 12 42' so that the effluent gases cause the round to rotate. A threaded hole in the center takes the primer unit. Seven tubular sticks make up the propellant charge composed of nitrocellulose and diglycol dinitrate. The sticks are supported at the venturi end on a grid. The center stick contains a length of quickmatch in a celluloid tube, and ending in a primed maintainer pellet. A small primer unit screwed into the steel venturi plug flashes directly on to the gun powder pellet at the end of the celluloid tube. This motor unit is similar to that of the 15 cm Wurfgranate. However, because of the heavier charge in the 30 cm ammunition, the metal mesh has been introduced to prevent the maintainer pellet from being crushed by the-central stick of the propellant charge if the rocket is dropped.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight of filled motor unit...... 129 lbs., 10 Weight of filled bomb.............. 146 lbs., Weight of propellant charge.... 33 lbs., 4 ozs. ozs.

3/4 ozs. ins.

Length (overall) .......................................... 47 Length of bomb ........................................

28.5 ins.

Length of motor tube ................................ 22.5 ins. Diameter of bomb .................................... External diameter of motor tube .............. Length of propellant charge .................... Burnt velocity ............................................. Range, maximum .................................... 11.8 ins. 8.56 ins. 18.4 ins. 754 f/s

4,976 yds.

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 June, 1945

354.1

ROCKET PROJECTILE FOR RAKETENWERFER 61


38 cm R. Sprgr. 4581

GERMAN

::
::

- ----~

This projectile is fired from the Raketenwerfer 61 (see pages 38.3 and 38.4). It shows a radical departure from standard spinstabilized rocket design by the use of insert splines at the after end of the motor body. These splines, fitting into the rifling of the projector liner, aid in giving an initial spin to the projectile. The rocket consists of three main assemblies: the high explosive body, motor body, and nozzle assembly. The high explosive body of two-piece welded construction is threaded internally at its after end to receive the motor body. The booster pocket and fuze adapter assembly is welded in position at the nose of the high explosive body. The bourrelet is located just behind the welded junction of the ogive and the cylindrical section. The motor body is threaded externally to screw into the high explosive body and internally to receive the nozzle assembly. Both the explosive body and nozzle assembly are secured by means of two diametrically opposed set screws. Nine grooves for the splines are machined into the base of the periphery of the motor body. The high explosive body is filled with 270 pounds of the German explosive charge 13A, which is 50/50 poured amatol. The 32 venturi holes in the nozzle plate are set at an angle of 140 to the axis of the rocket. In the center of the nozzle plate there is a threaded hole to receive the igniter primer for the rocket propellant. A rear spacer ring welded to the nozzle plate aids in the positioning of the outer row of propellant charges.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ................................ 38 cm (15 ins. approx.) Total weight of rocket ................................ 761 lbs. Overall length (not including fuze).......... 56.68 ins. Diameter of bourrelet .............................. 14.94 ins. Maximum range ...................................... 6179 yds.

Weight of explosive charge ...................... 270 lbs. Weight of propellant charge .................... 88.5 Ibs. Fuze .............................................. Point detonating

Weapon from which fired ............ Raketenwerfer 61

3542

1 June, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

15.2 cm PARACHUTE AND CABLE TYPE A. A. ROCKET

GERMAN

SPECIFICATIONS
Total weight (approx.) ................................ 150 lbs. Weight of parachute housing (containing parachutes and H.E. charge).... 28 lbs., 1 oz. Weight of fins and cable housing 90 lbs.. 4 ozs. Weight of nose (containing H.E. charge) ......................................... 4 lbs., 12 ozs. Weight of rocket motor unit .......... 27 lbs., 11 ozs. Weight of propellant charge ........ 11 lbs., 10 ozs. Length of projectile (overall) .................... 58.2 ins. External diameter (maximum) .................. 7.09 ins. External diameter of motor tube ............ 5.51 ins. Internal diameter of motor tube .................. 5.2 ins. Length of propellant charge ..................... 11.7 ins. Length of cable (approx.) .......................... 950 yds. 11 ft. Diameter of main parachute ......................... Diameter of pilot parachute ........................ 6 ins.

This is an antiaircraft rocket projectile containing a parachute to which is attached a length of cable, designed for use in large numbers to form a barrage against low flying aircraft. The projectile consists of four parts: nose piece, propellant chamber, parachute housing, and cable housing and tail unit. The nose piece is ogival in shape and screws onto the forward end of the propellant chamber. It contains a TNT destructive charge, weighing approximately 2.3 pounds, and initiated by means of a delay fuze connected to the propellant chamber. This is a steel cylinder closed at the forward end and threaded externally at the rear end to fit into the parachute housing. Four drillings in the forward end of the parachute housing form the venturi through which the propelling gases escape. At the forward end of the parachute housing is a TNT charge, weighing approximately 2 pounds. Below this charge are located the main and pilot parachutes which are attached to the forward end of the cable. The cable housing is constructed in two parts, the lower of which remains on the ground when the rocket is launched. The upper portion has a finned tail unit which fits over the lower portion of the cable housing. The a/-inch cable, attached at its forward end to the parachute, is coiled the length of the cable housing and passes through a hole in the lower portion to a ground anchor. After launching, the projectile continues upwards until the whole of the cable has been uncoiled; the parachute is then pulled out of the parachute housing and remains suspended in the air until dragged to earth by the weight of the cable. The rocket casing continues in flight until a delay igniter initiates the destructive charge in the nose of the projectile.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

May, 1945

35(-'

HIGH EXPLOSIVE-ANTITANK ROCKET GRENADE


8.8 cm R. Pz. B. Gr. 4322

GERMAN

This fin stabilized rocket projectile is fired from the German counterpart of the U. S. "Bazooka" (see page 217) and has a maximum effective range of 165 yards. Eight and one-half-inch armor penetration has been obtained in static tests with a standoff
of approximately 6'/2 inches.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight (complete, rocket as fired)............ 7.26 lbs.
Weight of high explosive filler ............ Weight of fuze assembly ......................... 1.47 lbs. .175 lb.

The complete round consists of a point fuzed high explosive, hollow charge loaded projectile assembled to a steel tube with a venturi and stabilizer assembly attached, containing an igniter, propellant and electric primer. The AZ 5095 fuze is of the point detonating type which in tests gave an approximate fuze functioning time of 0.0002 seconds (impact to detonation). The projectile assembly consists of the following stamped sheet steel parts: a body which contains the bursting charge, an adapter, a collar, a band, and a slightly heavier sheet steel nose. A detonatorbooster of the German Kl. Zdlg. 34 NP type is embedded in the bursting charge to the rear of the flash tube. The bursting charge is cyclotol (41.2% TNT, 58.8% cyclonite) weighing 1 lb., 7.2 ozs. The propellant and tube assembly consists of the propellant tube and the seven propellant grains and igniter assembly, located in the forward end which it holds. The seven propellant powder grains are approximately 7.6 inches in length x .45 inch outside diameter, and have a central perforation .22 inch in diameter throughout their length. The composition is 64 1 /2% nitrocellulose and 341/2% DEGN, with a small percentage of stabilizer. A new type of ammunition, the R. Pz. B. Gr. 4999 is reported to
give good performance up to a range of 220 yards, 25 C. (77 F.).

Weight of igniter assembly ........................ 021 lb. Weight of propellant charge .................. 382 lb. Length (overall) ........................................ 25.56 ins.

Diameter (external) .................................

3.437 ins.

Burnt velocity at 50 F. (approx.) ............ 340 f/s* Burning distance (approx.) ............................. 7 ft.'

Fuze functioning time (approx.)........ .0002 seconds Maximum pressure ............ 6,910 lbs. per sq. in.* Maximum thrust .................................. Impulse .................................... 1,716 lbs.'

87 Ibs. second** 165 yds.

Maximum effective range .......................

These figures are from firing a single round. ** These values doubtful; only one rocket motor was statically tested with propellant temperature 41 F.

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

357

ANTITANK ROCKET GRENADE


8.8 cm R. Pz. B. Gr. 4312

GERMAN

ALUMINUM DISC

This projectile is fired from the German 8.8 cm Raketenwerfer 43 (Piippchen-see page 352.1). From this weapon, as limited by the sight, a maximum effective range of 700 meters (765 yards) is obtained. The explosive head is identical to that of the rocket fired from the German counterpart of the "Bazooka" (page 357). The fuze (AZ 5095) functions as follows: the force of set back causes the set-back ring to move rearward, bending the two prongs of the stirrup spring. These prongs, by engaging in the inside groove of the set-back ring prevent the ring from returning forward. Meanwhile, the striker needle is held away from the primer detonator by a flat, coiled clock spring inside the set-back ring. The clock spring unwinds, expanding against the inside of the fuze body, thus providing a slight delay in the arming of the fuze. The propellant is a double base powder in the form of a single grain with 14 perforations. There is a hole .364 inch in diameter through the center of the grain. Three lands on the outside of the grain insure an outside burning surface. A triangular-shaped spacer holds the head igniter firmly against the quickmatch. The quickmatch fits in a slight indentation in the head igniter. The primer used in the "Piippchen" rocket is the standard No. 26 percussion primer found in many German artillery fuzes.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight (complete, as fired)........ 5 lbs., 13.06 ozs. Weight of H.E. filler ........................ 1 lb., 7V4 ozs. Weight of fuze with detonator .............. 3.15 os. Weight of motor and tail assembly.. 1 lb., 8.5 ozs.
Weight of propellant ................................ 1.63 ozs.

Overall length .......................................... 19.64 ins. Length of propellant grain ...................... Diameter of propellant grain ........ 4.95 ins.

......... .85 ins. 3.494 ins.

External diameter ....................................

358

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

H. E. UNROTATED ROCKET
8 cm Raketen Sprenggranate

GERMAN

NOSE. PIECE-

DETONATOR

STEEL EXPLODER TUBE

PELLETS
FOUR PELLETS

PLUNGER-

SPRING SLEEVE

H. E. WARHEAD
This rocket is actually 78 mm in diameter. Two features distinguish it from other German rockets: the use of tail fins to secure stability in flight without rotation, and the employment of a novel fuze arming device. The complete round weighs 15.19 pounds and is nearly 28 inches long. Its two principal components are the nose fuzed high explosive war head and the rocket motor tube. The shell is attached by means of an adaptor ring and the motor tube is closed by a cone-shaped assembly carrying the fins and containing the venturi and propellant supporting grid. Six tubular sticks of cordite form the propellant ignited by a circular gun powder igniter set off by a wire ignition bridge. The launcher used is the Mantelrohr. The nose fuze consists of a steel nose piece housing a light alloy striker held by a light spring, a percussion detonator, a magazine containing four pressed pellets, and a thermal arming device. When the rocket is fired, the heat of the propellant gases melts a ring of fusable metal, permitting the detonator and magazine to approach the striker. The main filling of the high explosive head is pressed flake TNT.

FUZE MECHANISM
SPECIFICATIONS
Weight of complete round .............. 15 lbs., 3 oz. Weight of motor unit with central adaptor.. 10 Ibs. Weight of high explosive head with central adaptor ..................................... 6 lbs., 5 oz. Weight of high explosive Weight of fuze filling...... 1 lb., 5 i oz. 4 oz.

(approx.) ..............................

Weight of propellant sticks ................

2 lbs., 3 oz. 27.7 ins. 6,300 yds.

Length of rocket ........................................ Ground range (estimated) ......................

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

359

7.3 cm PROPAGANDA ROCKET PROJECTILE AND LAUNCHER

GERMAN

This is a rocket projectile of conventional design, but having instead of the usual high explosive filling a number of propaganda leaflets in the forward compartment. The projectile consists basically of two steel tubes screwed into a central sleeve. The upper tube carries the propaganda leaflets and is closed at the forward end by a bakelite ballistic cap; a small bursting charge in the sleeve serves to expel the leaflets. The lower tube contains the propellant and is closed at the lower end by a screwed-in base plug. The leaflets are wrapped around a steel spring and are in turn inclosed in a light metal cylinder split horizontally. The ejection charge for the leaflets is fired by an igniter and a delay train when the split cylinder containing the leaflets is ejected; the spring around which the leaflets are wrapped forces apart the two halves of the cylinder and scatters the leaflets. The projector used for launching the rocket is of simple design and construction. The base frame is formed of 1/4-inch tubular steel with three spades welded on the underside. A crosspiece of the same tubular steel acts as a brace and also forms a base for the elevation pivot of the rocket guide. This guide consists of a length of 1 -inch angle iron 291/2 inches long. The launcher is operated on the mortar principle, that is, the rocket is placed on the trough and is held about twenty inches above the striker (which corresponds to the firing pin of a mortar) by a release lever. A cord which the operator may pull from a safe distance leads from the release lever, thereby permitting the rocket to slide down against the striker.

SPECIFICATIONS
ROCKET Overall length of complete round...... 16 3/32 ins. Length of plastic cap .............................. Length of message body ...................... Length of propellant chamber ................ Length of nozzle assembly .................. 2.21 ins. 6.87 ins. 4.70 ins. 1.30 ins. 5.234 ins. 2.308 ins.

Length of stick powder ........................ Diameter of stick powder ......................

Weight of complete round ................ 6 lbs., 10 oz. Weight of propellant ........................................ LAUNCHER Overall length ........................................ 45.7 ins. 19.7 ins. 29.5 ins.
28 ins.

1 lb.

Overall width ......................................... Length of guide .......................................


Overall height with guide at 45 ..............

Weight .............................

...................

27 lbs.

36i0

May,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

AIRCRAFT LAUNCHED ANTIAIRCRAFT ROCKET


X4

GERMAN

The X 4 is an antiaircraft rocket designed by the Germans to be launched from planes. It was manufactured and reported to have been successfully tested, but never reached the point of combat operation. It is a wire-controlled, rocket-propelled, finstabilized missile fitted with a proximity fuzed warhead. The propulsion system is a bi-fuel rocket. Stabilization is achieved by means of four large fins fitted to the body of the rocket, and four smaller fins fitted to the tail. The smaller fins bear solenoidoperated control surfaces through which two-dimensional directional control is achieved. These are operated from the parent aircraft by means of a control unit and two insulated wires leading to the rocket. These wires are about 33 miles long. Precise information about the warhead and fuzing system has not so far been recovered. The warhead consists of an uncased moulded grain of dinitroglycol-based explosive which depends on high blast effect. The fuze is a combination of acoustic proximity, impact, and self-destroying type. The proximity feature is functioned by aircraft propeller noises and a delay of 1/50-second is provided to enable the missile to approach the target after the acoustic impulse initiates the fuze. The body of the rocket houses the helical aluminum tube fuel tanks and combined two-compartment steel air bottle. The venturi protrudes from the tail portion. The rocket is made to rotate about its axis at the rate of one rotation per second. This permits stabilization in line of flight by a single gyro. The missile is carried on the parent aircraft on a conventional bomb carrier modified for this special purpose.

SPECIFICATIONS*
Length (overall) ................ 200 cm (6 ft., 6/4 ins.)
Length of warhead ............ 45 cm (1 ft., 5% ins.) Diameter of warhead (at base) 22 cm (8.675 ins.) Total weight before launching 60 kg. (132.3 lbs.)

Weight of warhead ..................

20 kg.

(44.1 lbs.)

Fuel.......... 4.5 liters (approx.) 98-100% nitric acid


2 liters (approx.) 57% crude m-xylidine 43% triethylamine Thrust............................... Initial 270 Ibs. to 315 lbs. falling off progressively to 45 to 68 Ibs. after 30 seconds.

*Not verified.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August,

1945

375

CATALOG OF ENEMY MATERIEL

INDEX TO VOLUME II
JAPANESE
25 mm Dual & Triple A.A./A.T. Auto103 matic Cannon, Model 96 (1936) ...... 75 mm Mobile Field A.A. Gun, Model 88 110 ....... ....... (1928) ........... Antitank Artillery 20 mm Automatic Antitank Rifle, Model 101 97 (1937) ......................... 20 mm A.A./A.T. Automatic Cannon, 102 Model 98 (1938) .................... 25 mm Dual & Triple A.A./A.T. Auto103 matic Cannon, Model 96 (1936) ....... 106 47 mm Antitank Gun, Model 1 (1941) .... Field Artillery 104 37 mm Infantry Gun, Model 11 (1922).. AMMUNITION 105 37 mm Gun, Model 94 (1934) .......... Artillery Ammunition 70 mm Howitzer, Model 92 (1932) ...... 107 310 70 mm Mortar Type Barrage Shell ..... 75 mm Field Gun, Model 38 (1905) (Im108 75 mm H. E. A. T. Ammunition ........ 311 proved) ........................... Artillery Ammunition Charts, 109 75 mm Regimental Gun, Model 41 (1908) 315, 316, 317, 318 75 mm Field Gun, Model 90 (1930)..... 111 314 Small Arms Ammunition Chart ......... 75 mm Field Gun, Model 95 (1935) ..... 113 Bombs 105 mm Howitzer, Model 91 (1931)..... 114 312 1/3 Kg. Bomb, Hollow Charge .......... 105 mm Gun, Model 92 (1932) ......... 115 313 150 mm Howitzer, Model 4 (1915) ..... 116 1 Kg. H. E. Bomb .... 120 H. E. Stick Bomb .... 150 mm Howitzer, Model 96 (1936) .... 117 Mortars Grenades 50 mm Grenade Discharger, Model 10 301 Hand Grenade, Model 91 (1931) ...... (1921) ............................ 118 302 Hand Grenade, Model 97 (1937) ...... 50 mm Grenade Discharger, Model 89 Hand Grenade, Model 99 (1939) (Kiska) 303 (1929) ............................ 119 304 Hand Stick Grenades ................. 50 mm Mortar, Model 98 (1938) ... 120 Hand Grenade, Antitank, Hollow Charge 304.1 70 mm Mortar, Model 11 (1922) ... 121 305 Aircraft Grenade ..................... 81 mm Mortar, Model 97 (1937) ... 122 Mines ]122.1 81 mm Mortar, Model 3 (1928) .... 306 Land Mine, Model 93 (1933) ........... 81 mm Mortar, Model 99 (1939) ... 123 Magnetic Antitank Mine, Model 99 (1939) 307 90 mm Mortar, Model 94 (1934) ... 124 308 Antiboat Mine ....................... '90mm Mortar, Model 97 (1937) ... 125 308.1 Anti-Vehicular Yardstick Mine ......... 150 mm Mortar, Model 97 (1937)....... 127 Land Mine, Navy Type 3 .............. 308.2 320 mm Spigot Mortar ............... 126 311 Ammunition, 75 mm, H. E. A. T. ........... Mountain Artillery Ammunition, Artillery (Chart), 75 mm Mountain (Pack) Gun, Model 94 315, 316, 317, 318 (1934) ............................ 112 .314l Ammunition, Small Arms (Chart) .......... 206 Tank Armament "Arisaka" Rifle....................... 106.1 57 mm Tank Gun, Model 97 ........... 22 Armored Cars ................. 19, 20, 21, Bangalore Torpedo ...................... 309 ARTILLERY Battery Commanders Telescope ............ 178 Binoculars ............................... 184 Antiaircraft Artillery Bomb, H. E., 1 Kg........ ........... . 313 20 mm A.A./A.T. Automatic Cannon, Model 98 (1938) .................... 102 Bomb, Hollow Charge, 1/3 Kg. ............ 312 AIRCRAFT ARMAMENT . 7.7 mm Fixed Aircraft Machine Gun, 216 ....... .. Model 89 (1929) .... . 7.92 mm Double Barrel Flexible Aircraft Machine Gun, Type 100 and Type 1.... 216.1 7.92 mm Flexible Aircraft Machine Gun, 217 Model 98 (1938) ................... 12.7 mm Fixed Aircraft Machine Gun 218 (Browning Type) .................. 13 mm A. A. Machine Gun, Model 93 219 (1933) ............................ 20 mm Aircraft Automatic Cannon, 251 Model 1 (1941) Mod. E...............

RESTRICTED

1 March, 1945

Ind. 1

INDEX TO VOLUME II
Bomb, Stick ............................. "Bren" Machine Gun ...................... "Brno" Machine Gun ...................... 120 214 214

JAPANESE

Browning Type Machine Gun ...............


Cannon, 20 mm, Automatic, Aircraft, Model 1 (1941) ModelE ......................... Cannon, 20 mm, Automatic, Antiaircraft/Antitank, Model 98 (1938) ................... Cannon, 20 mm Dual & Triple, Automatic, Antiaircraft/Antitank, Model 96 (1936)... Car, Armored (Vickers-Crossley, M25) ....... Car, Armored, Model 2592 (Th32) Naval Type ................................. Car, Armored, Model 2592 (1932) "Osaka".. Car, Armored, Model 2593 (1933) "Sumida" Car, Scout, Model 95 (1935) ............... Carbine, 6.5 mm, Model 38 (1905)..........208 Carbine, 6.5 mm, Cavalry, Model 44 (1911)..

218
251 102 103 19 20 21 22 28 207

Gun, Machine, 7.7 mm, Tank, Model 97 (1937)...............................214 Gun, Double Barrel, Flexible, Aircraft, Type 100 and Type 1....................... 216.1 Gun, Machine, 7.92 mm, Aircraft, Flexible, Model 98 (1938).......................217 Gun, Machine, 12.7 mm, Aircraft, Fixed (Browning Type).......................218 Gun, Machine, 13 mm, Antiaircraft, Model 93 (1933) ............................... 219 Gun, Submachine ........................ 204.1 Gun, 37 mm, Infantry, Model 11 (1922) .... 104 Gun, 37 mm, Model 94 (1934) .............. 105 Gun, 47 mm, Antitank, Model 1 (1941) ...... 106

Gun, 57 mm, Tank, Model 97.............106.1


Gun, 75 mm, Field, Model 38 (1905) (Improved) ............................... Gun, 75 mm, Regimental, Model 41 (1908).. Gun,. 75 mm, Mobile Field, Antiaircraft, 108 109

Cavalry Carbine..........................207
Chevrolet Truck .......................... 24 Director, Antiaircraft .................. 175, 176 Discharger, Grenade, 50 mm, Model 10 (1921) 118 Discharger, Grenade, 50 mm, Model 89 (1929) 119 FIRE CONTROL Antiaircraft Directors.............175, Multiple Power Observation Telescope Battery Commanders Telescopes.........178 40 cm Base Range Finder .............. 75 cm Base Range Finder ............. 1 Meter Base Range Finder ............. Stereoscopic 2 Meter Base Range Finder Stereoscopic 2 Meter Base Height Finder Binoculars .......................... Flower Pot Mine........................ Grenade, Aircraft.......................305 Grenade, Hand, Hollow Charge ........... Grenade, Hand, Model 91 (1931)...........301 Grenade, Hand, Model 97 (1937)........... Grenade, Hand, Model 99 (1939) "Kiska"... 176 .. 177 179 180 181 182 183 184

Model 88 (1928).......................110
Gun, 75 mm, Field, Model 90 (1930).........111 Gun, 75 mm, Mountain (Pack), Model 94 (1934)...............................112 Gun, 75 mm, Field, Model 95 (1935).........113 Gun, 105 mm, Model 92 (1932) ............. 115 Height Finder.......................... 183 Hollow Charge Ammunition ........... 311, 312 Hotchkiss Type Machine Gun .............. 219 Howitzer, 70 mm, Model 92 (1932) ....... 107 Howitzer, 105 mm, Model 91 (1931).........114 Howitzer, 150 mm, Model 4 (1915)......... 116 Howitzer, 150 mm, Model 96 (1936) ........ 117

Infantry Gun ......................


Knee Mortar .......................

104, 118,

105
119

Lewis Machine Gun..................... Mine, Antiboat .......... ................

214.1 308

308.2 304.1 302 303

Mine, Antitank, Magnetic, Model 99 (1939).. 307 Mine, Anti-Vehicular, Yardstick ........... 308.1 Mine, Land, Model 93 (1933) ... Mine, Land, Navy Type 3 ...... Mortar, Knee
""""" '

...........

308.2

.......

118,

119
120 122.1 122 123 124

Mortar, Mortar, Mortar, Mortar, Mortar, Mortar, Mortar,

Grenade, Incendiary......................304 304 Grenade, Stick, Hand..................... Gun, Machine, 6.5 mm, Heavy, Model 3 (1914) 210.1 Gun, Machine, 6.5 mm, Light, Model 11

(.1922)...............................209
Gun, Machine, 6.5 mm, Light, Model 96 (1936)................... . Gun, Machine, 6.5 mm, Tank, Model 91 (1931) ................................ 210

50 mm, Model 98 70 mm, Model 11 81 mm, Model 3( 81 mm, Model 97 81 mm, Model 99 90 mm, Model 94 90 mm, Model 97

(1938) (1922) 1928) ........... (1937) (1939) (1934) (1937)

125
127 126 29 30 112 209 201 23

Mortar,

211 Gun, Machine, 7.7 mm, Aircraft, Fixed, Model 89 (1929) ........................ 216 Gun, Machine, 7.7 mm, Heavy, Model 92 (1932)................................ 215 Gun, Machine, 7.7 mm, Lewis, Model 92 (1932) ................................ 214.1

150 mm, Model 97 (1937) Mortar, Spigot, 320 mm ..

Motorcycle, Model 95 (1935).............


Motorcycle, Model 97 (1937).............

Mountain Gun........................
"Nambu" Light Machine Gun............ "Nambu" Pistol....................... Nissan Truck.........................

Ind.

2.

1 March, 1945

OFIC

CIE

OF

ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

INDEX TO VOLUME II
177 Observation Telescope ..................... 251 Oerlikon Type Machine Cannon ............. 21 "Osaka" Armored Car .................... 112 Pack Gun ............................ 310 Parachute Barrage Shell .................. 201 Pistol, 8 mm, Automatic, "Nambu" ........ 202 Pistol, 8 mm, Automatic, Model 14 (1925)... 203 Pistol, 8 mm, Automatic, Model 94 (1934)... 205 Pistol, 35 mm, Pyrotechnic, Model 10 ...... 304 "Potato Masher" Grenade ................. 18.1 Prime Mover, Armored ................... 11 Prime Mover, 4-ton, Model 94 (1934) 12 Prime Mover, 5-ton, Model 92a (1932) Prime Mover, 5-ton, Model 92b (1932) 13 14 Prime Mover, 6-ton, Model 98 (1938) Prime Mover, 8-ton, Model 92a (1932) 15 Prime Mover, 8-ton, Model 92b (1932) 16 Prime Mover, 13-ton, Model 95a (1935) 17 Prime Mover, 13-ton, Model 95b (1935) 18 Pyrotechnic Pistol ........................ 205 Range Finders ............... 179, 180, 181, 182 Regimental Gun ........................ 109 Revolver, 9 mm, Model 26 (1893) ........... 204 Rifle, 6.5 mm, Model 38 (1905) ............ 206 Rifle, 6.5 mm, Sniper's, Model 97 (1937).... 208.1 Rifle, 7.7 mm, Model 99 (1939) ........... 212 Gun, Machine, 7.7 mm, Light, Model 99 (1939) 213 Rifle, 20 mm, Automatic, Antitank, Model 97 (1937) ................................ 101
Scout Car .. ...... ............... ...... . 28

JAPANESE

7.92 mm Flexible Aircraft Machine Gun, Model 98 (1938) .................... 12.7 mm Fixed Aircraft Machine Gun (Browning Type) .................. 13 mm A. A. Machine Gun, Model 93 (1933) ............................ 20 mm Aircraft Automatic Cannon, Model 1 (1941) Mod. E ...............

217 218 219


251

Shell, 70 mm, Mortar, Barrage .............. SMALL ARMS Machine Guns 6.5 mm' Light Machine Gun, Model 11 (1922) .......................... 6.5 mm Light Machine Gun, Model 96

310

209

(1936) (1914)

................

...........

210 210.1

6.5 mm Heavy Machine Gun, Model 3

Pistols 8 mm Automatic Pistol "Nambu" ..... 201 8 mm Automatic Pistol, Model 14 (1925) 202 8 mm Automatic Pistol, Model 94 (1934) 203 35 mm Pyrotechnic Pistol, Model 10.... 205 Revolvers 9 mm Revolver, Model 26 (1893) ...... 204 Rifles 6.5 mm Rifle, Model 38 (1905) ........ 206 6.5 mm Cavalry Carbine, Model 44 (1911) ............................ 207 6.5 mm Carbine, Model 38 (1905) ...... 208 6.5 mm Sniper's Rifle, Model 97 (1937).. 208.1 Submachine Guns 8 mm Model 100 (1940) .............. 204.1 Spigot Mortar ............................ 126 Stick Bomb .............................. 120 "Sumida" Armored Car ................... 22 Tank, Amphibious ........................ 10 Tank Guns 37 mm Model 94 ................ 3, 5, 10 57 mm Model 90 ............... 6, 7, 8 57 mm Model 97 ............. .... 9, 106.1 Tank, Light, Model 2593 (1933) .... .. .. .. 4 4 Tank, Light, Model 2595 (1935) .... ... .. . 5 Tank, Medium, Model 2589a (1929) .. ... . 6 Tank, Medium, Model 2589b (1929) Tank, Medium, Model 2594 (1934) . 8 Tank, Medium, Model 2597 (1937) . ...... Tankette, Model 2592 (1932) ...... ...... 2 Tankette, Model 2594 (1934) ......
. . . . . . 1 ......

............................

Tanket.tP

Mndra1 9.Q7 n1 QR7'

6.5 mm Tank Machine Gun, Model 91 (1931) ............................ 211 7.7 mm Light Machine Gun, Model 99 (1939) ......................... 213 7.7 mm Tank Machine Gun, Model 97 (1937) ............................ 214 7.7 mm Lewis Machine Gun, Model 92 (1932) ............................ 214.1 7.7 mm Heavy Machine Gun, Model 92 (1932) ........................... 215 7.7 mm Fixed Aircraft Machine Gun, Model 89 (1929) .................... 216 7.92 mm Double Barrel Flexible Aircraft Machine Gun, Type 100 and Type 1.... 216.1

Telescope, Multiple Power Observation Telescope, Battery Commanders ..... Torpedo, Bangalore, Model 99 (1939) .. Toyoda Truck ..................... Truck, Nissan, Model 81 (1921) ...... Truck, Toyoda, Model 2601 (1941) .... Truck, Model 94a (1934) ............ Truck, Diesel, Model 94b (1934) ..... Truck, Model 97 (1937) ............. Vickers-Crossley Armored Car ....... Vickers-Maxim Type Machine Gun ... Vickers Tank .... .. . . .......... Yardstick Mine ........ ........ .

. ... 177
...... ...... 178 309 24

...... ...... ......

25 26 27

...... 19 ...... 216 ...... 6

...... 308.1

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF 6

OF ORDNANCE

1 March, 1945

I nd.d

CATALOG OF ENEMY MATERIEL

INDEX TO WEAPONS BY CALIBER


JAPANESE
6.5 mm 206 Rifle, Model 38 (1905) ................... 207 Carbine, Cavalry, Model 44 (1911) ........ 208 Carbine, Model 38 (1905) ................ 208.1 Rifle, Sniper's, Model 97 (1937) .......... 209 Light Machine Gun, Model 11 (1922) ...... 210 Light Machine Gun, Model 96 (1936) ...... Heavy Machine Gun, Model 3 (1914) ...... 210.1 211 Tank Machine Gun, Model 91 (1931) ...... 7.7 mm Rifle, Model 99 (1939) ................... 212 Light Machine Gun, Model 99 (1939)...... 213 Tank Machine Gun, Model 97 (1937) ...... 214 Lewis Machine Gun, Model 92 (1932)...... 214.1 Heavy Machine Gun, Model 92 (1932)...... 215 Aircraft Machine Gun, Model 89 (1929).... 216 7.92 mm Double Barrel Flexible Aircraft Machine Guns, Type 100 and Type 1 ............. 216.1 Aircraft Machine Gun, Model 98 (1938).... 217 8 mm Automatic Pistol "Nambu" Automatic Pistol, Model 14 Automatic Pistol, Model 94 Submachine Gun, Model 100 .............. (1925) ....... (1934) ....... (1940) ....... 201 202 203 204.1 204 218 218 219 101 102 251 37 mm Infantry Gun, Model 11 (1922) ........... ......... Gun, Model 94 (1934) . ....... 47 mm Antitank Gun, Model 1 (1941) ............ 50 mm Grenade Discharger, Model 10 (1921) ..... Grenade Discharger, Model 89 (1929) ..... Mortar, Model 98 (1938) .... 57 mm Tank Gun, Model 97 .........

104

105

106

118 119 120

............

106.1

70 mm Howitzer, Model 92 (1932) .............. Mortar, Model 11 (1922) ................ 75 mm Field Gun, Model 38 (1905) .............. Regimental Gun, Model 41 (1908) ......... Mobile Field Antiaircraft Gun, Model 88 (1928) .............................. Field Gun, Model 90 (1930) .............. Mountain (Pack) Gun, Model 94 (1934) .... Field Gun, Model 95 (1935) .............. 81 mm Mortar, Model 97 (1937) Mortar, Model 3 ....... Mortar, Model 99 (1939) 90 mm Mortar, Model 94 (1934) Mortar, Model 97 (1937) 105 mm Howitzer, Model 91 (1931) ............... Gun, Model 92 (1932) ................... 150 mm Howitzer, Model 4 (1915) ............... Howitzer, Model 96 (1936) .............. Mortar, Model 97 (1937) .................

107 121

108 109 110 111 112 113

9 mm Revolver, Model 26 (1893) ............... 12.7 mm Aircraft Machine Gun (Browning Type)... 13 mm Antiaircraft Machine Gun, Model 93 (1933) 20 mm Automatic Antitank Rifle, Model 97 (1937) Antiaircraft/Antitank Automatic Cannon, Model 98 (1938) ...................... Aircraft Automatic Cannon, Model 1 (1941) Mod. E. .......................... 25 mm Dual & Triple A.A./A.T. Automatic Cannon, Model 96 (1936) .................. 35 mm Pyrotechnic Pistol, Model 10 .............

122 122.1 123

124 125

114 115

103 205

116 117 127

320 mm Spigot Mortar .........................

126

Ind. 4

1 March, 1945

RESTRICTED

MEDIUM TANK MODEL 2597 (1937) (SPECIAL)

JAPANESE

The Model 97 Special Medium Tank was first placed in operation in the early spring of 1942. It is a modification of the Model 2597 Medium Tank (see page 9) with a modified turret to accommodate the 47 mm Model 1 (1941) tank gun instead of the normal short-barreled 57 mm gun. The 47 mm tank gun conforms to the 47 mm Model 1 (1941) antitank gun (page 106) in the dimensions of chamber, caliber, and rifling and its performance is similar. The tank gun, however, has a vertical sliding breechblock, while the antitank gun has the horizontal type. The tank gun has a total traverse of 22 with an elevation from - 11 to + 170. It is shoulder-controlled, with geared elevation and depression. However, free movement can be obtained, if desired. Penetration tests on the antitank gun indicate a penetration of 21/2 inches of homogeneous plate at normal at a range of 1,050 yards. The Special Tank is readily recognized by its elongated turret, slightly offset to the right. This turret measures six feet from front to rear and three feet across the rear bulge. There is a door 19" x 16" in the turret back plate, an exit hatch 23" x 16" in the turret top plate, and an observation hatch 25" in diameter in the cupola with a vision port 4" in diameter in the cupola top plate. The gun mantlet of 30 mm thickness, sloped at 10 to the vertical, is bolted to the turret front. A 7.7 mm Model 97 L.M.G. is mounted at the turret rear. Another is mounted in the superstructure front plate at the left of the driver. The armor plate thickness of the Special Tank is essentially the same as that of its predecessor except that the hull side plates of the former have been increased in thickness to 35 mm.

SPECIFICATIONS
W eight (approx.) .......................................... 15 tons Length ............................. ........ .. 18 ft., 1 in. Width ............................ ........ 7 ft., 8 ins. Height ............................... ........ 7 ft., 11 ins. Ground clearance ..................................... 14 ins. Tread centers .................................. 6 ft., 7 ins. Ground contact ........................................ 11 ft., 7 ins. Width of track ............................................. 13 ins. Pitch of track ........................................ 43/4 ins. Track links ............................................... ........... .. 96 Fording depth ...................................... 3 ft., 3 ins. Theoretical radius of action Roads ........................................................ 100 miles Cross country .................................. Armor Turret front ............. 25 mm at 10 to vertical Gun mantlet ...... 30 mm cast at 10 to vertical Front vertical plate...... 25 mm at 10 to vertical Glacis plate .............. 17 mm at 80 to vertical Nose plate .................. 15 mm at 62 to vertical Side superstructure.... 20 mm at 40 to vertical Side hull plates .................................. 35 mm Top rear plate ..................................... 12 mm Armament One 47 mm model 1 (194) tank gun; two type 97 light machine guns. Ammunition (Rds.) 104 rounds of 47 mm ammunition; 2,575 rounds of small arms ammunition. Engine Air-cooled, V-12 diesel. Transmission Main gear box--4 speeds forward, 1 reversehigh and low ratios. Steering .................................................. Clutch brake Crew ................................... ............................... 5

RESTRICTED

Replacement Page

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

8e1

150 mm SELF-PROPELLED HOWITZER

JAPANESE

This weapon is the 38 year type (1905) 15 cm howitzer mounted on a medium tank chassis. The chassis resembles that of the Medium Tank Model 2597 (1937), Special, described on page 8.1. The armor is riveted in the characteristic Japanese fashion, and on the chassis is of the same thickness as on the corresponding tank chassis, with a maximum of approximately one inch. On the superstructure, the gun shield has one-inch frontal armor and one-half-inch side armor. The vehicle uses the standard V12, air-cooled, diesel engine, and the type 97 medium tank suspension, consisting of six dual rubber-tired bogie wheels on each side. The weapon mounted on this vehicle is the type 38 (1905) 15 cm howitzer, a very short weapon. It has an interrupted screw breechblock opening to the right, and uses a percusssion primer. The rifling is 58 inches long and has increasing right hand twist. The maximum range of the Field Howitzer is reported as 6,500 yards. The maximum elevation is 30 degrees. A self-propelled vehicle mounting a gun of 75 mm or 105 mm caliber, employing the same chassis and with a superstructure somewhat resembling the present vehicle has been reported.

SPECIFICATIONS
15 tons Weight ...................................................... ........................ 18 ft. Length .................................. Width .................................................. 7 ft., 6 ins. Height (overall) ......................................... 93 ins. Height of chassis .......................................... 47 ins. Height of shield .......................................... 61 ins. Ground clearance ........ .............................. 14 ins. Tread centers ...................................... 6 ft., 7 ins. Ground contact (approx.) .......................... 160 ins. 13 ins. Width of track ......................................... 5V1/ ins. Pitch of track ...........................................

Track links ....................

......... ..........

96

39 ins. Fording depth ............................................. Theoretical radius of action: 100 miles Roads ................................................ Cross country .......................................... Speed: Roads .................................................. 25 m.p.h. Cross country ........................................... Armor: gun shield 1 in. Front plate .............................................. Sides ............................................................ /2 in. Armament ............ 15 cm Howitzer, Model 38 (1905) Ammunition (Rds). ........................................ Engine .............................. V12. air-cooled, diesel Transmission-4 speeds forward: 1 reverse (high and low range) Steering ........................................ clutch brake Crew .............................................. probably 5

8*2

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

4-TON PRIME MOVER MODEL 94 (1934)

JAPANESE

Zb

The 4-ton Prime Mover is powered by a 90, V.8 air-cooled


gasoline engine with a cylinder bore of 90 mm and a piston stroke of 125 mm. The normal horsepower is 73 at 1,600 r.p.m.; maximum horsepower is 88. The firing order is 1-8-7-3-6.5-4-2. The electrical

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ........................................ 4 tons Trailer load capacity ........................................ Winch capacity ............... Length Width ............. over 2 tons

system includes a Bosch type magneto (Gesal model); a Bosch


R.T.C. 900 LI model, 75-watt generator; a 12-v., 80 amp.-hr. storage

........................................ 12 ft., 5 ins. ........................................ ........................................ 6 ft., 1 in. 7 ft., 3 ins. 11.5 ins.

Height

battery, and a Bosch 2.5 hp. electric starting motor. The ratio of the final drive is 5.657:1. Clutch brake steering is used and both

Ground clearance ........................................ Tread centers.................... Ground contact ...................................... Track width ........................................ Track links........................

5 ft.. 4 ins. 7 ft., 8 ins. 10 5 / 26.6 gals.: ins. ins.

hand and foot operation applies the brakes. The transmission is

the central selector type with 4 speeds forward and 1 reverse.


The vehicle is capable of towing its complement of artillery at 25 m.p.h. pump. There is a main and auxiliary type of lubricating oil is 4.4 to 6.6 lb. of gage pressure used. In when The

Fuel tank............Main, Fuel consumption

aux., 15.8 gals.

......................................... 20 Ins.

Oil pressure

Fording depth ........................................ Speed ........................................

25 m.p.h.

warmed up.

A Stromberg UR Z model carburetor is

Engine ..........................

V-8 cyl., air-cooled, gasoline

main fuel storage tank has a capacity of 26.6 gals.

addition,

there is an auxiliary tank having a capacity of 15.8 gals. A Sirocco type fan provides circulation for the air-cooled engine. A dry two-

Bore and stroke...................... 90 mm x 125 mm3.54 ins. x 4.92 ins. Horsepower ........................................ Ignition...........................Magneto Battery ........................................ 12 v., 80 amp.-hr. 88 (max.)

plate clutch is used. The grade-ascending ability is said to be 30


under the towing load. This vehicle can pivot turn. The winch

type Transmission................Selector 4 speeds forward. 1 reverse Steering ........................................Clutch brake Crew ......................................... ........... 6

capacity is 2.2 tons.


in 10 hours.

The theoretical radius of action is 125 miles

RETICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

6 OF ORDNANCE

1 April, 1945

11

5-TON PRIME MOVER MODEL 92A (1932)

JAPANESE

It is reported that there are two variations of this vehicle. Model A is powered by a 6-cylinder in-line L-head Sumida gasoline engine, and Model B by a 6-cylinder in-line air-cooled Isuzu Diesel. As far as may be ascertained, with exception of a modification in radiator design, the general appearance and suspension of these two models is similar. The Model A engine is an L-head type with the valves on the side. The cylinder bore is 110-mm, the stroke 135 mm, and the compression ratio is 4.5:1. The normal hp. is 64 at 1,200 r.p.m.; the maximum hp. is 98. Ignition is provided by a Bosch hightension magneto with 12-v. charging generator and two 12-v. 60 amp.-hr. vibration-proof batteries. The electric starting motor is 12-v. with a rating of 2.5 hp. Bevel spur pinion and ring gears have reduction ratios of. 2.66 and 5. The steering system is the clutch brake type with both handand foot-operated brakes. The transmission provides four speeds forward and one reverse. The maximum speed is 19 k.p.h. (11.8 m.p.h.). The lubricating oil is distributed by gear pump force-feed system. Oil pressure registers 1.0 kg. (2.2 lb.) at low speed and 2 kg. (4.4 lb.) at 1,100 r.pm. The oil capacity measures 14.65 liters (3.7 gal.). A vacuum fuel system is used with Stromberg UT 4 model carburetor. The main fuel storage tank holds 125 liters (32 gal.), the auxiliary tank 55 liters (14.5 gal.). Fuel consumption is 17 liters (4.5 gal.) per hour, or 1.05 liters per km. (2.4 mi./gal.). The cooling liquid is circulated by a centrifugal pump from a radiator, which carries 39.5 liters (10.4 gal.). The grade ability of this vehicle pulling a fixed weight is 30. The winch capacity is 2.5 metric tons (2.8 tons). The winch cable length is 20 meters
(65/2 ft.).

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ...................... 48 Metric tons-5.28 tons
Trailer load capacity.... 4.5 Metric tons-4.9 tons Winch capacity ............ 2.5 Metric tons-2.75 tons Length ................................ Width Height 3.55 m--l ft., 8 ins. ................................ 1.71 m5 ft., 11 ins.

Ground clearance .....................

7 ft.. 8 ins. .................................. 2.35 m.295 m-11.75 ins. 5 ft., 111V2 ins. 41/2 ins. 97/s ins.

Tread centers ..................................

Ground contact .............................. 7 ft.. Track width ............................................. Track links ................................................

........... .. 59

Fuel tank .............. Main, 32 gals.; aux., 14.5 gals. Fuel consumption .................................. 2.4 m.p.g. Fording depth ............................................. 24 ins.

Speed Hard roads ............................................ 18 m.p.h. Cross-country ........................................ 8 m.p.h. Engine .................................. Sumida, 6-cyl., gasoline
Bore and stroke.................. Horsepower 110 mm x 135 mm433 ins. x 5.31 ins.

.............. 64 at 1,200 r.p.m. (normal)

Ignition..........................Bosch
Battery ......................................

high-tension magneto
2 12-v., 60 amp.-hr.

Transmission ............ 4 speeds forward. 1 reverse Steering ............................................. Clutch brake Crew ................................... .......................... 6

12

1 April,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF

RDNANCE

(Replacement Page)

RESTRICTED

13-TON PRIME MOVER MODEL 95A (1935)

JAPANESE

This vehicle is powered by a 6-cylinder, in-line, water-cooled gasoline engine with a cylinder bore of 135 mm and piston stroke of 150 mm and a compression ratio of 5.1:1. Normal horsepower is 130 at 1,300 r.p.m.; maximum horsepower, 160 at 1,900 r.p.m. The firing order is 1-5-3-6-2-4. Ignition for the vehicle is distributed by a high-tension type magneto. The electrical system includes charging generator; two 12-v., 80 amp.-hr. batteries, and a 24-v. electric starting motor of 8-hp. capacity. The final drive has a reduction ratio of 2.93:1. A dry multiple plate clutch is used. Both foot- and hand-operated brakes are employed and the vehicle is steered by the clutch brake principle and is said to utilize a locking feature of the control brakes. The transmission is of the synchromesh type with 4 speeds forward and 1 reverse. Lubricating oil is distributed by gear-type force-feed system through an oil-pressure regulator. The oil-pressure gage registers 29-44 lb. and an oil-level stick is used for checking the crankcase, which has a capacity of 5% gals. It has been stated that the fuel feed equipment includes a fuel pump between the carburetor and storage tank and that the heavy-duty type of fuel is forced fed to a NIPPON B 45 model carburetor. There are two models of fuel storage tanks manufactured for this vehicle-one is the Mitsubishi type with main tank holding 70 gals. and an auxiliary holding 43 gals., and the other is the NIIGATA type main tank holding 50 gals. and an auxiliary tank holding 38 gals. Fuel consumption is stated to be 7.5 gals. per hour. The radiator holds 11 gals., circulated by a pump to the engine block. The grade-ascending ability of this prime mover 5'
quoted as 14 tons up a 150 incline, or 32 tons on a 71/20 incline.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight .....................................................
Trailer load capacity .................................... Winch capacity ........................................ Length ..........................................................

14.3 tons
32 tons 11.25 )ws 16 ft.

W idth ..................................................... 7 ft., 6 Height ...................... ......................... 9 ft., 3 Ground clearance .............................................. Tread centers .................................... 5 ft., 11 Ground contact .................................... 9 ft., 9 Track width ................................................ 161/2
Track links .................. ....................................

ins. ins. 1 ft. ins. ins. ins.

Fuel tank .................... Main. 70 gals.: aux., 43 gals. Fuel consumption ............................... .83 m.p.g. ............ 6.2 m.p.h. Fording depth .................................. Speed .......................................................

Engine ....................

6-cyl., water-cooled, gasoline


135 mm x 150 mm5.31 ins. x 5.91 ins.

Bore and stroke....................

Horsepower .............................. 130 at 1,300 r.p.m.

Ignition .............

... High-tension magneto

The winch capacity is 11 tons. -

Battery ............................................ 2 12-v., 80 amp. Transmission................Synchromesh 4 speeds forward, 1 reverse Steering ............................................ Clutch brake Crew ........................ ........................................

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

17

13-TON PRIME MOVER MODEL 95B (1935)

JAPANESE

This

prime mover

makes

use of

the same

chassis

as the of a

SPECIFICATIONS
weight ........................................ 15 tons 32 tons Trailer load capacity ...................................... winch capacity Length ........................................

Model 95A,

the only difference

being its

accommodation

6-cylinder, in-line, water-cooled, valve-in-head Diesel engine. cylinder diameter is pression ratio 15.5:1.

The

140 mm, the piston stroke 190 mm, and comThe normal horsepower is rated at 145 at

11.25 tons 16 ft. 7 ft., 6 ins. 9 ft., 3 ins. 1 ft.

........................................

1,300 r.p.m.

Maximum hp. is 165. The firing order is 1-5-3-6-2-4.

width ........................................ Height ........................................

There is a 24-v., 300-w. capacity charging generator, two 12-v., 80 amp.-hr. batteries, and two 24-v., 6-hp. electric starting motors.

Ground clearance Tread centers

........................................

........................................

5 ft., 11 ins. 10 ft., 4 ins.

Ground contact ....................................

Details are lacking on the reduction gear, which has a ratio of 2.92:1. short The steering system is of the clutch brake type assisted on turns by handand foot-operated control brakes, which

Track width ........................................

161/2 ins.

Track links ............................................... Fuel tank ........................................ Fuel consumption .......................................... 68 gals.

include a locking feature.

The transmission is said to be synchroThe maximum speed

Fording depth ............................................. Speed ........................................ 8.6 m.p.h. Diesel

mesh with 4 speeds forward and 1 reverse.

is 8.68 m.p.h. A gear-type forced-feed system is used for distributing lubricating oil in the crankcase. level stick are also fitted. An oil pressure gage and oil-

Engine .......................... 6-cyl., Bore and stroke...................... Horsepower

water-cooled, 5.51

140 mm x 190 mmins. x 7.48 ins. 145 at 1.300 r.p.m. ......... Diesel

Diesel oil fuel is supplied from a total

..............................

storage capacity of 68 gals. Forty-four liters (11.6 gals.) of water are circulated from the radiator to the engine block with the normal type pump. This vehicle is said to be capable of ascending a 15

Ignition ....................................... Battery ...................................... 4 speeds Steering ................ Crew................................

2 12-v., 80 amp./hr. forward, 1 reverse

Transmission................Synchromesh....................... Clutch brake

grade while towing a 14-ton load, or a 71/20 grade pulling a 32ton load. The winch capacity is 11 tons.

18

(Replacement

Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

RESTRICTED

ARMORED PRIME MOVER

JAPANESE

The chassis of this Japanese armored prime mover incorporates the better design features of the tankette development shown on pages one to three. This vehicle is an important link in the chain of Japanese transportation of personnel and supply in the large mainland areas. Its construction proves that the Japanese attach considerable importance to the interchange and utilization of standard tank component parts on combat vehicles for greater simplification of their supply problem. The hull provides for a layout of the engine and power train on the right, while the driver's compartment is located on the left side. A large load and stowage compartment at the rear extends over the tracks. Tubular bows are raised for protective covering and camouflage nets. Double doors open at the rear, below which a towing pintle is attached. There is no main armament; however, there is an observation turret built in the roof of the crew compartment behind the driver. Speaking tubes with ear phones are used for crew communication. Four hinged flap-covered openings provide additional vision for the crew and allow employment of small arms weapons. The power train in this vehicle is made up of the engine, fourspeed and reverse transmission, controlled differential with steering brakes and a final drive single reduction gear. The engine is a four-cylinder in-line diesel with Bosch type automatic fuel injection. A 12-volt ignition system is also provided with spark plugs located in the fuel injection ports. The electrical system utilizes parts standard and interchangeable with other vehicles. Two fuel tanks hold 38 gallons.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ...................
Width Height .......

.......................

5 tons

Length ................................................. ..........................................

12 ft., 8 ins. 6 ft., 4 ins. 5 ft., 2 ins. 14 ins.

...............................................

Ground clearance ........................................ Tread centers .................................................. Ground contact ............................................ Width of track ......................................... Pitch of track ...........................................

124 ins. 8 ins. 3 ins.

Track links .........................


Fording depth ......................

........... ........... .. 88
....................... 31 ins.

Theoretical radius of action R oads ..................... ....................................... Cross-country .............................................. Speed Roads ...................................................... 28 m .p.h.

Cross-country .............................................. Armor Front plate .................................................. 6 m m


Sides Floor ....... 12 mm ....................................... .......................................................... 12 mm Small arms weapons

Armament ................................

Ammunition (Rds.) .................................... Unknown Engine .............. 4-cylinder air-cooled OHV Diesel Transmission ............ 4 speeds forward; 1 reverse Steering ................................ Controlled differential Crew .................................. ....................... 2

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

18e1

COMBINATION PRIME MOVER AND WRECKER

JAPANESE

This vehicle, in

addition to its function as a prime mover and

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ........................................ ........ Trailer load capacity ........................................ Winch capacity ........................................... .................................... ............................. 20 ft., 8 ins. 17 ft. 7 ft.. 5 / 7 ft., 11 ins. ins.

wrecker, may have been used as a tank recovery vehicle. It has a total seating capacity of thirteeen men. Two front booms are The latter can be

provided, and a removable boom at the rear.

attached in such a manner as to act as a brace for the vehicle. The front booms, which are traversed by gears, are moved and operated independently by two different operators. There is a large towing winch behind the driver's seat, and two smaller winches near the front end. The prime mover/wrecker has been derived in part from

Length (overall) Length (less Width Height

arms)

........................................ ........................................

Ground clearance

........................................ 6 ft.,

16 ins. 4 ins.

Tread centers ........................................ Ground contact ...................................... Track width ........................................ ..............................

components of the Japanese Medium Tank. There are five bogies on each side, four of which are mounted in pairs. sprung by a. separate coil spring. Each pair connects to a coil spring, and the front bogie wheel is independently The drive sprocket is smaller

9 ft., 11 ins. 12 Ins.

Track links

Fuel tanks ...................................... Fuel consumption

2-30 gals .each

than that employed in the Medium Tank. The vehicle is powered by a 6-cylinder, valve-in-head, air-

.........................................

Fording Speed

depth ........................................... ............................... cyl. valve in head, air-cooled Diesel ins. x 6.5 ins.

cooled Diesel engine located in. the rear, The engine head is made of aluminum There are two fuel tanks which have a capacity of thirty gallons each. The clutch, a single plate type, is housed in an aluminum clutch housing. The transmission provides four speeds forward and one in reverse. from the transmission. The power takeoff of the winches is driven track The final drive system is quite unusual in

Engine........6

Bore and stroke .......................... 5.5

Horsepower
Ignition ..

..........................
............................ 2-12 v.

Battery ........................................

that there are two separate drive shafts, and each track is by an independent final drive mechanism. Removable grousers are supplied for use in difficult terrain.

Transmission ................ 4 speeds forward. 1 reverse Steering Crew ............................. ......... 13

.........................................

18.2

1 April, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARMORED TRACKED PERSONNEL CARRIER

JAPANESE

This vehicle serves as an artillery prime mover and as a personnel carrier for 24 men. It appears to be of recent manufacture, and its first known appearance in combat was during the Leyte campaign in the Philippines. It is a full-tracked vehicle armored with 1/-inch plate throughout. The engine which is located at the right front of the body is a 6-cylinder, in-line, valve-in-head, air-cooled diesel of a type similar to those used in the Model 2595 light tank and the combination prime mover and wrecker. Two fuel tanks provide an estimated total capacity of 50 to 60 gallons. The tracks and suspension are of the conventional Japanese design, using dual bogie wheels and a steel center guide track. The four bogie wheels, apparently identical with those on the Model 2595 light tank, are mounted on bell cranks and are sprung by horizontal coil springs which are inclosed within the body armor with only the bogie arms exposed. There are two return rollers. The track is driven from the rear. A clutch and brake steering system is used. The transmission provides four speeds forward and one reverse. A high and low transfer case is also provided. A mount for a 7.7 mm machine gun is located on the left front of the driver's compartment. The vehicle does not mount a winch, but is provided with a spring mounted towing pintle for use as a prime mover. It has a capacity of from 2 to 3 tons if used as a cargo carrier. Maximum speed is reported as approximately 35 miles per hour, with exceptionally good cross-country performance due to the amount of track area in contact with the ground in relation to the weight of the vehicle.

SPECIFICATIONS
W eight ........................ ......................................

Length (overall) .................................. 15 ft.. 9 ins. Width (overall) ......................................


H eight ......................

6 ft., 8 ins.

........................................

Ground clearance ..........................................


Tread centers ................ ..................................

Ground contact .................................. 9 ft., 10 ins.


Width of track ........................ ...................... 10 ins.

Pitch of track .....................................


Fording depth ................

3-13/16 ins.

Track links ........................ .......................... 125


................................ Theoretical radius of action Roads ...................... ...................................... Cross-country .............. ................................ Speed (maximum) .................................... 35 m.p.h. Armor (reported) .......................................... in.

Armament ............................ 7.7 mm machine gun Ammunition (Rds.) ........................................

Engine............................6-cylinder, in-line, valve-inhead, diesel. Transmission...............4 speeds forward, 1 reverse: high and low range. Steering............................Clutch Seating capacity and brake system

................................................ 24

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

18.3

ARMORED TANK RECOVERY VEHICLE

JAPANESE

REAR VIEW

This is an armored, self-propelled crane designed to retrieve damaged A. F. V.'s up to a weight of about 12 tons. The manufacturing date of one recovered specimen is given as 1941. The crane is mounted towards the rear of the chassis on a platform traversing through 3600 on an electrically powered turntable. The crane is prowered by the main engine through a drive shaft from the transmission to a gear box and thence through another box to the cable drums. The crane is controlled by three hand levers and three foot control clutches. When not in use, the boom which has a total length of 18 ft., 2 ins., rests on the top of the drive compartment and is held in place by two screw clamps. The conventional Japanese type of suspension is used. Four bell cranks are resisted by four armored compression springs per side. Eight-and-one-half-inch dual steel bogie wheels per side are mounted four inches apart and paired to each bogie. An 18 13/16-inch diameter double-tooth front drive sprocket, a rear idler, two 103-inch diameter rubber-covered return rollers, and the center guide steel track complete the suspension.
The driver's compartment measures 451/2 x 59 inches, and is

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight ...................................................... 81/4 tons Trailer load capacity ....................................... Length ........................................ Width .............................................. Height (to top of vehicle) .............. (to top of jib) ..................... 14 ft., 41/2 ins. 6 ft., 7 5 ft., 3 6 ft., 9 ins. ins. ins.

Ground clearance .................................. 11

ins.

Tread centers ................ .................................. Ground contact .............................. 11 ft., 4 ins. Track width ...................... ..................... 94 ins. Track links ................... Fuel tank ..................... ................................... ................... 40 gals. (est.) ............

Fuel consumption .......................................... Fording depth ................................. Speed ...................................... .................... 21 m .p.h .

Engine..............Ikegai, gasoline, 6-cylinder, in-line, air-cooled, 60 hp. Transmission ................................. ............. Steering ................................................. Clutch brake C rew ......................................... ................... .... 2 Armor

fitted with a door on the right side. The 6-cylinder, in-line, aircooled, Ikegai gasoline engine delivers 60 horsepower. The steering system is of the clutch brake principle, a separate springloaded clutch being fitted to each track. Two. pressed steel fuel tanks are located at the right rear of the hull; an additional one is utilized as the driver's seat. They have a combined estimated capacity of 40 gallons.

Front ...............................

............

in.

Sid es ...................................... .................... 5/ 16 in . Length of cable drums .......................... 10/4 ins. Diameter of cable drums ...................... 101/2 ins. Diameter of cables ........................ /4 in. (approx.) Overall length of boom ...................... 18 ft., 2 ins.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

18e5

"KATO"

GENERAL PURPOSE TRACTOR

JAPANESE

This is a commercial type wheeled tractor used for general purpose work. The front wheels are 29 x 5 inches and the rear dual wheels are 40 x 10 inches, all fitted with solid rubber tires. The drive is from the rear

wheels only, and steering is effected by a worm gear


system operating the front wheels. Normal automotive controls are provided, save for a hand throttle. The

transmission provides three speeds forward and two in


reverse.

The K3 type engine is identical to that used in. the


"Kato" 70 tractor--a 4-cylinder, valve-in-head, gasoline type. There are two cylinder blocks of two cylinders each instead of a solid cylinder block. The generator, high-tension magneto, and water pump are all linked together with universal joints and driven from a single

shaft extending from the timing gear on the right of the


engine.

The tractor is fitted with front and rear towing pintles


cast solid with the frame.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight.............................................. Winch capacity....................................... Length.............................................. Wheel base.................... .................... 90 ins. Overall width of tractor (rear) ........................................ 74 ins. Overall height of tractor ........................................ 5 ft. Capacity of fuel tank ........................................ 30 gals. Tread centers (front) ........................................ 63 ins. Ground clearance ........................................ 8 ins. Fuel capacity ....................................... (approx.) 30 gals. Engine ........................................ 60 h.p. at 1,200 r.p.m. Bore.............................................. 121 mm Stroke............................................ 152 mm

"KATO" 70 ARTILLERY TRACTOR


This is a slow speed tractor equipped with a towing hook and is believed to be the standard Japanese artil lery prime mover. There are two bogies on each side, each bogie having three bogie wheels, two bearing on the outside and one on the middle of the tractor. Clutch and brake steering are provided. The power plant is a

1r

i-cylinder, water-cooled, gasoline engine. The cylinder


block is of two separate sections. Each section is joined into one piece at the top, but the base of each cylinder
is separate from all other cylinders.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight.............................................. Winch capacity....................................... Length.............................................. Wheel base ........................................ 85 Diameter of drive sprocket ........................................ 26 133/4 ............................................... Width of track Length of track in contact with ground .................................... 89 Width of tread (from outside edge of tracks) .............. 67 Engine ........................................ Kato, K-3, 70 Bore............................................. 4.75 Stroke.............................................. 6

ins. ins. ins. ins. ins. h.p. ins. ins.

18.6

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

LOCOMOTIVE TRUCK

JAPANESE ^

The partial disruption of the Burma railway system has brought into being a very effective locomotive truck. One report states that use of the Japanese locomotive truck has not only aided in the transportation of supplies over damaged rail lines, it has made it possible to carry over the damaged railroad considerably more tonnage than could be moved by the use of locomotives alone. The "Loco-truck" is a highly specialized vehicle specifically designed to overcome the problem of breaks in the rails. The inner sections of the six wheels are cut to run along rail tracks; the outer sections are designed for tire mounts. On both front and rear of the truck are two permanently attached hydraulic jacks equipped with rollers. To remove the vehicle from the tracks, it is necessary to put one rail under the rear jacks and one under the front jacks at right angles to the tracks, lift the truck off the rails, and roll the truck to the side. The truck is then let down on its wheels, driven past the break in the rail line, and returned to the tracks. A diesel engine estimated at about 60 horsepower is used to power the vehicle. Overall length, including couplings, is 19 feet, 2 inches and width is 6 feet, 3 inches.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF A OF ORDNANCE

1 April, 1945

261

MOTOR TRICYCLE (KUROGANE)

JAPANESE

Above: Motor tricycle with light cargo carrier body. Right: Adapted for use as a small personnel carrier.

This motor tricycle has been recovered in two adaptations: as a light cargo vehicle and as a small personnel carrier. The motor is a 2-cylinder, V-type, air-cooled, gasoline engine with cooling fins made of ferrous metal. The ignition, of the automotive type, comprises battery, generator, coil, and distributor. Motorcycle type coil springing is used on the front wheels and leaf type springs on the rear part of the vehicle. The automotive type transmission provides three speeds forward and one reverse. Power is transmitted to the rear by a shaft and both rear wheels are driven through a differential. The brakes are mechanical, rod-operated, internal expanding, and operate on the two rear wheels only. The motor tricycle has been developed as a commercial freight carrier in Japan since 1930. Many commercial versions exist, with engines ranging from 350 cc to 1,000 cc displacement. Lighter types have single-chain drive without differentials, whereas heavier types may have shaft or double-chain drive with differentials. Load capacities vary from 300 to 1,000 pounds. It is believed that the army adopted whatever types were available, and that no standard army model exists.

SPECIFICATIONS
CARGO CARRIER
W eight ............................. ..... ................. 1 185 lbs.' Loading capacity ......................................... Length (overall) .............................. 8 ft., 11/2 ins. Length of body .............................. 4 ft., Width (overall) ................................ 4 ft., 2 ins. V2 in. 8/2 ins. /2 in.

Width of body ................................ 3 ft., Height (overall) .............................. 4 ft., Ground clearance ....................

.................... 6 ins.

Tread centers .................................... 3 ft., 6/8 ins. Wheelbase Tire size ........................................ 6 ft., 3 ins.

.........................................

4.75 x 18 ins. 4.75 x 27 ins.

Fuel tank ................................ Fuel consumption

.................

.......................................... ............

Fording depth ................................. S pe ed

.................................................................... V-type, air-cooled, gasoline

Engine..........2-cylinder,

Bore and stroke ........................................... Ignition ..................... .......................................

Transmission .............. 3 speeds forward: 1 reverse *Not verified

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

May,

1945

31

47 mm TANK GUN TYPE I (1941)

JAPANESE

The Japanese Type I (1941) 47 mm tank gun is mounted in the Type 97 Improved Medium Tank, replacing the 57 mm tank gun, a weapon of much lower velocity. The 47 mm tank model is very similar to the Type I, 47 mm antitank gun described on page 106. The breech mechanism, however, is of the semi-automatic, vertical sliding block type instead of the horizontal sliding block type. The barrel, 7 feet, 111/2 inches long, is of built-up construction. The firing mechanism is of the percussion hammer type, the recoil mechanism is a hydro-spring type. The piece is free mounted in a mantlet in the turret which permits a total traverse of approximately 15 degrees. Elevation and depression of from 8 to 10 degrees may be obtained. The gun fires high explosive and armor-piercing high explosive ammunition. Two types of telescopic sights for this gun have been recovered. Although different in size and design, they are both 4 power by 14 degrees. Firing tests on this gun reveal that A.P.H.E. ammunition at 500 yards will penetrate 2.7 inches of homogeneous armor at normal, and 2.2 inches of homogeneous armor at 30 from normal.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ....................................... 47 mm (1.85 ins.)
Weight ............................ .................. 904 lbs. 7 ins.

Length (overall) .............................. 9 ft., Length of tube .............................. Length of bore (including chamber) ...................... ....................... 7 ft.,

7 ft., 11/2 ins.

/4 in. 16

No. of grooves ....................

......... .........

Width of grooves ........................................... Depth of grooves ........................................... ...........

Width of lands .................................

Muzzle velocity (A. P. H. E. shell) .......... 2,700 f/s Max. range ................... ................................... .............. ........... .. 15

Rate of fire ................................. Traverse ...................................... ....

Elevation ................................................
Depression ..........................................

8
8

to 10
to 10

Length of recoil ............................................ Ammunition ...................... H. E. and A. P. H. E. 3.08 lbs. 3.37 lls.

Wt. of projectile (H. E.) ............................ (A. P. H. E.) ............................................

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

106.1

57 mm TANK GUN MODEL 97

JAPANESE

This gun, manufactured at Osaka Arsenal in 1939, is mounted on the Japanese Medium Tank Type 97. The tube, of monobloc construction, is fastened to the breech ring by twelve interrupted threads and secured by a lock on the right side of the tube. The breech ring is box-shaped. The breechblock of the vertical sliding type rides in two dovetailed slots in each side of the breech ring, and may be operated manually or semi-automatically. The firing pin is automatically cocked when the breech is opened. The trigger, on the left side of the gunner's shield, is protected by a trigger guard with a pistol grip. The recoil mechanism is a hydro-spring type. The gun is mounted in the turret of the tank, and has a 3600 traverse. It may also be freely elevated or traversed independently of the turret by means of two sets of trunnions. The inner vertical trunnions are set in a heavy steel bracket fitted to the cradle and permit a 5 left and right traverse. The bracket has a sighting window which may be closed for the gunner's protection. The outer horizontal trunnions fit into another steel bracket and give approximately 110 elevation and 90 depression. Although no sighting equipment was recovered with the gun, the appearance and location of the head rest, shoulder rest, and sight bracket indicate that a straight tube telescope is used.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ............................ ......................... 57 mm Weight of tube and breech ring.................. 138 lbs. Weight (firing position) .......................... 293.5 lbs. Length of tube and breech ring.............. 41% ins. Length (firing position) .................................. Height (traveling position) .......................... Height (firing position) ..................................

W idth (overall) ................................. ............


Width of trail spread ................................... Length of tube and breech ring.............. 415/ ins. Rifling........................R.H., uniform twist; approx. 1 turn in 281/2 cals. Length of rifling ........................................ 32.5 ins. No. of grooves ...................... .......... ........... . 20 Width of grooves ................................... .25 in. Depth of grooves ................................... .039 in. W idth of lands ................................. ............ Muzzle velocity ( shell) ........................... Max. range (horizontal) .................................. Max. range (vertical) ...................................... 20 r.p.m. Rate of fire ............................................... Traverse............360 with turret and 5 right and left independent of turret 11 Elevation .................... .................... ................... 9 Depression ...................... Length of recoil ............................................ 11 ins. Ammunition .................................. H.E. and A.P.H.E. Wt. of projectile ............................................

106 2

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

(Replacement Page)

RESTRICTED

8 cm (7.62) HIGH ANGLE GUN, TYPE 3

JAPANESE

This weapon, previously erroneously called the Type 10, is a naval type antiaircraft gun, mounted on a pedestal which permits a traverse of 360 degrees. The gun tube, of built-up construction, recoils inside a sleeve type cradle. A guide on the bottom of the tube rides in a groove, preventing rotation of the tube. Since the trunnions are located at the rear of the tube, muzzle preponderance is compensated for by an equilibrator inside the pedestal. A hand-operated, semi-vertical sliding type breechblock and a hydrospring recoil mechanism are used. Recoil and recuperator are located over the tube. A small cylinder above the recoil cylinder is apparently for storing an oil reserve. The elevating handwheel is located to the left of the weapon, and the traversing handwheel to the right. Two platforms, one on either side attached to the superstructure, allow the layers to move with the gun in traverse. A bracket on the left of the piece is believed to mount a telescope and range drum.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ............................................ 76.2 mm (3 ins.) Weight of gun and mount ........................ 5,290 lbs.
Weight of gun ............................................ 1100 lbs.

Length of barrel .......................................... 40 cals. Length of tube ...................................... 9 ft., 6 ins.


Height (traveling position) ...........................

Height (firing position) .................................. Width (overall) .............................................


Length of chamber ................................ 1 ft.. 8 ins. Rifling .................................................... No. of grooves ................................. R. H. twist .......... . 24

Width of grooves ........................................... Depth of grooves ........................................... Width of lands ............................................. Muzzle velocity (H.E. shell) ...................... 2.200 f/s Max. range (horizontal) .................................. Max. range (vertical) ................................ 26.000 ft? Rate of fire ........................................ 10 to 12 r.p.m. Traverse ........................................................ 360 750 50

Elevation ........................................................ Depression .................................. Length of recoil ................................................

Ammunition ............ H.E. w/powder train time fuze Wt. of projectile .............................. 12 lb., 11 ozs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

114.1

88 mm ANTIAIRCRAFT GUN TYPE 99

JAPANESE

This weapon which was recovered at Rangoon has a barrel of monobloc construction, machined to take a rectangular breech ring. A large threaded brass locking collar holds the breech ring in position. Rifling is right hand twist. The breech mechanism is semi-automatic of the vertical sliding type; the firing mechanism is a percussion type. The piece fits in a sleeve type cradle to which are fitted the buffer cylinder, the recuperator cylinders, the trunnions, and the elevating arc. The recoil mechanism is hydropneumatic. Two recuperator cylinders are located one on each side of the recoil cylinder which is centrally mounted above the piece. The elevating arc is mounted under the piece offset slightly to the left. It is operated by a handwheel and crank on the left of the gun, and like the traversing handwheel, on the right of the gun, is forward of the trunnions. The upper carriage consists of two side plates joined by three cross members, and revolves on a ball race fitted to its base. A pintle, bolted to the center of the base, extends down into a bearing in the pedestal. Three brackets are set at regular intervals around the upper carriage to prevent lateral play. The pedestal is a single cast truncated cone, reinforced internally and externally by six ribs. Twelve bolts secure it to a circular steel base plate. Follow-the-pointer dials are provided for azimuth, elevation, and fuze setting. Three mechanical fuze-setters are also provided. Some of the guns examined were equipped with open sights of very primitive design.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ......................... ................. 88 m m (3.5 ins.) Weight (complete) .................................. Weight of cradle ...................................... 14,560 lbs. 1,256 lbs.

Weight of carriage (including elevating & traversing mech.)......................4,894 lbs. Length (traveling position) .................................. Length of barrel assembly ..................... 255.8 ins. Height (traveling position) ........................... Height (firing position) .. W idth (overall) ............. Length of bore ............ ....................... ................................... .................................... .... 32

N o. of grooves ........................................ ......

Width of grooves .......................................... Depth of grooves .............................................. 1 mm W idth of lands ............. Muzzle velocity ( Max. range (horizontal) .. Max. range (vertical) .. R ate of fire ............... Traverse ................................... 2,650 f/s ....................... .......................... ....................................... 80 7 H. E. shell) ......................

..................................... ......... .......... 360 ... ................... ...... ....................

Elevation .......................................................... D epression ..................... Ammunition .......................

Length of recoil .......................... (approx.) 14-15 ins. Wt. of projectile (H. E.) .............. (approx.) 18 lbs.

114.2

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDANCE

RESTRICTED

105 mm FIELD GUN TYPE 14

JAPANESE

The Japanese 105 mm gun, Type 14, is a medium field weapon mounted on a two-wheeled carriage and drawn by a prime mover. The tube, of built-up construction, is retracted above the trails when in traveling position to provide proper balance. A breechblock of the interrupted screw type is used. The weapon has split trails which may be adjusted to equalize cant. The wheels are equipped with rubber or steel tires. The recoil system is the variable, hydropneumatic floating piston type. The fluid passage to the other side of the two air cylinders is suitably interrupted when the elevation is increased. The traversing mechanism consists of a worm and arc gear. The elevating mechanism is of the arc gear type. A spring equilibrator is attached to the gun, since the trunnion is retracted in relation to the tube. The sighting equipment consists of a panoramic sight and a drum type range scale.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ...................................... 105 mm (4.13 ins.) Weight (traveling position) .......................... Weight (firing position) ............................... Length (traveling position) ........................... Length (firing position) ................................. Height (traveling position) ........................... Height (firing position) .................................. Width (overall) ............................................ Width of trail spread ...................................... Length of bore ............................................ No. of grooves ............................................. Width of grooves ......................................... Depth of grooves ........................................... Width of lands ............................................ Muzzle velocity ......................................... 2,040 f/s Max. range (horizontal) ...................... 16,500 yds. Max. range (vertical) ...................................... 6-8 r.p.m. Rate of fire ............................................ Traverse ............................................ ............. .......... .............. ........... 30 5 Elevation ....................... Depression ... ............ ....... 43

Length of recoil ........................................... Ammunition................H.E. (long pointed); H.E., Shrapnel, Chemical, A.P. Wt. of projectile (H.E.) ................................ 33 lbs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

114e3

120 mm 45 CALIBER 11 YEAR TYPE GUN

JAPANESE

This gun is a naval coast defense weapon manufactured at Sasebo Arsenal. It uses semi-fixed ammunition. The barrel is of built-up construction with uniform right hand twist rifling. A manually operated, horizontal sliding block breech mechanism is used. It is unusual in that the block does not pass all the way across the rectangular breech ring. The rear of the breech ring is cut in a keyhole shape. The operator of the elevation handwheel may fire the gun by means of a lever mechanism, or it may be fired by a lanyard attached to the right side of the breechblock. The recoil system comprizes three cylinders, two located above and one below the barrel. The mount consists of a rectangular upper carriage which is mounted on a pedestal normally embedded in a solid foundation. A traversing scale is located on the pedestal. The traversing handwheel is in a horizontal position with the vertical shaft engaging a series of gears in the base mount. Platforms attached to the upper pedestal are provided for the gun layers and move in traverse with the gun. Fire control equipment is of the usual Japanese naval coast defense gun type.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ....................................... 120 mm (4.72 ins.) Weight (traveling position) .......................... Weight (firing position) ................................ Length of gun (overall) ................ 18 ft., Length of tube ............................ Height of gun .............................. 17 ft., 3/4 ins. 3/4 ins. ins.

6 ft., 11

Height (firing position) .................................. Width (overall) ................................. ............ Length of rifling ............................ 14 ft., 8V/2 ins. No. of lands .................. ............................... . 34 Width of grooves ........................................ Depth of grooves ........................................... Width of lands ............................................. Muzzle velocity (H. E. shell) .................. 2.700 f/s Max. range (horizontal) ................................ Max. range (vertical) ....................................... Rate of fire ................................ ............. Traverse ................................ Elev ation .... ....... ....... 360 ............................................................ 50

Depression ................................................. 10 Length of recoil ............................................ Ammunition .................................................. H. E. Wt. of projectile (H. E.) .......................... 44.75 lbs.

114*4

August,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

6 OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

120 mm, 45 CALIBER, NAVAL DUAL PURPOSE GUN, TYPE 10

JAPANESE

The Japanese Type 10 dual purpose gun has a 45-caliber barrel of monobloc construction with uniform right hand rifling. A long, narrow rectangular projection on the bottom of the barrel slides in a groove in the sleeve type cradle, preventing the barrel from rotating. The bearing surface for recoil being the machined barrel surface. The cradle is mounted on a pedestal mount which permits a traverse of 360 degrees. The elevating handwheel is on the right side of the mount, while the traversing handwheel is on the left. An auxiliary handwheel on the left side permits the piece to be elevated and traversed by the gunner. To compensate for muzzle preponderance, a spring pusher type equilibrator is used. The gun is well balanced, and exceptionally easy to elevate. The recoil mechanism is a hydrospring type, the two outside cylinders housing the counterrecoil springs, and the center cylinder the hydraulic mechanism. used. The mount is of riveted construction. A semiautomatic horizontal sliding breechblock is

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber .......................................... 120 m m (4.7 ins.) Weight (firing position) ........................ 6,500 lbs. Length (gun and mount) .............. 19 ft., 61/2 ins. Length (firing position) .................................. Height (gun and mount) .............. 7 ft., 81/2 ins. Height (firing position) .................................. in. Width (gun and mount) .............. 7 ft., 1 Length of tube .............................. 17 ft., 11/2 ins. Length of rifling ............................ 14 ft., 91/2 ins. Length, of chamber .................................... 29.5 ins. No. of lands .............................. .............. 34 /4 in. .050 in. /s in. Width of grooves .................. ................ De-th of grooves ................................. Width of lands ........................................

Muzzle velocity ( shell) ........................ 2,700 f/s Max. range (horizontal) ...................... 17,000 yds. Max. range (vertical) .................... 32,800 ft. (fuze) Rate of fire ........................ ................... 10-12 rds. Traverse ................................ .......................... 360 Elevation ...................................... ....... ........... 750 Depression ............... .................. 10 Length of recoil .......................................... 19.3 ins. Ammunition ........ H.E. shrapnel; H.E. phosphorus Wt. of projectile .................................... 45.75 lbs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

August,

1945

114.5

140 mm SEACOAST GUN TYPE 3

JAPANESE

It is believed that this naval coast defense weapon was designed primarily for use against ships, as the fuzes used with the gun's ammunition are not sensitive enough to function satisfactorily upon rapact with soft ground. This gun uses separate loading ammunition, and has a standard type mushroom head obturator. The breechblock is the horizontal swinging, interrupted screw type, having three threaded segments with two step threads. A hydropneumatic recoil mechanism is located above the barrel. A naval pedestal type mount is used. Strips of iron fastened to and radiating from the pedestal are buried in the ground to insure stability. The piece is sometimes fitted in a casemate, the front and sides of which are cast in one piece. The top is rolled plate. A mantlet is fitted to the gun on the inside of the casemate. Gun and casemate are rotated manually, as no power system is provided. No fire control equipment, with the exception of a telescopic sight mount, was recovered with the gun, and it is believed that the piece is fired by direct laying.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ........................................ 140 mm (5.5 ins.)
Weight (firing position) .................................. Length (overall) .................................. 23 ft., 8 ins. Length (firing position) ................................. Height (firing position) ................................. Width (overall) ............................................. Length of tube .............................. 22 ft., 101/2 ins. Length of rifling .......................... 19 ft., Width of grooves ........................................... Depth of grooves ...................................... 0.051 in. Width of lands ............................................. Muzzle velocity ( shell) 850 meters (2,789 ft.) per sec. from range disc on gun 3V2 ins. 42 No. of grooves .................................................. ...

Max. range (horizontal) 17,000 meters (18,598 yds.) from range disc on gun Rate of fire ............................................................ Traverse ............................ ....................... 360 30

Elevation ........................ Depression

........ ....................

...............................................

..... -7

Length of recoil ............................................ A m m unition ................. ...................................

Wt. of projectile (H. E.) Common ............. 83.8 lbs.

114.6

1 August,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

300 mm SHORT HOWITZER, TYPE 7

JAPANESE

This howitzer was captured on Luzon. The emplacement, circular in shape and measuring 33 feet in diameter and 8 feet in depth, was camouflaged by -a house on rails which was rolled back when the guns were to be fired. A small garden of banana trees was planted around the emplacement to add to the effect. The howitzer tube is believed to be a built-up type. The liner is rifled with a uniform right hand twist, calculated to be one turn in 9.4 calibers. Two air flasks are mounted on the carriage for blowing out the tube after firing. Two equilibrators are mounted below the tube. The breech mechanism is an interrupted screw type having 8 segments of 20 threads. A percussion hammer firing mechanism is operated by a lanyard. A short cartridge case is used for obturation. The upper carriage is a rectangular steel frame approximately 18 feet, 9 inches long, and 4 feet, 8 inches wide, fixed to a base plate. The lower carriage is a truncated steel cone embedded in concrete approximately 6 to 8 feet under the ground. The upper carriage baseplate rests on a rail above a worm wheel, fixed to the lower carriage which engages a spur rack fitted to the base of the upper carriage. The traversing handwheel is mounted in a horizontal position engaging a vertical shaft which terminates in the worm gear. The elevating handwheels, one on either side of the tube, are mounted on the carriage in a vertical position. A direct shaft from the elevating handwheel terminates in a spur gear which engages the elevating arc. A panoramic sight is mounted on the right side of the gun.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ............................ 305 mm (12 ins. approx.) Weight (firing position) ............................... Length of tube and breech ........... 16 ft., 6 ins. Length of carriage base .................... Width of carriage base .................... 18 ft., 9 ins. 4 ft., 8 ins.

Length (firing position) ................................... Height (firing position) ................................. W idth (overall) ................................. ............

Length of bore ................................. ............ No. of lands ........................ ........... ............ . 72

Width of grooves ........................................... Depth of grooves ........................................... Width of lands ............................................ Muzzle velocity ( shell) ...........................
Max. range (horizontal)-Trans. document ..................... ....................... 13,000 yds. Max. range (vertical) ...................................... Rate of fire ................................. Traverse .............................. .............. 360 70 3 420 mm ...................

Elevation, scale reading.................................. Depression, scale reading................................ Length of recoil; scale reading................. A m m unition ................. ...................................

Wt. of projectile-Trans. document............ 970 lbs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

116e3

81 mm MORTAR MODEL 3

JAPANESE

The Japanese 81 mm Mortar, Model 3, is a forerunner of the Model 97 (1937). Arsenal in 1943. The tube is a smooth-bore type and has two collars machined on the forward part for securing the bipod clamp. The bipod, constructed of light weight tubing, is very unstable. There is no cross leveling device, and rough cross leveling adjustments could be made by breaking the bipod support and moving the leg on the low side inward. The base plate is relatively heavy, and is believed to be identical with that now used with the 90 mm Mortar, Model 94. It is interchangeable with the base plate for the Model 97. Both traversing and elevating mechanisms employ the square type threads rather than the usual and more efficient buttress type as used on Model 97. No sight was recovered with the mortar. It was manufactured at the Yokosuka Navy

SPECIFICATIONS
W eight of tube ............................................ 47 Ibs. Weight of bipod .......................................... 25 lbs.

Weight of base plate .................................... 95 lbs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

122.1

150 MM MORTAR, MODEL 97 (1937)

JAPANESE

This mortar, of conventional design, is a smooth bore, muzzleloading weapon referred to by the Japanese as a medium mortar. Although its tactical use is not fully defined, it is known to have been used in fixed concrete emplacements as a part of the island defense system. The Model 97 is very heavy and sturdily constructed, weighing 770 pounds complete with sight. The breech cap and stud, with assembled firing mechanism, are screwed on in the normal manner. The firing pin may be adjusted to three different positions by means of a cam lock. When the lock is in the rear center position the firing pin is in a safe position; when the lock is turned to the right, the pin is "Floating," or, in other words, may be actuated by a sharp blow on the end of the cam shaft. When the firing pin is locked forward, the operation is the same as that of a mortar with a fixed firing pin. The bipod is of normal construction with but one exception. The elevating screw is actually two concentric screws, comparing very favorably with a single screw in stability and overall length. The traversing screw, buffer mechanism, and collar assembly are of the same design as other Model 97 Japanese mortars. The bipod and cradle may be separated for handling. The base plate is a heavy ribbed stamping of 0.25 inch metal built up by reinforcing ribs welded to the original stamping. It has the usual ball and socket locking arrangement. The sight is a panoramic elbow telescope of three power and thirteen degree field.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber .................................... 150 mm (5.906 ins.) Weight (complete) ...................................... 770 lbs. W eight of tube .......................................... 257 lbs. Weight of bipod & traversing assembly, (total) ....................... ... ................... 174.5 lbs.

Weight of sight & extension ...................... 1.5 lb. Weight of baseplate .................................. 337 lbs. Length of tube ........................................ 75.37 ins. Length of tube (internal) ............................ Length of baseplate ................................ 66 ins.

47.75 ins.

Width of baseplate .................................... 35.5 ins.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 March,

1945

127

ANTIAIRCRAFT DIRECTOR

JAPANESE

This director (possibly referred to by the Japanese as Model 97) is a plan prediction type of computer. It is probably used with the Japanese Model 88 (1928) 75 mm antiaircraft gun. Standard ballistics are obtained from cams; approximations and spot corrections take care of wind effects, muzzle velocity, and air density variations. The director is provided with telescopes, and with electric data receivers for azimuth and angular height, and for altitude or horizontal range. The director imposes significant limits on altitude and horizontal component rates. The maximum altitude rate is 179 miles per hour. The maximum horizontal component rates are 335 miles per hour. It is not known whether it is Japanese practice to orientate their directors with respect to true North; but if that is the case, targets flying in the cardinal directions with ground speeds in excess of 335 miles per hour would be beyond the capability of this director. Such ground speeds, when aided by wind, may be feasible. It should be noted that the director is capable of handling greater speeds if the target does not fly parallel to one of the principal coordinate axes. Optical tracking is provided on the director proper. An electrical data transmission system provides for the use of an external tracker such as a radar unit.

SPECIFICATIONS
Time of flight .................................... 30 secs. max. Present altitude .......................... 0 to 7,655 yds. Future altitude ........................ -820 to 8,475 yds.

Present horizontal range .............. 0 to 10,936 yds. Future horizontal range .......... 0 to 10,936 yds. N-S and E-W rates ..................... Altitude rate .................................. Lateral deection ................................

164

yds./sec.

87 yds./sec. 800 mils.

Horizontal range prediction .............. 4,101 yds.


Altitude prediction .............................

820 yds.

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 March, 1945

175

ANTIAIRCRAFT DIRECTOR, MODEL 2

JAPANESE

This appears to be the latest model of mechanical antiaircraft director made by the Japanese. It has data receivers (selsyns) for azimuth, angle of site, and slant range, probably provided for use with radar equipment. Primary input data may also be obtained by optical tracking by means of telescopes attached to the director and a height finder. Computation is based on angular rates. The transmitted data is future azimuth, future quadrant elevation, and future fuze. Data is transmitted to each weapon by means of selsyn motors and applied to the weapon by means of a match pointer system resembling that used with the American 90 mm, Ml antiaircraft fire control equipment. It is believed that this instrument is capable of furnishing data for three weapons. It is assumed the azimuth receiver will work with both the 8 cm and the 12 cm Japanese antiaircraft guns. As compared with th her modern directors, it is felt that this instrument is deficient in both design and construction. An angular rate computer is considered too inaccurate for anything other than small or medium caliber automatic tracer controlled anticurve-followthe aircraft fire. Human error is permitted through ing method of introducing time of flight, superelevation, and converting slant range into altitude. A great deal of backlash exists in various gear trains and. in the mechanical linkage of the multipliers.

SPECIFICATIONS
Limits as indicated by drums and dials Slant range (dial calibration) ........ 40,000 meters Slant range (limit of movement w/alt. converter) ........................ 19,000 meters 12,500 meters Horizontal range ......................... Altitude ..................... ................. 9,000 meters Quadrant elevation ............. - 10 to + 90 ........................ 35 seconds Fuze ..................... Dead fuze time ................................. 10 seconds Wind velocity ........................... 20 meters/sec. A zimuth ....................... ......... .................. No lim it Angular rate ............................... Undetermined Electrical data Cycles ............................ .................. 50 or 60 V olts ................................................... 50 or 60 Weapon with which used......120 mm, 45 cals. A.A. gun and 80 mm. 40 cals. A.A. gun. Characteristics 44 /4 ins. Height .......... ...................................... Length ........... .................................... 34V2 ins. Date of manufacture .................... Showa 18 (1943) Weapon data obtained from drums Fuze types (120 mm gun)........M88 (1928), M89 (1929), M91 (1931) Muzzle velocity ....................... 825 meters/sec. Fuze types (80 mm gun)....M89 (1929), 5th year type (1930) Muzzle velocity ....................... 670 meters/sec.

176

1 March, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

MULTIPLE POWER OBSERVATION TELESCOPE

JAPANESE

The Japanese multiple power observation telescope has three powers: 33X, 24X, and a third degree of magnification which has not been determined because of the absence of a third eyepiece in the instrument examined. Selection is made by rotating a dome-shaped holder in which the three eyepieces are mounted. This is somewhat similar to the turret head employed in motion picture cameras and to the selective eyepiece head of compound microscopes. The objective is a compound lens with an air space between the crown and flint components. A modified porro prism is used for the erecting system. The reticle design used with the 24 power eyepiece is a simple cross. The 33 power eyepiece is not equipped with a reticle. No provision is made for an instrument light. An open line sight is provided for quick location of an object in the field of view. The support which is made largely of machined brass castings has an upper and lower movement. The azimuth scale is graduated from 0 to 360 degrees in 1/2 degree steps; a vernier indicator allows readings of one minute to be made. Leveling is accomplished by adjusting the length of the tripod legs. The elevation arc is graduated in increments of 1/2 degrees to + and -30 degrees from 0. The tripod is of wood with brass

fittings.

SPECIFICATIONS
Length of telescopes ................................... ..... 24 ins. 12 lbs., ............ W eight of telescopes ............................. 8 ozs. Height of support ........................... Distance between trunnions ..................... ....................... 111/2 ins. ....... 51 ins.

W eight of support ........................................... 13 lbs., 4 ozs. Length of tripod ....................................................... 38/4 ins.

551/2 ins. Length of tripod (legs extended) ..................................... Weight of telescope .......................... ...... ....... 8 lbs., 8 ozs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 March, 1945

177

BATTERY COMMANDERS TELESCOPES


Model 93, 8 x 6 15'

JAPANESE

This telescope is so constructed that the tubes can be used only in the vertical position. Its primary use is believed to be for observation and correction of artillery fire. The eyepieces are of the multiple thread focusing type, and the diopter scale is graduated from - 2 to - 3. The reticle design consists of a vertical and horizontal mil scale graduated in increments of one mil from 0 to 30 on each side of 0. A light receptacle for artificial illumination of the reticle is provided. The telescope is fitted with an angle of site mechanism. The hinge mechanism of the assembly consists of a simple hinge pin and a fitted yoke. The interpupillary mechanism is locked near the base and between the two tubes.

Model 93 Battery Commanders Telescope

Telescope with Integral Tripod


The general purpose of this instrument is believed to be the observation and correction of fire, used with either machine guns or artillery. Unlike the instrument above, it employs a scissor movement and may, therefore, be used in either a vertical or horizontal position. The reticle is the only angle measuring device provided. The limit for horizontal angles is 30 mils to the right and 10 mils to the left of zero. Vertical angles of plus and minus 20 mils can be measured. The 90 prisms are cemented. Minimum and maximum interpupillary distances are 60 mm and 70 mm. The tripod is simply constructed, light in weight, and sturdy. It comprises an adapter or bracket for the telescope, a tripod head, and three tubular, fixed length legs with small metal shoes.

SPECIFICATIONS
Model 93 Power .......................................... . . ............ 8 diameters 6 15' 33/4 ins. 54 to 70 mm 9 ins. .15 ins. 12 ins. 2 lbs., 2 ozs. 11 13/16 ins. 11 ozs. Tel. with Int. Tripod 8 diameters 6 Field of view ........................................... . .......... Interobjective distance ................... Interpupillary setting ................. ......

.............. . 58 to 70 mm

Deviation of light in vertical plane .................................... 10 ins. ............ 2 in. Diam eter of Exit Pupil ................................... .......... Overall length ........................................ Overall width .................... ........................... ........ W eight ............... ..................... ................ .................... 12/4 ins. 61/4 ins.

6 lbs., 5 ozs.

Length of tripod .......................................................................... Weight of tripod ............................ ......................................

Battery Commanders Telescope with Integral Tripod

* The interobjective distance with the tubes horizontal, and the interpupillary scale set at 64 mm is 21 ins.; with the tubes vertical, and the interpupillary scale set at 64 mm, the interobjective distance is 5 ins.

178

1 March, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

40 CM BASE RANGE FINDER

JAPANESE

This range finder is a superimposed image vertical base instrument designed for use with machine gun and mortar fire. It consists of two major assemblies: the elbow, and the diaspirometer unit and head. The elbow housing is of seamless aluminum, 4% inches in length. It contains the eye and field lens, an amici prism, a reticle, a penta prism, and the objective lens. The brass diaspirometer unit contains two wedges with connecting gears that govern the aluminum range drum; the extension tube made of seamless aluminum which maintains the base length of the instrument; and the cast aluminum head which houses a penta prism and a weak correction wedge. The instrument is used in conjunction with a mount and tripod. Because of the short base length, this range finder is not accurate at distant ranges.

SPECIFICATIONS
Power ...................... ...................... 4 diameters Field of view (upper field) .............................. 110 4 ((lower field) ............................ Base length .......................
Measuring limits

...................... 40 cm
30 to 1,500 meters

....................

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 March, 1945

179

75 CM BASE RANGE FINDER

JAPANESE

This instrument is very similar to the 80 cm base range finder, Keuffel and Esser Model 1918. It also resembles the design of the Barr and Stroud instrument. It is, therefore, assumed that it is used much the same as the American 80 cm base, M1914M1 Range Finder. It is a coincidence type range finder with a split field of view, and'is used by light field artillery units. The ocular prism consists of three optical components cemented together resembling the arrangement in the American 1 meter base range finder, M1916. The eyepiece assembly is of the symmetrical type. The halving plate is a thick piece of optical glass with plano parallel surfaces. The measuring wedge and range scale are a single assembly. The latter is illuminated by the light rays entering through the range scale illuminating window, and reflected by a mirror. The objectives, installed as matched pairs are burnished in their cells. The penta prisms and wedge windows resemble those used in American range finders. An effort has been made, through a bushing in the center of the buffer assemblies, to desiccate the instrument. It is not believed that the eyepiece assemblies can be sufficiently sealed to make this effective. The tripod is lightly constructed and has no locking device for the legs. The tripod mount permits the range finder to be locked or rotated in azimuth. There is also a leveling device, but no level vial.

SPECIFICATIONS
Base length ................................................ Magnification ....................................... 75 cm

... 12 power

Range .....................................

100 to 10.000 yds.

Field of view .............. Vertical 2-horizontal 3 Weight of range finder ................................ Weight of carrying case .............................. 9 lbs. lbs.

180

1 March, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

1 METER BASE RANGE FINDER,

MODEL 94

JAPANESE I

This instrument is a one-meter base, stereoscopic, horizontal base rangefinder. Ranges are read directly from the reticles. The outer tube is made of cast aluminum. The inner tube, made of seamless steel tubing, is supported in the outer tube by means of a gimbal joint. The height of image knob is located on the right end of the instrument; the range correction knob is on the left side. The lighting window of the reticle is above the eyepiece plate. An auxiliary open sight is located above the right eyepiece. Uniform adjustment of interpupillary distande is obtained by connecting the two eyepieces with steel tape forming a figure 8. Rhomboid prisms keep the optical axes of the eyepieces in alignment with the reticles. The penta prism assemblies are held to circular plates which may be rotated to eliminate tilt of image and place both images at the same height in the field of view.

SPECIFICATIONS
Power .............................................. 8 diameters Field of view .................................. Base length ...................... ........... . 50

...................... 1 meter
and 4 diopters

Diopter movement ............ +

Interpupillary setting ......................... 55 to 75 mm Overall length .......................................... 43%/ ins. W eight ........................................... Serial number ........................... 6 lbs., 13 ozs. 1218

.........................

Measuring limits ...................... 250 to 8,000 yds.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 March, 1945

181

STEREOSCOPIC 2 METER BASE RANGE FINDER MODEL 97 TYPE 2

JAPANESE

This range finder is believed to be designed for use with seacoast defenses. It is provided with an elbow telescope for tracking purposes and a graphical computer for converting slant range to altitude. A number of its design features are quite similar to those in the Japanese 2 meter base Height Finder. Similarities are noted in the penta prism mounting, central prism assembly, reticle and eyepiece assemblies, night lighting of scales, and the filter assembly. The instrument is constructed with an outer tube, optical tube, and two tubular diaphragms, all of steel. The outer tube is covered with asbestos treated canvas. The tracking telescope provided with this instrument has a power of 10 diameters and a 5 degree field of view. The body is made of cast aluminum. The tracking telescope is attached to the main instrument by means of a dovetail bracket and is locked in place by a spring latch. Another accessory, the graphical altitude computor, consists of a pendulum arm inclosed in a circular holder. The pendulum is graduated with a vertical scale in increments of 50 meters from 100 to 1,000 meters, which represents slant range. Angle of site is indicated by a graduated scale on the face of the holder. The cradle has the trunnion bearing arms cast as an integral part of the body. The eyeguard assembly is a copy of the Carl Zeiss design.

SPECIFICATIONS
Power ................... ...................... 24 Field of view .................................... Undetermined Diameter of entrance pupil ...................... 1.9 ins. Diameter of exit pupil ............................. .08 ins.

Base length .......................................... 2 meters Diopter movement .............. + Measuring limits 2 to 4 diopters

............... 500 to 20,000 meters

Inter-trunnion distance ............................ 351/2 ins. Overall length ........................................ 86 ins. W eight .......................................................... 148 lbs.

182

1 March, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

STEREOSCOPIC 2 METER BASE HEIGHT FINDER, MODEL 93

JAPANESE

While primarily designed for use by antiaircraft batteries, a mining horizontal as well as vertical range. The eyepieces are of range finder of this type may be used by artillery units for deterthe focusing type. Interpupillary distances may be set to suit the individual observer by means of a lever located on the right eyepiece. The eyepiece assembly also contains two ray filters.

SPECIFICATIONS
Pow er .............................................. 20 diam eters
2 15' Field of view .............................................

Interpupillary setting ................ 56 mm to 74 mm Diopter adjustment ............................ + 2 to 4

Limits of range measuring........ 400 to 20,000 yds. Base length .................... ...................... 2 meters

The instrument consists of three major assemblies which are: the Range Finder Table, the Cradle, and the Tripod assembly. The outer tube is made of seamless steel tubing and has seven openings for adjustments. In addition, there are other openings for the eyepiece assembly, wedge windows, infinity correction lens assemblies, range knob, height of image knob, correction wedge

Overall length .................................. 7 ft., 55/ ins.


W eight ........................................ Cradle Overall length ...................................... 36 ins. 201 lbs.

Distance between trunnions .......... 34 11/16 ins. Height ........................................ 23 ins. (approx.) W eight .................................................. 162 lbs.

assembly, range drum window, and reticle light windows. The optical bar is made of seamless machined steel and represents better machine work than most Japanese fire control instruments.

Tripod Overall height .......................................... W eight 32 ins.

....................... ....................... 100 lbs.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

- OF ORDNANCE

1 March, 1945

183

BINOCULARS
Observation, 85 mm

JAPANESE

These binoculars are used for general observation upon a tripod for which an adapter is provided on the instrument. An elevation scale is etched on the reticle and the 90 prisms are cemented. Two steel bands connect the eyepieces mechanically. Drying bents are contained in each telescope.

Aircraft Spotting, 100 mm


Observation Binoculars. 85 mm

The telescope bodies of this instrument are of cast aluminum; the fittings are of brass. The erecting system consists of a roof angle prism held in position by four screws. The objective is housed in an eccentric adapter. The eyepieces are offset from the main tube. Interocular settings are obtained by rotating the eyepiece housings. There are two drying plugs in the body of each telescope.

Aircraft Spotting, 120 mm


It is believed that this improved model is replacing the 100 mm binoculars described above. The eyepiece assemblies include a rhomboid prism. Inter-ocular distances are varied by rotating the left eyepiece assembly. The erecting system consists of one porro prism and two 900 prisms cemented to the porro system. A feature of this instrument is the dehydrating unit consisting of a silk bag of silica gel placed in a perforated metal holder fitted between the two telescope assemblies. Drying vents are also provided.
Aircraft Spotting Binoculars, 100 mm

SPECIF ICATIONS
85 mm
Pow er .............................. 15X 4 Field of view .................... Interobjective distance (approx.) ............ 4 7/16 ins. Diopter movement ............ + 2 to - 4 Interpupillary Movement ............. 60 to 72 mm Length ........................ 18 ins. Width ...................... 181/2 ins. Weight .................. 21 /2 lbs. Manufacturer........Jap. Op. Co. Aircraft Spotting Binoculars, 120 mm Serial number .................. 915 100 mm 120 mm 20X 30 5 9/16 ins.
7 ins.

2 to -

3 mm ins. ins. ozs. Co.

2 to -

60 to 72 21/V2 16 32 lbs., 12 Jap. Op.

58 to 72 mm 24 ins. 18 ins. 50 Ibs., 8 ozs. Toyko Optical Mach. Stock Joint Co.

2254

184

1 March, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

FIRE CONTROL EQUIPMENT


for 75 mm Model 88 (1928) A. A. Gun

JAPANESE

Above: Elevation Computing Apparatus

Below: Azimuth Computing Apparatus

Speed and Course Angle Calculator

These instruments are used with the Mobile Field Antiaircraft Gun described on page 110. The method used to predict the future position of a moving target in space differs from both the angular rate of travel and the linear speed methods, although based on the latter. Antiaircraft installations captured before the middle of 1944 showed very little use of computing directors and remote control systems. The system described herein is apparently all that was available. The following instruments and computing mechanisms are employed in the system as off-carriage components: a. Two-meter-base height and range finder. b. Speed and course angle calculator. c. Charge (propelling) temperature and wind corrector scale. d. Spotting binoculars. The data computed with the off-carriage components are transmitted orally to the gun where they are manually registered in the on-carriage fire control instruments. The on-carriage components consist of the following: a. Elevation computing apparatus. b. Azimuth computing apparatus. c. Auxiliary elevation and lead corrector disc. d. Fuze setter. The accompanying illustrations show five of the significant components.

Propelling Charge Temperature and Wind Correction Scale

Fuze Setter

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

April, 1945

185

ARTILLERY TRAJECTORY CHARTS

JAPANESE

On the following three pages are reproduced trajectory charts for six Japanese antiaircraft and dual purpose guns. These were prepared by an Ordnance Technical Intelligence team in the field, and were constructed on the basis of the best available current information, but not on actual tests. It is, therefore, expected that revised charts will be made available as more accurate or detailed information is obtained, and that charts for other artillery pieces will be prepared from time to time. On the charts the limit of time fire is indicated. In all cases where mechanical time fuzes are available, the limit of time fire is based on the maximum setting of the fuze, since the fuze setting of a mechanical time fuze nearly coincides with actual time of flight at all points. For the 7 cm Type 88 antiaircraft gun, the limit of time fire has been taken from documents. The fuze in this case is the Type 89 30-second, powder-train fuze. Here it should be noted that the actual time of flight obtained with the maximum fuze setting varies grealy over the range of elevations, resulting from the inherent variation in burning time of the powder trains along different trajectories. If subsequent intelligence indicates use of a mechanical time fuze for this gun, as for example, with the 8 cm (3") dual purpose gun, the limit of time fire would approximate the locus of points reached in the time of flight corresponding to the maximum setting of the fuze. A later model powder-train fuze (Type 2, 44-seconds) has been reported for the 7 cm gun. Its contour differs from that of the Type 89, so that the trajectories of the shell would be somewhat different from those here reported; no data are available on the ballistic performance of the gun firing shell equipped with the Type 2 fuze, but it is believed that the performance would be slightly poorer since the Type 2 fuze gives a height of ogive somewhat lower than does the Type 89. However, preliminary intelligence indicates that with the Type 2 fuze actual times of flight correspond much more closely to fuze settings than in the case of the Type 89.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 June, 1945

187

TRAJECTORY CHARTS FOR A.A.

GUNS

JAPANESE

7 cm (75 mm) MOBILE GUN, ANTIAIRCRAFT, MODEL 88


Type 90 AA Shell, Type 89 Fuze Muzzle Velocity-2362 f/s Maximum Elevation-85

8 cm (3 inch) DUAL PURPOSE GUN MODEL 3


HE Shell, Normal Charge Muzzle Velocity-2230 f/s Maximum Elevation-75

188

Julie,

1945

188 1945OFFICE 1June, CHIEF 6OF

ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED RSRCE

TRAJECTORY CHARTS FOR A.A. GUNS

.JAPANESE

100 mm DUAL PURPOSE GUN


___ _ __ __ _ _

IK
__ ___

_3__

__

__

__

___

__

__

__

__

HE Shell, Normal Charge


Muzzle Velocity-2854 f/s

-0Is__

MIT OF TIME F S 45-SEC. MECH.TI E FUZE)

30NOlCATE

IME OF

FLlGHIT

(SECONDS)

zK

__

}_

__

__

I
_

RANGE (YARDS)

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

6OF

ORDNANCE

1ln,14 1 June,

1945

189

TRAJECTORY CHARTS FOR A.A. GUNS

JAPANESE

127 mm/40 Cal. DUAL PURPOSE GUN, MODEL 89


HE Shell, Normal Charge rime Fuze for Automatic Fuze Setter Muzzle Velocty-2362 f/s Maximum Elevation-90l

190

1 June,

1945

190 1945OFFICE 1June, CHIEF 6OF

ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

RSRCE

8 mm PARATROOPER'S SUBMACHINE

JAPANESE

GUN, TYPE 100 (1940)

This Japanese paratrooper's submachine gun is a light, blowback operated, automatic weapon which fires the regular issue bottle-necked 8 mm pistol cartridge. The gun, which is provided with a bayonet, also has a folding stock; that is, the stock is cut through just behind the receiver and hinged so that by releasing two locking hooks on the left side, the stock swings to the right and forward 180 degrees at the hinge and parallel with the barrel. The barrel and barrel jacket are held in place by a single screwpin threaded at the base and with a folding wingnut head, enabling changes without tools. The receiver assembly is machined in two units, with the units shrunk fit in final assembly. Two features of the firing mechanism which are of unusual interest are the fixed firing pin which screws into the face of the bolt, and the feeding and chambering bar which insures that the cartridge is very nearly chambered before the firing pin can touch the primer. In the illustrations above, the top picture shows the weapon as fired, and the photograph at lower left shows the method of folding. A bipod is frequently used with this gun as illustrated in the photograph at lower right.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ............................... ............... Weight (without bayonet, magazine, & sightleaf) ...................................... 7 lbs., 11 ozs.
Length (stock extended, without bayonet).. 34 ins. Length (stock extended, with bayonet)...... 49 ins.

8 mm

Length (stock folded, without bayonet).. 22.25 ins. Sight radius .............................................. Principle of operation............Blowback, 20 ins.

bolt action

Feeding device......................Curved box magazine; staggered feed type. Capacity of feeding device .................. 30 rounds Cooling system .................... ...................... Air

Ammunition types.................. 8 mm bottle-necked pistol cartridges Rate of fire ............................... ... 400-450 r.p.m. Type of sight .................................................. Length of barrel ......................................... Length of rifling .................................... Rifling Twist .................. Uniform R. H., approx. 1 in 12 No. of grooves ............................... Muzzle velocity ........................................ .......... . 6 1,080 f/s Leaf 9 ins.

8.125 ins.

RESTRICTED

Replacement Page

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

204*1

8 mm SUBMACHINE GUN, TYPE 100 (1940)

JAPANESE

The Japanese 8 mm submachine Gun, Type 100, is an automatic, air-cooled, magazine-fed, straight blowback-operated type, firing from an open bolt. Its basic design strongly resembles that of the German submachine guns. The weapon may be broken down into three main groups: a receiver which contains the bolt and driving spring, a barrel assembly, and a wooden stock assembly containing the trigger and trigger guard. A considerable amount of rough welding is used on the weapon; the front sight, bayonet lug, barrel lock, magazine well, driving spring guide, and trigger guard have all been attached to the rifle by this method. An unusual feature of the gun is a replaceable firing pin which screws into the face of the bolt. The weapon has a high cyclic rate of fire, estimated between 800 and 1,000 rounds per minute. Paratrooper's rifle, It differs from the Type 100 (1940) described on page 204.1, in the following respects: it does not have a folding stock; a standard bayonet can be mounted directly on barrel and barrel jacket; and the rear sight is fixed rather than of the sliding ramp type.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ...................... ................... 8 mm (.315 in.)
9 oz. 36 ins. Weight with sling and magazine...... 9 lbs., 2 oz. W eight of m agazine ....................................... Length (overall) ................. ......................... Sight radius: Principle of operation................ Straight blowback Feeding device ................ Curved box magazine Capacity of feeding device ............... Cooling system ..................... .... 30 rounds

.................. Air

Ammunition types .............................. 8 mm pistol Rate of fire (cyclic) .... 800-1,000 rds. per min. (est.) Type of sight-Front: Inverted "V" Rear: "V" with small peep additional. W eight of barrel .................................. Length of barrel ................................... 9-3/16 ins. Length of rifling .......................................... Rifling: Tw ist ........................................... Form ................ ..................R . H . 8.3 ins.

.................................. 6 1,050 f/s

No. of grooves .................................... M uzzle velocity ........................................ Maximum range ..................................

Effective range .....................................

204.2

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

TRIPLE BARREL SIGNAL PISTOL

JAPANESE

MO

The triple barrel signal pistol, of naval design, is made of steel with black baked enamel finish and is equipped with plastic grips. It consists of three main parts: the barrel assembly, the firing mechanism housing, and the receiver. The barrels, which are slightly tapered and of the smooth bore type, can be fired only singly. The left barrel is marked with a red stripe, the top barrel with a white stripe, and the right barrel with a green stripe. The various kinds of ammunition used with the weapon (red, white, and green flares) must correspond with the color markings on the barrel. The weapon is carried in a leather holster. The pistol is opened for loading by pulling forward on the spring-loaded barrel release lever and forcing downward on both ends of the pistol. Movement of the safety lever upward places the gun in the firing position; downward movement of the lever places the gun in the safe position. A counter-clockwise movement of the cocking lever cocks all three spring-loaded firing pins. Each firing pin has its own sear, and movement of the barrel selector lever to the desired stop directs the movement of the trigger to the proper sear, releasing the proper firing pin and firing the round in the selected barrel. The three stops on the barrel selector lever are as follows: the left hand stop for the left hand barrel, the central stop for the top barrel, and the right hand stop for the right hand barrel. The barrel assembly and firing mechanism recoil on the receiver during firing against the action of a recoil spring located in the receiver. A double barrel version of this pistol is shown at the right.

SPECIFICATIONS
W eight of pistol ............................. 3 lbs., 11 ozs. Length of barrel (approx.) ........................... 4 ins.

Bore diameter at muzzle ......................... 26.8 mm


Bore diameter at breech ........................ 28.4 mm Types of ammunition used

Red, white, & green flares

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

204

6.5 mm SNIPER'S RIFLE MODEL 97 (1937)

JAPANESE

The Japanese 6.5 mm Sniper's Rifle, Model 97, is a manually operated, bolt-action, air-cooled, shoulder weapon similar to the Model 38 (1905) 6.5 mm rifle except for its monopod, turneddown bolt handle, and telescopic sight. The telescopic sight is attached to the left hand side of the receiver by means of a dovetailed base. It is a fixed focus type of 2.5 power and has a 10 field of vision. The telescopic sight is approximately seven inches long and is equipped with an eyepiece of soft rubber. The reticle is marked in the following graduations: vertical from 0 to 15, horizontal 20 mils each side of the center, the markings being at 5 mil intervals. The horizontal line intersects the vertical scale at the 3 mark. The telescopic sight is removable and when not in use is carried in a well constructed canvas case which has a heavy coating of lacquer on the outside for waterproofing. The case is fitted on the inside with a wooden spacer to secure the sight when it is inside. A small pocket to hold the sight cleaning brush is also constructed inside the case. The rifle is also provided with a folding monopod which is pivoted on the lower band.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight (w/telescopic sight).............. 10 lbs., 8 oz. 50.25 ins. ...................... 26.9 ins. Length (overall w/o bayonet)................ Sight radius .....................

Principle of operation ................ Manual, bolt-action Feeding device .................................... Box magazine Capacity of feeding device .................... 5 rounds Cooling system ................................................ ... Air Ammunition types............Mod. 38, 6.5 mm ball and reduced charge ball Rate of fire................According to dexterity of user Type of sight ........................ 2.5x telescopic sight W eight of barrel ........................................... Length of barrel ........................................ Length of rifling ....................................... Rifling Twist .............. Uniform R.H. one turn in 7.88 ins. Metford segmental Form ........................................ ............ 4 No. of grooves .................................. Depth of grooves ........................................ Width of grooves ........................................ Chamber pressure ......................................... Muzzle velocity .......................... Muzzle energy ............... 2,400 ft. per sec. 31.4 ins. 29.1 ins.

................................. 2,600 yds. 600 yds.

Maximum range .................................... Effective range (approx.) ...................... Type of mount ................................

Folding monopod

RESTRICTED

Replacement Page

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

208.1

RIFLE GRENADE LAUNCHERS


There are three distinct types of grenade launchers in use by the Japanese. They are known as the Type 2 or cup type, the Type 100 or Kiska type, and the spigot type. The Type 2, which is patterned after the German grenade launcher of the same type, fits over the front sight of the rifle and has a short rifled barrel. It fires both the 30 mm and 40 mm hollow charge rifle grenades. This grenade weighs 122 ounces, is 8 inches long, has a maximum external diameter of 11/2 inches, and contains 3.8 ounces of TNT. The grenade, which is armed during flight by a base detonating, set-back actuated fuze, detonates upon impact with the target. It will penetrate 37/ inches of mild steel plate.

JAPANESE

TYPE 2 CUP TYPE LAUNCHER

,6

The Type 100 may be used with either the 6.5 mm Type 38 or the 7.7 mm Type 99 rifle. Ordinary ball ammunition is used to launch the grenade from the rifle e fm to exe te g gas from the fired cartridge is utilized (the expanding
to expel the grenade from the launcher), a feature

which enables the rifle to be carried with the launcher attached and ready for use as either a rifle or as a grenade launcher. The Type 99 smooth bodied grenade known as the Kiska grenade is the only type used with the launcher. Ranges up to 100 yards may be obtained. Overall length .......................... . 8% ins. 4/2 ins. Length of grenade tube .................... Diameter of grenade tube (interior) ......... 1%3ins. Total weight ....................... .. 1 lb., 9 ozs.
TYPE 100 LAUNCHER

The spigot type launcher, which may be used with either the Type 38 or Type 99 rifle, fires the Type 91,
Type 3 H.E., and several types of smoke and incendiary

grenades. It consists of a rifled barrel threaded to an adapter. The launcher is attached to the rifle at the rear of the front sight mount by two locking arms on the. adapter. When a bayonet is fixed to the rifle, additional stability is obtained by the use of a two-pronged lug on the adapter which fits on the bayonet guard. Length of barrel .................... Outside diameter of barrel ............ Inside diameter of barrel ............. Overall length ...................... W eight (complete) ...................... 150 27 21 107 mm-5.9" mm-1" mm-.82" mm-4.2" 15.5 ozs.

SPIGOT TYPE LAUNCHER

208.2

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

6.5 mm HEAVY MACHINE GUN MODEL 3 (1914)

JAPANESE

The Japanese 6.5 mm Model 3 Heavy Machine Gun, a gasoperated, air-cooled, full-automatic weapon with a comparatively low cyclic rate, although obsolescent, is being recovered in small quantities from battle areas. It is similar to the 7.7 mm Model 92, but is chambered for the 6.5 mm cartridge. The gas piston and bolt assemblies, and the barrel and barrel sleeve may be interchanged in the two weapons. However, it is impossible to convert the Model 3 for use with the 7.7 mm ammunition as the strip feed port in the Model 3 is one-eighth of an inch narrower than that in the Model 92. Various machining cuts found in the internal parts of the Model 3 were eliminated in the later model, to provide for ease of production. The oil reservoir is of slightly different shape and probably has a lower capacity than that of the Model 92. The trunnions are of two diameters. The part of the trunnion which contacts the trunnion bearing in the mount is of smaller diameter than that portion which extends beyond the mount. The head thus formed tends to reduce transverse motion. The weapon has conventional spade grips provided with two finger triggers fixed integrally with the trigger lever so that either or both will fire the gun. There is no safety device. Two rear sights are provided: one, a folding ring type antiaircraft sight, is attached permanently to the rear top of the receiver; the other, a tangent curve, radius arm type, is offset to the right. The latter sight is graduated from 300 meters to 2,200 meters (328 yards to 2,406 yards). It is believed that a cartwheel type front sight is used, as an adaptor for such a sight is riveted to the front of the cooling jacket.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight (w/tripod) ...................................... 122 lbs. (w/o tripod) ................................ 61.7 lbs. Length .................. ...................... 47.2 ins. ...................... 23.6 ins. Sight radius ..................... Principle of operation .......................................... Gas Feeding device .................................... Metal strips Capacity of feeding device .................. 30 rounds Cooling system .............................................. ..... Air Ammunition types....................Mod. 38, 6.5 mm ball ammunition Rate of fire..............................Cyclic-450-500 r.p.m. Practical-200 r.p.m. Type of sight..........Two rear sights: folding ring, antiaircraft type; tangent curve, radius arm type, grad. 3282,406 yds. Weight of barrel .......................................... Length of barrel ........................................ 29.2 ins. Length of rifling ........................................ 26.4 ins. Rifling Twist ............ Uniform, R.H., one turn in 7.88 ins. Form ....................................... Metford segmental No. of grooves ............................. ........... 4 Depth of grooves .......................................... Width of grooves ............................................. Chamber pressure .............. 58,800 lbs. per sq. in. Muzzle velocity .......................... 2,434 ft. per sec. Muzzle energy ............... ................................. Maximum range .................................... 4,376 yds. Effective range ..................................... 1,500 yds. Type of mount ................................... ............ Tripod Elevation ..................................... -15 to +90 Traverse ......................................................... 33.5

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

210*1

7.7 mm PARATROOPER RIFLES


Model 99 (1939)

JAPANESE

zwba

Model 2 (1942)

Both of the weapons shown above are basically the same as the Japanese 7.7 mm standard infantry rifle, Model 99. They have been designed, however, to incorporate a takedown feature which enables them to be used by paratroop units. Manufactured at Nagoya Arsenal, they are manually-operated, bolt-action, magazine-fed, clip-loaded rifles. The modified Model 99 differs from the basic following respects: the barrel locking adaptor is receiver; the barrel is secured into the adaptor screw threads; the bolt handle is detachable; and two parts. weapon in the secured to the by interrupted the stock is in

SPECIFICATIONS
W eight ...................................................... 8.9 lbs. 44" Clip 5 rounds Length .............................................................. Feeding device ................................................. Capacity of feeding device .................. Principle of operation ............Manual, bolt-operated

Ammunition types .......................... Model 99 rimless Type of sight......Front: inverted "V" blade on "T" base; Rear: leaf graduated from 328 to 1,640 yds. with aperature sight and aperture battle sight side arms for A.A. fire. Weight of barrel .......................................... Length of barrel ........................................... . 257/8" Length of rifling ............................................ Rifling: Twist..................Uniform, right hand; one turn in approx. 10 ins. ........ Metford segmental Form ............................ ............ 4 No. of grooves .............................. Depth of grooves ........................................ Width of grooves ...................................... Chamber pressure ........................................... Muzzle velocity .......................................... 2360 f/s 3,000 yds. Maximum range ...................................... Effective range .......................................... 600 yds.

The Model 2, called "Teraju" by the Japanese, is of much better workmanship than the Modified Model 99. The barrel and front end are detached from the stock at the receiver ring. When taken down, the barrel section is 25 V2 inches long; the stock 201/4 inches. Total weight of the loaded weapon is 8.9 pounds. The takedown system is simple and sturdy. The barrel has a straight, unthreaded shank with a lug on the bottom. The shank fits into a socket in front of the receiver. A tapered locking key passes through the receiver (from right to left) and engages in front of the barrel lug. The key cannot be taken out completely, but may be withdrawn far enough to allow removal of the barrel. It is locked in place by screwing a nut on the right side into the receiver wall. A spring actuated plunger located in the front end of the buttstock locks the barrel and forestock in position. This plunger must be retracted before the barrel can be rotated for takedown.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

212.1

7.7 mm LEWIS MACHINE GUN MODEL 92 (1932)

JAPANESE

The Lewis type machine gun is used widely by the Japanese. Markings on a number of these guns found in the New Georgia area indicate that the weapon as used by the Japanese is of naval origin. It is also believed that the gun is used extensively for ship or air base protection as the tripod mount is adaptable for antiaircraft fire. The Model 92 is of standard Lewis gas-operated, air-cooled, drum-fed design, equipped with a blade front sight and a rear peep-sight calibrated in hundreds of meters from 0 to 17. No allowance is made for windage or drift. Although no antiaircraft sight was discovered with the gun, a mount for such a sight is attached to the weapon. The gun is mounted on a tripod having tubular steel legs which may be locked at various angles from the vertical. The tripod legs are attached to flat square plates which have holes in the center to accommodate bolts which are used to secure the tripod to the deck of a ship. The head of the tripod has a 3600 traverse. Without removing the gun from the mount, the main portion of the tripod head can be moved from a horizontal to a vertical position, and the gun attached to the top of the head for antiaircraft use. In this position, the limits of elevation are approximately -80 to +85. Azimuth is calibrated in 2 mil intervals from 0 to 6,400 mils. 7.7 mm rimmed Navy ammunition fed from a 47-round drum is used. Ammunition chests recovered were found to hold 21 loaded drums.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight gun and tripod ............................ 122 lbs. 39 ins. Length ............................................................
Principle of operation....Lewis gas-operated system Feeding device ................................ Drum magazine Capacity of feeding device .................. 47 rounds Cooling system ................................................... Air Ammunition types.................... 7.7 mm full-rimmed ammunition Rate of fire .................................... Cyclic-600 r.p.m. Type of sight........Blade front sight: rear peepsight calibrated from 0 to 1700 meters ......... 49 lbs. ....... Weight of gun ........................... Length of barrel .......................................... 24 ins. Length of rifling ........................................... Rifling Twist ............................................... Uniform, R.H. .............. Concentric Form .................................. ............ 4 No. of grooves .................................. Depth of grooves ......................................... Width of grooves ........................................... Chamber pressure ........................................... Muzzle velocity .......................... 2411 ft. per sec. Muzzle energy ............................................ 4000 yds. Maximum range .................................... 500 yds. Effective range ........................................ Type of mount ............................................. Tripod Elevation ..................... ..................................... +60 Ground mount ......................... - 15 +85 Antiaircraft mount ........................ -80 .............. 360 Traverse ...............................

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 June, 1945

214.1

7.7 mm HEAVY MACHINE GUN MODEL 01 (1941)

JAPANESE

This gun incorporates most of the features of the Model 92 Heavy Machine Gun, but is smaller and lighter. A total weight saving of 41 pounds in the gun and tripod mount is achieved. The barrel of the new gun is considerably shorter than that of the Model 92; therefore, the muzzle velocity is probably lower. Both guns feed from 30-round strips, but the 01 (1941) uses rimless ammunition. The new gun incorporates the following modifications: The barrel of the Model 01 may be quickly removed. The flash hider is screwed onto the muzzle, eliminating the knurled locking collar used on the older gun. The gas regulating system is similar to that of the 7.7 mm Model 99 (1939) Light Machine Gun. A smaller oil reservoir is used. A new method of attaching the ejection port cover allows easier access to the receiver which should aid in clearing stoppages. Minor changes in the metal sights have been made. A crank-shaped safety is fitted through the top of the sear housing with its handle at the left rear of the receiver. The new tripod is lighter and has different type spades. It also has a different mechanism for elevating the pintle support above the tripod base. The receiver of the Model 01 is lighter.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight (total) ............................................ 69.9 lbs. Weight (without mount) ................ 34 lbs., 2 ozs. Weight of mount .......................................... 37 lbs. Weight of tripod ...................................... 36.3 lbs. Length (overall w/flash hider) ............. 42%/s ins. Length (overall w/o flash hider) .............. 38 ins. .............. Sight radius ................................. Principle of operation ................ Gas, full-automatic Feeding device ........................................ Metal strips Capacity of feeding device ............... 30 rounds Cooling system ................................. .......... Ammunition types....Model 92 ball. A.P. and tracer (rimless) Rate of fire (estimated)..........450-500 r.p.m. cyclic 200-250 r.p.m. effective Type of sight..................Rear, calibrated from 100 to 2.200 meters. Weight of barrel .............................. 11 Ibs., 6 ozs. Length of barrel .................................. 23-3/16 ins. Length of rifling............................................ 22 ins. Rifling R.H. Twist ......................................................... Form ..................... ....................................... No. of lands ........................................ ............ 8 No. of grooves ........................................... Depth of grooves ......................................... Width of grooves ......................................... Muzzle velocity ............................................. Maximum range ............................................ Effective range ............... ................................. Type of mount ................................................ Tripod Elevation ..................... ..................................... Traverse (total-on arc) .................................. 450

214.2

1 une,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

DOUBLE BARREL FLEXIBLE AIRCRAFT MACHINE GUNS MODEL 100 and MODEL 1

JAPANESE

These two weapons which are very similar offer the advantage of two guns being mounted in the space occupied by one gun of normal size, thus saving weight in the gun and mount, and space in the plane. A small ammunition supply making frequent magazine changes necessary is a disadvantage partially for the advantages of the double barrel principle. The operating mechanism for both barrels is housed in a single receiver. This is a single forging, milled to house the two separate actions. The magazine opening is cut out of the top of the receiver, the ejection slot out of the bottom. Each action has its own back plate. The gas piston group resembles the Bren light machine gun in design. The bolt is a steel forging well machined. The gas cylinder tube is constructed of seamless steel tubing and is threaded to the receiver at the rear. The trigger assembly is made up of two separate sear assemblies riveted to the pistol grip framework. Two pistol grips are located about 6 inches apart; the sears are connected to a horizontal trigger bar mounting a trigger on either end. Both guns may be fired by depressing either trigger. The magazine is the saddle-drum type. Each side holds 50 rounds and feeds one gun. Each side has its own spring so that, in the event of a jam affecting one barrel, the other gun may continue to fire. The Model 1 (1941) gun appears to be basically the same weapon as the earlier model, Model 100 (1940) which is shown at the bottom of the illustration. The Type 1 gun shown at the top of the picture has a head or shoulder rest attached to the gun. This rest is made of wood and canvas and is attached to the gun with steel frames. The specifications were secured from the earlier weapon.

SPECIFICATIONS
C aliber ...................... .............................. 7.92 m m 36 lbs. Weight of gun ................................................ Length (overall) .......................................... 37.5 ins. Length of receiver .................................. 16.25 ins. Length of barrel ........................................ Length of rifling ...................................... 24.5 ins. 22.37 ins.

Diameter of boreacross lands ............................................ 0.310 in. across grooves ...................................... 0.313 in. Number of lands ............................. ........... 4

Width of lands ......................................... 0.0781 in. Width of grooves .................................... 0.1718 in.

Depth of grooves ...................................... 0.003 in. Twist of rifling .................................... Uniform R. H. Pitch of rifling ......................... ........ 7 (approx.) Gas

Type of operation ................................................

Type of fire ........................................ Automatic only Type of feed................Magazine, saddle-drum type Capacity of magazine .......................... 100 rounds Weight of magazine empty .................... 73/ lbs. lbs.

Weight of magazine filled ...................... 133/

Ammunition .................................... A. P.-Incendiary Rate of fire (estimated) .................. Range ........................................ 400-600 r.p.m.

250 to 350 meters

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 March, 1945

216*1

7.7

om

EXPLOSIVE CARTRIDGE

JAPANESl E

PROJECTILE JACKET' HAMMERPROPELLING CHARGE L.ANVIL FELT WASHER PERCUSSION CAP INNER COMPARTMENT H. E. FILLING

This fixed round of ammunition consists of a brass cartridge


case and a high explosive projectile. The semi-rimless case is The top of

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber.....................
7.7 mm (.303 in.)

tapered, forming a neck which fits over the projectile.

the neck is coned into the cannelure of the bullet. 'The base of the case is recessed to take a simple percussion type primer, and the rest of the case is filled with a propelling charge of graphited nitrocellulose grains, about half of which, in the specimens examined, had a very fine axial perforation. The brass projectile is cylindrical in shape with a truncated

Weight of complete round.... 26.15 grms.-.915 oz.


Length of complete round ............ Length of cartridge case ........................ Weight of cartridge case (without percussion cap) ................ 14.93 grms.-.523 oz. ............ 10.69 grms.-.374 oz. 3 3/32 ins. 2 9/32 ins.

ogival nose. It contains a brass inner compartment, ogival in shape and open at the base, and a hammer consisting of a lead antimony plug encased in a brass sheath. open, the walls being turned in The rear of the projectile is to retain the hammer. also

Weight of projectile

Length of projectile ............................. Maximum diameter

1 15/32 ins. 0.310 in. 0.021 in.

....................................

Both .the

Thickness of main compartment walls...... Weight of main compartment Thickness ....................................

main projectile and the inner compartment. are filled with the explosive charge, a mixture of PETN and RDX. A white felt

2.95 grms.-.103 oz.

washer pressed into the base of the inner compartment protects the explosive charge from the effect of setback when the round is fired.

of inner compartment walls.... 0.008 in.

Weight of inner compartment..0.20 grms.-.007 oz. Height of inner compartment ................... 0.390 in.

When. the projectile strikes a target, the hammer in

the rear
Length of hammer ...................................... 0.700 in.

end sets forward crushing the explosive against the walls of both the inner
explode.

and

main

compartments,

causing

the

projectile

to

Weight of hammer ............... 6.65 grms,-.233 oz. Diameter of hammer ........................... :........ 0.258 in.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 April, 1945

221

20 mm AIRCRAFT AUTOMATIC CANNON, MODEL 99 Mk 1 FLEXIBLE

JAPANESE

This weapon is an air-cooled, blowback-operated, Oerlikon type machine cannon. It operates on the same basic principle as all Oerlikon cannons of this type. The Japanese gun is a close copy of the Swiss gun, in that it is designed for full automatic fire only. The gun is manufactured in Japan on Swiss machinery. The above illustration shows the flexible version. A significant feature is that the parts which are subjected to little wear, such as the grips, mounts, gunners' shoulder rest, and other exterior parts are generally made of light weight metal. This weapon is almost identical with other Model 99 (1939), 20 mm aircraft cannon reported to be used in the majority of Japanese planes, both as fixed guns in fighter craft, and as flexible guns in bombing planes. The weapon is fed from a drum type magazine. It is cocked or charged by manual means, and has no semiautomatic charger or rounds counter. The cocking handle is rotated to draw the recoiling parts to the rear and cock the gun for the first shot, the gun firing from an open bolt. Cocking operations for succeeding shots are performed by the blowback operation of the gun itself.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber .......................................... 20 mm-0.87 ins. Weight (without magazine) ........................ 62 lbs. Weight of 60 rd. magaine (empty).............. 20 lbs. Length (overall) ............................................. 55 ins.

Length of barrel ............................................ 30 ins. No. of grooves ............ 9; Uniform right hand twist Width of grooves ........................................... Depth of grooves ...................................... 0.022 in.

Width of lands ............................................ Muzzle velocity (shell) ............................ Cyclic rate ............................................. 1,930 f/s. 510 r.p.m.

Traverse ......................................... Flexible aircraft Length of recoil ............................................ Turns of cocking handle required to cock piece ........................................... 11 ins.

Ammunition........HE; HE with tracer; HE with selfdestroying tracer; HE-I; AP; AP tracer; AP-HEI; Long burning tracer; Practice Wt. of HE projectile ................................ 4.50 ozs.

Type of feed ......................................... 60 rd. drum

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 June, 1945

251

20 mm AIRCRAFT CANNON Ho 5 (BROWNING PRINCIPLE)

JAPANESE

This weapon, an improvement on the 12.7 mm Japanese copy of the U. S. Cal. .50 aircraft machine gun, is a recoil-operated, disintegrating metallic link belt-fed, air-cooled, aircraft machine cannon. It is mounted as a fixed weapon and as such it is fired electrically by remote control. The recoil mechanism consists of a metal cylinder into which is fitted a coil spring. Through the center of this extends a 5/16-inch rod which screws into a brass bushing. The rod extends through the spring follower which rests on the coil spring and is secured by two lock nuts. Buffering action takes place in the recoil direction only. There is no quick change barrel. Because of the weight of the bolt and the heavy recoil spring, a booster is used, th;s being found in the flash hider. The gun has a high cyclic rate of fire, muzzle velocities of 2,304 f/s (A.P.), 2,430 f/s (H.E.), and a penetration performance /-inch homogenous plate at 200 at 200 yards; /2-inch at 200 at of 7 580 yards. The maximum weight lifting capacity of the belt is 62 pounds. The disassembly of the weapon is the same as the Browning Cal. .30 and Cal. .50 machine guns with a few minor exceptions. The Japanese weapon has no back plate latch. The back plate is held in place by two pins, one at the top, and one at the bottom.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ............................................ 20 mm (0.79 in.) Weight w/accessories .................. 104-11/16 lbs. Weight w/o accessories .......................... 86 Length (overall) ........................................
Sight radius ................. ...................................

lbs.

63% ins.

Principle of operation..........Recoil with muzzle cup Feeding device .......................... Metal link belt type Capacity of feeding device ............... 100 rounds Cooling system ................................................. ..... Air

Ammunition types .................. A.P., H.E., Incendiary Cyclic rate ................................................ 950 r.p.m. Type of sight ............................................... Weight of barrel .................................... Length of barrel .......................................... Reflector 1/2Va lbs. 35.4 ins.

Length of rifling ........................................ 31.5 ins. Rifling

Tw ist ................................

.............................. R.H .

................... Form ................................ ........... . 8 No. of grooves ........................................ Depth of grooves ........................................ Width of grooves ....................................... Chamber pressure ......................................... Muzzle velocity (A.P. Shot) ...................... 2304 f/s

(H.E. Shell)....................
Effective

2,430 f/s

range .......................................... 600 yds.

1 June, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

20 mm AIRCRAFT MACHINE GUN (MODIFIED MODEL 97 ANTITANK GUN)

JAPANESE

This Japanese 20 mm aircraft gun is a modified version of the Model 97 antitank gun described on page 101. It is a gasoperated, full-automatic, magazine-fed, air-cooled weapon. The barrel, of monobloc construction, is fitted with a muzzle brake and attached to the receiver by means of a bushing of the interrupted screw type. The magazine fits into a rectangular opening in the top of the receiver, and the empty cartridge cases are ejected from a similar opening in the bottom. The ejector is secured to the underside of the receiver top just behind the magazine opening. The operation of the aircraft version of this gun is similar to that of the antitank rifle. The six phases are: loading, locking, firing, unlocking, extraction, and ejection. The first three occur on the counterrecoil, and the last three on the recoil. The gun is cocked the first time by pulling the retracting handle to the rear. This retracts the operating group to the position where the sear will engage the gas piston and hold it to the rear. After the magazine is inserted and locked in place, the gun is ready to fire. The gun was mounted in the dorsal turret of the Bomber "Helen" on a semicircular-shaped rack, and is fixed to the rack by the lower left hand edge of the receiver. The rack is used for elevating the gun. The gun and mount are in turn mounted on the turret ring. The sight used on this gun is a reflector type sight and it is believed that there is provision made for deflection shooting. A fixed version has also been reported. Documentary evidence discloses that the ammunition for the turret gun is referred to as HO1 and the fixed as H93.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ............................................ 20 mm (.79 in.)
Weight (without mount) .............................. 74 lbs.

Length (with muzzle brake) .................. 68/ ins. (without muzzle brake) .............. 671/4 ins.
Sight radius ................................ Capacity of feeding device .............. Gas Principle of operation ........................................

Magazine, 15 rds. Inverted saddle type, 50 rds.


Cooling system ................................................. Air Ammunition types ............ AP/T: HE/T: HE/I; Ball Rate of fire (estimated).................. 300 rds. per min. Type of sight ............................................ Reflector Weight of barrel .......................................... Length of barrel ............................................ 47 ins. Length of rifling (approx.) ............................ Rifling Tw ist Form 42 ins.

...................... ...................................... ..................... .......................................

No. of lands & grooves ......................................


Depth of grooves ...................................... Width of grooves ...................................... Chamber pressure ..........................................

Muzzle velocity (estimated)..2,500-2,900 ft. per sec. Muzzle energy ............................................. Effective range ...................................... 1,000 yds. Type of mount ...................... Dorsal turret and fixed

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

253

20 mm AIRCRAFT CANNON TYPE 99 Mk. II

JAPANESE

This is a gun of higher power than the Type 99 Mk. I, 20 mm cannon. Like the earlier gun, it operates on the Oerlikon principle and is found both with drum type magazine feed (Mod. III-top photo) and with belt feed (Mod. IV-lower photo). The principal differences between this model and the Mk. I consist of a longer barrel and a longer chamber. The barrel protrudes 18 inches beyond the leading edge when mounted in the wings of fighter aircraft. The projectiles used are identical to the Mark I, but the cartridge employed contains approximately 40% more propellant than the older type, thereby increasing the velocity of the Mk. II 500 to 700 foot seconds. The muzzle velocity of the weapon varies from 2,500 to 2,700 foot seconds depending upon the type of projectile used. The gun has been found in ZEKEs and HAMPs. It is probably fitted in RUFEs and as a flexible gun in the tail turret of BETTY.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber .......................................... 20 mm (.787 in.)
Weight of gun ............................................. 67 lbs.

Length of gun (overall) ................................ 73 ins. Length of barrel ......................................... Length of rifling .......................................... 47 ins. 41.5 ins. 9

Number of grooves ...............................................

Depth of grooves ....................................... 0.026 in. Twist of rifling ....................................... Right hand Principle of operation ............................ Blow back Feeding device .......................... French drum or belt Capacity of drum ...................................... 100 rds.

Cooling system ................................................. Air Sights .............................................. Reflector type

Charging mechanism ................................ Pneumatic Firing system .................................... Flexible cable Effective range (est.) .......................... Rate of fire (est.) ............................ 600-700 yds. 400-500 r.p.m.

Ammunition............................Ball, A.P., A.P./I., T., H.E., H.E./T., H.E./I.

254

August,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

CONICAL ANTITANK HOLLOW CHARGE HAND GRENADE

JAPANESE

ADAPTER

EXPLOSIVE CHARGE

This Japanese antitank grenade consists of a Pentalite (50/50 TNT & PETN) explosive charge cast around a thin aluminum cone, a wooden stand-off head, a fuze, and a tail attachment. The explosive charge, which is shaped in the form of a hollow truncated cone, has a covering of thin waxed paper and a well in the upper end to receive the booster of the fuze. A cast ring pellet surrounds the cyclonite booster. The fuze, an all-ways impact type, is constructed in two parts which are threaded together. It will not function unless the mine has attained a velocity of approximately forty feet per second, and strikes a hard surface. The wooden base provides proper stand-off distance and has a central hole of slightly smaller diameter than that of the cone. The grenade is encased in a silk bag, either white or olive drab in color, and closed by a draw-string at the bottom. A tail made of hemp is tied around the top of the grenade to provide stability in flight. The device, which will penetrate about 2 inches of armor plate, should be thrown from a distance of approximately ten meters. A modified version of this grenade, referred to as the Type B, has been recovered. It differs from the grenade previously encountered in the Philippines in the following respects: it is smaller, the cover is yellow silk instead of canvas, the fuze is screwed into a metal seat on top of the mine, the fuze body is metal with a single-pronged safety pin, and the detonator tube is larger. According to reports, there is also a larger grenade of the same type which has a Type 94 explosive charge.

SPECIFICATIONS
Large Grenade Small Grenade
Length of grenade.............. 6/4 ins. Length of tail...................... 14 ins. Diameter at base.............. Length of fuze.................. Length of cone.................. Diameter of cone............ Cone angle, apex...................... 4/ 1/ 3
7

5 /s ins.

ins. ins. ins.


7

4 ins. 1/ 2% ins. ins.

2/8 ins. 30

2 ins.

Weight complete ............ 1.25 kg. Weight of grenade Weight of fuze .......... 1.14 kg.

.84 kg. .76 kg. 42.3 grams .60 kg. 42.5 grams 50.0 grams 5.1 grams

............ 42.3 grams

Weight of explosive .......... .87 kg. Weight of cone .......... 141.7 grams Weight of base .......... Weight of booster .... 56.7 grams 5.1 grams

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE

CIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 April, 1945

304.1

POTTERY HAND GRENADE

JAPANESE

This hand grenade, made of terra cotta,

and, like the

Model 3 Flower Pot Land Mine, filled with Type 88 explosive,


SCRATCH BLOCK MATCH COMPOSITION CARRYING

BAND

is assumed to be a Navy weapon. Except for the neck at the top, it is spherical, consisting of two halves baked together.
It is out. light brown, in The grenade is color, and lightly glazed both inside and encased in a straw-colored, waterproof

RUBBER COVERINGS WOODEN COLLAR

RUBBER TUBEou.Teiinwtrof
'^

DELAY ELEMENT
INITIATOR

rubber sack. The ignition system consists of a match composition and


scratch block, a 4-5-second delay element, a lead azide initiator, and a tetryl booster. All are encased in a rubber

BOOSTER

BODY POTTERY

tube except the match composition which is

lacquered into

the neck of the grenade. In order to operate the grenade, the small rubber covering is removed from the top and the scratch block is struck on the protruding match composition, igniting the delay element.

SPECIFICATIONS
Height (base to top of neck) ........................................ Diameter..................... Total weight............................................... Weight of explosive ........................................ .................... 99 mm-3.9 ins. 79 mn-3.1 ins. 1 lb. 100 grams-3.5 ozs. 7/16 inch

Pottery thickness ........................................

HIGH EXPLOSIVE RIFLE GRENADE MODEL 3


This grenade, designed to be fired from Models 38 and 99 rifles by means of a spigot launcher and wooden bullet, is similar in use and operation to the Model 91 rifle grenade. However, it is smaller and has a smooth-wall body rather than the serrated type. It contains a cyclonite primer enclosed in a brass container, a tetryl booster, and a three-ounce bursting charge of cast TNT; it is also fitted with an instantaneous fuze and a tail assembly with four fins spot welded to the rear part of the tube. The grenade is armed by the removal of a safety fork. On impact, an inertia block is forced into the fuze body shearing a brass shear wire and driving the firing pin into the detonator.

SPECIFICATIONS
Diameter of grenade body ........................................ 1.63 ins. 2.43 Ins. Length of grenade body ........................................ 1/s in. Wall thickness............................................. 7.88 ins. Overall length of grenade ........................................ Weight of grenade without explosive ........................................ 14 ez. Weight of explosive body without explosive ........................................ 10 ozs. Length of fin assembly ....................... 4 15/16 Ins. 1 13/16 ins. ......................................... Outside diameter of tube Inside diameter of tube ........................................ 1 1/16 ins. Width of tail assembly ........................................ 21/ ins. Length of tail fin......................................... 23/ ins. Width of tail fin ....................................... ....................... in. Material of construction ........................................ Steel Weight of main charge ........................................ 3 ozs. Weight of primer........................................... 3 qr. Weight of booster..........................................1 r.

304.2

1 April, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ANTI-VEHICULAR YARDSTICK MINE

JAPANESE

This Japanese land mine, of Naval origin, is usually found buried in landing strips. Almost any vehicle will activate the mine, but its use as an anti-personnel device is limited since a pressure of approximately 336 pounds is necessary to set it off. The mine consists of an oval shaped tube of sheet metal with a cap on both ends; an explosive charge comprising eight blocks of picric acid, each cast in a paper container and coated with paraffin; and four percussion type fuzes. The picric acid blocks which are flattened on one side do not fill the mine completely. The space between the flat side of the blocks and the wall of the case accommodates the protruding heads of the fuzes which are inserted between blocks. The percussion type fuze consists of a cylindrical body which houses the striker release plunger, a booster housing, and a striker housing. The two latter parts are identical in external appearance and screw into the sides of the main body diametrically opposite each other. The striker release plunger, a split pin with an enlarged flat head, is positioned in the fuze body by a copper shear wire. A second hole 90 degrees from the shear wire hole accommodates a safety wire. The lower end of the plunger is split by a slot, the width of which is increased on the inner end. The mine is held in an unarmed position by the safety wire which is inserted through a hole in one of the end caps, and extends the entire length of the mine. A spring clip on the cap holds the wire in place. When the mine is to be put into operation, the safety wire is removed and a burying plug is screwed into the hole in the cap to make the assembly waterproof. A thick tarry substance is applied to-the seams around the end caps probably for the same purpose.

SPECIFICATIONS
Length (overall) ......................................... Diameter (oval) .............................. 36 ins. 3.35 x 1.8 ins. 10.58 lbs.

Total weight ................. .......................

Weight of mine .......................................... 4.63 lbs. W eight of filling ........................................ 5.95 lbs. Weight of each explosive block .................... /4 lb.

Filling ........................................................ Picric acid Weight of complete fuze ........................... . .29 lb.

Color................Brown outside; black lacquer inside

RESTRICTED

(Replacement Page)

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 March, 1945

308*1

NAVY TYPE 3 (FLOWER POT) LAND MINE-SMALL

JAPANESE

SAFETY PIN

_-

MINE WALL

COVER

vH
^ e,/'

EXPLOSIVE CONTAINER

The mine case, made of earth-colored terra-cotta, has a thin dull glaze on its outer surface and a highly glazed inner surface. A light rubber bag inside the body contains a Type 88 explosive filler. It is believed that the bursting charge may be a mixture of 50% ammonium nitrate and 50% TNT, or 90% ammonium nitrate and 10% dinitronapthalene. The fuze which is interchangeable with the standard Type 88 and Type 100 artillery fuzes (thereby permitting the use of artillery projectiles as land mines) screws into a rubber seat sealed in place in the mine. Fuze body, cover, plunger, and striker holder are made of bakelite; the springs, percussion hammer, striker, and release fork are of metal construction. Because so few of the components are made of ferrous materials, it probably would be difficult to locate the mine with a magnetic type detector. When rigged, the fuze is fired either by pressure or by pull. The percussion hammer, located within the fuze, is held in place by a release fork to which a trip wire may be attached. When the wire is pulled, the fork releases the hammer which is forced downward by the hammer spring. The hammer comes in contact with the striker forcing it through its bakelite holder into the percussion cap. When pressure is applied directly on the head of the fuze, the plunger spring is compressed causing the hammer release fork to bear on the cover. As the plunger spring is further compressed, the hammer head cams out the fork. It then fires as above.

SPECIFICATIONS
Weight of mine (fuzed) ................. 11 lbs., 6 ozs. Diameter (maximum) ................................ 220 mm* Height (without fuze) ................................ 105 mm Height (fuzed) .......................................... 157.5 mm Explosive filling ........................................ Type 88

Weight of explosive ........................ 4 lbs., 8 ozs. Length of fuze ............................................. 65 mm

Weight of fuze (without booster) ............ 56 grams * According to reports, there is a larger mine of this same type. It is 270 mm in diameter, but has the same height as the smaller mine. It is said to contain 61/2 pounds of explosive.

308 2

1 March, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ANTITANK "LUNGE"

MINE

JAPANESE

This suicide mine, an antitank device used by Japanese Closequarter Combat Units, consists of a conical-shaped hollow charge encased in a steel container, and a wooden handle. Three legs equally spaced around the base of the charge provide proper stand-off distance. A well in the apex of the charge contains the detonator. The firing mechanism, quite simple in construction, consisting of a needle type striker, a shear pin, and a safety pin, is housed in a metal sleeve. This sleeve, which holds the mine"and the handle 2.4 inches apart, slips over the end of the handle and is held in place by the shear pin and safety pin; it is attached to the body of the mine by a threaded connecting ring. To operate the mine, the soldier must first remove the safety pin, and then, using bayonet tactics, lunge forward striking the mine squarely against the tank. When the legs of the mine strike the target, the handle is driven forward breaking the shear pin, and the striker is driven into the detonator, initiating explosion of the mine. Reports indicate that when head-on contact is made, the mine will penetrate 6 inches of steel plate; with contact at a 600 angle, steel plates of approximately 4 inches can be penetrated.
PLATEBOTTOM

r]

D
ins. ins. ins. ins. lbs. ins. lbs.

SPECIFICATIONS
Length of mine body (approx.) .................. 12 Diameter of base of body (approx.) .......... 8 Length of handle ...................... .................... 59 Diameter of handle .................................. 11/4 Weight of explosive charge .................... 62 Length of legs ......................................... 51/4 Weight of mine (total) .............................. 14.3

' ;di f

*% ;01
UllK,

K1
-

:i:
14. eq

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

May,

1945

308.31

81 mm ANTIAIRCRAFT MORTAR PROJECTILE

JAPANESE

PROPELLANT

DELAY ELEMENT

HIGH

CYLINDER

NOSE PLUG

PRIMER

PROPELLANT CONTAINER

EJECTING CHARGE

PARACHUTES

This antiaircraft projectile, fired from the 81 mm barrage mortar, is composed of three sections. The rear portion consists of a primer, black powder charge, propelling charge, 15-second delay train, and a black powder ejecting charge. The explosive cylinder, or middle section, comprises a 40-second delay pellet in a central cylinder and three H.E. pellets cast around the delay element. The forward end section contains a wooden nose plug, two parachutes, and a suspension cord. The projectile is slid down the mortar tube in a manner similar to the firing of a standard mortar shell. Upon striking the firing pin, the primer is ignited, and it, in turn, sets off the loose black powder in the base of the round. The black powder ignites the propellant and the 15-second delay train. The shell is propelled from the mortar and continues in flight until the delay train ignites the ejecting charge which forces out the wooden nose plug, the two parachutes, the suspension cord, and the explosive cylinder. At the same time, the 40-second delay pellet is ignited. The explosive cylinder is suspended by a small parachute attached to the cylinder by 12-inch strands, and by a larger parachute attached to the cylinder by the 30-foot suspension cord. The end of the suspension cord is covered with match com-

position and acts as a pull igniter. If an airplane strikes the suspension cord of the floating high explosive assembly, the jerk on the cord pulls the end of the cord through the primer, causing detonation of the high explosive. If the pull igniter is not functioned, the burning train of the 40-second delay pellet reaches the detonator and sets off the explosive cylinder. An 81 mm flare shell, identical in external appearance except for color markings, is also used. It contains two parachutes and a flare, apparently of a magnesium composition. When the projectile is in flight, a 15second delay train sets off an ejecting charge of black powder which forces out the nose plug, parachutes, and flare. The burning of the ejecting charge ignites the flare, which floats earthward on the parachutes.

SPECIFICATIONS
Caliber ..................................................... Length (overall) ......................... ........................... ........... 81 mm ............. .. 213/ ins.
............... . 1 9/16 ins. in. x 4 ins.

Diameter of cylinder ............................... Size of fins ................................. ..............................

Color ..............................................................

Black with tan nose plug

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May,

1945

310.1

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

7 cm (70 mm)

MODEL 92 HE
P. 107

7 cm (75 mm)

MODEL 90 HE POINTED AA
P. 110 P. 110

WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 92 Howitzer ............................... 7 cm Model 94 Tank Gun .............................. PROJECTILE: Caliber-70 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-8.4 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-1.30 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None FUZES: Model 88 Instantaneous (Howitzer-Mortar Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Howitzer-Mortar Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Gun Type) Nose Fuze

WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 88 Field AA Gun ....................... 7 cm Model 88 Field AA Gun (Special) ............... PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind--Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-14.4 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-0.85 lb. Kind-T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None

FUZES: Model 89 Time (Powder Train) Nose Fuze and Auxiliary Fuze

REMARKS-Captured documents indicate that the Gun Type Fuze is used when this projectile is fired from the tank gun and that the Howitzer-Mortar Type Fuze is used when this projectile is fired from the howitzer.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May,

1945

319

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

7 cm (75 mm) MODEL 90 HE POINTED


WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun ............................. 7 cm Model 88 Field AA Gun (Special) ................. PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-14.0 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-1.19 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None FUZES: Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Gun Type) Nose Fuze REMARKS-This projectile has two rotating bands and a bourrelet band. P. 111 P. 110

7 cm (75 mm) MODEL 90 HE POINTED


WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 38 Field Gun .............................. 7 cm Model 41 Cavalry Gun ....................... 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun ............................... 7 cm Model 95 Field Gun .......................... 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun ........................... 7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun ........................... 7 cm Model 88 Field AA Gun (Special) .................. PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-14.0 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one white and one yellow Charge: Weight-1.19 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None P. 108 P. P. P. P. P. 108 113 111 112 110

FUZES: Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Gun Type) Nose Fuze REMARKS-This projectile has one rotating band and a bourrelet band

320

1 May, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

7 cm (75 mm) MODEL 90 HE POINTED


WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 38 Field Gun ............................. 7 cm Model 41 Cavalry Gun ............................ 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun ...................... 7 cm Model 95 Field Gun .............................. 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun ........................... 7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun .......................... ................ 7 cm Model 88 Field AA Gun (Special) PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-14.0 Ibs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-1.19 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None FUZES: Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Gun Type) Nose Fuze REMARKS-This projectile has one rotating band and does not have a bourrelet band. P. 108 P. P. P. P. P. 108 113 111 112 110

7 cm (75 mm)

MODEL 94 HE
P. 108 P. P. P. P. P. P. 108 113 111 109 112 110

WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 38 Field Gun .............................. 7 cm 41 Cavalry Gun .................................. 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun ...................... 7 cm Model 95 Field Gun ............................. 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun .............................. 7 cm Model 41 Mountain Gun ........................... 7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun ........................... 7 cm Model 88 Field AA Gun (Special) ................. 7 cm Model 11 Field AA Gun .......................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-13.3 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-1.78 lbs. Kind-Mixture of Ammonium Nitrate, Guanidine Nitrate, ite, or TNT Tracer-None FUZES: Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Gun Type) Nose Fuze

Cyclon-

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May,

1945

321

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

7 cm (75 mm)

MODEL 97 HE SEMI-STEEL
P. 108 P. 108 P. 113 P. 109

7 cm (75 mm) MODEL 98 MODIFIED HE


WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 38 Field Gun ................................ P. 108 7 cm Model 41 Cavalry Gun ........................... 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun ...................... P. 108 7 cm Model 95 Field Gun .............................. P. 113 7 cm Model 41 Mountain Gun .......................... P. 109 PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with fuze)-10.1 lbs. Color-Black with the nose painted white Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-2 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None FUZES: Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Gun Type) Nose Fuze REMARKS-The shell body for this projectile has been converted from shrapnel to HE by the addition of a heavy steel nose. Although suspected, it is not known definitely that this projectile is used in the 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun, the 7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun, and the 7 cm Model 88 Field AA Gun (Special)

WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 38 Field Gun ............................ 7 cm Model 41 Cavalry Gun ......................... 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun ..................... 7 cm Model 95 Field Gun ............................. 7 cm Model 41 Mountain Gun .......................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-13.4 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One green or one yellow and one green Charge: Weight-0.86 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None FUZES: Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Gun Type) Nose Fuze

REMARKS-Although suspected it is not known definitely that this projectile is used in the 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun, the 7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun, and the 7 cm Model 88 Field AA Gun (Special)

322

May,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

75 mm HE (DUTCH)
WEAPONS: 75 mm Dutch Bofors ................................. PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-14.67 lbs. Color-Yellow Charge: Weight-1.4 lbs. Kind-Picric Tracer-None FUZE: Selective Super Quick or Short Delay Nose Fuze REMARKS-Inasmuch as quantities of this ammunition and weapons have been captured by the Japanese, it may be used against our troops

7 cm (75 mm)

MODEL 1 APHE
P. 108 P. P. P. P. P. 108 113 111 112 109

WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 38 Field Gun ............................ 7 cm Model 41 Cavalry Gun .......................... 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun .................... 7 cm Model 95 Field Gun .............................. 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun ............................. 7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun ........................... 7 cm Model 41 Mountain Gun ........................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-APHE Weight (with Fuze)-14.6 lbs. Color-Black Bands--One white Charge: Weight-0.17 lbs. Kind-Mixture of cyclonite and wax has been found Tracer-Yes FUZE: Model 1 Medium Short Delay Base Fuze

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

323

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

7 cm (75 mm) MODEL 2 HOLLOW CHARGE


WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 41 Mountain Gun .......................... 7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun ........................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-Hollow Charge Weight (with Fuze)-8.21 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow Charge: Weight-1.2 lbs. Kind-Mixture of Cyclonite and T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None FUZE: Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type) Nose Fuze REMARKS-Although suspected, it is not projectile is used in the 7 cm Model 38 Cavalry Gun, 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun, 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun, AA Gun (Special) known definitely that this Field Gun, 7 cm Model 41 Field Gun, 7 cm Model 95 and 7 cm Model 88 Field P. 109 P. 112

7 cm (75 mm)
WEAPONS:
7 cm

MODEL 90 SHRAPNEL
............................ P. 108 P. P. P. P. P. 108 113 109 111 112

Model 38 Field Gun

7 cm Model 41 Cavalry Gun .......................... 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun ...................... 7 cm Model 95 Field Gun ..............................
7 cm Model 41 Mountain Gun ...........................

7 cm Model 90 Field Gun

7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun

.............................. ...........................

PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shrapnel Weight (with Fuze)-15.4 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-0.22 lb. Kind-Black powder Tracer-None FUZE: Model 5 Combination Time and Percussion Nose Fuze REMARKS-This projectile contains 268 (approximately lead balls 5.5 lbs.)

324

1 May, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

7 cm (75 mm)

INCENDIARY
P. 108 P. P. P. P. P. 108 113 111 109 112

7 cm (75 mm) MODEL 90 SMOKE (WP)


WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 38 Field Gun .............................. 7 cm Model 41 Cavalry Gun ............................ 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun ...................... 7 cm Model 95 Field Gun ........................... 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun .............................. 7 cm Model 41 Mountain Gun .......................... 7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun ........................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell P. P. P. P. P. P.

WEAPONS: 7 cm Model 38 Field Gun ............................ 7 cm Model 41 Cavalry Gun ............................ 7 cm Modified Model 38 Field Gun ...................... 7 cm Model 95 Field Gun ............................. 7 cm Model 90 Field Gun .............................. 7 cm Model 41 Mountain Gun .......................... 7 cm Model 94 Mountain Gun ..........................

PROJECTILE:
Caliber-75 mm Kind-Shell Type-Incendiary Weight (with Fuze)-12.1 lbs. Color-Gray Bands-None Charge: Weight-Approx. 1.5 lbs. Kind-Solution of white phosphorus and rubber pellets in carbon disulphide Tracer-None FUZE: Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type) REMARKS-The model number of this projectile has not been determined

Type-Smoke
Weight (with Fuze)-12.6 lbs Color-White Bands-None Charge: Smoke-1.54 lbs. of white Phosphorus Bursting-0.22 lb. of Picric Acid and Dinitronaphthalene Tracer-None FUZE: Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type)

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May,

1945

325

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

8 cm (3 inch) HE AA [NAVAL]
WEAPONS: 8 cm AA Gun [Naval] .................................. PROJECTILE: Caliber-3 inches Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-13.5 lbs. Color-Maroon body with green nose Charge: Weight-0.97 lb. Kind-Picric has been found Tracer-None FUZE: Navy Time Nose Fuze (Powder train)* REMARKS-The model number of the projectile and that of the gun from which fired have not been determined. * The model number of the fuze has not been determined. However the design is identical to the Army Type 89 fuze, the only difference being that this fuze has Navy inspection stampings.

8 cm (3 INCH) HE [NAVAL]
WEAPONS: 8 cm Low Angle Gun [Naval] ........................... PROJECTILE: Caliber--3 inches Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze and booster)-13.8 lbs. Color-Maroon body with green nose Charge: Weight-1.38 lbs. Kind-Picric has been found Tracer-None FUZE: Navy Model 5 Nose Fuze REMARKS-The model number of the projectile and that of the gun from which fired have not been determined.

326

May,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

54

'13THIDS. IPER INCH 114 THD05. (PERINCH ___1.25 IA. 300 -. DIA.

"98 o.4 3.71

33-+
1

1 5
.10

SMARKING SYSTEM

- ERINCH
1.22 IA.

A
11 -25

IN INI.II5S

[ FIPVNANC f~t G

A(S

8 cm (81 mm) MODEL 100 HE MORTAR


WEAPONS: 8 cm Model 97 Mortar ................................ PROJECTILE: Caliber-8 1 mm Kind-Mortar Shell Type--HE Weight (without Fuze and propelling charge)-6.75 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow Charge : Weight-1.18 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found FUZE: Model 100 Mortar Fuze P. 122

8 cm (81 mm) MODEL 98 HE MORTAR


WEAPONS: 8 cm Model 97 Mortar ............................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-8 1 mm Kind-Mortar Shell Type-HE Weight (without Fuze and Propellingt Charge)-6.84 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge : Weight-1.09 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. FUZE: Model 93 Mortar Fuze P. 122

RESTRICTED

RESTRICTED CHIEF ~OFFICEORDNANCE1My,14

6OF

1 May,

1945

327

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

8 cm (81 mm)

HE MORTAR [NAVAL]
P. 122.1

8 cm (88 mm) MODEL 100 HE POINTED AA


WEAPONS: 8 cm Model 99 AA Gun ............................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-88 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-19.9 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow Charge: Weight-1.98 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None FUZE: Model 100 Mechanical Time Nose Fuze

WEAPONS: 8 cm Model 3 Mortar [Naval] .......................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-81 mm Kind-Mortar Shell Type-HE Weight (without Fuze)-6.99 lbs. Color-Black with red and green nose Bands-None Charge: Weight-Approximately 1.12 lbs. Kind-Picric acid and Dinitronaphthalene (Tridite) FUZE: Naval Mortar Fuze

REMARKS-The model number of this projectile and that of the fuze have not been determined.

328

May,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

9 cm (90 mm) MODEL 94 HE MORTAR


WEAPONS: 9 cm Model 94 Light Infantry Mortar .................... 9 cm Model 97 Mortar ................................. PROJECTILE: Caliber-90 mm Kind-Mortar Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze-without Propelling Charge)-11.6 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-2.36 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found FUZE: Model 93 Mortar Fuze .P. 124 P. 125

9 cm (90 mm) HE MORTAR SEMI-STEEL


WEAPONS: 9 cm Model 94 Light Infantry Mortar .................... 9 cm Model 97 Mortar ................................. PROJECTILE: Caliber-90 mm Kind-Mortar Shell Type-HE WeightColor-Black Bands--One green or one yellow and one green Charge: WeightKindFUZE: Model 93 Mortar Fuze P. 124 P. 125

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

May, 1945

329

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

10 cm (105 mm) MODEL 91 HE POINTED


WEAPONS: P. 114 10 cm Model 91 Howitzer ............................... P. 115 10 cm Model 92 Gun .................................. ... 10 cm Model 14 Gun ............................ 10 cm Model 38 Gun ................................. PROJECTILE: Caliber-105 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-34.65 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-5.55 lbs. Kind-Mixture of Ammonium Nitrate, Guanidine Nitrate, Cyclonite, or TNT Tracer-None FUZES: Model 88 Instantaneous (Howitzer-Mortar Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Howitzer-Mortar Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Instantaneous (Gun Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Gun Type) Nose Fuze REMARKS-Captured documents indicate that the howitzer type fuze is used when this projectile is fired from a howitzer and that a gun type fuze is used when this projectile is fired from a gun.

10 cm (105 mm) MODEL 91 HE


WEAPONS: 10 cm Model 10 cm Model 10 cm Model 10 cm Model 91 92 14 38 Howitzer ............................. Gun ................................... Gun ................................ Gun ................................ P. 114 P. 115

PROJECTILE: Caliber-105 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-35.3 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-5 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found FUZES: Model Model Model Model 88 88 88 88 Instantaneous (Howitzer-Mortar Type) Nose Fuze Short Delay (Howitzer-Mortar Type) Nose Fuze Instantaneous (Gun Type) Nose Fuze Short Delay (Gun Type) Nose Fuze

REMARKS-Captured documents indicate that the howitzer type fuze is used when this projectile is fired from a howitzer and that a gun type fuze is used when this projectile is fired from a gun.

330

May,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

7.20

14.17

3.83

.37

1.97 80 ....... ...... _

53. 9 dt 16 I 641

"

10

Ali.

,'. '7Y

NSN

IN

1N('HFS
f8P.<NANrFWEPT

^.

12 cm (120 mm) HE AA [NAVAL]


WEAPONS: 12 cm Model 11 AA Gun [Naval] PROJECTILE: Caliber-120 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight-(with Fuze)-45.5 lbs. Color-Maroon Body with green nose Bands-None Charge: Weight-3.7 lbs. Kind-Trinitroanisole Tracer-None FUZE: Navy Model 91 Mechanical Time Nose Fuze REMARKS--The model number of the projectile has not been determined. There are three known modifications of the Model 91 Fuze, giving four fuses, called Model 91, each varying only slightly from the others. ........................

12 cm (120 mm) HE [NAVAL]


WEAPONS: 12 cm Low Angle Gun [Naval] PROJECTILE: Caliber-120 mm Kind-Shell Type--SHE Weight (without Fuze)-45.37 lbs. Color-Maroon body with green nose Bands-One yellow Charge: Weight-3.92 lbs. Kind--4Picric acid has been found Tracer-None FUZES: Navy Model 88 Nose Fuse Navy Model 5 Nose Fuse REMARKS--When the Navy Model 5 Nose Fuse is used an adapter (brass) is necessary. The Model number of the projectile and that of the gun from which fired have not been determined. ..........................

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

May,

1945

331

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

12 cm (120 mm) HE [NAVAL]


WEAPONS: 12 cm Low Angle Gun [Naval] ..........................

12.7 cm (127 mm) HE AA [NAVAL]


WEAPONS: 12.7 cm AA Gun [Naval] ...............

PROJECTILE: Caliber-120 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE (Base Fuzed) Weight (with Fuze)-45.12 lbs. Color-Maroon body with red and green nose Bands-One yellow Charge: Weight-4.6 lbs. Kind-Picric acid Tracer-None FUZE: Model 3rd Year Base Fuze REMARKS--The model number of the projectile and that of the gun from which fired have not been determined.

PROJECTILE: Caliber-127 mm. Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)- -50.8 lbs. Color-Maroon body with green nose Bands-None Charge: Weight-4.15 lbs. Kind-Picric acid Tracer-None FUZE: Navy Model 91 Mechanical Time Nose F.uze REMARKS -The model number of the projectile and that of the gun have not been determined. There are three known modifications of the Model 91 fuze giving four fuzes called Model 91, each varying only slightly from the others.

332

May,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

14 cm (140 mm) HE [NAVAL]


WEAPONS: 14 cm Low Angle Gun [Naval] .......................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-140 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE WeightColor-Maroon body with green nose Bands-None Charge: WeightKindTracer-None FUZE: Navy Model 88 Nose Fuze REMARKS-The model number of the projectile and that of the gun from which fired have not been determined.

14 cm (140 mm) HE [NAVAL]


WEAPONS: 14 cm Low Angle Gun [Naval] .......................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-140 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE (Base Fuzed) Weight (with Fuze)-84 lbs. Color-Maroon body with red and green nose Bands-None Charge: WeightKind-Picric Acid Tracer-None FUZE: Navy Base Detonating Fuze REMARKS-The model number of the projectile, that of the gun, and that of the fuze have not been determined.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 Ma,

1945

333

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

3.75

3.05

507

8B mDS PER INCH

15THDS.
rPER INCH !9 THDS. iPER INCH I20

242.92

kit DfMErJljl(

OI1DHANC

pp

rS AE.f.

14 cm (140 mm)
WEAPONS:

HE-CAPPED CNAVAL]
..........................

15 cm
WEAPONS:

(150 mm)

MODEL 92 HE
P. 116

14 cm Low Angle Gun [Naval] PROJECTILE: Caliber-140 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE (Base Fuzed) WeightColor-Maroon and green Bands-One yellow

15 cm Model 4 Howitzer ............................... 15 cm Model 38 Howitzer............................ PROJECTILE: Caliber-150 mm Kind-Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-79.5 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-16.9 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found Tracer-None FUZES:

Charge:
WeightKind Tracer-None.

FUZE:
Navy Base Detonating Fuze REMARKS-The model number of the projectile, that of the gun from which fired, and that of the fuze have not been determined.

Model 88 Instantaneous (Howitzer.Mortar Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Howitzer-Mortar Type) Nose Fuze REMARKS-It is not known definitely but it is expected that this projectile can be fired from the 15 cm Model 96 Howitzer.

334

May,

1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

15 cm (150 mm) MODEL 13 SMOKE (WP)


WEAPONS: 15 cm Model 4 Howitzer ............................... 15 cm Model 38 Howitzer ............................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-150 mm Kind-Shell Type-Smoke Weight (with Fuze)-73.9 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: 9.9 lbs. of white phosphorus 2.4 lbs. of Picric Acid Tracer-None FUZES: Model 88 Instantaneous (Howitzer-Mortar Type) Nose Fuze Model 88 Short Delay (Howitzer-Mortar Type) Nose Fuze REMARKS-The white phosphorus is inclosed in a brass can. The picric acid burster is in the nose. It is not known definitely but it is expected that this projectile can be fired from the 15 cm Model 96 Howitzer. P. 116

15 cm (150 mm) MODEL 96 HE MORTAR


WEAPONS: 15 cm Model 96 Medium Mortar .......................... PROJECTILE: Caliber-150 mm Kind-Mortar Shell Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-56.6 lbs. Color-Black Bands-One yellow or one yellow and one white Charge: Weight-13 lbs. Kind-T.N.T. has been found FUZE: Model 93 Mortar Fuze REMARKS-The Model 96 is called a medium mortar although it is 150 mm.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 May, 1945

335

ARTILLERY AMMUNITION

JAPANESE

20 cm (203.2 mm) ROCKET


WEAPONS: Trough Type Launcher .................................. PROJECTILE: Caliber-203.2 mm Kind-Rocket Type-HE Weight (with Fuze)-195 lbs. Color-Maroon Charge: Weight-34.4 lbs. Kind-Trinitroanisole Propellent-18.6 lbs. of double base powder FUZE: Point Detonating Nose Fuze REMARKS-The model number of the rocket and that of the fuze have not been determined. The rocket is spin stabilized by inclined nozzles in the base. The case for the HE head is the same as the projectile body on 20 cm Naval HE Shell and may have a rotating band seat although there is no rotating band. Rockets have been found both with and without the seat. P. 352

336

1 May, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

PROJECTILE P. D. FUZES

JAPANESE

Type 93 Small Instantaneous Nose Fuze USE: 20 mm and 37 mm guns. Superseded by Type 100 Small Instantaneous Fuze. OPERATION: The striker is held away from the primer by a spring-loaded forked detent which moves out by centrifugal force. A pivoted shutter, which blocks the flash channel is also
forced aside by centrifugal force.

TYPE 93 INSTANTANEOUS

SMALL

NOSE FUZE

Type 100 Small Instantaneous Nose Fuze USE: 20 mm and 37 mm guns. Supersedes Type 93 Small Instantaneous Fuze. OPERATION: Arms by centrifugal force similar to Type 93 Small Instantaneous Fuze, except that it doesn't have a centrifugal shutter.
TYPE 100 SMALL INSTANTANEOUS NOSE FUZE

Type 88 Instantaneous Nose Fuze (Gun and Howitzer Types) USE: 47 mm, 70 mm, 75 mm, 105 mm, 150 mm guns and howitzers. Interchangeable with Type 88 Short Delay Nose Fuze. OPERATION: The striker is held off the primer by four safety blocks surrounded by a ferrule and the arming collar. The arming collar moves down on setback and is held down by the stirrup spring. Centrifugal force causes the blocks to move from under the striker against the ferrule. The howitzer type fuze has weaker stirrup springs and ferrule due to weaker setback force and centrifugal force.

TYPE 88 INSTANTANEOUS NOSE FUZE (FOR GUN AND HOWITZER TYPES)

Type 88 Short Delay Nose Fuze (Gun and Howitzer Types) USE: 57 mm, 70 mm, 75 mm, 105 mm, and 150 mm guns and howitzers. Interchangeable with Type 88 Instantaneous Fuze. OPERATION: Similar to the Type 88 Instantaneous Fuze. The gun type fuze has a movable primer carrier and striker.
TYPE 88 SHORT DELAY NOSE FUZE GUN AND HOWITZER TYPES)

(FOR

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 Augu st, 1945

337

MORTAR PROJECTILE FUZES

JAPANESE

Type 88 Small Instantaneous Fuze USE: 50 mm and 70 mm rifled mortars.


SMALL INSTANTANEOUS FUZE
TYPE 88

OPERATION:

Arms due to setback and centrifugal force

similar to the Type 88 Instantaneous Gun Fuze.

Type 89 Small Time Fuze USE: 50 mm mortar and 70 mm mortar and howitzer. OPERATION: Setback forces movable striker onto primer firing black powder delay train in one fixed and one movable ring.

TYPE 89 SMALL TIME FUZE

Type 93 Instantaneous-ShortDelay Fuze USE: 70 mm, 81 mm, 90 mm, and 150 mm


mortars. OPERATION: On impact the striker hous-

ing, which holds a fixed striker, is forced in shearing a shear wire and at the same time the movable primer moves forward against the creep spring onto the firing
pin. Choice of instantaneous or short

delay is made by inserting or removing a delay pellet below the primer.

TYPE 93 INSTANTANEOUS-SHORT

DELAY

FUZE

Type 100 Instantaneous-Short Delay Fuze USE: 81 mm and probably 70 mm, 90 mm, and 150 mm mortars. OPERATION: Functions in the same manner as the Type 93 Instantaneous-Short Delay Fuze. The delay element is not removable, but is mounted in a cylindrical tube, which has a flash hole running through it with the delay pellet 90 removed. The fuze may be set for instantaneous or short delay, without disassembling the fuze, by turning the setting screw.

TYPE 100 INSTANTANEOUS-SHORT DELAY FUZE

338

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

ANTIAIRCRAFT FUZES
Type 93 Small Powder Time Fuze USE: Has not been determined. OPERATION: On setback, the striker moves against a spring hitting the primer. The resulting flash ignites a variable powder delay train which, in turn, sets off the detonator. No impact feature is incorporated in this fuze. The time ring is graduated from 0-10 and is thought to represent 1,000 yards, i. e., 0-10,000 yards.

JAPANESE

SMALL

TYPE 93 POWDER TIME FUZE

Type 10th Year Time Fuze USE: Reported to be used in ole H. E. projectile for 75 mm antiaircraft gun and in target projectiles for 75 mm and 105 mm guns. OPERATION: On setback the movable primer overcomes the resistance of the arming collar and strikes the fixed firing pin thus starting the time rings. There are three time rings, two being movable. The flash from the time ring sets off the black powder magazine in the base of the fuze. No impact feature is incorporated.

TYPE 10TH YEAR TIME FUZE

Type 89 Long-Pointed Fuze USE: 75 mm antiaircraft guns and is reported to be used in 105 mm antiaircraft guns. On setback a movable OPERATION: primer overcomes a spring and strikes the fixed firing pin igniting a delay train, which in turn actuates an auxiliary fuze below. No impact feature is incorporated.

Type 100 Combination Impact-Mechanical Time Fuze USE: Japanese 9 cm (88 mm) antiaircraft gun reported to be used in 105 mm antiaircraft gun.
TYPE 89 LONG-POINTED FUZE

OPERATION: Time-Setback causes a starting plunger to disengage a locking disc on the clock and a setback pin frees the escape wheel allowing the clock mechanism to function. The clockwork mechanism is like that used in the D-2(a) bomb fuze. Centrifugal force moves a brass safety disc from under the shoulder of the spring-loaded firing pin and at the set time 0-50 seconds the firing pin is released to fire a primer. Impact-The impact feature consists of a separate fixed firin pin and a movable primer carrier which is held in the unfired position by two centrifugal detents. Centrifugal force causes the detents to move out, freeing the primer carrier which is held off of the firing pin by a creep spring. On impact, the primer-carrier moves against the creep spring onto the firing pin firing the primer.

TYPE 100 COMBINATION IMPACTMECHANICAL TIME FUZE

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

ORDNANCEE OF ORDNANCE

u1 1945 t 1 Aug ust, 194g33

339

ANTIAIRCRAFT FUZES

JAPANESE

Type 2 Combination Powder Time and Impact Fuze USE: Undetermined. OPERATION: Time-Setback causes the time striker to overcome its spring and set off the primer and powder time ring, which ignites a black powder magazine at the end of the set time up to 44 seconds.---Impact-A separate small impact unit screws into the nose of the time fuze body. Centrifugal force causes a spring-loaded detent to move from under the striker, which is forced into the primer on impact. The flash from the primer passes down through two flash channels to ignite the black powder magazine in the base. ) na (

TYPE 2 COMBINATION POWDER TIME AND IMPACT FUZE

COMBINATION TIME AND IMPACT NOSE FUZES


Type 3rd Year Combination Time and Impact Fuze Type 5th Year Combination Time and Impact Fuze USE: Type 3rd year-75 mm shrapnel and old 75 mm H. E. projectiles.
/2 /3 /4 /5 is 17 8 19 20 Type 5th year-75 mm shrapnel. Reported to be used in 75

///iII/iliiitil I\\\\\\\\\\\\\\
c

mm incendiary; 105 mm shrapnel and incendiary projectiles;


and 150 mm shrapnel and illuminating projectiles. OPERATION: These two fuzes are identical in operation, differing only in the maximum time settings which are:

TYPE 3RD YEAR


COMBINATION TIME AND IMPACT FUZE

Type 3rd year-maximum 22 sec. year-maximum Type 5th year-maximum 36.6 sec. The Type 3rd year has two time rings, one being movable.

S7 + SThe Sp

Type 5th year has three time rings with two being movable. Time-On setback a movable primer, held in the unfired position by a stirrup spring, strikes a fixed firing pin and ignites a
powder delay train.

/ 2 334

I \\\
____ <

Impact-The impact feature of these fuzes is separate, consisting of a fixed firing pin and a movable primrer carrier held in the unfired position by a centrifugal detent. An anti-creep spring separates the primer and firing pin. After firing, centrifugal force moves the detent out, freeing the primer carrier,

and on impact it moves forward against the creep spring onto the firing pin functioning the fuze instantaneously.
TYPE 5TH YEAR COMBINATION TIME AND IMPACT FUZE

340

1 August, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

BASE FUZES
Type 94 Small Delay Base Fuze USE: 37 mm A. P. projectiles for tank and antitank guns.

JAPANESE

OPERATION: This is a simple setback arming, inertia firing fuze. As the projectile is fired, setback causes an inertia collar to break a shear wire and move back, wedging itself on the striker, thus arming the fuze. On impact, the inertia collar and striker overcome a creep spring and the striker, impinges the primer which in turn ignites a delay train and detonator.
TYPE 94 SMALL DELAY BASE FUZE

Type--Small Mk. 2 Base Fuze USE: A. P. projectiles for 47 mm antitank gun. OPERATION: This fuze has no arming features. The movable
SMALL MK. 2 BASE FUZE

'

-/

primer carrier is separated by a spring from the fixed firing pin,

which is threaded into the forward part of the booster. On impact, the pimer moves down onto the firing pin and the primer flash passes through a small hole beside the firing pin into the delay.

Type 92 Small Short Delay Base Fuze USE: A. P. projectiles for 57 mm tank guns. OPERATION: Centrifugal force causes two spring-loaded detents to move out from notches in the striker which is separated from the primer by a creep spring. On impact, the striker moves against the spring onto the primer.

o
TYPE 92 SMALL SHORT DELAY BASE FUZE

Medium Mk. 1 Base Fuze USE: A. P. projectile for 75 mm gun. OPERATION: The movable primer carrier is held by two spring-loaded detents. These are moved out by centrifugal force and, on impact, the primer carrier overcomes the creep spring and moves onto the striker. The flash of the primer passes through two holes beside the firing pin into the delay element.
MEDIUM MK. 1 BASE FUZE

Type 95 Small Base Fuze USE: Reported to be used in A. P. projectiles for the 70 mm tank gun and all 75 mm and 105 mm guns.
OPERATION: The striker is held by two spring-loaded detents

o
TYPE 95 SMALL BASE FUZE

which are moved out by centrifugal force. On impact, the


striker overcomes the creep spring and moves onto the primer.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 August, 1945

341

TABULATION OF JAPANESE ROCKETS


6.8 cm Possibly a Line Throwing Device 12 cm Incendiary Shrapnel Rocket (Navy) 20 cm (202 mm) Army * 20 cm (210 mm) Navy ** 60 kg Type 97 No. 6 60 kg Type 97 No. 6 250 kg. Bomb Body W/ Permanently Bomb W/Rocket Bomb W/Rocket Attch. Rocket Motor Motor (Large) Motor (Small) 45 cm Rocket

Total Weight (Ibs)

51

200 to 205

198

Bomb only-124

91.9 Motor 124 Bomb

616 w/o Propell.* *

1,514

Overall Length (ins.)

10.5

286

38/4 or 37

41 approx.

33-Motor

40%5/Motor

118

671/2

Filling

WP Pellets

TNT

TNA

Hexanite & TNA

Hexanite & TNA

TNA-HND

Picric Acid

Weight of Filling (lbs.)

35.7

38.5

50

50

212

Maximum Range (yds.)

2000-3000
Controlled by

3,250 yds. Field


Test * * * *Test

1,970 Field

1,094-1,314

2,000 estimate

11,000 (7,500
battle observation)

2,000 Field Test

Aerial Burst Time Fuze

How Stabilized

Not Known

Spin

Spin

Spin

Fin

Fin

Fin

Spin

Weapons From Which Fired

Triple Rail Guides on Revolving Carriage Mounted on Tripod

Wooden Trough with Metal Bracket

Type 4 Launcher (Looks like a Mortar)

Wooden Rail Type Single & Triple 2-Wheeled Carriage w/61/2' Barrel and Split Trails Metal Trough (7'-6" long) on Fixed Bipod

Type 10 Launcher ("V" Shaped Trough)

Wooden W/2 Rail Trough Type 3 Rocket Launcher

Truck Mounted Launcher Reported but not Recovered "V" Shaped Trough 22.9' Long

Wooden Launcher w/ Solid Wood Wheels and Tropgh Crude & Expendable

* Four modifications of motor encountered in SWPA to 1 April, 1945. * * No propellant recovered to date 23 March, 1945. * * * The Japanese mention three classes of these rockets under trial, all differing in weight. * ** * Other field tests resulted in 2,600-2,800 yard ranges.

ROCKET LAUNCHER AND ROCKET MOTOR MODEL 10

JAPANESE

ROCKET MOTORED BOMB LAUNCHER

This is a device designed to propel the 60 kg. (132 lbs.) aircraft bomb out of an inclined trough. The launcher is constructed of wood and metal with legs made of iron pipe. The rear is attached by a pin to a base plate with six wedge cut ground pins. The launcher channel is a right angle trough about twenty feet long with a motor and bomb positioner made of 1'/-inch pierced sheet metal. This is "V" shaped, (The motor and bomb positioner is not shown in the schematic sketch above.) slightly over four feet long, and hinged at three points on the lower right side of the launcher. Elevation is controlled by cables run from the base plate to the legs, and between the legs. The rocket motor resembles a blunt, short-bodied bomb. The propellant container is a cylinder with a cap welded on the front and a tail assembly and venturi tube secured on the rear. The propellant which weighs 12.94 pounds consists of three cylindrical sticks tied in a yellow silk bag. It is ignited by an igniter pad and an igniter fuze in the forward part of the motor by means of wires leading to a small hand blasting machine. When fired the motor propels'the bomb from the launcher and then drops off. Ranges up to 1,300 yards are claimed by the Japanese for this device, but it is felt that little, if any, accuracy may be expected. It is evidently designed to deliver fire on beachheads and other similar wide targets at fairly short ranges.

SPECIFICATIONS
LAUNCHER Length of launcher (overall) ............ 19 ft., Width at leg shoes .......................... 10 ins.

8 ft., 5.5 ins.

Height at 30 range setting .......................... 11 ft. Length of leg ................ ............ 12 ft., 4 ins. 1.75 ins. 10 ins. 7.5 ins. 8.5 ins. 6 ins.

Diameter of leg .......................................... Width outside of trough at base .............. Width outside of trough at front ................ Width inside of trough at base ................ Width inside of trough at front .................. Length of cable from baseplate to leg ............................................... ROCKET MOTOR Length of motor and bomb positioner (overall) .............................................

20 ft., 3 ins.

4 ft., 3 ins. 33 ins.

Length of motor (overall) ..........................

Length of propellant cylinder .................. 11.5 ins. Diameter of propellant cylinder (outside).. 7.44 ins. Diameter of venturi tube (outside) ........... Length of tail fin ..................................... Width of tail fin .................................... 1.5 ins. 11.75 ins. 3.625 ins.

Width of tail, fin to fin .......................... 11.875 ins.

RESTRICTED

OFFICE CHIEF

OF ORDNANCE

1 April, 1945

351

20 cm ROCKET PROJECTILE AND LAUNCHER

JAPANESE

W
4 A.4
,:

MOTOR ASE PLATE

This ground-launched rocket is fired from a trough shaped launcher approximately 7 feet long, which weighs approximately 175 pounds. The Japanese claim a range of 1,800 meters (1,970 yds.) at 50 elevation. The rocket is spin-stabilized, rotating in a clockwise direction. The complete round, without fuze, is approximately 41 inches long and weighs 198.3 pounds. The projectile has a straight body and an ogival nose. It is fitted with a centrifugally armed point detonating fuze. In addition to this standard fuze, the Type 91 Time, Type 100 Combination, and Type 88 P. D. fuzes will also fit the fuze pocket. However, it is not known whether the rocket will produce sufficient setback to arm these fuzes. The explosive charge, Type 91 (trinitroanisol), is cast directly into the lacquered interior of the case. The base plate which screws into the projectile body is also threaded to take the motor. The motor body, a straight cylinder, is closed at the rear by a base plate to which a grid is attached. A perforated cup fits against the motor closing plate at the forward end. Seven sticks of propellant (nitroglycerine, nitrocellulose, NaC1, and centralite) fit securely into the combustion chamber between the perforated cup and the grid. Six sticks form a circle around an identical central stick; all have only a single axial perforation. The motor base plate of hardened steel has six offset nozzles and a central threaded opening for a percussion type primer. Ignition is mechanical and from the forward end. A black silk powder bag lashed to the perforated cup forms the ignition charge.

SPECIFICATIONS
PROJECTILE Weight of projectile without fuze .................................... 49.9 kg.-110 lbs. 38.6 lbs.

Weight of high explosive filling .................................... 17.5 kg.-

Overall length of projectile without 4 fuze .................................. 588.0 mm- 23.1 ins. Minimum diameter of orifices....15.0 mm-.591 ins.

Angular cant of nozzles ................................. .. 25 Diameter of body........ 210.5 mm (approx. 8.30 ins.) Wall thickness .................... 12.0 mm-.472 in.

MOTOR Overall length of motor body..460 mm-18.11 ins. Weight with propellant .............. 40.0 kg.-88 lbs. Weight of propellant ................ 8.3 kg.-18.3 lbs. Weight of black powder ignition charge ............................ 50.6 grams-1.77 ozs. Wall thickness ............................ 10.0 mm-.39 in. Length of propellant sticks.. 290.0 mm-11.41 ins. Diameter of propellant sticks.. 58.0 mm-2.28 ins. Diameter of perforation .............. 11.0 mm-.43 in. Weight of propellant sticks (eachvaries slightly) .................. 1.162 kg.-2.56 lbs.

352

April, 1945

OFFICE CHIEF

) OF ORDNANCE

RESTRICTED

IAPANLS )RDNAN(
MARKING

KEY CHARACTERS for Essential Japanese Ordnance Materiel


TABLE CHARACTER ORDNANCE TABLE CHARACTER ORDNANCE

1*

Tanks Trucks Cars Vehicles Sha Bullet Grenade Shell (w. #12) Bomb (w. #18) Rocket Dan

MG

11

Rifle Pistol Carbine J


_ _

12

Artillery Shell

(W.

#2)

Ryi

Cannon Howitzer Mortar

13~

!i~iI~Mark
Go'

Data on Bombs

Number and

H5

Explosives Ammunition Yaku

14

Metric Terms (Weight & Dimension)


Sanchi Miri

Type

15

Aircraft

Shiki .

Ki

Year Month Nen Getsu

16

Metals

Tetsu

~Fuel
Yu

Gasoline Oils
Lubricating Oils

17

Fuze Cap Train Kan

Primer Shell Case Bangalore Torpedo Grenade Launcher Complete Round


To'

18

Airplane Bomb (w. #2)


Baku

(Organization

(o)

Unit or

19 Sho

Factory

He)

Gun

10

Torpedo (Aerial)

Mines

20

Arsenal

Rai

Sho

RESTRICTED

Translation of

JAPANESE ORDNANCE
MARKINGS

AUGUST, 1945

A. S. F. OFFICE OF THE CHIEF OF ORDNANCE WASHINGTON, D. C.

RESTRICTED

RESTRICTED

Table of Contents
PAGE

SECTION ONE-Introduction
General Discussion of Japanese Characters........................................... 1

Unusual Methods of Japanese Markings.......................................................

SECTION TWO-Instructions for Translating Japanese Markings Different Japanese Calendar Systems......................................................... Japanese Characters for Type and Modification............................................ Explanation of the Key Characters and Their Use.......................................
Key Characters for Essential Japanese Ordnance Materiel.......................... Method of Using the Key Character Tables in Translation............................

8 9 10
11 12

Tables of Basic Key Characters for Japanese Ordnance................................

17

SECTION THREE-Practical Reading and Translation of Japanese Characters Japanese Markings Copied from a Tag Within an Ammunition Box.......... Japanese Markings on an Airplane Bomb.................................................... Japanese Markings on a Heavy Gun.................................................... Japanese Markings Used to Indicate Arsenals.......................... Japanese Ballistic Terms ............................. .................. ............. 72 73 74 75

.............. 76

RESTRICTED

materiel often necessitates translation into English of the ideographs and phonetic alphabet characters stamped on equipment or printed on accompanying tags, boxes or pamphlets. Because of their inability to read Japanese, many persons responsible for inspection of captured ordnance items are unable quickly and accurately to identify unfamiliar materiel. This book has been prepared as a practical guide to the translation of Japanese ordnance nomenclature. Its successful use does not require a prior knowledge of Japanese but depends only upon the application of simple principles that can be learned within a few hours. It explains how the recognition of twenty key ideographs, in conjunction with tables in the text, will enable the reader to translate markings that describe Japanese ordnance.

Complete identification of Japanese

SECTION ONE
INTRODUCTION

General Discussion of Japanese Characters KANJI


Until a phonetic alphabet was invented between 774 aid 835 A.D. the Japanese depended entirely upon ideographs or picture-characters for written expression of their thoughts. Even today ideographs remain the principal medium for written Japanese, although the phonetic characters have considerable subsidiary use. Since-most of the words in the language are represented by an individual character, several thousand ideographs have to be memorized for facility in reading or writing. Most of these characters were adopted from the Chinese in the third century A.D., this Chinese origin being indicated by their name, "Kanji," which means "Chinese characters." During the long period that has elapsed since their adoption, the Chinese sounds for the ideographs have been modified until the present Japanese equivalents are quite different from the original Chinese. Japanese sentences do not follow normal English structure. While each noun and its descriptive adjectives are represented by a separate ideograph, the position of the noun does not correspond to that in English. Japanese ordnance inscriptions usually have an easily recognized noun character at or near the first part of the sentence. In translating, this permits identification of the noun ideograph to serve as a key to the meaning of the combined characters, as is shown in the section of this book entitled "Explanation of the Key Characters and Their Use." The way in which ideographs are combined to designate a term or item is apparent from the combination of the three characters for picric acid in which the ideographs for yellow, color, and powder are employed.

Yellow

Shoku

Color

PICRIC ACID

Yaku

Powder

Because the number of word sounds in Japanese are limited, a single sound may have various meanings according to the context of" the sentence in which it is used. In written Japanese each of these meanings is clearly denoted by a distinctive ideograph. For instance, there are numerous meanings of the word "Sha," each represented by a different ideograph, some of which are illustrated below.

Sha

Sha

Sha

In Japanese ordnance terms, only the "Sha" character on the extreme left of this group of six selected pictures of the sound "Sha" is of value. This particular representation of "Sha" indicates a vehicle and, when so used, is always at the end of the group of characters; for example, "jinrikisha" (a two-wheeled cart), and "sensha" (a battle tank).

CART

TANK

SJin

(Man)

Sen

(Battle)

j
S

Riki

(Moves)

Sha

(Wagon)

Sha

(Wagon)

This form of "Sha" appears in the nomenclature of all Japanese vehicular ordnance items, where it is the terminal sound or ideograph. This "Sha" is the root word for all Japanese vehicles, and is one of 20 key characters in the table of key ordnance characters which will be explained in detail later in this outline.

KANA
The Japanese realized the disadvantages and limitations of their ideograph system in its inability to represent the constantly increasing number of foreign words being absorbed into the language. This problem was solved by use of the phonetic alphabet called "Kana." Unlike Kanji, which cannot express the correct sound or proper construction of words, the

JAPANESE

]KANA ALPHABET

jJka
gki ga

'ku

'mu

LTze
be bau

mi

Lu E0
Lu ALI1
he

tu

E,1 p7aI
1:4f

ju

LIII LYIa

ts LXII buL
Ez1 EZZ Lu0

Sshi

Lilill

LIII

eighty Kana characters represent the basic syllables of the language. Since its characters represent sounds and not letters, Kana may be more accurately considered a syllabary than an alphabet. Because of its phonetic nature Kana can be used for foreign words after they have been reduced to Japanese syllables as closely as possible imitative of the sounds in the original words. Kana is designed around the five vowels, A, I, U, E, 0, and the fifteen consonants, K, G, M, N, H, P, B, T, D, F, R, S, W, Y, Z. The working plan of this table is simple. For example, the consonant K produces five separate syllable sounds when added singly to each one of the five vowels. These are KA, KI, KU, KE, and KO. There is a separate alphabet mark, or Kana character, for not only each of the five vowels, but also for each of the seventy-five two'letter sounds, making a total of eighty individual Japanese Kana characters in the basic table. The pronunciation of the vowel sounds is slightly different from the English pronunciation: thus A, I, U, E, 0, are pronounced ah, ee, oo, ay, oh, in Japanese. These pronunciation sounds remain the same when they are converted into the two-letter syllables of the Kana Table. The table of Kana characters appears on Page 3. These Kana characters are used not only for Japanese ordnance items but also for Japanese medical and chemical warfare terms. Examples of the use of Kana are set forth below. Note again that the Kana characters represent syllables. When the Japanese want to convert a new English word such as "aneroid" into their printed language they use the Kana system of basic sounds. This can only be done after the English word is separated into a grouping of sounds closest to those in the Kana alphabet. To

the Japanese, "aneroid" sounds like the following: ah/nay/ro/ee/do. All these sounds appear in the Kana Table, and can be written by using the Kana characters. The following are examples of the method of changing three words, Aneroid, Magnesium, and Browning, into the written Kana language:

A ah Ne nay Ro ro I ee Do do

ANEROID

S MAGNESIUM
Ma . Gu Ne Shiyu Mu

SBROWNING
Bu Ra U Ni En* Gu

*A special character, en or an, generally ending a word.

Since the Kana characters are easier to write than Kanji numerals, Japanese often use Kana to list ordnance items; hence it is common to find a vertical list of items headed by a Kana symbol instead of a number (when used as first, second, third, etc.). On artillery ammunition items, as boosters and fuzes, Kana characters such as "To" are stamped into the metal, or painted thereon. These are important identification marks, discussed later in this publication.

Unusual Methods of Japanese Marking


There are four main types of material on which Japanese character markings describing ordnance items are placed. These are: (1) wooden shipping-cases, (2) metal parts of ordnance items, (3) cardboard tags, tied to the item by string or pasted on metal inner-cases, (4) descriptive booklets, which either accompany the item within the wooden shipping case or are obtained among captured records found with the equipment. (1) On wooden shipping cases, the Japanese generally describe the item by characters painted across one or more sides of the wooden box, as illustrated:

The first step in translating such an inscription is to determine the order in which the Japanese characters are written. They may start either from left to right or from right to left. The direction in which they are to be read can be found by noting the location of the character for Type ("Shiki") which invariably appears in inscriptions for all ordnance items. In the illustration, it is the third ideograph from the right. By memorizing the Japanese numerals from one to ten, shown in Table No. 5 of Section Two, it is easy to recognize their ideographs, which in Japanese always precede the character for "Type." In the illustration Japanese numerals for "88" are the first two on the extreme right followed by the ideograph for "Shiki" (Type). Thus the direction of placing the characters on this shipping box is from right to left. When right to left order has been followed in marking, it is suggested (for simplicity in translation) that the characters be copied on paper as usual, but placed in the opposite direction from that found, as follows: (2) Japanese mark metal parts of ordnance items with both Kanji and Kana characters. The polished brass surface of an artillery shell cartridge-case lends itself readily to the paint-

Hachi

Hachi 88 Type

Shiki

Tan

En Short-Delay

Ki

Shin Fuze

Kan

*Key Characters

ing of the more intricate Kanji characters for marking purposes. These are to prevent mistakes when several types of shells resemble each other, although intended for different weapons. The markings here generally indicate the type of gun that is to fire this ammunition. The following illustration is arranged, not for the purpose of translation of the markings, but to show their position.

Kana characters are simple in design and make good dies for stamping Japanese metal parts, or for quickly painting an abbreviated arsenal mark. The flexibility of Kana characters in describing various ordnance items is evident in the use of one of the plainest and most widely employed Kana characters,
"To."

When "To" is painted on the body of an artillery shell, just above the rotating band, it indicates that the shell was manufactured at the "Tokyo Army Branch Ordnance Depot." This is illustrated by the view of a Japanese 150 mm howitzer shell.

However, when the Japanese mark their machine gun ammunition for airplanes, although they use the same character, "To," to mark the bottom of the cartridge case, it indicates an entirely different place of manufacture. In this case "To" refers to the Toyokawa Navy Yard. As an interesting sidelight on this abbreviated system of marking, the sound of the character "To" is the sound of the first part of the word Toyokawa. Likewise the "A" of the Kana alphabet is used to indicate the Asahi Plant, while "Yo" is used to mark the products of the Yokosuka Navy Yard in airplane machine gun ammunition. (3) When the Japanese place characters on pasteboard tags or on paper labels attached to ordnance items, they use Kanji.

A sample of such a marking copied from a label glued to the cardboard shipping container for a shell is shown in Section Three of this text. This inscription demonstrates that when the Japanese print ordnance terms on paper they arrange the characters in a long, vertical line reading from top to bottom. The reproduction of characters on this label is accompanied by their actual translation, using the system of selecting the key characters and subsequently referring to the tables in which they are located, as explained in Section Two.

Uf7
n

-- p SJapanese ' |

(4) After study of this booklet it will be possible to translate the general descriptive matter in pamphlets accompanying Japanese ordnance items. It is cautioned here that the Japanese put such general descriptions on what we would call the back page of our books. Holding the Japanese book in a normal position it is necessary to turn to the final page- and look for key characters. For example, illustrated here are two sections from the descriptive page of a captured Japanese booklet on artillery shells. These are shown not for the purpose of translation, but merely to illustrate where to look for them in the book, and to repeat the caution that the characters are to be read along a vertical line from
top to bottom. The heavy-type column to the left is the name: "Artillery Ammunition," while that to the right is the date, "May 1938."

SECTION TWO
INSTRUCTIONS FOR TRANSLATING JAPANESE MARKINGS

Different Japanese Calendar Systems


The Japanese designate types of ordnance materiel, such as mortars, howitzers, rifles, guns, etc., with a descriptive term indicating the year the item was officially adopted. For marking high explosives, a date on the label of the package or outside of the shipping box indicates the date of manufacture. It is common for the Japanese to make liberal use of calendar dates, but it must be remembered that four different systems are employed.

BASIC JAPANESE CALENDAR


One system employs the basic Japanese calendar years, represented either by four digits, as in the year 2598, or by its reduced form 98 derived by dropping the first two digits as is done when our year 1945 is abbreviated to '45. The Japanese Kanji ideograph "Shiki," always employed with the abbreviated date numerals, is shown with the numeral characters for nine and eight.

Ku

Hachi

Shiki

Type

As an example of a date in a decade preceding that shown, the year 1921 is the equivalent of the Japanese calendar year 2581, and any Japanese models produced in that year would be called their "Type 81."

REIGN OF EMPEROR OR ERA


The Japanese also indicate the date in terms of the year of the reign of a Japanese emperor, each reign being known as an era. Any ordnance materiel produced within one of these periods might be marked as "Showa Era, 18 Year" (our year 1943), as explained later. There have been three different eras representing the reigns of individual Japanese emperors within the past seventy-seven years. The reign of the present emperor, begun in 1926, is referred to as the "Showa Era," meaning the bright period, or the golden era. It is designated by the characters shown at right.

Sho Bright

Wa Era

Development of modern Japanese ordnance has occurred only in the three most recent eras. Era 2 covers the Meiji Era from 1868 to 1912. Era 3 covers the Taisho Era from 1912 to 1926. Era 4 covers the Showa Era from 1926 to the present time. Although Eras 2, 3 and 4 are designated by different ideographs, they employ the same general principle in relation to indicating a date marking. The basis for each is to (a) name the era during which the item was designed or manufactured, and (b) give the particular year of this era to which the date applies. Conversion of a date within any Japanese era to one in our calendar can be accomplished by adding the given Japanese year to the English date for the year preceding the beginning of the era. For example, the English equivalent of the 20th year of the Showa Era can be found by adding 20 to 1925, which gives our year 1945. Table No. 6 describes the Kanji characters used by the Japanese to indicate the Meiji Taisho, and Showa Eras.

Japanese Characters for Type and Modification TYPE


The Japanese always use dates or numerals with a character which refers to dates in classifying their ordnance items. Only one character is used to indicate the type classification. This character is "Shiki." It appears on artillery shells, bombs, small arms, guns, howitzers, fuzes, etc., but always in association with numerals of one or two digits. These numerals are abbreviations for dates in the Japanese calendar. The following are some common markings used by the Japanese on their ordnance items to express Type and Type Numbers:

Ni 2

Shiki Type

Cha Brown TNT

Katsu

Saku Bursting

Yaku Powder

(Year) 1942

Bursting Charge

Ju
11th

Ichi

Nen Year

Shiki Type Sea

Kai

Gan Coast Gun

Ho

MODIFICATIONS
The Japanese describe modifications of ordnance items in the following manner:

Ichi

Shiki

Baka Modification 1

Dan

1 1941

Type

Airplane Bomb

^rm.

Modification 2

In marking bombs, the Japanese use, in addition to these characters, three extra characters to indicate "mark," "weight," and "design number." These are discussed in Table No. 13. Note: It is common to find the ideograph for modification with a numeral placed together near the base of the shell. The meaning is "The new improved type No. 2."

Explanation of the Key Characters and Their Use


On page 11 and on the inside of the cover appears a table of key ordnance characters. Each key character is a base or root word which the Japanese use in designating ordnance materiel. Next to each key character, the Japanese write additional characters which modify the root word to indicate the full description of the particular item, as "Sen Sha" (tank) or "Chu Sen Sha" (medium tank). Also in this section are tables of key characters that list those characters which normally accompany the key ideograph, modify it, and in combination with it give the name of a specific Japanese ordnance item. Except in rare instances, the key character is always the last character in a related group of sounds or written characters, but note that in following this rule the direction of writing must first be ascertained. One key character, such as "Sha" (a vehicle) is the terminal root word for four classes of ordnance items in the vehicular family, namely: Tanks, Trucks, Cars and Tractors. The particular type of vehicle referred to by "Sha" can be ascertained by using the table to identify the characters that precede the key ideograph. Table No. 2 has a key character of "Dan," and includes such items as Bullets and Grenades. Note that this key character, "Dan," is added to another key character, "Ryu," to form a double key character group. From this combination is derived a new table (Table No. 12) to indicate Artillery Shells and Rockets. Likewise the key character "Dan" just described is joined with a second key character "Baku," to form, another double-character group, giving us Table No. 18 on Airplane Bombs.

KEY CHARACTERS for Essential Japanese Ordnance Materiel


TABLE CHARACTER ORDNANCE

Tanks Trucks

Cars

Vehicles Sha Bullet Grenade (w. #12) Bomb (w. #18) Rocket Dan

iShell

3
Ho'

Gun
Cannon

Howitzer Mortar

Explosives Ammunition Yaku

Type

Shiki

6
Nen

1113
Getsu

Year
Month

Gasoline

5
Yu

Fuel Oils
Lubricating Oils

Primer Shell, Case Bangalore Torpedo Grenade Launcher Complete Round To

(Unit

(or)1 ~* Gun

Organization

or

Hei

1t
Rai

Mines

Torpedo (Aerial)

These are the only tables which are made up from double key characters. The materiel to which the other tables relate appears on top of each table.

Method of Using the Key Character Tables in Translation


1. Become thoroughly familiar with each key character, and with the characters for numerals from 1 to 10. 2. Ascertain the direction in which the particular writing to be translated has been written; i. e., from left to right, right to left, or top to bottom. Page 13 of this outline explains the method. 3. Select all the key characters in the writing. 4. Mark off the characters accompanying each key character. This may be done by drawing rectangles around each related group of characters (key characters plus accompanying modifying characters). Note: Where the writing to be translated involves a considerable number of characters (i. e., more than 50), it is recommended that the writing be treated piecemeal in groups of three or four characters, selecting a key character from a group and translating that group before proceeding to the next group.

Sha
Vehicle

Sen
Battle

Sha
Wagon

Chu Medium

Sen Battle

Sha Wagon

Wagon

TANK

MEDIUM TANK

The three characters "Chu," "Sen," and "Sha" that compose the word for medium tank, are shown above as the Japanese would write them from left to right on a wooden crating for the vehicle. The key character "Sha" is placed last, to the right of the modifying characters "Chu" and "Sen." When the Japanese mark ordnance items they do so without punctuation. That is one reason why it is necessary to memorize the twenty key characters used in ordnance. The following example is employed to show the method used in building up "Ju" (meaning a small gun), into the compound group of characters, "Ken Ju" (meaning a pistol) and then "Ji Do Ju" (meaning an automatic rifle).

i7 Small Gun

Ken Hand Operated

JR
Small Gun Self-

fi

D Acting

Ju Small Gun

PISTOL

AUTOMATIC RIFLE

Up to now only one key character with its adjective ideographs has been described. The illustration below shows the ideographs for "automatic rifle" by a new key character, "Shiki," plus its descriptive adjective ideographs. Note that there are no periods, commas, or open spaces.

Ku

Hachi

Shiki

Ji Self-

D6

J]i
Small Gun

Type

Acting

TYPE 98

AUTOMATIC

RIFLE

The direction in which the Japanese wrote these characters must be determined. The finding of "Shiki" (Type), the character third from the left, is the first step. It is always preceded by numerals. Since the numerals for 9 and 8 are to the left of "Shiki" the writing plan is from left to right. Since it is a key character, the last character of the line (bearing in mind the direction of the writing of the group) is selected. It is "Ju," a key character for small arms, as is shown in Table No. 11. Taking "Ju" and its two preceding characters (the Japanese usually write in groups of two, three, or four characters when describing ordnance), turn to Table No. 11. There the meanings of the three picture characters are found to be automatic rifle. Similarly, it is found that "Ku Hachi Shiki" means Type 98. Elsewhere in this publication are illustrated actual markings found on a captured Japanese ammunition box, an airplane bomb, and a heavy gun. The names of the Japanese characters are given in each case, the key characters being set off from the long string of modifying characters by placing a cross-line just below the key character. The partial translation and the full translation are given with each example. Note that if the Japanese write from left to right, the cross-line follows the key character and is to the right of it. If the Japanese write from right to left, then the cross-line follows the key character but is to the left of it. When .the Japanese string of characters proceeds from top to bottom, as illustrated in Section Three (page 72), the cross-line is beneath the key character. In the case mentioned there were 43 Japanese characters appearing in one consecutive vertical line which has been divided into four columns for convenience in printing. The following illustration is employed to show how several vertical columns of Japanese characters may be broken down into the key characters for translation purposes. It has been taken from a Japanese book on Japanese artillery shells. The only additions to it have been the placing of the letters A, B, C, D, and E for reference purposes and the drawing of a line

beneath each key character to illustrate the method followed in determining key characters and the preceding characters which are used to describe them. Roughly, the method is to go to the foot of each vertical line for the first key character and strike a line under it. The best plan, to avoid confusion in locating the next key character, is to work in groups of but two or three characters at a time. When the Japanese write in vertical columns, the Sreading starts at the top right hand corner. Here the column marked A is the first to be read. Start at the foot of the column for the first key character. It is "Yaku," found in Table No. 4. The next question is, how many characters relate to "Yaku"? Table No. 4 shows that in this particular case only "Yaku" and its adjoining character "Dan" are in the table and mean Ammunition (General). The third character from the bottom is next found to be a key character "Ho." In questioning how many characters are to be included with "Ho," look through Table No. 3. Here it is to be noted that "Ho" and "Po," denoted by the same ideograph, are inter-

changeable when referring to artillery pieces and mortars, depending upon the type of weapon. In this particular case the key character is "Po" and the two characters next to "Po" in the Japanese text are included with the key character in line 5 of the table to form the Japanese word "Ryu Dam Po," meaning Howitzer. The next key character "Sanchi," meaning centimeter, makes translation easy. With it is the numeral "Ju" (ten) to complete the term 10 CM. It is quite evident that the next character "Shiki" is a key character and it is preceded by the numeral characters "Ku" (nine) and "Ichi" (one), given in Table No. 5. The translation of this phrase is thus "Type 91." By this same method the ideographs in Column B are identified and translated into "Model 91 Streamlined Shell." Column C is translated as "Fuze." Column D'has two sections, an upper and a lower section, the first of which is translated as "Projectile," or "Shell Body," while the lower section means "Explosive Charge, TNT."

TABLES OF BASIC KEY CHARACTERS FOR JAPANESE ORDNANCE

TANK
Sen Sha

Battle

Wagon

gII !jf4
Kei
Light

LIGHT TANK
Sha
______________

Sen
Battle

Wagon

MEDIUM TANK
Cha Sen Sha

Medium

Battle

Wagon

HEAVY
Heavy
Battle Wagon
______

TANK

________

MOTOR CAR
Do Sha

Self

Moving

Wagon

Ji
Self

MOTOR TRUCK
DI Moving a Sha Wagon
(Continued on next page)

Freight

7B

TANKS

TRUCKS

VEHICLES
Sha

Vehicle
---- --- --

lIt
Ki
Do

Ka
Freight

Sha
Wagon

CATERPILLAR TRUCK

Cycled

Track

MOTOR CYCLE
Ji
Self-Moving Do

Ji
Self-Cycling

Ten

Sha Vehicle

SIDE CAR

Sokut
-

Sha
Vehicle
4

Side
i

--

S-

COMMAND
Shi
Command

CAR

Sha
Vehicle

RECONNAISSANCE
Ji
Self-Moving Do Tei Scout Sha Vehicle

ARMORED CAR
So Ko>

Sha
i

Armor-Plated

Vehicle (Continued on next page)

~4~~'~'

~TANKS

.i'K
VEHICLES

/4

Sh4;

t
Hei Troop

4i
S6 Armor-Plated.
KS

ARMORED
TROCA

Sha Vehicle

Dan Ammunition

Yaku

Sha Wagon

AMMUNITION WAGON

TRACTOR
Ken Traction
Y

Sha Vehicle
I I

I
Ka (An) Artillery Gun LJo Ken
4

Sha Conveyance

ARTILLERY TRACTOR

Tractioned

~J,~

#J
ur
U

CTRPLA
In Sha Vehicle

~
Ken

WTRACTOR

Mu Endless.

Gen

Ki Cycle

Do

Tractioned

Hakai To Destroy

Sen Battle

Sha Wagon

TANK DESTROYER

AMPHIBIAN

RiuSui
iu

Ryo Dojbie-Use

Yo

Sen

Sha
Wagon

TN

Sea and

Land

Baftle

POINTED BULLET
Sen

Dan Bullet

Cone-shaped

RIFLE BULLET
Sbo Small Gun

Iii

Dan

Bullet

TRACER BULLET
Ei Kan Dan

Tracer

Bullet

!~S1LLIGHT
Ei
Trace
Ko

Dan
Bullet

TRACER BULLET

Light

IW

En

Dan

SMOKE TRACER BULLET

Trace

Smoke

Bullet

EXPLOSIVE
Baku Retsu Ju Dan BLE

Explosive-Burst

Rifle-Bullet
(Continued on next page)

i3 l
D

BULLETS
GRENADES

BOMBS (TABLE 18)


SHELLS (TABLE 12)
ROCKETS

Dan

INCENDIARY
Sh
Incendiary

1
(Used

Yo
by)

Sho ,
Small Arms

DanBUL
(Bullet)

Ko

Zai

Dan Bullet

HARD WOOD BULLET

Hard Timber (Wood)

DUM-DUM BULLET
Da
Dum

Da
Dum

Mu

Mu

Dan
Bullet

ARMOR PIERCING BULLET


Ha Pierce Ko Armor
I

Ju
Rifle

Dan

Bullet
I_-I-

Dan
Dan

Shi
Sh
---

SHRAPNEL BULLET

--

GRENADE

Grenade

__

__

(Continued on next page)

q
7-

Dan

BULLETS GRENADES BOMBS (TABLE 18) SHELLS (TABLE 12) ROCKETS

|
Shu Hand (Thrown) Ryu Shell Dan

HAND GRENADE

RIFLE GRENADE
--Rifle-

Iii ' ----(Use)

Yo

Teki
Grenade

Dan

PHOSPHORUS
GRENADE
Rin Phosphorus Zai Filled (Dose) Teki Grenade Dan

THERMITE GRENADE
Shaku
---

Nestu
'--

Teki
----

Dan

Intense

Heat (Red Hot)

Grenade

3 1
Fun Spitting Out Shin (as it Advances)

STANDARD ROCKET
Dan

Tsu
Known (as)

J
Regular Shell

(PROJECTILE) (of the 20 cm type)

A ROCKET

STANDARD

PROJECTILE

- ---

Note: Ho and Po interchangeable

Sam
Sam
Mountain Mounfaln Gun Gun

MOUNTAIN GUN

Po
-r

Note: Field is "Yagai"


I

iiT
Field (Abbrev.) Gun
U--I-

FIELD GUN

CANNON
Hei Sha Trajectory
Ho

Low

Gun

15 CM CANNON
J 15 Go Sanchi Centimeter Ka Cannon Non Ho Gun

t Ut
HOWITZER
Ry7 (Common)

Dam Shell
Gun

Po'

Note: Calvary is "Kiho"

P
Ki

HL
H

CAVALRY GUN

Cavalry (Abbrev.)

Gun (Continued on next page)

/
7/'

L4
5UE..

GUN
CANNON HOWITZER

calibre Ju) than

M R A

b Kai Gun

Ii~INAVAL
H

GUN

Sea

Branch

Gun

~-ijf1~L~SIEGE
Shu

GUN

1,
Man-the-Gun

Defenders

Kai

Gan

IiIf
H

COAST DEFENSE
GUN

Sea

Coast

Gun

Kak

Ko3

SMOOTH-BORE GUN

Smooth-Bore

Gun

AUTOMATIC GUN ft
Self-Acting
______

Gun

Soku

Sha

QUICK-FIRING GUN
H

Rapid-Fire

Gun
(Continued on next page)

l~1
/5

GUN
CANNONFB

HOWITZER Ho
Gune

MORTAR

(larger

DUAL- PURPOSE GUN (HIGH-ANGLE GUN)


Ka High-Angle Kaku Gun H

BATTALION (INFANTRY) GUN


Dal Tai Unit
I

'p I
A Multi-Sized Hei Sha Low-Trajectory

Large-Size

Gun
I

Is
Tai

Ii~
Gun Ho" Gun

REGIMENTAL GUN

Ren

Unit

INFANTRY CANNON
Ho Infantry Hei

MORTAR
KyIi
Ho

Mortar

RIFLED MORTAR
Jhz

Sen

Ky7

______

Rifling

Mortar
(Continued on next page)

/
~ ~ ~'CANNON ~
".,:..

GUN
//

HOWITZER
MORTAR Gun (larger

i1~
Kei
Light

_LIGHT

Haku

-Geki
Gun

Ho

TRENCH MORTAR

Close-Quarters (Attack)

HEAVY
Ji7
.4

Haku

Geki
t

TRENCH MORTAR Gun

Heavy

Close-Quarters (Attack)

Kyoku
High-Angle

Sha
4

Ho
Infantry

He)

Ii~i
4

Ha

INFANTRY MORTAR (81 mm)

Fire

Gun

ANTIAIRCRAFT
Tai
Anti

Ku
Aircraft

Ko
High Angle (Elevation)

Sha
Gun

Ho

GUN

Tai
Anti

Sen

Sha

Iio
Gun
Ho

ANTITANK GUN

Tank

K.

ANTIAI RCRAFT Ki Sh
Kn

Ko
High Angle (Elevation)

MACHINE CANNON

Machine-Firing

Large-Size Gun (Cannon)__________________

GUN CANNON
Ho Gun (larger
a~re tMan Ju)

MORTARR

~
I Do

ANTIAIRCRAFT MOBILE GUN

KJ

Sha

Mobile

High-Angle (Elevation)

Gun

I4 1iir
Ko

Feb
Ko Sha Ho

ANTIAI RCRAFT
FIXED GUN

Tei

Fixed

High-Angle (Elevation)

Gun

"POM-POM" GUN MACHINE CANNON


Ki Kan

Machine-Firing

Large-Sized Gun (Cannon)

Cho

Sha

Tei

IiTj
Gun

LONG-RANGE FIELD GUN


Ho

Long

Range

n____Ji
Do Sha Ken

TRACTOR DRAWN ARTILLERY


Ho

Self-Powered

Vehicle

With Traction (Carrying a)

Yo

Sgai

Ho

FORTRESS HEAVY ARTILLERY

Fortress

Heavy

Gun

ROCKET GUN
Fun

Shin

Dan Shell

Ho Gun Gun

Spitting Out-(as it)-Advances Rocket

PROPELLANT CHARGE
So Yaku

"
Ten Ignition Ka Yaku Powder

PRIMING POWDER

(IGNITER)

BOOSTER CHARGE
Den Booster K Yaku Powder

B l
Ko A Shu Grade 4 Shi

O
Rei 0

L
Ga Gram

IS
Den

lA-GRADE,
Ka Yaku Powder

40 GRAM,
BOOSTER CHARGE

Booster

Note: Explosion Burst is: "Sakurotsu" (Example, shrapnel) Saku (Abbrev.) Explosive Burst Yaku Powder

EXPLOSIVE BURSTING CHARGE

TTV I I ~ I ABURSTING
Cha TNT Katsu Saku (Bursting) Yaku Powder

CHARGE

AMMUNITION (GENERAL)
Dan
Ammunition

Yaku

(Continued on next page)

EXPLOSIVES
Yaku

Powder

6
Sen K Ryue Explosive Dan Shell Saku Bursting Yaku~z Powder Used to Perforate Armor Plate

HOLLOW CHARGE AMMUNITION

ti.Z
Ji
1 5 Go Sanchi Centimeter

h
Ka

WS

Non

Dan Ammunition

Yaku

15

GM ICANONR

sAMMUNITON

FOR

Cannon

SMOKELESS POWDER
M4
Mu

En
En

Ka Gun
I

Yaku Powder
4

Smokeless
I

Dai
Dai
Large

Ryt Ya
Ryu
Grain

Yaku

LARGE-GRAINED POWDER
,,

Powder

FINE-GRAINED POWDER
Small Grain Powder

BROWN (COLORED) POWDER


Kas Brown Shoku Color

Yaku
Powder

GUN POWDER

6b% tPOWDER
Koku
Black

BLACK (COLORED)
GUN POWDER

Shoku
Color

Yaku
Powder

(Continued on next page)

Sh?

Ilt
f

NITRO-POWDER
Yaku
Powder

Ka

Nitro

|
Chu
Medium (Size)

>l
Kei

^i
Ryui
Flake

;
Yaku
Powder

MEDIUM SIZE
SQUARE FLAKE

Ho
Square

POWDER

STRIP POWDER
Tai Jo

Ka
Gun
i,-

Yaku

Band-Shaped

Powder
p

NOTE: To indicate the more modern varieties of military high explosives, the Japanese have selected arbitrary symbols or characters which are used as a sort of code. There are no known English equivalents for these symbols, and therefore no English words were placed under the characters as has been done in other tables in this outline.

SI

!
Sho

>

4f

(CH2)3 (N.
U Yaku

NO2)3

CYCLONITE (EQUIVALENT TO RDX OR HEXYL)

SSr HTNT
S|
Cha Katsu Yaku

C6H2CH 3 (N02) 3
Powder

(TRINITROTOLUOL)

Brown

*
An

E!
Ga

AC.
Yaku

CYCLONITE NITROGUANIDINE ISTHE CHEMICAL ("GUNIGIN," TR) NITROGUANIDIN C. NHN. 2 NH.NH2NITROGUANIDINEAMMONIUM NHNO NH.NH2 NITRATE
(Continued on next page)

~
jat
/~

'~'

~EXPLOSIVES

C6H-2

(N0 2)4 NCH 3

TETRYL

't

C(CH 2 0N02)4

PETN

(PENTAERYTHRITE
TETRANITRATE)

Ak;iy
"

.'f

NH4

0104

CnH~n-2

H2N.C

5[[~SE:

CYCLONITE (NH) NH 2 HNO3

AMMONIUM PERCHLORATE (MIXTURE)


CYCLONITE

COH2 (0C H5) (N02)3

TRINITROP'HENETOL

r NeiYak HeiA

'Iii.

SEE: (Nx

NT

AMTOLUO

5En To Yaku

KI

POTASSIUM

CLRT

14C
Yellow Color

C6H2 (N02)3 OH
Shoku

PICRIC ACID

YakuL Ko

Powder

SEE: PICRIC ACID AND TNT

AI TNTI

(Continued on next page.


32

~''~

/EXPLOSIVES

'<

,j

-~SEE:

BOTH COMPOUNDS

PICRIC ACID

SEE: PICRIC ACID

PARCAFI

Jj jjjj
JIL

C 10

oH (N02)2
6
-

DINITRONAPHTALENE
NH4NO. NH4 NO3

C~oHNOCHEDDITE (NITRONAPHTALENE KCIO 8 POTASSIUM CHLORIDE)

HgC N:O:FULMINATE p ~3J3HgC22O2(DETONATOR)


Kai K

OF MERCURY

HgC2N2O2
Baku Fun

FULMINATE OF MERCURY

KCIO3s

Sb2S 3

POTASSIUM CHLORATE ANTIMONY SULFIDE

Pb(N
Chik Ka En

Pb(N3)2LEAD
3

AZIDE

)2(DETONATOR)

JAPANESE NUMERALS TYPE 99


0
1 2 3

Q
-

Rei

JLJ)L
Kujuku

~ ~
-

Ichi Ni San

Shiki

4 5 6 7

[7LShi G
L

99 TYPE 1

MODEL

Roku Hichi

8
Ichi Shiki 9
10

A
1tKu

Hachi

MODEL ONE 11th Year TYPE

ti
Ji ichi

11

12
13

-~1.
Ju ichi Nen Shiki

t iii tu

Ju n
Jsan

11th

Year

MODEL
17
18

19 20 30 40
50jj 100 1000 10,000

tf t t

-1t
I

Ju shicki

Iii hachi
ftki

t tSan IL t L

Ni j j Shi ju
Go ji Hyaku Sen

-h'

71Man

100,000
1,0001000

75Jzu
75

man
Haku man

ERAS
TIME PERIODS DURING TIME DURING REIGN OF THREE RECENT EMPERORS NAMES

NAMES

CALENDAR

DATES OF ERAS CALENDAR DATES OF ERAS

j IiJ
Mei Ji

MEIJI ERA

1868 TO 1912 INCLUSIVE

kE
Tai Sbo

TAISHO ERA

1912 TO 1926 INCLUSIVE

UJ

1i
ShA Wa

SHOWA ERA

1926 TO PRESENT TIME

There Are Three Ditferent Dates for the Following:

h
JI 10th Nen Year

10th YEAR

10th Year
MEIJI ERA 1867

10
Mei Ji Ju Nen

Meiji (Era)

10th

Year

1877

Tai

Sho

Ju

Nen

Taisbo (Era)

10th

Year

1 10th Year SHOWA ERA 1925


10

Sho

Wa

Ju

Nen

Showa (Era)

10th

Year

1935

Month
Getsu

The first month of the Japanese year is January and the twelfth month is December, the same as in our calendar system.
10th

t
Ju
Getsu
Month

OCTOBER

REFERENCE LINE NUMBER

THESE ARE USED IN PRINTED TEXT FOR ABBREVIATIONS ON CANS OR DRUMS. SEE PAGE 38.

ENGLISH

TRANSLATION

1
Ki Volatile Hatsu Oil Yu

GASOLINE (KANJI)

2
Rin

GASOLINE (KANA)

Ga

So

IB

i ~Ud
Pu
Ordinary

ORDINARY GASOLINE
Ki
Volatile

Tsu

Hatsu
Oil

Yu

4
Toku Shu

4j
Ki Hatsu

l
Yu

SPECIAL GASOLINE

Special

Volatile

Oil

5
Bun Distilled
Ryu Ki Hatsu

GASOLINE l"CRACKING PROCESS"


Yu Oil

FROM

(FRACTIONAL DISTILLATION)

Volatile

7kLJI
Ka Ku Ki Ki Hatsu Yu

AVIATION GASOLINE
Aviation Volatile Oil
(Continued on next page)

'411
Oil
REFERENCE NMER THESE ARE USED IN PRINTED TEXT FOR ABBREVIATIONS ON CANS OR DRUMS. SEE PAGE 38.

UBFUEL O

GASOLINEILS

ENGLISH TRANSLATION

Jiji 4 f4 ;[j
Gen Rjo Ku Hatsu

jj
Yu Oil

ADDING

TETRA-ETHYL-LEAD)

Raw Material

Volatile

KEROSENE

9'
________

"
Lubricating Oil

LUBRICATING OIL

10i'
10
Light
Lubricating 11
Katsu
___________Heavy

i
Oil
i
YuOil

LUBRICATING OIL

LIGHT

LUBRICATING

HEAVY

OIL

Lubricating

12

9\
Pa

2 1
Ra Pin

41
Oil

PARAFFIN OIL
(Continued on next page)

15.11LUBRICATING
Oil

~ItIIGASOLINE

FUEL OILS

OILS

REFERENCE NMER

THESE ARE USED IN PRINTED TEXT FOR ABBREVIATIONS ON CANS OR DRUMS. SEE PAGE 38.

ENGLISH TRANSLATION

13
Nai Internal Eu Oil Yu

INTERNAL

(ENGINE) OIL

14
.Extfernal

EXTERNAL Oil

(GEAR) OIL

15

1% bi#I4Ii {
Nen

FUEL OIL

Ry~

Yu

Fuel

Oil

16

gY. Hi

I)II)I
Ma Castor-Bean

71

(I
Shi Oil

CASTOR OIL
YU

17

1IJr1EI
K5 YU

MINERAL

OIL

Mineral

Oil
(Continued on next page)

GASOLINE
LUBRICATING OILS FUEL OILS OIil
Yu

ABBREVIATED JAPANESE MARKINGS USED ON GAS AND OIL DRUMS

ABBREVIATED JAPANESE MARKINGS USED ON GAS AND OIL DRUMS

2 K 1

or

2
1 SE KI or P

No. 2 Gasoline Note: Abbreviation "KI" is derived from KIHATSUYU (Gasoline)

Abbreviation: SEKI YU (Kerosene) No. 1 Kerosene

FU KI 3

or

I 10

KEI YU

or

Note: Abbreviation FUTSU (Ordinary)

Abbreviation: KEIKATSU YU Light Oil

1 JU TT
4

91 G 11 Abbreviation: JUKATSU No. 1 Heavy Oil

Toku Special 91-Octane Gasoline

BUN 80 5

or

80 CG 13 ichi Nai

Abbreviation: BUNRYU (Distilled) 9 0-Octane Cracked-Gasoline

Abbreviation: NAI BU No. 1 Internal Oil

KU 90 KI
6

or

A 90 G 14 ichi Gai

Abbreviation: KOKUKI (Aviation) 90-Octane Aviation Gasoline

Abbreviation: GAIBU No. 1 External Oil

KU 87 GEN KI
7 -

or

G 87 B
*Numbers correspond to those in preceding table. (Key Character "Yu")

Abbreviation: GENRYO and KOKUKI 87-Octane Aviation Base-Gasoline

PRIMER
Baku Explosive Tube To

SHELL CASE
Yaku TO Tube Case

Powder

CARTRIDGE: CASE . PRIMER


Yaku
Cartridge

Kyo
Case

Baku
Explosive Tube

To

BANGALORE TORPEDO
Ha Demolition Kai Tube

To

BANGALORE TORPEDO
Baku Yaku Tube To Explosive-Powder

p
Teki Grenade Dan T3 Tube

GRENADE DISCHARGER

(Continued on next page)

43-J
9 .GRENADE

SHELL CASE BANGALORE TORPEDO


DISCHARGER

ToI
Tube (Shaped Container)A

COMPLETE ROUND

As'
Dan Yaks
Artillery Shell (Complete)

fl
T3
Tube

COMPLETE

ROUND

[ItiJ
Ryfl High Explosive Dan Dan Yakue
k

COMPLETE ROUND
HE SHELL

TJ Tube

Artillery Shell (Complete)

xgF

xpoive41

iIi,
Walking Zo
m 1I

Ho

Hie
He;

INFANTRY

Troops

ORDANCE
Hei
I IJ I I Ir I I '

Manufacture (Arms) for Troops

ENGINEERS
Hei
Construction
mimi -

Troops
I

CAVALRY
Ki
Horse

Hei Troops
I

-*

;Hei
Ho
Gun

ARTILLERY

Hei Troops

___

iLIGHT
Ho
Gun

ARTILLERY
Hei
Troops (Continued on next page)

Kei
Light

-SERVICE

/DIVISION

Hei

Troo ps

HEAVY ARTILLERY
Heavy Gun Troops

FIELD ARTILLERY
Ya
Field
.. ....

Sen
Warfare
p

Ho
Gun
. ..

Hei
Troops

COAST ARTILLERY
Kai Gan Hei

Sea

Coast

Gun

Troops

MECHANICALLY-DRAWN ARTILLERY

Ji
Self-Moving

Do

Sha Vehicle

Ken Tractioned

In Gun

Ho

Hei Troops

SELF-PROPELLED ARTILLERY
Ju Self-Moving
D

Ho

Hei Troops

Gun

b
H5 Hei

HORSE-DRAWN ARTILLERY
Gun Troops
(Continued on next page)

Horse (drawn)

ANTIAI RCRAFT
ARTILLERY
K
High

A
Angle

Sha
Gun

T
Troops

Hei

DIVISIONAL ARTILLERY
Shi Division Dan Gun H$ Hei Troops

ARMY AIR
Riku
Land
m m I

Gun
Unit

Ko
Air

Ki
I

Hei
Troops

SERVICE

Ka

iKa U1 Gaku
Gakue
Sen
Warfare

CHEMICAL WARFARE SERVICE


Hei

Chemistry

Troops

I:1

I'

I----

'F'
Small

0IN4,16
Ka Fire Hei
Troop (Branch)

SMALL ARMS

SMe

(Continued on next page)

SERVICE
//
,//1/

DIVISION
Hei'

Troops

~JL

ARMY AND NAVY


UNITS

Gun

Unit

ARMY
Gun

Riku Land
1

Unit

NAVY
Kai Sea Gun Unit

AIR FORCES
Ku Air Gun UnitJ_______________

LAND MINE
Ji
Land

Rai
Mine

WATER MINE
Sui
Water Mine

Rai

m
Shoku Contact Hatsu Land Ji Rai Mine

LAND-MINE

CONTACT

Vuh Furu

*
Sha
-

ANTITANK MINE
Ji
Land

Sen Tank

Rai
Mine

If'
Tes Iron Sen Wire Kei Tripping Tei Purpose Rai Mine

TRIP-WIRE

MINE

1a
Ji
Self-Acting

Ji
fi

Rai
Rai

CLOCK-WORK MINE

Hatsu Land

Mine (Continued on next page)

Baku
________________Explosive

Rai
Mine

MINE DEMOLITION

Fu
Floating,

FLOATING MINE
Yu Sui Rai
Mine

Wafer

TORPEDO (Aerial)
Ku Rai

Air

Mine

___

II

Ki

Kan

5~tt~
Gun

MACHINE GUN

Machine

LIGHT
Kei
Light

Ki
Machine

Kan
Gun

Ju

MACHINE GUN

HEAVY
Aft

MACHINE GUN Ki Kan


----~--~---

Heavy

Machine

Gun

MACHINE GUN Ko Tei Ki Kan

FIXED

J
Gun

Fixed

Machine

AFLEXIBLE

MACHINE GUN

Ja
Flexible

Nan

Ki Machine

Kan Gun

Ji

t
h El
Ko High-Angle Sha Ki Machine Kan Gun

ANTIAIRCRAFT MACHINE GUN

Ju

(Continued on next page)

MACHINE GUN

AUTOMATIC

RIFLE

PISTOL
Dimesiu Gun (Smaller
RIFLE

~than "Ho")

RIFLE
Sho
GunJ

Small

Gun

AUTOMATIC RIFLE
Ji Self-Acting Do Gun J

PISTOL
Ken Hand-Operated Gun

CARBINE
Ki Horse (Cavalry) Gun ]u

i
Ryu Dan

ARTILLERY A SHELL
Shell

(Type used for Artillery) H.E.

4
Toku Shu Ho Dan

SPECIAL
SHELL
Gun-Shell

Special

COMMON
]in Common

Jo

Ryu

Dan

High Explosive Shell

EXPERIMENTAL SHELL
Shi Experimental Sei Dan

Shell

q
Dai Ko

e Kei

4
Ho

1
Gun-Shell

e
Dan

LARGE CALIBER

Large

Caliber

PA

KUwy
________________________________________________________________________

HIGH-EXPLOSIVE SHELL
a
Ryu Dan

Hiqh

Explosive Shell
(Continued on next page)

f,7

ii

ARTILLERY

SHELL
/

Ryu

Dan

pI

Ry
Ei K5

R Dan
Dan

HE SHELL WITH LIGHT-TRACER

Ryi

Tracer (with) Light

HE Shell

O(for
Ku Ni Shiki Ho Ryi Dan

TYPE 92nHESHELL
Infantry)
HE Shell

Type

Infantry

A"Abb
LONG-POINTED (Streamlined) SHELL
Sen Come to a Sharp Point
_ 4___

Dan

Shell
U

_,

fg

GAS SHELL
Dan

-Gas

Shell

7~f~h BSHELL
Sen Pierce Through Ko Armor Plate Ryu Shell

HI
Dan

~HOLLOW

CHARGE

Dan
Sb

INCENDIARY SHELL

~----------Shell

Dan

Incendiary

(Continued on next page)

5Is
S
Ryu Dan

ARTILLERY

SHELL

111
Mei Glare Dan Shell

(Illuminating)

,STAR SHELL

Sho Brilliant

SMOKE SHELL
Hatsu Emit En
Smoke

Dan Shell

4r
Ko
| i_-

"ANTIAIRCRAFT

_H

'
Ei Dan Shell

POINTED SHELL

Sha

Sen Pointed
F

High-Angle (Fire)

Ha Pierce
-e

Ff1
Armor-plate
F~h

ARMOR-PIERCING HE SHELL
Ryu HE Shell
U

Dan
I'

Tek is an abbreviation of Tekkyo (Remove)


ml

AP STEEL SHELL (AP Shot)


Tek Remove, Destroy Armor-plate
4

Dan Shell
9

qIng
B3
Armor-piercing

AP SHELL WITH HARDENED CAP


Dan Shell
(Continued on next page)

Cap

S~

N"

ARTILLERY SHELL

Ryu

Dan
/ I~

Ko Semi

' 1
Sei Steel
II

1|SHELL
Sen Ryu Shell Dan

SEMI-STEEL

DRAWN-STEEL SHELL
Tan Forge
V

Ko Steel
I

Rya Shell

Dan
I

Ken

Tetsu

Dan
Dan

CHILLED STEEL (AP) SHELL

Chilled Steel

Shell

Ho

F J
Tj
Use

j
Y

PROJECTILE
Non Dan
PDfCANNON Projectile

Ka

Gan

FOR

Gun-Turret

un____ Cannon

USE

San Ryu
High-explosive
San

SHRAPNEL
Dan

Case

Shell

(Finned Shell) MORTAR SHELL


Yu

Yoku Wings

Dan

SThis is an exception to the general rule that key characters are terminal characters.

Possessing

Shell
(Continued on next page)

Shaku

>'

~
/I/

~'/

ARTILLERY
SHELL
/7uDa

itp
Rifle
f

Ere
Ryi Dan
4,

RIFLE GRENADE

Grenade

Netsu
1* t

Teki

THERMITE GRENADE
Dan

Intense

Heat (Red hot)

Grenade

POTATO-MASHER TYPE HAND-GRENADE


E Tsuki Shu Ryu Dan

Stick-Hand

Hand

Grenade

BALL

AMMUNITION
jitsu

Dan

Solid

Ammunition

PROJECTILE
Dan
Shell

Gan
Body (Form)
________________

This is an exception to the general rule that key characters are terminal characters.

TABLE No. 13
PRELIMINARY DESCRIPTION
JAPANESE AIRPLANE BOMBS AND THEIR MARKINGS
SLAND 1
Riku

. Baku Bomb

Dan

BOMB (Thin-cased HE-GP Bomb) Demoliion Blast

Land-Use

2
Tsu

ORDINARY BOMB (Heavy-cased HE-GP Bomb)

Jo

Baku

Dan

Demolition SAP

General Purpose

Bomb

SPECIAL PURPOSE 1BOMB


Toku
Special Kind

Shu

Baku
Bomb

Dan

14 Types (Mark No. Series)

Group 3, or Special Purpose Bombs, is by far the most important, being composed of a diversified list ranging from chemical bombs to rocket and incendiary bombs. Although there are 26 types of Special Purpose Bombs listed with mark numbers in Japanese ordnance catalogs, there are but 14 known types in actual use and some of these are advanced only to the experimental stage. While the Japanese characters "Baku Dan" (airplane bomb) appear on all aerial bombs, or their shipping cases, the characters for "mark" number appear only on Special Purpose Bombs, and just preceding "Baku Dan." Look first for the character "mark" and its number. If "mark" is present, then the number following it describes the type (through reference to Table No. 13).

f
Go Mark 2 Ni

MARK-2
Baku Dan

BOMB Airplane Bomb

When the ideograph for ."mark" is absent, look for "Baku Dan." The characters preceding it will describe whether it is a Land Bomb or an Ordinary (General Purpose) Bomb. These are set forth in Table No. 18.

S
Go

Meaning is: MARK (Number)

On "Special Series" bombs a number follows this character to indicate the type as follows:
Mark No. Type of Bomb

Mark No. 1 .....


2 ..... 3 .....
4.....

Type of Bomb .Gas, chemical Antisubmarine Incendiary Rocket Armor-Piercing Magnesium Incendiary and Oil Incendiary . Unknown . . .. .. .
. Unclassified

5 .....
6 . ....

7 ..... 8 .....
9.....

14 .............. . Unclassified 15............. 16............. 17 ............. 18............. 19 ............. 20 ............. 21............. . Cluster, Airdrome .. Stick Cluster 22.............
23........ ..... .Long-delay

10..... 11 .... 12 ..... 13.....

24 ............. . Parachute 25 ............. . Parachute Cluster 26 ............. . Above Ground

(Continued on next page)

NUMBER 6

Roku

Ban

The Japanese have several common weights for airplane bombs.

Examples: 30 Kg.; 60

Kg.; 250 Kg.; 700 Kg.;

800

Kg.
In the example illustrated,

The preceding character indicates the weight of the bomb.

Roku Ban means number 6. Multiply the 6 by 10, and the result is the weight of the bomb in

kilograms. (60 kg.)

Meaning is: DESIGN NUMBER (so-and-so)


Kata

Meaning is: MODEL

(so-and-so)
Shiki

Note: The Japanese characters on this page are related to markings

found only on JAPANESE AIRPLAN E BOMB3S.

A
//TABLES

METRIC

Sanchi7

CENTIMETER
Sanchi

MILLIMETER
Miri Mi Ri

~
t

GRAM

(15.432 grains)

Guramu

~
Byo
_ _

1 SECOND
_ _ _ _ _ _

AKILOGRAM
(2.2 lbs.)
Kilo 1. K. 205 = 1.205 Kg.

1 LITER (1.7607 pints)


Rittoru

i F
Deka Rittoru

DECALITER 1

(2.2008 gallons)

1 POUND (120.96 momme)


Pondo
(Continued on next page)

~'I

%"~ ~4

J~j~
Fm'
Sanchi

METRIC

TABLES

iAIRCRAFT _V
K5 Flying (in) Air Ku Machine 1 Ki

Riku Land

Gun Branch (Flying) Machine

Ki

7I
I
Kai Sea Gun Branch (Flying) Machine Ki

NAVY PLANE

" Riki Land Jo Best (Use) (Flying) Machine

-PLANE
Ki

LAND

,5
Sui Sea Best (Use) (Flying) Machine

SEA PLANE

1
Rai Water Mine 2 Geki Attack 3

TORPEDO I lAIRPLANE
Ki (Flying) Machine
(Continued on next page)

s5_
Armor

ARMORED AIRCRAFT
Ka

Hi Flight

Ko
(Flying) Machine

Plated

BOMBING AIRPLANE
Bomb 4 Attack (Flying) Machine

BOMB
Baku Bomb 4 Geki Attack 3 Sho Jun (Flying) Machine Ki

Sighting Device (For a)

FOOTNOTES TO TABLE 15
Abbreviations reference

Ki

Ni

MACHINE
Kio Air Rai Mine

TORPEDO

Aerial

Kai

Machine

ATTACK
Baku
Ko Geki
Baku Dan

ADan RPLANE

BOMB

IRON
Tetsu
Iron

b KJ Steel

STEEL Tetsu

~L~1"JBRASS
Yellow Copper
____________

~n
_________ Copper

COPPER
___________

R
Sei
Bluish

&'J
ILed

BRONZE
D
______ ______

Copper

LEAD
Namari

(Continued on next page)

11
Go

1
Kin

ALLOY

Compound Metal

CAST IRON
Chu Tetsu Iron

Cast

CHROMIUM STEEL
Ku Ro Ma Ko Tetsu Chromium Steel

SEMI-STEEL
Ko Sei Sen
Steel with Steel-type pig-iron

DRAWN STEEL
Tan Forged Ko Steel
*

CHILLED STEEL
Ken SKo is an-abbreviation of KoTetsu (steel) Chilled Tetsu Steel (Continued on next page)

CAST STEEL
Chu'
Cast
Ko

Steel
*

Sf
GO
. ..

ALLOY STEEL
Ko Steel

Kin
. .

Compound Metal
*

STEEL PLATE Ke
Steel Bau Plate

ZINC
A Lead * Ko is an abbreviation of KoTetsu (steel) En

Jt~II
Dan Projectile Head

TXShin

n3I~SNOSE
Kan Tube (Fuze)
_____________

FUZE

Communicating

BASE
Dan Projectile Tei Base Shin Fuze Kan

FUZE

Iris
Ei Slow-moving Fire Ka Shin Fuze Kan

TIME FUZE

Chaku Arrival
-

Hatsu Departure

jfa"
Shin
i

PERCUSSION FUZE
Kan

Fuze

Fuku Double-Motion
-I-,

D
I

Shin Fuze

K an
I

COMBINATION FUZE (Time and Percussion)

INSTANTANEOUS FUZE
Shu
4

Matsu Depart (Fire)

Shin lnstantaneous

Kan Fuze

Instant

Ta Short-time hKi Late-Period

finFUZE
Shin Fuze Kan

SHORT-DELAY

(Cotinued on next page).

MEM'K

FUZE

POWDER
A Pipe or

TRAIN

-~

5*~'z
UNFUZED
1

Shin

Kan

Without

Fuze

FO~
Baku.

I+rii
Dan Shin

I
Kan

BOMB FUZE

Airplane
_ __

Bomb

Fuze
_

FUZE

~
Baku Retsu Shin Kan

DETONATING

Explosive (Force)

Fuze

4
Ka Do Shin Klan

POWDER' TRAIN

(of a Fuze) Fire-Road (Powder Train) Fuze

K~lL
Yaku Ban

1F
Fuze

I~jTIME aTRAIN
(of Fuze)
Kan

Shin

Powder-Block

PERCUSSION CAP
Rai Kan

(of a Cartridge)

Detonating

Tube (Cap)

PRIMER CAP
Bak Explosive Kan Tube (Cap)
_____________

__
Riku For (Land) Use (the) Best Jo

R
Baku Explosive Dan Shell

LAND BOMB

41* I
Tsu
Known as Regular (Standard)

LKEL
GENERAL
Jo Baku
Bomb

Dan

PURPOSE (HE) (Ordinary) BOMB

SPECIAL

PURPOSE
Toku
Special

Shu
Kind (of)

Baku
Bomb

Dan

BOMB

19
Sho
Incendiary-

_
Baku
Bomb

INCENDIARY
(Airplane)

I
Use

Yo

Dan

1120

RM2
Dan

PHOSPHORUS BOMB

Rin
-I

Baku Bomb

Phosphorus

'

bk 45~
WP-Ka En Baku
Bomb

LIQUID
Dan

FLAME

BOMB

Fire-Flame

(Continued on next page)

$% ,1!
Baku Dan Shell

AIRPLANE.
BOMBS

Explosive

(Bomb)

hJ~~
Sai (Into) Smallest
I

FRAGMENTATION' BOMB
I
-

Baku Pieces
I

Dan

Bomb

hJ~~
Ga
Gas

GAS BOMB

Su

Baku Bomb

Dan

DEMOLITION BOMB
Baku Explosive Ha Demoltion Yo Use Baku Bomb Dan

PU ARMOR-PIERCING BOMB
Ha Pierce

Ke3
Armor

Baku Bomb

Dan

~ *
Gi Baku Abbrev. for Gi Sei (Dummy) Bomb

Ji~i
Dan

DUMMY BOMB

Ha Demolition

Kai

Gi Dummy

Sei

U-

- S-

FACTORY Sei Made in Z5 Work Sho Plant

im' h
Sho Small Rifle

Jo

SMALL ARMS FACTORY


Sei Zo Work Sho Plant MP~VV B EfB

Made in

POWDER FACTORY

Ka
Fire (Gun)

Yaku
Powder

Sei

Zo

Sho

(Made in) Manufacturing Plant

KJ
Work

ARSENAL WORKSHOP
Sho

Shop

-~

ARSENAL
Gun K3
Work

ARMY

Riku
Land

Sho
Shop
___________

Branch

ARSENAL
Zo Manufacture (Arms for)
1

Hei Troops

Sho Shop

4
Gun KJ Arsenal Sho

Kure Kure

Kai Naval

THE NAVAL ARSENAL AT KURE

SECTION THREE
PRACTICAL READING AND TRANSLATION OF JAPANESE CHARACTERS

JAPANESE

W MA
AN AMMUNITION BOX
Start at left top corner and read down.

TAG WITHIN

Dan

AMMUNITION

Ni

TYPE 2

To

AIRCRAFT

TOKYO

I
Ku

Table 5
Yaku
Table 4

Shiki

Kyo

Table 15
Ki

IIa
Sho

SHOWA 18th YEAR

Ei

LIGHT TRACER

Wa
Ko

Riku

ARMY

rn

20 MM

1943
AP

Table 10
Gun

Ha

SHELL

A
Hachi

K~i

Zo

ARSENAL Table 2

Metric Table 14
Nen

Table 6
Dan

He:

Aqu Dan

Table 20
Sho

AMMO.

111J
Kan

POM-POM GUN ii

NOVEMBER

~
Yaku

Table 4
COMPLETE ROUND Table 8

l 1
i!1
Sei FACTORY

Table 3

GIi
Getsu

Table 7
TT,

Sho

Table 19

Note: The Japanese characters on this page were copied direct from tags within ammunition boxes that had been captured in the Philippines.

iy i f

(P

i.

JAPANESE

MARKINGS

ON AN AIRPLANE BOMB

LA
Ichi
(No.) One

TYPE 1
Ichi
(No.) One

...

(1941)
1
1

MODEL

Shiki
Type

Ichi
(No.) One

Kata
Model

Kai
Modification

MODIFICATIN

* * Indicates KEY CHARACTERS that appear on bombs.


(Reference to Table 13)

L1ASS'IFIED

t IWD
JAPANESE MARKINGS ON A HEAVY GUN

Japanese 150 mm Howitzer

Inscriptions on Weapon

After transposing characters, left to right.

Ku

Roku

Shiki

Ju

Go

Sanchi

Ryu

Dan

Po

TYPE 96

15 CENTIMETER

HOWITZER

Sho

Wa

Ju

Go

Nen

Saka

Ke

Sho

SHOWA

15th YEAR (1940)

OSAKA

ARSENAL

'.I r

JAPANESE MARKINGS USED TO INDICATE ARSENALS


The following are the markings found on ordnance items, such as Cannon and Artillery Shells, and represent Japanese Arsenals.

SYMBOL

JAPANESE ARSENAL OR MANUFACTURING PLANT

Kokura Arsenal

Tokyo Arsenal

G p

Gas and Electric Co.

Nagoya Arsenal

1Heijo Arsenal

Osaka Arsenal

Chiyoda Arsenal

South Arsenal

Tokyo Explosives Factory

75

/;JAPANESE Lti SA TERMS

TRAJECTORY
Dan Do

BALLISTICS
Dan Do Gaku

Sai

I~ +
Sha
Dai

MINIMUM

RANGE

Sha

Tei

MAXIMUM RANGE
Sai Sha T ei

MUZZLE VELOCITY
Sho Soku

~1 u
Sha

I~JELEVATION
ANGLE OF
Kaku

DEGREES OF
__ _ __ _ _ _

Gy3

Do

'I..,PER
Mei

~iJ~

METERS

SECOND

Toru

Mai

By3

_______________

u u,

JAPANESE BALLIS
(Continued)

TERMS

TIME OF FLIGHT
Kei Ka

Ji

Kan

HIGH VELOCITY
KJ Soku Do

LOW VELOCITY
Tei
Soku Do

STRIKING VELOCITY
Mei

Chuz7

Soku

Do

AZIMUTH
Hai
I

Ka

Ku
I

LAYING
(of a gun)
Sho

fun

Ii
Kei KJ

~
Kei

DIAMETER OF BORE
LENGTH OF BORE
Cho

<~i~

OF JAPANESE ORDNANCE ITEMS

SUBJECT

TABLE NUMBER

SUBJECT

TABLE NUMBER

Aircraft................................... Airplane Bombs..........................13, Ammunition .............................. Arsenal.............2 Artillery Shells ........................... Automatic Rifle........................... Bangalore Torpedo.......................
Bombs.....................................13,

15 18 4 12 11 8
18

Machine Guns

.................... .........

11

Mark Number (Bombs)................


Metals...

13
16

...... .............................

Metric Terms............................. 14 Mines ................ .......... 10 Model (Type) ........................... 5 Month...................................... .6 Mortars.................................... Oils... ..................................... Organization. 3 7

Bullets ...................................... Cannon ..................................... Caps (Fuze)..............................


Carbine

2 3 17 1

.................... ..... 9 Pistol ....................................... 11 Powder Trains........................... Primers .. ,................. Rifles...........:............................ Rocket ...................................... Service Branch.................. Shells ....................................... Shell Case ................................. Tanks........................................ Torpedo (Air) ........................... Tractor..................................... Trains (Explosive).......................
Trucks......................................

Cars.................. ........... ..

......................................

1
8 4

17 11 2
12

Complete Round........................... Explosives................... Factory...................................... Fuel Oils..................................


Fuzes

19
7
17

................. ................

r.....

Gasolines....................

8 1 10 11 .17 1 1
6

Grenades .....................
Grenade Launcher ....................... 8 Guns......................................... 3 Hand Grenades ........................... 2 Hollow Charge.......................... 4, 12 Howitzers...................3 Lubricating Oils. ......................... 7

Vehicles......................................
Year...................................

i; a

1kY78 .

ilk 1.6

NOTES

5Um~_~2

Ail

.tom

is

Vv-

You might also like